Brother Printer 1660e User Manual

Brother Laser Printer  
Technical Reference Guide  
<MODELS COVERED BY THIS MANUAL>  
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N  
P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/  
1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
First version  
Ver. A  
August, 1999  
March, 2000  
Created for HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/  
1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C  
Revised for Addition of HL-2400Ce/3400CN  
Ver. B  
Ver. C  
March, 2001  
Revised for Addition of HL-1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
Revised for Addition of HL-1450/1470N  
October, 2001  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
GLOSSARY  
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION  
1. ABOUT THE MANUAL----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3  
2. AREAS OF USE------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4  
CHAPTER 2 PCL  
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 7  
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------10  
3. CONTROLLING THE PRINTER ---------------------------------------------------------------------11  
4. JOB CONTROL-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------15  
5. USING FONTS-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------33  
6. USING GRAPHICS--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------65  
7. MACROS--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------85  
8. STATUS READBACK----------------------------------------------------------------------------------91  
9. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------99  
CHAPTER 3 PCL5C  
1. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3  
2. COLOR MODES----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4  
3. COLOR PALLETS--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------10  
4. COLOR GRAPHICS------------------------------------------------------------------------------------13  
5. ENHANCE OUTPUT------------------------------------------------------------------------------------15  
6. HP-GL/2---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------17  
7. INDEX-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------19  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 GRAPHICS LANGUAGE  
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4  
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6  
3. TERMINOLOGY ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 7  
4. COMMAND SYNTAX ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 9  
5. THE HP-GL GRAPHICS WINDOW -----------------------------------------------------------------10  
6. PREPARING TO PRINT GRAPHIC IMAGES------------------------------------------------------11  
7. COMMANDS---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------12  
8. INDEX-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------52  
CHAPTER 5 PJL PRINTER JOB LANGUAGE  
1. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4  
2. HOW TO USE PJL -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8  
3. COMMAND GROUP------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9  
4. KERNEL COMMANDS---------------------------------------------------------------------------------10  
5. JOB SEPARATION COMMANDS -------------------------------------------------------------------13  
6. ENVIRONMENT COMMANDS------------------------------------------------------------------------15  
7. STATUS READBACK COMMANDS ----------------------------------------------------------------30  
8. DEVICE ATTENDANCE COMMANDS -------------------------------------------------------------45  
9. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------48  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON FX-850  
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3  
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5  
3. EMULATION DETAILS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6  
4. TERMINOLOGY ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 7  
5. CONTROLLING THE PRINTER ---------------------------------------------------------------------- 8  
6. COMMANDS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9  
7. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------30  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER XL  
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3  
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5  
3. EMULATION DETAILS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6  
4. NOTATION USED IN THIS EMULATION DESCRIPTION--------------------------------------- 7  
5. COMMANDS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8  
6. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------21  
CHAPTER 8 BARCODE CONTROL  
1. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 3  
2. PRINT BAR CODES OR EXPANDED CHARACTERS ----------------------------------------- 4  
3. DEFINITION OF PARAMETERS---------------------------------------------------------------------- 5  
4. EXAMPLE PROGRAM LISTINGS--------------------------------------------------------------------10  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL GRAPHICS LANGUAGE  
1. COMMAND LIST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 3  
2. INTRODUCTION----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4  
3. COMMANDS ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6  
4. INDEX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------27  
APPENDIX A COMPARISON LIST  
APPENDIX B FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS  
APPENDIX-C HBP MODE COMMANDS  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000 SERIES UNIQUE  
COMMANDS  
ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GLOSSARY  
Absolute plotting  
A method of plotting in the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphics language where  
coordinates are specified relative to the origin of the coordinate system currently in  
use.  
Anchor point  
The top left-hand corner of the PCL picture frame. You can position this on the  
page using a PCL command.  
Anisotropic scaling  
A form of image scaling using the SC command in HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode in  
which the user units can be of different sizes. Hence the entire graphics window  
can be used to display the image.  
ASCII  
The standard system for assigning number codes (0 ~ 255) to alphabetic, numeric  
and control code characters.  
Attribute  
Bitmap font  
Bold  
A characteristic of a downloadable font or a character of a Downloadable font that  
is represented by a number of a fixed length.  
A font whose characters are defined as raster images. The characters that make  
up a bitmap font are of a fixed size.  
A wider line thickness for typographicalcharacters, used to make the text stand  
out, for example, in headings.  
Calling a macro  
Cartridge  
A way of running a macro in which changes to the modified print environment are  
not retained when the macro has finished running.  
A storage medium that you can insert into the printer cartridge slots. Cartridges  
can store fonts. The advantage of using cartridges is that they allow you to use  
more fonts without taking up printer memory space.  
Cartridge font  
A font that is stored on a cartridge. These are widely available commercially.  
The imaginary grid on which downloadable characters are designed.  
A number assigned to a character that uniquely identifies it.  
Character cell  
Character code  
Character descriptor  
A block of data that describes the characteristics of an individual character in a  
downloadable font, such as its width and height.  
Character set  
A selection of different characters. Characters sets normally include the alphabet  
in both upper- and lowercase, the digits' 0-9, punctuation marks, common  
mathematical symbols and a few other useful characters. There are also some  
specialized character sets that are used for specific applications like mathematics.  
A font is defined as having a particular character set.  
Column  
A vertical sub-division of the page whose width is equal to the HMI (horizontal  
motion index). The print position moves across the page one column width when  
any single character is printed ( in a monospaced font), or when a space character  
is printed ( in a proportionally spaced font). See also HMI.  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Control code  
An ASCII code that tells the computer to perform a particular function, such as a  
carriage return.  
Control panel reset  
Cross-hatching  
Current units  
A reset or factory reset performed using the printer control panel.  
A method of shading using perpendicular diagonal lines that cross one another.  
The current unit type in use in HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode. Current units are either  
user units or graphics units depending on whether an SC command has been used.  
Cursor  
Although the printer does not have a cursor, it is sometimes easier to visualize the  
printer's operation in terms of a cursor that can be moved from place to place on  
the page.  
Cursor position  
Decipoint  
The current position of the imaginary cursor.  
A unit of measure equal to 1/720".  
Default conditions  
A set of HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode settings that you restore using the DF;  
command. The default conditions are a subset of the initial settings.  
Destination image  
Dots  
The graphic image that is already in place on a page and to which the source image  
is applied in the LaserJet series print model.  
A unit of measure equal to 1/600", the smallest increment that the cursor can  
move.  
Downloadable font  
A character font that can be downloaded from your computer to the printer. You  
can either buy Downloadable fonts or create your own. A downloadable font  
consists of a font descriptor block followed by a character code, character  
descriptor block and the data for each character in the font.  
Downloading  
The process of sending either a font, a macro or a graphic image from your  
computer to the printer.  
Effective window  
The area of the page on which HP-GL and HP-GL/2 output can appear. The  
effective window is determined by the overlap of the logical page, the PCL picture  
frame, the hard clip and the soft clip limits.  
Emulation mode  
A mode of operation in which the printer imitates the functions of a different model.  
Enabling a macro for overlay  
A macro that is enabled for overlay runs as the final operation before each page is  
printed, using the macro overlay environment printer settings.  
Escape sequence  
The Esc character followed by a string of other characters that tell the printer  
which operation to perform.  
Factory default environment The collection of printer settings that have been made to the printer before it leaves  
the factory. You can reset the printer to the factory settings either by using a  
printer command or using the control panel.  
Factory reset  
A reset in which LaserJet mode is made the current emulation mode and the  
factory default environment is restored.  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fill  
A shading applied to a shape that you have drawn.  
See monospacing.  
Fixed spacing  
Font  
A collection of characters that are designed to work in harmony together. A font  
has several characteristics that identify it uniquely: character or symbol set,  
spacing, pitch, height or point size, style, stroke weight and typeface. Fonts can  
either be resident in the printer's ROM, installed on cartridge or downloaded from  
your computer. You can either buy downloadable fonts commercially or create  
your own. The word "font" is often wrongly used to mean "typeface". A font is  
confined to a single height or point size whereas a typeface is not.  
Font descriptor  
A block of data that is downloaded to the printer as the first part of a downloaded  
font. The font descriptor describes the characteristics that are common to every  
character in the font, such as stroke weight, and contains other relevant  
information.  
Graphics mode initial settings  
The HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode settings that are in effect when you enter HP-GL  
and HP-GL/2 mode. You can restore the initial conditions using the IN; command.  
Graphics units  
The default units of the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 coordinate system. Also sometimes  
called plotter units.  
Graphics window  
The area on the page in which HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphic images can appear.  
Initially this is the same as the picture frame, but you can change the size, position  
and aspect ratio of the graphics window using the IW command.  
Gray scale  
A degree of continuous shading ranging from 0%, white, to 100%, black.  
Hard clip limits  
The area of the page on which it is physically possible to print using HP-GL and  
HP-GL/2 graphics language commands. The hard clip limits are determined by the  
size of the physical page and are equivalent to the LaserJet mode printable area.  
Hatching  
Height  
A method of shading using parallel lines.  
The height in typographic points (1/72" units) of an unaccented capital letter in a  
font.  
HMI  
Horizontal motion index. The horizontal distance that the print position moves  
across the page when any single character is printed ( in a monospaced font ), or  
when a space character is printed ( in a proportionally spaced font ). You can set  
the HMI using printer commands, however, when you alter any font characteristic  
( in effect, select a new font ) or switch between the primary and secondary fonts,  
the HMI is reset to its default value based on the newly selected font.  
Horizontal plot size  
Internal font  
The original horizontal size of an imported HP-GL and HP-GL/2 image.  
A font that is stored in the printer ROM and is therefore always available for use,  
for example, Brougham 10 pitch, or a font generated from a scalable typeface  
stored in the printer's ROM, for example, Tennessee bold 15 pt.  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Isotropic scaling  
Justification  
A form of image scaling using the SC command in HP-GL or HP-GL/2 mode in  
which the user units must be of equal size. Hence it may not be possible to use the  
entire graphics window to display the image.  
The way in which text is aligned. For example, left justification involves aligning the  
left end of every line of text.  
Label  
A text string that forms part of an HP-GL and HP-GL/2 plot.  
Landscape  
Logical page  
The orientation in which the top edge of the page is longer than the side edges.  
The area of the physical page on which the cursor can be positioned in LaserJet  
mode. You can use PCL commands to specify the position of the logical page on  
the physical page. Also known as the PCL addressable area.  
LSB  
i) The least significant byte of a set of data bytes.  
ii) The least significant bit of a single byte of data.  
Macro  
A sequence of PCL commands that can be stored in the printer memory. To run  
the sequence you need only use a single PCL command.  
Macro execution  
Executing a macro is a way of running a macro whereby any changes made to the  
modified print environment by the macro are retained when macro execution has  
been completed.  
Macro overlay environment Used only by a macro that has been enabled for overlay. A combination of the  
user default environment and the modified print environment.  
Medium  
The line thickness of normal type.  
Modified print environment The collection of all current LaserJet printer settings. This environment is saved if  
you call a macro or enter HP-GL and HP-GL/2 mode, it is restored when the  
macro has finished running or when you quit HP-GL or HP-GL/2 mode.  
Monospacing  
MSB  
Some bitmap fonts are printed with each character occupying the same space on a  
line of text. This is known as monospacing.  
i) The most significant byte of a set of data bytes.  
ii) The most significant bit of a single byte of data.  
Pattern  
i) The hatching or cross-hatching that can be applied to an outline shape.  
ii) The non-white areas of the source image in the LaserJet print model.  
Pattern transparency  
The patterned ( non-white ) areas of the source image are either transparent, in  
which case the destination image is visible through the white parts of the pattern, or  
opaque, in which case the destination image is not visible at all throughout the  
patterned areas of the source image.  
PCL  
Printer Control Language. The language consisting of escape sequences that is  
used to control the printer in LaserJet mode  
PCL addressable area  
PCL picture frame  
See logical page.  
See picture frame.  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pen  
Although this printer is a laser printer the HP-GL/2 and HP-GL graphics languages  
retains the notion of a pen and allows you to select between two pens, white and  
black. You must select a pen before you can draw anything. The HP-GL and HP-  
GL/2 language were originally developed for use with plotters and the terminology  
remains.  
Perforation skip  
A feature whereby the printer automatically compensates for a page break and  
resumes printing from the top of the text area on the next page.  
Permanent font  
Permanent macro  
Physical page  
A downloaded font that is retained when a printer reset is performed.  
A macro stored in the printer that will not be erased if the printer is reset.  
The paper or envelope on which the printer prints.  
Picture frame  
The area of the physical page in which HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphic images can  
be printed.  
Pitch  
Plot  
The number of characters in one inch of text. Only applicable to monospaced  
(fixed pitch fonts.)  
A drawing produced using the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphics language. So called  
because the language was originally invented for use with plotters.  
Plotter units  
Point  
See graphics units.  
The standard unit of measurement for character height. Equal to 1/72".  
Point factor scaling  
A form of image scaling using the SC command in HP-GL or HP-GL/2 mode in  
which the user units and the location of the scaling point P1 are specified in terms  
of graphics units.  
Point size  
See height.  
Polygon  
A shape consisting of one or more closed groups of connected lines.  
Polygon buffer  
An area of printer memory in which you can store one or more polygons and sub-  
polygons defined using HP-GL and HP-GL/2 commands. Some HP-GL and HP-  
GL/2 commands use the polygon buffer automatically.  
Portrait  
The orientation in which the side edges of the page are longer than the top edge.  
A component of a font's style - whether it is upright or italic.  
Posture  
Primary font  
In LaserJet mode the printer maintains two current font settings. The primary font  
is the first of these.  
Print model  
A way of describing the interaction between different graphic elements ( source  
image, pattern and destination image ).  
Printable area  
The area of the page on which the printer can print.  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Print position  
The position from which printing of the next character or graphic object will begin,  
providing that no operations that change the print position are performed in the  
interim.  
viii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Proportional spacing  
Fonts intended for high quality typographic output use a method of character  
spacing in which the space occupied by a single character on a line of text depends  
on the individual design of the character. This is known as proportional spacing.  
Scalable fonts are almost invariably proportionally spaced.  
RAM  
Random Access Memory. The printer's memory in which fonts and macros can be  
stored and where pages that are to be printed are composed.  
Raster graphics  
Relative plotting  
A method of representing a graphic image as a series of zeroes and ones that  
correspond to white and black dots respectively.  
A method of plotting in the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphics language where  
coordinates are specified relative to the point at which the last graphics command  
terminated.  
Reset  
When you reset the printer you restore a base set of conditions. A reset can either  
be performed using the control panel or by sending the printer a reset command.  
There are two types of reset, the normal reset and factory reset. A normal reset  
simply restores the current emulation mode with the most recent control panel  
settings -- it does not change the emulation mode itself. A factory reset makes  
LaserJet mode the current emulation mode and restores the factory default  
environment.  
Resident font  
ROM  
See internal font.  
Read Only Memory. Part of the printer's memory that contains the software  
controlling the printer and the printer internal fonts. The ROM cannot be altered  
unless the type of ROM fitted to the printer is Flash ROM, in which case it can be  
written to electronically via the parallel port of the printer .  
Row  
A horizontal sub-division of the page whose height is equal to the VMI (vertical  
motion index). The print position moves down the page a distance equal to the row  
height when a line feed is performed.  
Sans serif  
A kind of typeface normally used for headlines. Sans serif typefaces do not have  
little hooks (serifs) on the individual characters. This helps Sans serif headline text  
stand out more prominently.  
Scalable fonts  
Scaling  
A font for which you can specify the character size. The printer will automatically  
scale the characters to the size you require.  
In HP-GL or HP-GL/2 mode you can use the SC command to scale graphic  
images. The three types of scaling are known as anisotropic, isotropic and point  
factor scaling.  
Scaling points  
Two imaginary points called P1 and P2 that define a rectangular area relative to the  
picture frame. You can use the HP-GL or HP-GL/2 SC and IP or IR commands to  
transform and scale images by changing the relationship between the two scaling  
points.  
Scalable typeface  
A typeface for which you can choose a point size (height) in order to obtain a  
particular font for printing. For example, you might select the Utah typeface and  
then select 14 pt. as the height. The printer has many resident typefaces. You can  
also buy scalable typeface cartridge and disks.  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Secondary font  
In LaserJet mode the printer maintains two current font settings. The secondary  
font is the second of these.  
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Serif  
A kind of typeface normally used for body text. Serif typefaces have little hooks  
(serifs) on the individual characters that makes text more readable.  
Soft clip limits  
Source image  
See graphics window. The soft limits are determined by the IW command.  
The graphic image that is applied to the destination image in the LaserJet print  
model. The interaction of the two images is determined by the current source and  
pattern transparency settings.  
Source transparency  
Spacing  
The source image is either transparent, in which case the destination image is  
visible throughout the white parts of the source image, or opaque, in which case the  
destination image is not visible at all through the source image.  
The way in which a font's characters are arranged on a line of text. See  
monospacing and proportional spacing.  
Stick font  
The default HP-GL and HP-GL/2 font consisting of thin lined characters.  
Stroke weight  
The thickness of the lines that comprise the characters in a particular font.  
Medium, bold and light stroke weights are commonly used.  
Sub-polygon  
A shape consisting of a closed group of points connected by lines. Several sub-  
polygons can form one polygon.  
Symbol set  
See character set.  
Tab channel  
A set of up to sixteen vertical tab stops. Up to eight vertical tab channels can be  
set up in the Epson FX-850 mode.  
Temporary font  
A downloaded font that is erased from the printer's memory when a printer reset is  
performed. To use the font again you must download it again.  
Temporary macro  
A macro that is erased from the printer's memory when a reset is performed. If  
you want to use the macro again you must redefine it and download it to the printer  
again.  
Text area  
Text direction  
TIFF  
The area of the physical page on which the printer can place text.  
The orientation of printed text relative to the physical page.  
Tagged Image File Format. A common file format used for storing raster graphics  
data.  
Transparency  
Typeface  
See pattern transparency and source transparency.  
The design style of a set of typographic characters. The character design is  
intended to make the characters work together cohesively to produce readable text.  
The word "font" is often erroneously used to mean "typeface".  
User default environment The current combination of LaserJet factory default settings and settings made  
using the control panel. This is the environment that is in effect when you switch  
on the printer in LaserJet mode or change to LaserJet emulation from another  
emulation mode. You can reset the printer to its user default settings either by  
using a printer command or using the control panel.  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
User units  
Coordinate units specified by the user with the HP-GL and HP-GL/2 SC command.  
Vector graphics  
A method of defining graphic images in terms of coordinates, points and lines. The  
HP-GL and HP-GL/2 graphics languages use this method.  
Vertical plot size  
VMI  
The original vertical size of an imported HP-GL and HP-GL/2 image.  
Vertical motion index. The vertical distance that the print position moves down the  
page when a line feed is performed. This can be set using printer commands or  
with the printer's control panel by adjusting the "Lines" menu option in PAGE  
FORMAT MODE.  
xii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 1  
INTRODUCTION  
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. ABOUT THE MANUAL ............................................................................................................... 3  
2. AREAS OF USE........................................................................................................................... 4  
2.1 Using Word Processing Packages and Spreadsheets.............................................................4  
2.2 Graphics.....................................................................................................................................4  
2.3 Programming .............................................................................................................................4  
2.4 Font Development......................................................................................................................5  
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1. ABOUT THE MANUAL  
This technical reference manual is intended to help you get the most out of each of the emulation modes  
supported by your HL-Series laser printer. It is divided into nine sections - this introductory section and one  
section for each of the emulation modes. Each emulation mode section describes the software commands (the  
escape sequences and control codes) that you can use to make the printer perform each of its available  
functions. Some example programs are included to give you useful ideas.  
This manual is for our PCL models. For the differences between each model, see the Appendix "Model  
Comparison."  
For basic set-up information, such as how to connect the printer to your computer, look in the User’s guide.  
The User’s guide also describes the printers control panel and how you can set various options using the  
keys.  
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2. AREAS OF USE  
There are several different applications for which you may want to use your HL-Series laser printer. Four  
general areas are outlined in the following sections.  
2.1  
Using Word Processing Packages and Spreadsheets  
You may simply wish to use the printer with your software application packages, such as word-processors or  
spreadsheets. Many software packages automatically send commands to the printer requesting particular  
type styles, character sizes and specifying page set-up information and other relevant data. In this case you  
will not need to use this manual, as your software package will perform the task of controlling the printer for  
you. Other packages allow you to embed software commands within your word-processed or spreadsheet  
documents. This manual describes the commands you need, and you can simply include them in the form that  
your package requires. In either case, read the documentation that came with your software to find out its own  
specific requirements for driving a printer.  
2.2  
2.3  
Graphics  
HP-GL/2 or HP-GL mode offers many powerful graphic features that enable you to draw and print detailed  
images quickly and easily. Many commercial graphic packages, notably computer-aided design applications  
programs, produce HP-GL/2 or HP-GL output. LaserJet mode also has several graphics features. You can  
either write your own programs to generate images or use existing graphics software.  
Programming  
If you are writing software, for example in BASIC or C, to drive the printer, the description and formal  
specification of each command will enable you to transcribe them straight into your programs. Below is a  
simple example of a program to draw and print a three inch black square. The program is given in both C and  
BASIC.  
C language program  
#include <stdio.h>  
main()  
{
FILE *prn; /* initialization section */  
prn = fopen("PRN","wb");  
fprintf(prn,"\33E"); /* Esc E - Reset the printer */  
fprintf(prn,"\33%0B"); /* Esc%0B - Enter HP-GL/2 */  
fprintf(prn,"IN"); /* Initialize */  
fprintf(prn,"SP1PA1024,1024"); /* Select pen 1 & move to 0,0 */  
fprintf(prn,"PDFT1RA4096,4096"); /* Draw 3" solid square */  
fprintf(prn,"\33%0A"); /* Quit HP-GL/2 & restore original cursor  
position */  
fprintf(prn,"\33E /* Reset and eject page */  
}
BASIC language program  
10 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E"; :REM Esc E - Reset the printer  
20 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B"; :REM Esc%0B - Enter HP-GL/2  
30 LPRINT "IN"; :REM Initialize  
40 LPRINT "SP1PA1024,1024"; :REM Select pen 1 & move to 0,0  
50 LPRINT "PDFT1RA4096,4096"; :REM Draw 3" solid square  
60 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A"; :REM Quit HP-GL/2 & restore original cursor  
position  
70 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E"; :REM Reset and eject page  
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.4  
Font Development  
In LaserJet mode you can send your own character designs to an HL-Series laser printer and print text using  
them. To do this you need first to design your characters on paper. Having done this you can then either  
input and download your characters using a commercial software package, or encode your designs  
numerically and write your own program to download them.  
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 2  
PCL  
PRINTER CONTROL  
LANGUAGE  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................7  
2. INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................................. 10  
3. CONTROLLING THE PRINTER ...................................................................................................... 11  
3.1. Control Codes ..................................................................................................................................11  
3.1.1. Backspace (08) <08h> ................................................................................................................... 11  
3.1.2. Line feed (10) <0Ah>...................................................................................................................... 11  
3.1.3. Form feed (12) <0Ch> .................................................................................................................... 11  
3.1.4. Carriage return (13) <0Dh>.............................................................................................................. 11  
3.1.5. Select primary font (14) <0Eh>........................................................................................................ 11  
3.1.6. Select secondary font (15) <0Fh>.................................................................................................... 11  
3.1.7. Escape (27) <1Bh>........................................................................................................................ 11  
3.1.8. Horizontal tab (09) <09h> .............................................................................................................. 11  
3.1.9. Space (32) <20h> .......................................................................................................................... 11  
3.2. Escape Sequences..........................................................................................................................12  
3.2.1. Line termination............................................................................................................................. 12  
3.2.2. End-of-line wrap............................................................................................................................. 12  
3.2.3. Display functions mode .................................................................................................................. 13  
3.3. Environments ...................................................................................................................................14  
3.3.1. Factory default environment ............................................................................................................ 14  
3.3.2. User default environment................................................................................................................. 14  
3.3.3. Modified print environment............................................................................................................... 14  
3.3.4. Macro overlay environment.............................................................................................................. 14  
4. JOB CONTROL................................................................................................................................... 15  
4.1.1. Page size...................................................................................................................................... 15  
4.1.2. Output tray.................................................................................................................................... 16  
4.1.3. Paper source................................................................................................................................. 17  
4.1.4. Left long-edge offset registration...................................................................................................... 18  
4.1.5. Top offset registration..................................................................................................................... 19  
4.1.6. Simplex/duplex printing (For HL-1660e/2060/3400CN) ....................................................................... 19  
4.1.7. Paper side selection....................................................................................................................... 19  
4.1.8. Job separation command................................................................................................................ 20  
4.1.9. Reset............................................................................................................................................ 20  
4.1.10. Reset to factory default settings .................................................................................................... 20  
4.1.11. Reset to user settings .................................................................................................................. 20  
4.1.12. Printer self test ............................................................................................................................ 20  
4.1.13. Exit current emulation mode.......................................................................................................... 20  
4.1.14. Change emulation mode ............................................................................................................... 21  
4.2. The Page..........................................................................................................................................22  
4.2.1. Physical page................................................................................................................................ 22  
4.2.2. Printable area................................................................................................................................ 22  
4.2.3. Logical page.................................................................................................................................. 22  
4.2.4. Text area....................................................................................................................................... 22  
4.2.5. HP-GL/2 graphics window............................................................................................................... 22  
4.2.6. Portrait page dimensions ................................................................................................................ 23  
4.2.7. Landscape page dimensions........................................................................................................... 24  
4.2.8. Coordinates................................................................................................................................... 25  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2.9. Units............................................................................................................................................. 25  
4.2.10. Unit of measure............................................................................................................................ 25  
4.2.11. Setting the left and right margins ................................................................................................... 25  
4.2.12. Resetting the horizontal margins.................................................................................................... 26  
4.2.13. Setting the top margin .................................................................................................................. 26  
4.2.14. Setting the vertical motion index (VMI) ........................................................................................... 27  
4.2.15. Setting the horizontal motion index (HMI) ....................................................................................... 27  
4.2.16. Setting line spacing...................................................................................................................... 28  
4.2.17. Text length.................................................................................................................................. 28  
4.2.18. Page length................................................................................................................................. 29  
4.2.19. Perforation skip............................................................................................................................ 29  
4.2.20. Positioning the cursor................................................................................................................... 30  
4.2.21. Vertical positioning....................................................................................................................... 30  
4.2.22. Horizontal position........................................................................................................................ 31  
4.2.23. Positioning the cursor using control codes...................................................................................... 32  
4.2.24. Using the cursor position stack ..................................................................................................... 32  
4.2.25. Half line feed................................................................................................................................ 33  
4.2.26. Logical page orientation................................................................................................................ 33  
4.2.27. Text direction............................................................................................................................... 33  
5. USING FONTS..................................................................................................................................... 35  
5.1. Introduction.......................................................................................................................................35  
5.1.1. Font types..................................................................................................................................... 35  
5.1.2. Bitmap fonts.................................................................................................................................. 35  
5.1.3. Scalable fonts................................................................................................................................ 35  
5.1.4. Bound fonts................................................................................................................................... 36  
5.1.5. Unbound fonts ............................................................................................................................... 36  
5.1.6. Font sources ................................................................................................................................. 36  
5.1.7. Internal fonts.................................................................................................................................. 36  
5.1.8. Card/cartridge fonts........................................................................................................................ 36  
5.1.9. Downloadable fonts........................................................................................................................ 38  
5.1.10. Primary and secondary fonts......................................................................................................... 38  
5.1.11. Specifying the primary font............................................................................................................ 38  
5.1.12. Specifying the secondary font........................................................................................................ 38  
5.1.13. Selecting the default fonts............................................................................................................. 38  
5.1.14. Switching between the primary and secondary fonts........................................................................ 38  
5.1.15. Criteria for font selection ............................................................................................................... 38  
5.1.16. Symbol set.................................................................................................................................. 40  
5.1.17. Symbol collections....................................................................................................................... 40  
5.1.18. Type of character spacing............................................................................................................. 40  
5.1.19. Pitch........................................................................................................................................... 40  
5.1.20. Height ......................................................................................................................................... 40  
5.1.21. Style........................................................................................................................................... 40  
5.1.22. Stroke weight............................................................................................................................... 40  
5.1.23. Typeface..................................................................................................................................... 40  
5.2. Font Selection Commands ..............................................................................................................41  
5.2.1. User-defined symbol sets ............................................................................................................... 41  
5.2.2. Symbol set ID code command ........................................................................................................ 41  
5.2.3. Define symbol set .......................................................................................................................... 41  
5.2.4. Symbol set control command.......................................................................................................... 43  
5.2.5. Selecting the symbol set ................................................................................................................ 43  
5.2.6. Selecting the type of character spacing............................................................................................ 45  
5.2.7. Selecting the pitch......................................................................................................................... 45  
5.2.8. Selecting the height ....................................................................................................................... 46  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.2.9. Scaling the scalable fonts vertically or horizontally............................................................................ 46  
5.2.10. Selecting the style ....................................................................................................................... 46  
5.2.11. Selecting the stroke weight ........................................................................................................... 47  
5.2.12. Selecting the typeface.................................................................................................................. 47  
5.2.13. Font orientation............................................................................................................................ 48  
5.2.14. Transparent print data................................................................................................................... 48  
5.2.15. Underlining text............................................................................................................................ 49  
5.3. Downloadable font manipulation......................................................................................................50  
5.3.1. Font ID.......................................................................................................................................... 50  
5.3.2. Operations on downloaded fonts...................................................................................................... 50  
5.3.3. Selecting a downloaded font............................................................................................................ 50  
5.4. Creating Downloadable Fonts..........................................................................................................51  
5.4.1. Downloading.................................................................................................................................. 51  
5.4.2. Sending the font descriptor ............................................................................................................. 51  
5.4.3. Unicode symbol index character complement bits............................................................................. 63  
5.4.4. Sending a character code............................................................................................................... 64  
5.4.5. Sending a character descriptor and data.......................................................................................... 64  
6. USING GRAPHICS............................................................................................................................. 70  
6.1. Source, Pattern and Destination......................................................................................................70  
6.1.1. Set source transparency................................................................................................................. 70  
6.1.2. Set pattern transparency ................................................................................................................ 71  
6.1.3. Set area fill identity ........................................................................................................................ 72  
6.1.4. User-defined pattern command........................................................................................................ 73  
6.1.5. Set pattern reference point.............................................................................................................. 73  
6.1.6. User-defined pattern control ............................................................................................................ 74  
6.1.7. Set pattern type............................................................................................................................. 74  
6.2. Plotting Rectangles ..........................................................................................................................76  
6.2.1. Cursor position .............................................................................................................................. 76  
6.2.2. Set rectangle width........................................................................................................................ 76  
6.2.3. Set rectangle height ....................................................................................................................... 76  
6.2.4. Draw filled rectangle....................................................................................................................... 76  
6.3. Raster Graphics...............................................................................................................................78  
6.3.1. Positioning the cursor..................................................................................................................... 78  
6.3.2. Set raster resolution....................................................................................................................... 78  
6.3.3. Set high resolution control .............................................................................................................. 78  
6.3.4. Set raster image orientation............................................................................................................ 78  
6.3.5. Set raster area height..................................................................................................................... 80  
6.3.6. Set raster area width...................................................................................................................... 80  
6.3.7. Set raster y-offset .......................................................................................................................... 80  
6.3.8. Set compression mode................................................................................................................... 80  
6.3.9. Start raster transfer........................................................................................................................ 86  
6.3.10. Send raster data.......................................................................................................................... 86  
6.3.11. Compress transfer graphics........................................................................................................... 86  
6.3.12. End raster transfer........................................................................................................................ 86  
6.3.13. Horizontal 1200-dpi image format mode (Raster Graphic Mode 1027)................................................ 88  
6.4. Vector Graphics ...............................................................................................................................91  
6.4.1. Enter HP-GL/2 mode...................................................................................................................... 91  
6.5. The Picture Frame...........................................................................................................................92  
6.5.1. The default picture frame................................................................................................................. 92  
6.5.2. Set picture frame anchor point......................................................................................................... 92  
6.5.3. Set picture frame vertical size......................................................................................................... 92  
6.5.4. Set picture frame horizontal size..................................................................................................... 92  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.5.5. Specify vertical plot size................................................................................................................. 92  
6.5.6. Specify horizontal plot size............................................................................................................. 92  
7. MACROS .............................................................................................................................................. 93  
7.1. The Purpose of a Macro...................................................................................................................93  
7.2. Defining a Macro ..............................................................................................................................94  
7.2.1. Macro ID....................................................................................................................................... 94  
7.2.2. Start macro definition ..................................................................................................................... 94  
7.2.3. End macro definition....................................................................................................................... 94  
7.3. Running a Macro..............................................................................................................................95  
7.3.1. Execute macro.............................................................................................................................. 95  
7.3.2. Call macro..................................................................................................................................... 95  
7.3.3. Enable macro for overlay................................................................................................................. 95  
7.3.4. Disable macro for overlay................................................................................................................ 95  
7.4. Handling Macros...............................................................................................................................96  
7.4.1. Delete all macros........................................................................................................................... 96  
7.4.2. Delete all temporary macros ........................................................................................................... 96  
7.4.3. Delete macro................................................................................................................................. 96  
7.4.4. Make macro temporary................................................................................................................... 96  
7.4.5. Make macro permanent.................................................................................................................. 96  
7.4.6. Delete all macros from the storage device........................................................................................ 96  
7.4.7. Delete macro from the storage device.............................................................................................. 96  
7.4.8. Save macro into the storage device.................................................................................................. 96  
7.4.9. Execute data................................................................................................................................. 97  
7.4.10. AppleTalk configuration................................................................................................................. 97  
7.4.11. MIO video I/O port control.............................................................................................................. 98  
8. STATUS READBACK........................................................................................................................ 99  
8.1. Introduction.......................................................................................................................................99  
8.2. Memory Status request....................................................................................................................99  
8.3. Entity Status .....................................................................................................................................99  
8.4. Status Response.............................................................................................................................99  
8.5. Status Response Syntax ...............................................................................................................100  
8.5.1. Set status readback location type ..................................................................................................100  
8.5.2. Set status readback location unit ...................................................................................................100  
8.5.3. Inquire status readback entity ........................................................................................................101  
8.5.4. Entity status response..................................................................................................................101  
8.5.5. Font response..............................................................................................................................101  
8.5.6. Bitmap fonts.................................................................................................................................102  
8.5.7. Bound scalable fonts.....................................................................................................................102  
8.5.8. Unbound scalable fonts .................................................................................................................102  
8.5.9. Download fonts.............................................................................................................................102  
8.5.10. Location type 1 (currently selected) font ........................................................................................102  
8.5.11. Font extended response..............................................................................................................104  
8.5.12. Macro response..........................................................................................................................105  
8.5.13. Use-defined pattern response.......................................................................................................105  
8.5.14. Symbol set response...................................................................................................................105  
8.5.15. Entity error codes........................................................................................................................106  
8.5.16. Free space command..................................................................................................................106  
8.5.17. Font cache.................................................................................................................................107  
8.5.18. Memory status response.............................................................................................................107  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
8.5.19. Memory error response................................................................................................................107  
8.5.20. Flush all pages command............................................................................................................107  
8.5.21. Echo command...........................................................................................................................107  
9. INDEX..................................................................................................................................................108  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
COMMAND LIST  
Control Codes  
11  
12  
Escape sequences  
Esc&k#G  
Esc&s#C  
EscY  
Line termination  
End-of-line wrap  
Display function mode  
Display function mode  
12  
12  
13  
13  
EscZ  
Environments  
14  
Job Control  
15  
Esc&l#A  
Esc&l#G  
Esc&l#H  
Esc&l#U  
Esc&l#Z  
Esc&l#S  
Esc&a#G  
Esc&l1T  
EscE  
EscCR FD  
EscCR!#R  
Escz  
Esc%-12345X  
EscCR##  
Page size  
Output tray  
Paper source  
15  
15  
16  
16  
17  
17  
17  
18  
18  
18  
18  
18  
18  
19  
Left long-edge offset registration  
Top offset registration  
Simplex/duplex printing (For HL-1660e/2060/HL-3400CN)  
Paper side selection  
Job separation command  
Reset  
Reset to factory default settings  
Reset to user settings  
Printer self test  
Exit current emulation mode  
Change emulation mode  
The Page  
20  
Esc&u#D  
Esc&a#L  
Esc&a#M  
Esc9  
Unit of measure  
23  
23  
23  
24  
24  
25  
25  
26  
26  
27  
27  
28  
28  
28  
29  
29  
30  
30  
31  
31  
31  
Setting the left and right margins  
Setting the left and right margins  
Resetting the horizontal margins  
Setting the top margin  
Setting the vertical motion index (VMI)  
Setting the horizontal motion index (HMI)  
Setting line spacing  
Text length  
Page length  
Perforation skip  
Vertical cursor positioning -rows  
Vertical cursor positioning - units  
Vertical cursor positioning - decipoints  
Horizontal cursor positioning - columns  
Horizontal cursor positioning - units  
Horizontal cursor positioning - decipoints  
Using the cursor position stack  
Half line feed  
Esc&l#E  
Esc&l#C  
Esc&k#H  
Esc&l#D  
Esc&l#F  
Esc&l#P  
Esc&l#L  
Esc&a#R  
Esc*p#Y  
Esc&a#V  
Esc&a#C  
Esc*p#X  
Esc&a#H  
Esc&f#S  
Esc=  
Esc&l#O  
Esc&a#P  
Logical page orientation  
Text direction  
Using fonts  
33  
Esc(3@, Esc)3@  
SI, SO  
Esc*c#R  
Esc(f#W  
Selecting the default fonts  
35  
35  
37  
37  
39  
39  
40  
41  
Switching between the primary and secondary font  
Symbol set ID code command  
Define symbol set  
Esc*c#S  
Symbol set control command  
Esc(symbol set ID Select the symbol set  
Esc(s#C, Esc)s#C Select the symbol set  
Esc(s#P, Esc)s#P Selecting the type of character spacing  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Esc(s#H, Esc)s#H Selecting the pitch  
Esc(s#V, Esc)s#V Selecting the height  
EscCR!#H, EscCR!#V Scaling the scalable fonts vertically or horizontally  
Esc(s#S, Esc)s#S Selecting the style  
Esc(s#B, Esc)s#B Selecting the stroke weight  
Esc(s#T, Esc)s#T Selecting the typeface  
41  
42  
42  
42  
43  
43  
44  
45  
46  
46  
46  
47  
59  
59  
Esc&p#X  
Transparent print data  
Esc&d#D, Esc&d@ Underlining text  
Esc&*c#D  
Esc*c#F  
Esc(#X, Esc)#X  
Esc)s#W  
Esc*c#E  
Esc(s#W  
Font ID  
Operations on downloaded fonts  
Selecting a downloaded font  
Sending the font descriptor  
Sending a character code  
Sending a character descriptor and data  
Using graphics  
65  
Esc*v#N  
Esc*v#O  
Esc*c#G  
Esc*c#W  
Esc*p#R  
Esc*c#Q  
Esc*v#T  
Set source transparency  
Set pattern transparency  
Set area fill identity  
User-defined pattern command  
Set pattern reference point  
User-defined pattern control  
Set pattern type  
65  
66  
67  
68  
68  
69  
69  
71  
71  
71  
73  
73  
73  
74  
74  
74  
74  
79  
79  
79  
79  
79  
81  
83  
84  
84  
84  
84  
84  
Esc*c#A, Esc*c#H Set rectangle width  
Esc*c#B, Esc*c#V Set rectangle height  
Esc*c#P  
Esc*t#R  
EscCR ##  
Esc*r#F  
Esc*r#T  
Esc*r#S  
Esc*b#Y  
Esc*b#M  
Esc*r#A  
Esc*b#W  
Esc*b#C  
Esc*rB  
Draw filled rectangle  
Set raster resolution  
Set high resolution control  
Set raster image orientation  
Set raster area height  
Set raster area width  
set raster y-offset  
Set compression mode  
Start raster transfer  
Send raster data  
Compress transfer graphics  
End raster transfer  
End raster transfer  
Horizontal 1200-dpi image format mode (Raster Graphic Mode 1027)  
Enter HP-GL/2 mode  
Set picture frame anchor point  
Set picture frame vertical size  
Set picture frame horizontal size  
Specify vertical plot size  
Specify horizontal plot size  
Esc*rC  
Esc*b##W  
Esc%#B  
Esc*c0T  
Esc*c#Y  
Esc*c#X  
Esc*c#L  
Esc*c#K  
Macros  
85  
Esc&f#Y  
Esc&f0X  
Esc&f1X  
Esc&f2X  
Esc&f3X  
Esc&f4X  
Esc&f5X  
Esc&f6X  
Esc&f7X  
Esc&f8X  
Esc&f9X  
Esc&f10X  
Esc&f1030X  
Esc&f1036X  
Esc&f1038X  
Macro ID  
Start macro definition  
End macro definition  
Execute macro  
Call macro  
Enable macro for overlay  
Disable macro for overlay  
Delete all macros  
Delete all temporary macros  
Delete macro  
Make macro temporary  
Make macro permanent  
Delete all macros from the storage device  
Delete macro from the storage device  
Save macro into the storage device  
86  
86  
86  
87  
87  
87  
87  
88  
88  
88  
88  
88  
88  
88  
88  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
EscCR!#E  
Esc&b#W  
EscCR!1234#M  
Execute data  
AppleTalk configuration  
MIO video I/O port control  
89  
89  
90  
Status Readback  
91  
Esc*s#T  
Esc*s#U  
Esc*s#I  
Esc*s1M  
Esc&r#F  
Esc*s#X  
Set status readback location type  
Set status readback location unit  
Inquire status readback entity  
Free space command  
Flush all pages command  
Echo command  
92  
92  
93  
97  
98  
98  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
INTRODUCTION  
This laser printer provides a complete emulation of the supported Hewlett Packard LaserJet printer. Features  
include raster and vector graphics, support for bitmap and scalable fonts and page control. There are many  
resident fonts in the printer and you can gain access to more by inserting a font cartridge/card or the storage  
device into the printer or by downloading fonts from your computer.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
CONTROLLING THE PRINTER  
3.1. Control Codes  
Control codes are ASCII codes that tell the printer to perform a given function, such as a carriage return. You can  
send these codes to the printer as part of a program.  
3.1.1. Backspace  
(08)  
<08h>  
ASCII code 8. This code moves the cursor one column to the left.  
3.1.2. Line feed  
(10)  
<0Ah>  
ASCII code 10. This code performs a line feed.  
3.1.3. Form feed  
(12)  
<0Ch>  
ASCII code 12. This code ejects the most recently printed page from the printer.  
3.1.4. Carriage return  
(13)  
<0Dh>  
ASCII code 13. This code performs a carriage return.  
3.1.5. Select primary font  
(14)  
<0Eh>  
ASCII code 15. When you send this code to the printer subsequent characters will be printed in the current  
primary font. This is explained further in the sub-section entitled “Using fonts”.  
3.1.6. Select secondary font (15)  
<0Fh>  
ASCII code 14. When you send this code to the printer subsequent characters will be printed in the current  
secondary font. This is explained further in the sub-section entitled “Using fonts”.  
3.1.7. Escape  
(27)  
<1Bh>  
ASCII code 27. You must use this character code to start every instruction sequence that you send to the printer.  
3.1.8. Horizontal tab  
(09) <09h>  
ASCII code 9. This code moves the cursor one tab position to the right. The tab positions are at the left margin  
and at the left edge of every 8th column as defined by the horizontal motion index (HMI) described in the next  
section, entitled “The Page”.  
3.1.9. Space  
(32)  
<20h>  
ASCII code 32. This code moves the cursor one column to the right.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.2. Escape Sequences  
Escape sequences, also known as PCL (Printer Control Language) commands, tell the printer which operations to  
perform. An escape sequence consists of the Esc character followed by a string of characters which define the  
operation to be performed. Some escape sequences require parameter values. These are included in the sequence  
as numeric characters. The final letter of an escape sequence must be uppercase: all others must be lowercase.  
You can send the printer instructions by embedding escape sequences in programs or in word processed  
documents.  
In this manual escape sequences are shown as they would be entered, except that the character # in a sequence  
indicates that a number should be included at that point in the sequence. If no number is included, the printer  
interprets that parameter’s value as 0.  
When downloading fonts or sending raster scan images to the printer the final uppercase character of the  
sequence is followed by the relevant data.  
Two escape sequences can be combined into one if the first three characters of each sequence (including the Esc  
character itself) are the same. Hence, Esc*c45Gand Esc*c2P may be combined to give Esc*c45g2P. The  
uppercase ‘G’ which terminated the first sequence becomes a lowercase character in the combined sequence.  
Combined escape sequences are executed left to right, so be careful to place commands in the order in which you  
want them to be executed.  
Esc*c45G  
Esc*c2P  
Esc*c45g2P  
3.2.1. Line termination  
You can set the carriage return, line feed and form feed control codes to perform compound functions. You can  
either do this using the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide) or by sending the printer the following escape  
sequence:  
·
·
·
0 = Carriage return, line feed and form feed perform their normal functions.  
1 = Carriage return performs carriage return/line feed, line feed and form feed perform their normal functions.  
2 = Carriage return performs its normal function, line feed performs carriage return/line feed and form feed  
performs carriage return/form feed.  
·
3 = Carriage return performs carriage return/line feed, line feed performs carriage return/line feed and form feed  
performs carriage return/form feed.  
0
1
2
3
CR®CR  
LF®LF  
FF®FF  
CR®CR+LF  
CR®CR  
LF®LF  
FF®FF  
LF®CR+LF  
LF®CR+LF  
FF®CR+FF  
FF®CR+FF  
CR®CR+LF  
3.2.2. End-of-line wrap  
If the printer tries to print a line of text that is longer than the width of the text area, the end of the line will  
normally be lost. However, you can set the printer to flow text onto the next line so that text is not lost.  
You can turn on the automatic text wrap feature either from the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide) or by  
sending the printer the following escape sequence:  
Esc&s0C (27)(38)(115)(48)(67) <1Bh><26h><73h><30h><43h>  
To turn off the facility send:  
Esc&s1C (27)(38)(115)(49)(67) <1Bh><26h><73h><31h><43h>  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.2.3. Display functions mode  
You can choose to make the printer print escape sequences instead of executing them. Send the printer the  
following sequence:  
EscY  
(27)(89) <1B><59>  
Now the printer prints out escape sequences and prints the characters of the control codes. It does not execute  
them. The only exceptions to this are CR, the carriage return code, which causes a carriage return and line feed to  
be performed, and the EscZ escape sequence which turns the mode off.  
To turn the display functions mode off and enable escape sequences to be executed again send:  
EscZ  
(27)(90) <1B><5A>  
The printer exits the display function mode after printing a character of code 1B Hex and the letter "Z". All  
subsequent escape sequences and control codes are executed normally and not printed literally.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.3. Environments  
3.3.1. Factory default environment  
The factory default environment is the collection of printer settings programmed into the printer before it leaves  
the factory. You can restore the factory default environment using the printer’s control panel.  
See the User's Guide to find how to reset the printer from the printer's control panel.  
Some settings cannot be restored to the factory default environment with the RESET operation from the printer's  
control panel.  
3.3.2. User default environment  
The user default environment is a combination of factory default settings and settings which the user has made  
from the printer’s control panel or remote printer console. You can store user default setting(s) in the printer by  
using the printer control panel. You can restore the user default environment either by sending the reset escape  
sequence to the printer, EscE, or by performing a reset from the printer’s control panel. On some models, there  
are multiple User settings available, refer to your printer User Guide to see if your printer supports these.  
3.3.3. Modified print environment  
The modified print environment is made up of all the current printer settings. If you call a macro or go into HP-  
GL/2 graphics language the modified print environment settings are saved. When the macro has been executed,  
or when you quit HP-GL/2, these saved settings are restored. The modified print environment consists of settings  
for the following features:  
Page length  
Primary font characteristics  
Raster graphics presentation mode  
Page size  
Secondary font characteristics HMI Raster graphics left margin  
Orientation  
Primary font  
Pattern ID  
Left registration  
Top registration  
Paper source  
Secondary font  
Current pattern  
Font ID  
Source transparency mode  
Pattern transparency mode  
Print direction  
Character code Macro ID  
VMI/Line spacing  
Horizontal rectangle size  
Vertical rectangle size  
Area fill ID  
Number of copies  
Margins  
Raster graphics compression mode  
Underline mode  
Perforation skip mode  
Line termination mode  
End-of line wrap  
Current font  
Raster graphics height  
Raster graphics width  
Raster graphics resolution  
3.3.4. Macro overlay environment  
The macro overlay environment is a combination of the user default environment and the current modified print  
environment. The overlay environments settings take effect when a macro is enabled for automatic overlay. This  
is detailed in the section of this manual in which macros are described.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
JOB CONTROL  
4.1.1. Page size  
Esc&l#A (27)(38)(108)#(65)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<41h>  
# stands for the type of paper or envelope to be used.  
Values for # correspond to the paper or envelope sizes shown in the table. Envelopes sizes are shown in the  
shaded part of the table.  
HL-1050 HL-1070  
HL-  
1250/  
P2500  
HL-  
1270N  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-2060  
HL-  
2400C  
HL-  
2400Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
Model  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
1
2
3
6
25  
Executive  
Letter  
Legal  
Ledger  
A5  
¡
¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡
¡ ¡ ¡  
¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
26  
27  
45  
46  
100  
1024  
1025  
1026  
1028  
2048  
80  
A4  
A3  
B5 (JIS)  
B4 (JIS)  
B5  
B6  
A5  
A6  
¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡
13"X19"  
16"  
Monarch  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
81  
90  
COM-10  
International  
DL  
International  
91  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
C5  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-2460  
HL-  
1450/  
1470N  
Model  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡
1
2
3
6
25  
Executive  
Letter  
Legal  
Ledger  
A5  
26  
27  
A4  
A3  
¡
¡ ¡  
45  
46  
B5 (JIS)  
B4 (JIS)  
B5  
B6  
A5  
¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡
100  
1024  
1025  
1026  
1028  
2048  
80  
¡
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
A6  
13"X19"  
16"  
Monarch  
COM-10  
International  
DL  
¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
81  
90  
International  
91  
¡ ¡ ¡ ¡  
¡ ¡ ¡  
C5  
Free size  
101  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
When the printer receives this command any unprinted pages are printed and the left, right and top margins  
and the text length are set to their factory defaults for the new page size.  
·
·
The cursor is moved to the top left of the text area on the new page.  
Depending on your model, you may also set the page size from the printer’s control panel or remote printer  
console program (see the User Guide).  
·
If the paper size you select differs from the size of the currently loaded paper, a message appears in the  
control panel prompting you to load the selected size of paper (for HL-1660e, 2060, 2400C/Ce, 3400CN, 3260N  
and 2460).  
Example)  
Select letter size:  
Esc&l2A  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch><32h><41h>  
Select the width of free size paper: Esc&l#G(1/720 inch unit; for HL-3260N and 2460)  
Select the height of free size paper: Esc&l#F (1/720 inch unit; for HL-3260N and 2460)  
4.1.2. Output tray  
Esc&l#G (27)(38)(108)#(71)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<47h>  
# denotes the output tray.  
· 1:  
· 3:  
· 4:  
· 5:  
· 6:  
· 7:  
· 8:  
· 9:  
· 10:  
· 11:  
· 12:  
Select the printer output tray.  
Select #1 bin.  
Select #2 bin.  
Select #3 bin.  
Select #4 bin.  
Select #5 bin.  
Select #6 bin.  
Select #7 bin.  
Select #8 bin.  
Select #9 bin.  
Select #10 bin.  
· 100: Select the finisher tray (HL-3260N)  
·
·
·
·
This command selects the specified output tray.  
This command is ignored when the specified tray is not available.  
The PJL OUTBIN command is ignored when this command is executed.  
If the printer has data to print when this command is executed, the command is valid from the next page  
immediately after the data is printed.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.1.3. Paper source  
Esc&l#H (27)(38)(108)#(72)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<48h>  
# denotes the paper source.  
Values for # may be 0, 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
If # = 0 the current page is ejected and the paper source remains the same.  
If # = 1 the current page is printed and the upper cassette becomes the paper source.  
If # = 2 the current page is printed and paper is fed in manually.  
If # = 3 the current page is printed and envelopes are fed in manually.  
If # = 4 the current page is printed and the lower cassette becomes the paper source.  
If # = 4 the current page is printed and the multi-purpose tray becomes the paper source. (HL-1660e/2060)  
If # = 5, 6 the current page is printed and the lower cassette becomes the paper source.  
(HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460)  
·
·
If # = 7 the current page is printed and the paper source is auto selected.  
If # = 8 the current page is printed and the lower cassette (Tray 3) becomes the paper source.  
(HL-3400CN/3260N/2460)  
·
If # = 9 the current page is printed and the lower cassette (Tray 4) becomes the paper source.  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
·
·
·
·
·
·
If # = 100 the current page is printed and the Tray ID 1 becomes the paper source. (HL-2460)  
If # = 101 the current page is printed and the Tray ID 2 becomes the paper source. (HL-2460)  
If # = 102 the current page is printed and the Tray ID 3 becomes the paper source. (HL-2460)  
If # = 103 the current page is printed and the Tray ID 4 becomes the paper source. (HL-2460)  
If # = 1 or # = 2 either paper or envelopes may be fed in, depending on the current page size setting.  
The cursor is positioned at the top left of the text area on the next page.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
HL-1050  
HL-1060/  
1070  
HL-1250/  
1270N/  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
/2060  
HL-  
2400C  
HL-  
HL-  
HL-  
1450  
/1470N  
2400Ce 3400C  
N
#=0 Eject  
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
N/A  
#=1 Sheet Feeder Tray 1  
#=2 Manual Feed  
#=3 N/A  
¬
¬
Tray 2  
Tray 2  
Tray 2  
¬
Envelope  
#=4 N/A  
MP Tray Tray 2  
¬
¬
¬
¬
#=5 N/A  
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
#=6 N/A  
#=7 Auto  
selection  
#=8 N/A  
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
Tray 3  
N/A  
HL-1650/  
1670N  
HL-3260N HL-2460  
#=0  
#=1  
#=2  
#=3  
#=4  
#=5  
#=6  
#=7  
#=8  
#=9  
Eject  
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
¬
Tray 1  
Manual Feed  
Envelope  
Tray 2  
Tray 2  
Tray 2  
Auto selection  
N/A  
Tray 3  
¬
¬
N/A  
Tray 4  
#=100 N/A  
#=101 N/A  
#=102 N/A  
#=103 N/A  
¬
¬
¬
¬
Tray ID 1  
Tray ID 2  
Tray ID 3  
Tray ID 4  
4.1.4. Left long-edge offset registration  
Esc&l#U (27)(38)(108)#(85)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<55h>  
# stands for the distance in decipoints (1/720") that the left edge of the logical page is to be moved.  
·
·
·
Values for # may be in the range -32,767 to 32,767.  
The distance specified is relative to the logical page’s current position.  
# can be positive or negative. Use a positive number to move the logical page to the right on the physical  
page, and a negative number to move it to the left.  
Positive  
Negative  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.1.5. Top offset registration  
Esc&l#Z (27)(38)(108)#(90)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<5Ah>  
# stands for the distance in decipoints (1/720") that the top edge of the logical page is to be moved.  
·
·
·
Values for # may be in the range -32,767 to 32,767.  
The distance specified is relative to the logical page’s current position.  
# can be positive or negative. Use a positive number to move the logical page downwards on the physical  
page, and a negative number to move it upwards.  
Negative  
Positive  
4.1.6. Simplex/duplex printing (For HL-1660e/2060/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460)  
Esc&l#S (27)(38)(108)#(83)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<53h>  
# can be 0, 1, or 2.  
·
·
·
·
# = 0 indicates Simplex printing.  
# = 1 indicates Duplex - Long edge binding printing.  
# = 2 indicates Duplex - Short edge binding printing.  
If the optional duplex unit is not installed onto the printer, this mode is set to Simplex mode.  
This command setting is not saved in the printer's NV-RAM.  
[Short Edge Binding]  
[Long Edge Binding]  
4.1.7. Paper side selection  
Esc&a#G (27)(38)(97)#(71) <1Bh><26h><61h>#<47h>  
# can be 0, 1, or 2.  
·
# = 0 indicates the next side. If there is a page being processed, the printer finishes the processing of that  
page. If there are no pages being processed, this command is ignored.  
·
# = 1 indicates the front face.  
If the currently processing page is an odd page, the printer finishes the processing of that page and attaches  
a dummy page.  
If the odd page has already been processed onto the page and the even page has not been processed yet,  
only a dummy page is attached.  
If the currently processing page is an even page, the printer finishes the processing of the page.  
If both an even and odd page have been processed and the next odd page has not been processed yet, this  
command is ignored.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
# = 2 indicates the back face.  
If the currently processing page is an odd page, the printer finishes the processing of the page.  
If the odd page has already been processed onto the page and the even page has not been processed yet,  
this command is ignored.  
If the currently processing page is an even page, the printer finishes the processing of the page and attaches  
a dummy (white) page.  
If both an even and odd page have been processed and the next odd page has not been processed yet, only a  
dummy (white) page is attached.  
4.1.8. Job separation command (For HL-3260N/2460)  
Esc&l1T (27)(38)(108)(49)(84) <1Bh><26h><6Ch><31h><54h>  
It is recommended to insert this command at the end of each job.  
4.1.9. Reset  
EscE  
(27)(69) <1Bh><45h>  
·
·
·
A printer reset restores the user default environment, deletes any temporary fonts and temporary macros.  
Any pages that have been transmitted are printed out.  
You can also perform a printer reset using the printer’s control panel or remote printer console program (see  
the User Guide).  
4.1.10. Reset to factory default settings  
EscCRFD (27)(13)(70)(68) <1Bh><0Dh><46h><44h>  
This command causes a factory reset to be performed, restoring all the printer’s factory default settings. See  
·
·
the section “Factory default environment” for a list of the factory default settings.  
You can also perform a factory reset using the printer’s control panel or remote printer console program (see  
the User Guide).  
4.1.11. Reset to user settings  
EscCR!#R (27)(13)(33)#(82) <1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<52h>  
·
·
# can be 0, 1 or 2.  
#0 indicates the current settings are restored. Unlike the Esc E reset command, the Esc CR!0R command  
resets the input buffer.  
·
·
·
#1 indicates the user settings 1 are restored, if the printer supports multi user settings.  
#2 indicates the user settings 2 are restored, if the printer supports multi user settings.  
Depending on the model, you may be able to lock the control panel settings ("SETTING LOCK=ON"). In that  
case, parameters 1 and 2 are ignored.  
4.1.12. Printer self test  
Escz (27)(122)  
<1Bh><7Ah>  
A printer self test causes a test sheet to be printed out to show that the machine is working properly. Depending  
on the model, you may also see the test pattern for HRC setting.  
4.1.13. Exit current emulation mode  
Esc%-12345X  
(27)(37)(45)(49)(50)(51)(52)(53)(88)  
<1Bh><25h><2Dh><31h><32h><33h><34h><35h><58h>  
·
·
·
When the printer receives this command, all page data already received is printed out.  
All settings are reset to the user settings.  
Exits the current emulation mode.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
PR2000070  
4.1.14. Change emulation mode  
EscCRGL  
(27)(13)(71)(76) <1Bh><0Dh><47h><4Ch>  
This command changes the emulation mode to HP-GL mode.  
EscCRAB (27)(13)(65)(66) <1Bh><0Dh><41h><42h>  
This command changes the emulation mode to BR-Script Batch mode.  
EscCRAI (27)(13)(65)(73) <1Bh><0Dh><41h><49h>  
This command changes the emulation mode to BR-Script Interactive mode.  
EscCRI  
(27)(13)(73)  
<1Bh><0Dh><49h>  
This command changes the emulation mode to IBM Proprinter XL mode.  
EscCRE  
(27)(13)(69)  
<1Bh><0Dh><45h>  
This command changes the emulation mode to Epson FX-850 mode.  
Depending on the model, you can also switch between emulation modes using the printer’s control panel (see  
the User Guide).  
Emulations available for each model are listed below.  
PCL HP-GL BR-Script2 BR-Script3  
Epson  
IBM  
FX-850 Proprinter XL  
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
HL-1050  
HL-1070  
¡
¡
¡
¡
HL-1250  
¡
HL-1270N  
HL-P2500  
HL-1660e  
HL-2060  
¡
¡ ¡  
¡ ¡  
¡ ¡  
¡ ¡  
¡ ¡  
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
¡
HL-2400C  
HL-2400Ce  
HL-3400CN  
HL-1650/1670N  
HL-3260N  
HL-2460  
¡
¡
¡
¡ ¡  
¡ ¡  
¡
HL-1450  
¡
¡
HL-1470N  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2. The Page  
4.2.1. Physical page  
The physical page refers to the size of the paper or envelope currently in use: A4, Letter, B5, JIS B5, Legal and  
Executive are the permitted paper sizes: Monarch, COM-10, International DL and International C5 are the  
allowable envelope sizes.  
4.2.2. Printable area  
The printable area is a rectangular area of the physical page on which the printer can print. Its edges are  
approximately 1/6" in from the edges of the physical page, please refer to the printer User Guide for the exact  
measurement for each model.  
4.2.3. Logical page  
The logical page is the area of the physical page where the cursor can be positioned. (Although the printer does  
not really have a cursor, we refer to the position on the page from which the printing of a character or graphic  
starts as the cursor position). You can alter the size of the logical page using the left offset registration and top  
offset registration commands. The logical page is also called the PCL (printer control language) addressable area.  
4.2.4. Text area  
The text area is the area of the physical page on which text can be printed, and is determined by the left, right and  
top margin settings, the text length and whether the perforation skip facility is on or off. All these settings can be  
made either from the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide) or using PCL commands.  
4.2.5. HP-GL/2 graphics window  
The HP-GL/2 graphics window is the area of the physical page on which images can be printed using HP-GL/2  
commands. This is described in the HP-GL/2 section of this manual. The default graphics window is bound by the  
left and right edges of the logical page and horizontal boundaries half an inch below the top and above the  
bottom of the logical page.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2.6. Portrait page dimensions  
(DEFAULT VALUES)  
F
H
G
Physical page  
Printable area  
Logical page  
E
E
Default HP-GL/2 picture frame  
B
D
Physical page length  
B
D
G
G
Maximum logical page length  
Distance from edge of physical page to  
edge of logical page  
F
F
G
H
C
A
PAPER SIZE  
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
LETTER  
LEGAL  
EXECUTIVE  
A4  
2550  
2550  
2175  
2480  
2078  
2148  
1476  
1754  
1240  
2480  
2480  
1237  
1162  
1913  
1299  
3507  
3900  
3035  
3300  
3300  
4200  
3150  
3507  
2952  
3030  
2078  
2480  
1754  
3507  
4783  
2850  
2250  
2704  
2598  
4960  
5700  
4298  
5100  
2400  
2400  
2025  
2338  
1936  
2010  
1334  
1612  
1098  
2400  
2400  
1087  
1012  
1771  
1157  
3365  
3750  
2893  
3150  
3300  
4200  
3150  
3507  
2952  
3030  
2078  
2480  
1754  
3507  
4783  
2850  
2250  
2704  
2598  
4960  
5700  
4298  
5100  
75  
75  
75  
71  
71  
69  
71  
71  
71  
40  
40  
75  
75  
71  
71  
71  
75  
71  
75  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
40  
40  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
B5  
JIS B5  
B6  
A5  
A6  
A4 80 character  
A4 long  
COM-10  
MONARCH  
C5  
DL  
A3  
13"X19"  
JIS B4  
Ledger  
All measurements are in 1/300" units  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2.7. Landscape page dimensions  
(DEFAULT VALUES)  
F
H
G
Physical page  
Printable area  
Logical page  
E
E
D
B
Default HP-GL/2 picture frame  
Physical page length  
G
G
B
D
F
Maximum logical page length  
Distance from edge of physical  
page to edge of logical page  
G
F
H
C
A
PAPER SIZE  
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
LETTER  
LEGAL  
EXECUTIVE  
A4  
3300  
4200  
3150  
3507  
2952  
3030  
2078  
2480  
1754  
4783  
2850  
2250  
2704  
2598  
4960  
5700  
4298  
5100  
2550  
2550  
2175  
2480  
2078  
2148  
1476  
1754  
1240  
2480  
1237  
1162  
1913  
1299  
3507  
3900  
3035  
3300  
3180  
4080  
3030  
3389  
2834  
2910  
1960  
2362  
1636  
4665  
2730  
2130  
2586  
2480  
4842  
5580  
4180  
4980  
2550  
2550  
2175  
2480  
2078  
2148  
1476  
1754  
1240  
2480  
1237  
1162  
1913  
1299  
3507  
3900  
3035  
3300  
60  
60  
60  
59  
59  
60  
59  
59  
59  
59  
60  
60  
59  
59  
59  
60  
59  
60  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
50  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
150  
B5  
JIS B5  
B6  
A5  
A6  
A4 long  
COM-10  
MONARCH  
C5  
DL  
A3  
13"X19"  
JIS B4  
Ledger  
All measurements are in 1/300" units  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2.8. Coordinates  
The printer control language coordinate system has its origin at the intersection of the left edge of the logical  
page and the top margin. The x-coordinate value of the current cursor position increases as the cursor moves  
from left to right, the y-coordinate value increases as the cursor moves down the page. The cursor can be  
explicitly positioned anywhere on the current logical page using the PCL coordinate system. In addition, the  
cursor’s coordinate position will change as text and graphics are printed.  
4.2.9. Units  
You can specify cursor movement within the PCL coordinate system using one of three different unit systems.  
Decipoints  
A decipoint is one-tenth of a typographic point measurement = 1/720".  
Rows and columns  
Using the horizontal motion index (HMI) (Esc&k#H) and vertical motion index (VMI)(Esc&l#C) commands you  
can set the width of a column and the height of a row. You can then use the column width and row height as the  
units of the coordinate system. The line-spacing command is an alternative to the VMI command.  
Units  
The unit of measurement used must be defined by the unit of measure command as described in 4.2.10.  
4.2.10. Unit of measure  
Esc&u#D (27)(38)(117)#(68)  
<1Bh><26h><75h>#<44h>  
·
# value can be 96, 100, 120, 144, 150, 160, 180, 200, 225, 240, 288, 300, 360, 400, 450, 480, 600, 720, 800, 900, 1200,  
1440, 1800, 2400, 3600, 7200.  
·
·
# stands for the unit of measurement in dots per inch.  
The value set by this command is used as the unit setting for use by other setting commands such as  
ESC*p#X.  
·
The default value of # is 300.  
Example)  
Esc&u300D Esc*p+100x+200Y  
move cursor 100/300 inch right and 200/300 inch down.  
Esc&u600D Esc*p+100x+200Y  
move cursor 100/600 inch right and 200/600 inch down.  
4.2.11. Setting the left and right margins  
Esc&a#L (27)(38)(97)#(76)  
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<4Ch>  
# stands for the distance between the left edge of the logical page and the left margin in columns.  
Esc&a#M (27)(38)(97)#(77)  
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<4Dh>  
# stands for the distance between the left edge of the logical page and the right margin in columns.  
·
The column width is as defined by the HMI. If you subsequently change the HMI, the margin positions that  
you have set do not change - that is, when you specify margin positions they remain fixed physically until  
you specify new ones or reset them to default values.  
·
·
You cannot specify a value for the left margin that is greater than the value of the current right margin.  
If the current cursor position is to the left of your new left margin setting, the cursor will be moved to the new  
left margin.  
·
You cannot set the right margin further right than the right edge of the logical page.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
·
If the current cursor position is to the right of your new right margin setting, the cursor will be moved to the  
new right margin.  
The factory default left and right margin settings are at the left and right edges of the logical page  
respectively.  
Depending on your model, margin settings can be made from the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide).  
10 REM ***** SET AND CLEAR SIDE MARGINS *****  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
40 REM --- END OF LINE WRAP ON ---  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"&s0C";  
60 REM --- LEFT MARGIN SET TO 10 COLUMNS ----  
70 LPRINT ESC$+"&a10L";  
80 REM --- RIGHT MARGIN SET TO 70 COLUMNS ----  
90 LPRINT ESC$+"&a70M";  
100 REM --- PRINT "0123456789" 10 TIMES  
110 FOR I=1 TO 10  
120 LPRINT "0123456789";  
130 NEXT  
140 LPRINT  
150 REM --- CLEAR SIDE MARGIN ----  
160 LPRINT ESC$+"9";  
170 REM --- PRINT "0123456789" 10 TIMES  
180 FOR I=1 TO 10  
190 LPRINT "0123456789";  
200 NEXT  
210 REM --- PAPER EJECT ----  
220 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
230 END  
4.2.12. Resetting the horizontal margins  
Esc9 (27)(39) <1Bh><39h>  
This command resets the left and right margins to the left and right edges of the logical page respectively.  
4.2.13. Setting the top margin  
Esc&l#E (27)(38)(108)#(69)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<45h>  
# stands for the distance between the top of the logical page and the top margin in rows.  
·
·
The row height is as defined by the VMI. If you subsequently change the VMI (or the line spacing) the top  
margin position that you have set does not change - that is, when you specify the top margin position it  
remains fixed physically until you specify a new one or reset it to a default value.  
The top margin command is ignored if you try to set a margin greater than the current length of the logical  
page.  
·
·
·
The top margin command is ignored if the current VMI is 0.  
The factory default top margin setting is half an inch below the top of the logical page.  
Depending on your model, the top margin can be set from the printer’s control panel (see the User Guide).  
10 REM ******* SET TOP MARGIN TO 10 LINES *******  
20 REM  
30 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
40 LPRINT ESC$+"&l10E";  
50 LPRINT "10 LINES "  
60 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
70 END  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2.14. Setting the vertical motion index (VMI)  
Esc&l#C (27)(38)(108)#(67)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<43h>  
# stands for the height of one row in 1/48".  
·
·
# can have any value in the range 0-32767.  
The distance specified by the VMI is the vertical distance moved down the page when the printer performs a  
line feed. The VMI is also sometimes referred to as the line pitch.  
·
·
·
·
If you try to set a VMI that is greater than the current length of the logical page the command is ignored.  
Changing the VMI setting does not affect the position of the top margin.  
The factory default setting is 8 - that is, the printer will print six lines of text per inch.  
Depending on your model, you can change the number of lines per page setting fromthe printer's control  
panel or remote printer console. If you change its setting, the VMI will change automatically.  
10 REM ***** SETTING THE LINE PITCH *****  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 REM  
40 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/48 INCH ---  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"&l1C";  
60 FOR I=1 TO 10  
70 LPRINT "I can't read."  
80 NEXT  
90 LPRINT ESC$+"&l8C";  
100 LPRINT  
110 LPRINT  
120 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/12 INCH ----  
130 LPRINT ESC$+"&l4C";  
140 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/12 inch"  
150 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/8 INCH ----  
160 LPRINT ESC$+"&l6C";  
170 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/8 inch"  
180 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/6 INCH ----  
190 LPRINT ESC$+"&l8C";  
200 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/6 inch"  
210 REM --- SET LINE PITCH TO 1/4 INCH ----  
220 LPRINT ESC$+"&l12C";  
230 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/4 inch"  
240 LPRINT "line pitch is 1/4 inch"  
250 REM --- PAPER EJECT ----  
260 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
270 END  
<Sample file 1>  
4.2.15. Setting the horizontal motion index (HMI)  
Esc&k#H (27)(38)(107)#(72)  
<1Bh><26h><6Bh>#<48h>  
# stands for the width of one column in 1/120".  
·
·
# can have any value in the range 0-32767 and can have up to four decimal places.  
If you are using a fixed space font the HMI is the horizontal distance moved across the page when the printer  
prints one character.  
·
·
If you are using a proportionally spaced font the HMI is the horizontal distance moved across the page when  
the printer receives a space control code <20h>.  
If any font characteristics are changed, or a Select Primary Font or Select Secondary Font control code is sent  
to the printer, the HMI is set to correspond to the default pitch value of the newly selected font.  
·
·
Changing the HMI setting does not affect the positions of the left and right margins.  
The factory default setting is 12 - that is, the printer will print ten characters of fixed pitch text per inch.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10 REM ***** SETTING THE CHARACTER PITCH *****  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 REM --- DEFAULT IS 10 CPI PITCH ---  
40 LPRINT "10 PITCH "  
50 REM --- SET 5 CPI PITCH ---  
60 LPRINT ESC$+"&k24H";  
70 LPRINT "AAA"  
80 REM --- SET 6 CPI PITCH ---  
90 LPRINT ESC$+"&k20H";  
100 LPRINT "AAA"  
110 REM --- SET 8 CPI PITCH ---  
120 LPRINT ESC$+"&k15H";  
130 LPRINT "AAA"  
140 REM --- SET 10 CPI PITCH ---  
150 LPRINT ESC$+"&k12H";  
160 LPRINT "AAA"  
170 REM --- SET 12 CPI PITCH ---  
180 LPRINT ESC$+"&k12H";  
190 LPRINT "AAA"  
200 REM --- SET 0 CPI PITCH ---  
210 LPRINT ESC$+"&kH";  
220 LPRINT "I CAN'T READ"  
230 REM --- PAPER EJECT ----  
240 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
250 END  
<Sample file 2>  
4.2.16. Setting line spacing  
Esc&l#D (27)(38)(108)#(68)  
# stands for the number of lines to be printed per inch.  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<44h>  
·
·
·
·
·
# can have any of the following values: 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 12, 16, 24 or 48.  
This command performs the same function as the VMI command.  
Changing the line spacing setting does not affect the position of the top margin.  
The factory default setting is 6 - that is, the printer will print six lines of text per inch.  
Depending on your printer model, the number of lines per page can also be set from the printer’s control  
panel or remote printer console (see the User Guide).  
4.2.17. Text length  
Esc&l#F (27)(38)(108)#(70)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<46h>  
# stands for the number of lines of text (at the current VMI) to be printed on each page.  
·
·
·
Values for # should be within the value (Logical Page length-Top margin).  
Text is printed from the top margin downwards.  
If you specify a value that would cause the text area to extend beyond the end of the logical page, the  
command is ignored.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Top margin  
Page length  
Text length  
Bottom margin  
4.2.18. Page length  
Esc&l#P (27)(38)(108)#(80)  
# stands for the length of the logical page in lines (at the current VMI).  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<50h>  
·
·
·
If you specify a page length greater than is allowed by the physical size of the paper in the currently installed  
paper tray, a control panel message prompts you to load paper of the appropriate size.  
When the printer receives this command any unprinted pages are printed and the left, right and top margins  
and the text length are set to their user defaults.  
If you specify a page length greater than is allowed by any of the supported paper sizes, the command is  
ignored.  
·
·
If the current VMI is 0 the command is ignored.  
For the USA, the factory default page size is letter, for which the default page length is 66 lines (11 inches at 6  
lines per inch). For Europe, the factory default page size is A4, for which the default page length is 70 lines  
(11.6 inches at 6 lines per inch). The default lengths for other paper sizes are: Legal - 84 lines, Executive - 63  
lines (all at 6 lines per inch).  
·
Depending on your printer model, you can also set the page length from the printer’s control panel or remote  
printer console by setting LINES to the required number of lines per page in the PAGE FORMAT mode (see  
the User Guide).  
10 REM ******* SETTING THE PAGE LENGTH TO 66 LINES *******  
20 REM  
30 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
40 LPRINT ESC$+"&l66P";  
50 FOR I=1 TO 67  
60 LPRINT STR$(I)  
70 NEXT  
80 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
90 END  
4.2.19. Perforation skip  
You can set the printer to flow text from one page to the next when it encounters a line feed (or half line feed) that  
would otherwise move the cursor position to below the bottom of the text area. When perforation skip is enabled  
the cursor is automatically moved to the top left hand corner of the text area on the next page and printing  
continues.  
Esc&l#L (27)(38)(108)#(76)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<4Ch>  
# is either 0 or 1.  
·
·
·
·
# = 0 turns the perforation skip feature off.  
# = 1 turns the perforation skip feature on.  
The factory default mode is perforation skip on.  
Whenever the perforation skip mode is changed, the top margin and page length values are reset to their  
default values.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2.20. Positioning the cursor  
You can position the cursor anywhere on the logical page. In addition, the cursor position is automatically  
changed when text or graphics are printed. You can either position the cursor using absolute PCL coordinate  
values or position it relative to the current cursor position, using dots, decipoints or rows and columns as units.  
In case of using dots, the units value is defined by the ESC & u # d command. The commands for positioning the  
cursor are listed below.  
4.2.21. Vertical positioning  
Vertical cursor positioning - rows  
Esc&a#R (27)(38)(97)#(82)  
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<52h>  
# = number of rows  
·
·
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of rows parameter indicates that the cursor is to be positioned  
relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be repositioned  
vertically downwards on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved upwards.  
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the vertical repositioning is absolute - the cursor will be  
repositioned the specified number of rows below the top margin, the PCL coordinate system’s x-axis.  
·
·
·
The parameter value can have up to two decimal places.  
The cursor’s horizontal position remains unchanged.  
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor  
will be positioned at either the top or bottom of the logical page as appropriate.  
Vertical cursor positioning - units  
Esc*p#Y (27)(42)(112)#(89)  
<1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<79h>  
# = number of units  
·
·
Units value is defined by the Esc & u # D command.  
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of dots parameter indicates that the cursor is to be positioned  
relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be repositioned  
vertically downwards on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved upwards.  
·
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the vertical repositioning is absolute - the cursor will be  
repositioned the specified number of dots below the top margin, the PCL coordinate system’s x-axis.  
·
·
The cursor’s horizontal position remains unchanged.  
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor  
will be positioned at either the top or bottom of the logical page as appropriate.  
Vertical cursor positioning - decipoints  
Esc&a#V (27)(38)(97)#(86)  
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<56h>  
# = number of decipoints in 1/720"  
·
·
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of decipoints parameter indicates that the cursor is to be  
positioned relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be  
repositioned vertically downwards on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved upwards.  
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the vertical repositioning is absolute - the cursor will be  
repositioned the specified number of decipoints below the top margin, the PCL coordinate system’s x-axis.  
·
·
The cursor’s horizontal position remains unchanged.  
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor  
will be positioned at either the top or bottom of the logical page as appropriate.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2.22. Horizontal position  
Horizontal cursor positioning - columns  
Esc&a#C (27)(38)(97)#(67)  
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<43h>  
# = number of columns  
·
·
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of columns parameter indicates that the cursor is to be positioned  
relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be repositioned  
to the right on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved to the left.  
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the horizontal repositioning is absolute - the cursor will  
be repositioned the specified number of columns to the right of the left edge of the logical page, the PCL  
coordinate system’s y-axis.  
·
·
·
The parameter value can have up to two decimal places.  
The cursor’s vertical position remains unchanged.  
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor  
will be positioned at either the left or right edge of the logical page as appropriate.  
10 REM ***** HORIZONTAL CURSOR POSITIONING *****  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 REM  
40 REM --- POSITIONING CURSOR AT COLUMN 10 ---  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"&a10C";  
60 LPRINT "A";  
70 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 5 COLUMNS TO THE LEFT ---  
80 LPRINT ESC$+"&a-5C";  
90 LPRINT "B";  
100 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 10 COLUMNS TO THE RIGHT ---  
110 LPRINT ESC$+"&a+10C";  
120 LPRINT "C";  
130 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
140 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
150 END  
<Sample file 3>  
Horizontal cursor positioning - units  
Esc*p#X (27)(42)(112)#(88)  
<1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<58h>  
# = number of units  
·
·
The Units value is defined by the Esc & u # D command.  
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of dots parameter indicates that the cursor is to be positioned  
relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be repositioned  
to the right on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved to the left.  
·
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the horizontal repositioning is absolute - the cursor will  
be repositioned the specified number of dots to the right of the left edge of the logical page, the PCL  
coordinate system’s y-axis.  
·
·
The cursor’s vertical position remains unchanged.  
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor  
will be positioned at either the left or right edge of the logical page as appropriate.  
10 REM ***** HORIZONTAL CURSOR POSITIONING *****  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 REM  
40 REM --- POSITIONING CURSOR AT 1 INCH ---  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"*p300X";  
60 LPRINT "A";  
70 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 0.5 INCHES TO THE LEFT ---  
80 LPRINT ESC$+"*p-150X";  
90 LPRINT "B";  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
100 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 1 INCH TO THE RIGHT ---  
110 LPRINT ESC$+"*p+300X";  
120 LPRINT "C";  
130 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
140 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
150 END  
<Sample file 4>  
Horizontal cursor positioning - decipoints  
Esc&a#H (27)(38)(97)#(72)  
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<48h>  
# = number of decipoints 1/720"  
·
·
A plus or minus sign preceding the number of decipoints parameter indicates that the cursor is to be  
positioned relative to its current position. A signed positive parameter value signifies that the cursor is to be  
repositioned to the right on the page, a negative value means that it will be moved to the left.  
An unsigned number as the parameter signifies that the horizontal repositioning is absolute - the cursor will  
be repositioned the specified number of decipoints to the right of the left edge of the logical page, the PCL  
coordinate system’s y-axis.  
·
·
The cursor’s vertical position remains unchanged.  
If you attempt to move the cursor to a position that is outside the boundaries of the logical page, the cursor  
will be positioned at either the left or right edge of the logical page as appropriate.  
10 REM ***** HORIZONTAL CURSOR POSITIONING *****  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 REM  
40 REM --- POSITIONING CURSOR AT 1 INCH ---  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"&a720H";  
60 LPRINT "A";  
70 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 0.5 INCHES TO THE LEFT ---  
80 LPRINT ESC$+"&a-360H";  
90 LPRINT "B";  
100 REM --- MOVING CURSOR 1 INCH TO THE RIGHT ---  
110 LPRINT ESC$+"&a+720H";  
120 LPRINT "C";  
130 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
140 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
150 END  
<Sample file 5>  
4.2.23. Positioning the cursor using control codes  
The carriage return, space, horizontal tab and backspace control codes can also be used to reposition the cursor  
using the current VMI and HMI settings.  
4.2.24. Using the cursor position stack  
You can save and retrieve up to 20 cursor positions using the cursor position stack.  
Esc&f#S (27)(38)(102)#(115)  
<1Bh><26h><66h>#<73h>  
# = 0 or 1  
·
·
Setting # to 0 stores the current cursor position on the stack.  
Setting # to 1 retrieves the cursor position currently on the top of the stack and makes it the current cursor  
position.  
·
Resetting the printer deletes all the positions from the stack.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2.25. Half line feed  
Esc=(27)(61) <1Bh><3Dh>  
This command moves the cursor down half a row as defined by the last VMI or line spacing command (Esc&l#C).  
4.2.26. Logical page orientation  
Esc&l#O (27)(38)(108)#(79)  
<1Bh><26h><6Ch>#<4Fh>  
# = 0, 1, 2 or 3  
·
·
This command sets the orientation of the logical page relative to the physical page.  
Values of # produce orientations as follows: 0 = portrait, 1 = landscape, 2=reverse portrait and 3 = reverse  
landscape.  
·
Sending this command to the printer causes the page length, text length, top, left and right margins to be set  
to their user default values. Any previously transmitted data is printed out and the cursor is positioned at the  
top left hand corner of the text area on the next page.  
·
·
Portrait or Landscape orientation can also be selected from the printer’s control panel.  
The factory default orientation is portrait.  
X
(0,0)  
"TEXT"  
Y
Top margin  
Physical page  
Logical page  
X
(0,0)  
Y
Portrait  
# = 0  
Landscape # = 1  
Y
(0,0)  
Physical page  
Logical page  
Top margin  
X
Y
(0,0)  
X
Reverse portrait  
Reverse landscape  
# = 2  
# = 3  
4.2.27. Text direction  
Esc&a#P (27)(38)(97)#(80)  
<1Bh><26h><61h>#<50h>  
# = 0, 90, 180 or 270.  
·
This command changes the orientation of the logical page relative to the physical page, but without the side  
effects of the logical page orientation command. Hence you can print text in different directions on the same  
page.  
·
·
Values of # have the following effects: 0 = portrait, 90 = landscape, 180= reverse portrait and 270 = reverse  
landscape. The value specifies the angle through which the text direction is rotated counterclockwise.  
The cursor position remains at the same physical page position.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
All subsequent text is printed in the newly selected orientation.  
The PCL coordinate system and margin settings are rotated through the specified angle. Hence the cursor  
coordinates will change.  
·
·
HP-GL/2 graphics images cannot be rotated using this command.  
The factory default orientation is portrait.  
10 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
20 REM --- PRINTER RESET ---  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
40 REM --- MOVING CURSOR TO X=500, Y=500 ---  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"*p500X";  
60 LPRINT CHR$(27);"*p500Y";  
70 REM --- 0 deg ---  
80 LPRINT CHR$(27);"&a0P";  
90 LPRINT "BROTHER ";  
100 REM --- 90 deg ---  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27);"&a90P";  
120 LPRINT "BROTHER ";  
130 REM --- 180 deg ---  
140 LPRINT CHR$(27);"&a180P";  
150 LPRINT "BROTHER ";  
160 REM --- 270 deg ---  
170 LPRINT CHR$(27);"&a270P";  
180 LPRINT "BROTHER ";  
190 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
200 LPRINT CHR$(12)  
210 END  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.  
USING FONTS  
5.1. Introduction  
A font is a collection of characters that have common characteristics, such as size, style and typeface, and which  
ranges over a given set of symbols. For example, 12 point Tennessee Bold in the Roman-8 symbol set is a typical  
HL Series font. Different sorts of fonts are used to create various typographic effects. Traditionally, large point  
size sans serif typeface fonts, like Helsinki and Utah are used for document headlines while smaller fonts with  
serif typefaces, like Tennessee and Portugal are used for body text. In LaserJet mode you can have access to a  
large range of fonts that are already built in to the printer’s ROM, plus the facility for downloading more fonts  
from a personal computer or plugging in font cards/cartridges or the storage device. When you select a font for  
printing you will specify a number of characteristics which identify the font you require. The laser printer does its  
best to print using the font you specified, but if amongst all its available fonts it does not have the exact one that  
you specified, it will compromise and give you what it regards as the closest available font. Sometimes the results  
will not be what you expected and you should exercise care in selecting fonts for printing.  
In most instances the selection of a font will be handled automatically from your word processing software or  
other applications package. In these cases you need only ensure that the correct font is available (that is, as a  
standard font in the ROM, on cartridge/card or downloaded) and the application will do the rest. You do not need  
to concern yourself with sending any escape sequences.  
As well as using software commands you can also select fonts using the printer’s control panel. Consult the  
printer User Guide for details.  
5.1.1. Font types  
There are two types of fonts supported by the HL Series printers in LaserJet mode - bitmap fonts and scalable  
fonts.  
5.1.2. Bitmap fonts  
The characters which make up a bitmap font are raster bit images of the relevant symbols. When text is printed  
using the font it is nearly always monospaced and when you select the font you specify it by its typeface, pitch  
(the number of characters printed per inch), height (point size) and symbol set.  
5.1.3. Scalable fonts  
The printer has many scalable fonts available as standard. The following table shows scalable fonts available for  
models HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN. (For the other models'  
resident fonts, please see the printer User's Guide.)  
Intellifont Compatible Fonts:  
HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/  
2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
ü
Alaska  
Antique Oakland  
PcBrussels  
Medium, Extra Bold  
Medium, Oblique, Bold  
Light, Light italic, Demi, Demi italic  
Medium, Oblique, Bold, BoldOblique  
Oklahoma  
Cleveland Condensed  
Connecticut  
Brougham  
Guatemala  
LetterGothic  
Maryland  
PcTennessee  
PcBrussels  
Utah  
Medium, Oblique, Bold, Bold oblique  
Antique, Italic, Bold, Bold italic  
Medium, Oblique, Bold  
Roman, Italic, Bold, Bold italic  
Light, Demi, LightItalic, DemiItalic  
Medium, Oblique, Bold, BoldOblique  
Medium, Oblique, Bold, Bold oblique  
Utah Condensed  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Microsoft Windows 3.1 TrueType Compatible Fonts:  
HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/  
2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
ü
ü
ü
ü
Tennessee  
Helsinki  
BR Symbol  
W Dingbats  
Roman, Italic, Bold, Bold Italic  
Medium, Oblique, Bold, BoldOblique  
BR-Script Fonts:  
HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/  
2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
ü
Atlanta  
Book, BookOblique, Demi,  
DemiOblique  
ü
ü
ü
Copenhagen  
Portugal  
Calgary  
Roman, Italic, Bold, Bold italic  
Roman, Italic, Bold, Bold italic  
MediumItalic  
Brother Original Fonts:  
HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/  
2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
ü
ü
ü
ü
Bermuda Script  
German  
US Roman  
San Diego  
You can select a font in any of these typefaces, specifying height (point size) and symbol set. Characters printed  
in scalable fonts are always proportionally spaced - that is, the spacing between characters on a line depends on  
their shapes. To add to the number of fonts available, you can buy scalable typeface cartridges/cards which you  
can insert into the printer’s cartridge/card slots and scalable typeface disks from which you can copy the  
typefaces into the printer’s memory. You can also create your own downloadable scalable typefaces, using  
software commands.  
5.1.4. Bound fonts  
Bound fonts are fonts which have only a single symbol set.  
5.1.5. Unbound fonts  
Unbound fonts are fonts which have a large amount of symbols selected from a complementary symbol index  
(intellifont) or unicode symbol index (TrueType).  
5.1.6. Font sources  
Depending on your printer model, fonts available to the printer can be in one of three places, either in the  
printer’s ROM as supplied from the factory, on a cartridge/card, on the storage device, or in the printer’s RAM.  
RAM fonts are downloaded from a personal computer.  
5.1.7. Internal fonts  
The printer comes with some bitmap fonts contained in its ROM and many scalable typefaces which can be used  
to create scalable fonts.  
5.1.8. Card/cartridge fonts  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
You can buy cartridge/card -based bitmap fonts and scalable typefaces. Plug the cartridge/card into one of the  
printer’s cartridge/card slots and then select any font from them as if it were in the printer’s ROM. Depending on  
your model, you can also save bitmap fonts and scalable typeface in the flash ROM memory, installed optional  
storage device and you can use any of these as if they were a font card.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.1.9. Downloadable fonts  
You can buy diskettes containing fonts which can be copied directly to the printer using the DOS COPY  
command. You can also design your own fonts and download them to the printer.  
One disadvantage of downloaded fonts is that they reside in the printer’s RAM memory. The printer also uses  
this memory for composing the text and graphic output that it prints on the page. If the memory contains too  
many fonts the printer may run out of memory. Since downloaded fonts are stored in the printer’s RAM they are  
lost when the printer is switched off, and you must download them again before you can use them.  
5.1.10. Primary and secondary fonts  
The printer maintains two sets of font characteristics which define its primary and secondary fonts. The primary  
font is the one it will use by default, the secondary font can be selected instead. This facility enables you to have  
two parallel font definitions that you can switch between easily without invoking long escape sequences. You  
can select the primary and secondary fonts using PCL commands.  
Depending on your model, you can also set any available fonts to be the printer’s user default primary and  
secondary fonts using the printer’s control panel. Refer to the User Guide for instructions on how to do this.  
The factory default settings for both primary and secondary fonts are Brougham 12 point, 10 cpi Roman 8.  
5.1.11. Specifying the primary font  
When you specify primary font characteristics you send escape codes with ‘(’ as the second character of the  
sequence. This tells the printer that the font characteristic you are specifying applies to the primary font.  
5.1.12. Specifying the secondary font  
When you specify secondary font characteristics you send escape codes with ‘)’ as the second character of the  
sequence. This tells the printer that the font characteristic you are specifying applies to the secondary font.  
5.1.13. Selecting the default fonts  
To set the primary font settings to those of the printers default font and discard all the software settings you  
have made in the meantime, send the printer the following escape sequence:  
Esc(3@ (27)(40)(51)(64)  
<1Bh><28h><33h><40h>  
To set the secondary font settings to those of the printers default font send:  
Esc)3@ (27)(41)(51)(64) <1Bh><29h><33h><40h>  
5.1.14. Switching between the primary and secondary fonts  
To select the primary font as the font for printing send the printer the SI control code:  
SI (15)  
(0F)  
To select the secondary font as the font for printing send the printer the SO control code:  
SO (14) (0E)  
5.1.15. Criteria for font selection  
The printer will try to match your stated font requirements as best it can with the fonts available to it in any of the  
three possible font locations. In most cases you will be specifying a font you know to be present in one of the  
locations and the resulting printed text will appear exactly as you envisaged. However, if you specify a particular  
combination of font characteristics that is not possible, the printer will produce the closest possible match that it  
can by satisfying the following specifications in the following order: symbol set / spacing type / pitch (for  
monospaced fonts) / height / stroke weight / style.  
The meanings of each of these are explained in the following sub-sections. Likewise, if you simply specify a font  
attribute that is not available, for example if you request a Utah Light font when only Utah Medium and Utah Bold  
are available in the font locations, the printer will simply ignore the requirement (light stroke weight, in this case)  
that it cannot fulfill.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.1.16. Symbol set  
The symbol set is the list of symbols that constitute a particular font. Normally, symbol sets contain lower and  
upper case letters, numbers, punctuation marks and a selection of other commonly used symbols. Some symbol  
sets are designed for specific needs, for example, for generating text with mathematical expressions. The symbol  
set has the highest priority of all the characteristics you specify when you designate the font you require. If the  
symbol set you choose is available, but not in conjunction with any of the other characteristics you specify, the  
printer will satisfy your symbol set request at the expense of the rest of your designation and the text printed out  
may well look completely different from what you expected to see.  
5.1.17. Symbol collections  
The symbol collections contain many symbols and a symbol set is made from symbol collections by selecting the  
required symbols for unbound fonts. As symbol collections have more symbols than symbol sets, unbound  
fonts can have more symbols than bound fonts. Due to the compatibility between symbol sets and symbol  
collections, the printer searches the designated MSL or Unicode number by using a symbol set mapping table.  
5.1.18. Type of character spacing  
Character spacing is either fixed (monospacing), in which every printed character is allocated the same amount of  
space on the line, or proportional, where characters are spaced according to their shape and size. For any serious  
typographic work proportional spacing is essential since fixed spacing is unattractive and hard to read. In  
general, monospacing is used with bitmap fonts and proportional spacing is used with scalable fonts. However,  
proportionally spaced bitmap fonts do exist.  
5.1.19. Pitch  
Pitch is the number of characters that are printed per inch and therefore only applies to monospaced fonts. If you  
make a pitch selection while using a proportionally spaced font the command will have no immediate effect.  
However, the new pitch will be stored as part of the primary (or secondary) font designation and applied the next  
time a monospaced font is selected as the primary (or secondary) font.  
The printer’s in-built bitmap fonts all have a pitch of either 10, 12 or 16.66 characters per inch.  
5.1.20. Height  
Height refers to the height in points (1/72") of unaccented capital letters in a font. This is the generally accepted  
method of defining the height of a font’s characters. Scaled fonts can be specified to an accuracy of 0.25 points.  
5.1.21. Style  
A font’s style is defined by its posture (upright or italic), width (condensed, normal or expanded) and structure  
(solid, outline or shadow). Upright and italic bitmap fonts and scalable typefaces are available in the printer’s  
ROM. However, these are all normal and solid fonts. To print using any of the other styles (for example, using  
Condensed Helsinki or Outline Tennessee) you would have to download the requisite font or install a font  
card/cartridge containing it.  
5.1.22. Stroke weight  
Stroke weight refers to the thickness of the lines which make up the printed characters. Characters of normal line  
thickness are called medium. Thicker lines are referred to as bold or black and thinner lines as light or thin. You  
can specify 15 different stroke weights - 0 denotes medium weight, negative values signify thinner strokes, and  
positive values signify bolder (thicker) strokes. If you have the bold font available that matches your font  
designation, a stroke weight selection of 1 to 7 will produce bold text. Likewise, for light or thin text you would  
need to make the requisite light or thin font available for the stroke weight selection to have any effect.  
5.1.23. Typeface  
Typeface refers to the designed style of the characters. Commonly known typefaces include Times, Helvetica,  
Univers and Palatino. The printer has its own resident typefaces. When selecting a particular typeface ensure  
that it meets all your other specified criteria, otherwise the printer will substitute a font of a different typeface that  
can satisfy the other, higher priority criteria, such as style and stroke weight.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.2. Font Selection Commands  
5.2.1. User-defined symbol sets  
User-defined symbol sets can be used with Unbound scalable fonts. Three new commands below are prepared  
for use to control a user-defined symbol set.  
To define a symbol set, its ID code must first be defined.  
Next, a list of symbols for the symbol set must be downloaded.  
Then, you can use the defined ID code for the symbol set selection.  
5.2.2. Symbol set ID code command  
Esc*c#R (27)(42)(99)#(82)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<52h>  
·
·
Value for # can be from 0 to 2047.  
This command defines the ID code for a user-defined symbol set which can be used to control symbol set  
selection.  
·
·
The symbol set ID code defined by this command must be calculated by using the following formula.  
Symbol Set ID Code = ( # x 32 ) + ( ID - 64 )  
Symbol set selection values consists of numerical character(s) and an alphabetical character.  
For example, 8U is the symbol set selection value for Roman-8. In this case, the Symbol set ID code  
is 277 as the result of the following calculation.  
(8 x 32 ) + (85 - 64) = 277  
Make sure to select an unused number for a new ID code that you define. If the ID code has been used  
already, the printer deletes the existing symbol set and defines the new symbol set.  
5.2.3. Define symbol set  
Esc(f#W[data] (27)(49)(102)#(87)  
<1Bh><28h><66h>#<57h>  
·
·
·
·
·
# value can be from 18 to 32767.  
# stands for number of bytes of data that follow this command.  
If an existing ID code is used for a user-defined symbol set, it is overwritten.  
Up to 2047 downloadable user-defined symbol sets can be stored subject to the printer's memory capacity.  
If a memory full error occurs while downloading the user-defined symbol set, the symbol set which is being  
downloaded becomes invalid.  
·
·
The symbol set which is defined by this command is temporarily stored in the printer memory.  
The data following this command should be in the following format.  
15  
8
7
0
MSB  
LSB  
0 - 1 Header Size (18)  
2 - 3 Encoded symbol set designator  
4 - 5 Format  
Symbol Set Type  
6 - 7 First Code  
8 - 9 Last Code  
10 - Character Requirements  
Symbol Map [Last Code - First code + 1 ]  
(B)  
Boolean  
(0,1)  
(UB)  
(SB)  
Unsigned Byte  
Signed Byte  
(0 ~ 255)  
( -128 ~ 127 )  
(UI)  
(SI)  
(ULI)  
(SLI)  
(ASC**)  
Unsigned Integer  
Signed Integer  
( 0 ~ 65535 )  
( - 32768 ~ 32767 )  
Unsigned Long Integer ( 0 ~ 232-1)  
Signed Long Integer  
ASCII string array  
(-231 ~ 231 - 1)  
(0 ~ **-1) of characters  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
0 -1: Header size (UI) - set to 18 or greater.  
This value stands for the number of header bytes.  
2 -3 : Encoded Symbol Set Designator (UI) - should be as same as the ID code which is defined by ESC*c#R.  
4 :  
Format (UB) - 1 for MSL (Intellifont), 3 for Unicode (TrueType).  
5 :  
Symbol Set Type (UB) - 0, 1 or 2.  
0 specifies a 7-bit font with character codes 20H to 7FH acceptable.  
1 specifies an 8-bit font with character codes 20H to 7FH and 80H to FFH acceptable.  
2 specifies 8-bit 256 all character fonts. Only when the printer is set to transparent print mode can the  
characters 0, 7~15 and 27 be printed.  
6 - 7: First Code (UI) - indicates the first code of definition data following this header.  
8 -9: Last Code (UI) - indicates the last code of definition data following this header. This value should be more  
than the first code value. Also, the data followed this header should have (Last code - first code + 1)  
bytes.  
10 - 17:  
Character Requirement Flag ( 8 bytes )  
Used in conjunction with the character complement field in the header of the font descriptor to decide the  
compatibility of a symbol set for an unbound font. This flag indicates which symbol collections are  
necessary to make the required symbol set.  
Each bit in this field stands for the selection of each symbol collection. When set to 1, the symbol  
collection is included and when set to 0, the symbol collection is not included in the unbound scalable  
font.  
Character Requirements for MSL Symbol index  
Bit  
Value  
Designated Use  
63  
1
0
Basic Latin required (such as ISO 8859/1 Latin 1)  
Basic Latin not required  
62  
61  
1
0
1
0
East European Latin required (such as ISO 8859/2 Latin 2)  
Basic European Latin not required  
Turkish required (such as ISO 8859/9 Latin 5)  
Turkish not required  
34  
1
0
Math required (such as Math-8)  
Math not required  
33  
1
0
Semi-graphic required (such as PC-8 D/N)  
Semi-graphic not required  
32  
1
0
Dingbats required (such as ITC Zapf Dingbats series 100, series 200 )  
Dingbats not required  
2,1,0  
000  
MSL Symbol index  
Character Requirements for Unicode Symbol index  
Bit  
Value  
Designated Use  
31  
1
0
ASCII required (such as ISO 6 ASCII)  
ASCII not required  
30  
29  
1
0
1
0
West Europe extensions required (such as ISO 69 French)  
West Europe extensions not required  
East Europe extensions required (such as ISO 8859/2 Latin 2)  
East Europe extensions not required  
28  
1
0
Turkish extensions required (such as ISO 8859/9 Latin 5)  
Turkish extensions not required  
27  
1
0
1
0
Desktop Publishing extensions required (such as Windows 3.1)  
Desktop Publishing extensions not required  
Accent extensions required (such as ISO 8859/1 Latin 1)  
Accent extensions not required  
26  
25  
1
0
PCL extensions required (such as Roman-8)  
PCL extensions not required  
24  
1
0
Macintosh extensions required (such as MC text)  
Macintosh extensions not required  
23  
1
0
PostScript extensions required (such as PS Text)  
PostScript extensions not required  
22  
1
0
Code Page extensions required (such as PC-8)  
Code Page extensions not required  
2,1,0  
001  
Unicode Symbol Index  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Symbol map (Array of UI )  
The symbol map, which has a list of symbol index numbers, is used to define the symbols for the symbol set.  
This map defines the combinations of symbol index numbers and character codes.  
5.2.4. Symbol set control command  
Esc*c#S (27)(42)(99)#(83)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<53h>  
·
·
·
·
·
·
Values for # can be 0, 1, 2, 4, or 5.  
0 specifies to delete all temporary and permanent user-defined symbol sets.  
1 specifies to delete all temporary user-defined symbol sets.  
2 specifies to delete current user-defined symbol set.  
4 specifies to make current user-defined symbol set temporary.  
5 specifies to make current user-defined symbol set permanent.  
5.2.5. Selecting the symbol set  
Esc(symbol set ID (27)(40)  
This command selects the symbol set (character set) for the primary font.  
<1Bh><28h>  
·
·
·
Symbol set IDs consist of a number followed by a letter.  
Default symbol set ID is Roman-8. If an invalid default symbol set ID is selected, the symbol set becomes  
Roman-8.  
·
The selectable symbol set varies depending on the printer model.  
Symbol set  
Set primary font  
Esc(0D  
Esc(1D  
Esc(1E  
Esc(9E  
Esc(0F  
Esc(1F  
Esc(0G  
Esc(1G  
Esc(0I  
Symbol set  
Set primary font  
Esc(2K  
ISO 60 : Norwegian 1  
ISO 61 : Norwegian 2  
ISO 4 : United Kingdom  
Windows 3.1 Latin 2  
ISO 25 : French  
ISO 69 : French  
HP German  
ISO 21 : German  
ISO 15 : Italian  
Microsoft Publishing  
Desk Top  
ISO 57 : Chinese  
ISO8859-1 (ECMA-94) Latin 1  
Wingdings  
PS Math  
Ventura Math  
Math-8  
Esc(0N  
Esc(579L  
Esc(5M  
Esc(6M  
Esc(8M  
Esc(19M  
Esc(2N  
Esc(5N  
Esc(0S  
Esc(10J  
Esc(13J  
Esc(14J  
Esc(4S  
Symbol  
ISO 8859-2 Latin 2  
ISO 8859-9 Latin 5  
ISO 11: Swedish; names  
PS Text  
Ventura International  
Ventura US  
ISO 16 : Portuguese  
ISO 84 : Portuguese  
Windows 3.1 Latin 5  
ISO 6 : ASCII  
ISO 2 : IRV  
Windows 3.0 Latin 1  
PC-8 D/N  
Pi Font  
Windows 3.1 Latin 1  
Esc(6J  
Esc(7J  
HP Spanish  
Esc(1S  
Esc(2S  
Esc(3S  
Esc(0K  
Esc(6S  
Esc(9T  
Esc(1U  
Esc(8U  
Esc(10U  
Esc(12U  
Esc(17U  
Esc(12J  
ISO 17 : Spanish  
ISO 10 : Swedish  
ISO 14 : JIS ASCII  
ISO 85 : Spanish  
PC Turkish  
Legal  
Roman 8  
PC-8  
PC-850  
Esc(5S  
Esc(5T  
Esc(0U  
Esc(2U  
Esc(9U  
Esc(11U  
Esc(15U  
Esc (19U  
PC-852  
MC Text  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
User-defined symbol sets are defined by the command ESC ( f # W.  
Esc)symbol set ID (27)(41) <1Bh><29h>  
This command selects the symbol set (character set) for the secondary font.  
·
·
To select any of the above symbol sets for the secondary font simply substitute ‘)’ for ‘(’ in the command  
shown in the table.  
10 REM ****** SELECT A CHARACTER SET ******  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
40 REM --- ROMAN-8 CHARACTER SET SELECTION ------  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(8U";  
60 REM --- PRINT CHARACTERS ----  
70 FOR I=160 TO 255  
80 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
90 NEXT  
100 LPRINT  
110 REM --- PC-8 CHARACTER SET SELECTION ------  
120 LPRINT ESC$+"(10U";  
130 REM --- PRINT CHARACTERS ----  
140 FOR I=160 TO 255  
150 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
160 NEXT  
170 LPRINT  
180 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
190 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
200 END  
There is a further group of symbol sets that are available for Brother fonts only. You can select these as follows:  
Esc(s#C (27)(40)(115)#(67) <1Bh><28h><73h>#<43h>  
This command selects the symbol set (character set) for the primary font.  
·
Esc)s#C (27)(41)(115)#(67)  
<1Bh><29h><73h>#<43h>  
·
·
This command selects the symbol set (character set) for the secondary font.  
Brother symbol set IDs consist of a number only.  
Symbol Set  
Roman-8  
US ASCII  
German  
UK English  
French  
Dutch  
Set primary font  
Esc(s1C  
Symbol set  
Portuguese  
Swiss German  
American Spanish  
Norwegian/Danish  
Canadian  
Finnish/Swedish  
South African  
PC-8 D/N  
PC-8  
PC-850  
PC-860  
PC-863  
Set primary font  
Esc(s15C  
Esc(s16C  
Esc(s17C  
Esc(s18C  
Esc(s19C  
Esc(s20C  
Esc(s21C  
Esc(s23C  
Esc(s25C  
Esc(s26C  
Esc(s27C  
Esc(s28C  
Esc(s29C  
Esc(s38C  
Esc(s2C  
Esc(s3C  
Esc(s4C  
Esc(s5C  
Esc(s6C  
Esc(s7C  
Esc(s8C  
Esc(s9C  
Esc(s10C  
Esc(s11C  
Esc(s12C  
Esc(s13C  
Esc(s14C  
Italian  
S. Spanish  
A. English WP  
UK ASCII/2  
Symbol  
International  
American English  
UK ASCII  
PC-865  
Japanese English  
·
To select any of the above symbol sets for the secondary font simply substitute ‘)’ for ‘(’ in the command  
shown in the table.  
10 REM ****** SELECTING CHARACTER SETS ******  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
40 REM --- GERMAN CHARACTER SET SELECTION ------  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(s3C";  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
60 REM --- PRINT CHARACTERS ----  
70 FOR I=33 TO 127  
80 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
90 NEXT  
100 LPRINT  
110 REM --- FRENCH CHARACTER SET SELECTION ------  
120 LPRINT ESC$+"(s5C";  
130 REM --- PRINT CHARACTERS ----  
140 FOR I=33 TO 127  
150 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
160 NEXT  
170 LPRINT  
180 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
190 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
200 END  
5.2.6. Selecting the type of character spacing  
Esc(s#P (27)(40)(115)#(80)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<50h>  
·
This command selects the spacing type for the primary font.  
Esc)s#P (27)(41)(115)#(80)  
<1Bh><29h><73h>#<50h>  
·
·
This command selects the spacing type for the secondary font.  
# = 0 selects fixed spacing and # = 1 selects proportional spacing.  
10 REM ****** SELECTING A PROPORTIONAL OR FIXED SPACE FONT ******  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
40 REM --- SELECT A PROPORTIONALLY SPACED FONT ----  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(s1P";  
60 FOR I=33 TO 127  
70 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
80 NEXT  
90 LPRINT  
100 REM --- SELECT A FIXED SPACE FONT ---  
110 LPRINT ESC$+"(s0P";  
120 FOR I=33 TO 127  
130 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
140 NEXT  
150 LPRINT  
160 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
170 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
180 END  
5.2.7. Selecting the pitch  
Esc(s#H (27)(40)(115)#(72)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<48h>  
This command designates the pitch for the primary font.  
Esc)s#H (27)(41)(115)#(72)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<48h>  
·
·
This command designates the pitch for the secondary font.  
# = the number of characters to be printed per inch. However, the actual size range is defined in combination  
with the character height.  
·
The printer’s in-built bitmap fonts all have a pitch of either 10, 12 or 16.66 characters per inch, and you can  
specify any of these as follows:  
Esc&k0S  
Esc&k2S  
Esc&k4S  
( 10 cpi )  
( 16.66 cpi )  
( 12 cpi )  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
The selection will apply to whichever font you are currently specifying (primary or secondary).  
If the printer doesn't have the specified size font, the next largest size font is used. If the printer doesn't have  
a larger sized font, the next smallest one is used.  
·
This value is ignored by the printer when a proportional spaced font is selected.  
10 REM ****** CHARACTER PITCH SELECTION ******  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
40 REM --- SELECT A 10 CPI PITCH FONT ----  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(s10H";  
60 FOR I=33 TO 127  
70 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
80 NEXT  
90 LPRINT  
100 REM --- SELECT A 12 CPI PITCH FONT ---  
110 LPRINT ESC$+"(s12H";  
120 FOR I=33 TO 127  
130 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
140 NEXT  
150 LPRINT  
160 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
170 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
180 END  
5.2.8. Selecting the height  
Esc(s#V (27)(40)(115)#(86)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<56h>  
This command designates the height of the primary font.  
Esc)s#V (27)(41)(115)#(86)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<56h>  
·
·
·
This command designates the height of the secondary font.  
# is the size in points (1/72") from 0.25 to 999.75 in 0.25 increments.  
This value is ignored by the printer when a fixed-spaced scalable font is selected.  
5.2.9. Scaling the scalable fonts vertically or horizontally  
EscCR!#H (27)(13)(33)#(72)<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<48h>  
This command designates the height of the scalable fonts.  
EscCR!#V (27)(13)(33)#(86)<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<56h>  
This command designates the width of the scalable fonts.  
·
·
# can be from 0.25 ~ 3.00 in 0.01 increments.  
# value is set to 0.25 when # is specified less than 0.25, and # value is set to 3.00 when # is specified bigger  
than 3.00.  
·
The value set by this command is initialized when the emulation is changed, a printer Reset, Test Print or  
Macro overlay is executed.  
5.2.10. Selecting the style  
Esc(s#S (27)(40)(115)#(83)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<53h>  
·
This command designates the style of the primary font.  
Esc)s#S (27)(41)(115)#(83)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<53h>  
·
·
This command designates the style of the secondary font.  
If you select a particular style (for example upright condensed outline) the command will only take effect if the  
font is available in one of the three font locations.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Value  
0
1
Font Style  
Upright & solid  
Italic  
4
Condensed  
5
8
Condensed italic  
Compressed, or extra condensed  
Expanded  
Outline  
Inline  
24  
32  
64  
128  
160  
Shadowed  
Outline shadowed  
10 REM ****** PRINT IN ITALIC & UPRIGHT STYLE ******  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
40 REM --- PRINT USING AN ITALIC FONT ----  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"(s1S";  
60 REM --- PRINT FONT ----  
70 FOR I=33 TO 127  
80 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
90 NEXT  
100 LPRINT  
110 REM --- PRINT USING AN UPRIGHT FONT ---  
120 LPRINT ESC$+"(s0S";  
130 REM --- PRINT FONT ----  
140 FOR I=33 TO 127  
150 LPRINT CHR$(I);  
160 NEXT  
170 LPRINT  
180 REM -- PAPER EJECT ---  
190 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
200 END  
5.2.11. Selecting the stroke weight  
Esc(s#B (27)(40)(115)#(66)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<42h>  
This command designates the stroke weight of the primary font.  
·
Esc)s#B (27)(41)(115)#(66)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<42h>  
·
·
This command designates the stroke weight of the secondary font  
# is an integer between –7 and 7. A value of 0 signifies a medium stroke weight, negative numbers signify thin  
or light stroke weights and positive numbers signify bold stroke weights.  
·
If you select a light or bold stroke weight the command will only have an effect if the font is available in one of  
the three font locations.  
5.2.12. Selecting the typeface  
Esc(s#T (27)(40)(115)#(84)<1Bh><28h><73h>#<54h>  
·
This command designates the typeface of the primary font.  
Esc)s#T (27)(41)(115)#(84)<1Bh><29h><73h>#<54h>  
·
·
This command designates the typeface of the secondary font.  
If the typeface you specify is not available in any of the three font source locations the printer will substitute  
a font of a different typeface.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
The available values vary with the printer model. The following table shows the value for each typeface and  
availability.  
Typeface  
Set primary  
font  
Set secondary 1050 1250/ 1070 1270N 1660e 2400C 3400CN  
font  
P2500  
/ 2060 /Ce  
Alaska  
Antique Oakland  
Brougham  
Cleveland Condensed  
Connecticut  
Guatemala Antique  
LetterGothic  
Maryland  
Esc(s4362T  
Esc(s4168T  
Esc(s4099T  
Esc(s4140T  
Esc(s4116T  
Esc(s4197T  
Esc(s4102T  
Esc(s4297T  
Esc(s4113T  
Esc(s4143T  
Esc(s4101T  
Esc(s4148T  
Esc)s4362T  
Esc)s4168T  
Esc)s4099T  
Esc)s4140T  
Esc)s4116T  
Esc)s4197T  
Esc)s4102T  
Esc)s4297T  
Esc)s4113T  
Esc)s4143T  
Esc)s4101T  
Esc)s4148T  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Oakland  
PC Brussels  
PC Tennessee  
Utah  
BR Symbol  
Helsinki  
Tennessee  
W Dingbats  
Esc(s16686T  
Esc(s16602T  
Esc(s16901T  
Esc(s31402T  
Esc)s16686T  
Esc)s16602T  
Esc)s16901T  
Esc)s31402T  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Atlanta  
Calgary  
Copenhagen  
Portugal  
Esc(s155T  
Esc(s159T  
Esc(s157T  
Esc(s158T  
Esc)s155T  
Esc)s159T  
Esc)s157T  
Esc)s158T  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Letter Gothic16.66  
Brougham  
OCR-A  
Esc(s130T  
Esc(s128T  
Esc(s104T  
Esc(s110T  
Esc)s130T  
Esc)s128T  
Esc)s104T  
Esc)s110T  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
OCR-B  
Bermuda Script  
Germany  
San Diego  
US Roman  
Esc(s134T  
Esc(s132T  
Esc(s133T  
Esc(s135T  
Esc)s134T  
Esc)s132T  
Esc)s133T  
Esc)s135T  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
5.2.13. Font orientation  
The printer’s built-in fonts are all portrait fonts. If you switch the orientation of the logical page to landscape and  
select a font, the printer will automatically create the landscape font in its memory. This saves you having to make  
the landscape font available by installing a card/cartridge or by downloading the font, but takes up printer  
memory and may cause the printer to run out of space when trying to compose complex page layouts.  
5.2.14. Transparent print data  
Esc&p#X (character codes)  
(27)(38)(112)#(88)  
<1Bh><26h><70h>#<58h>  
·
·
·
This command enables you to print characters which are normally unprintable.  
# is the number of bytes of data that follow the command.  
Each byte of data is interpreted as a character code and the corresponding character in the currently selected  
symbol set is printed (if there is one). You can use this command to print the symbols in the character set  
which do not appear on the keyboard.  
·
·
If there is no character in the current symbol set corresponding to a specified code, a space is printed.  
The command is useful when using character sets like the IBM All Character Set in which every single code  
has a corresponding character.  
·
Any control codes within the data will have no effect. The control code byte is treated as a character code.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.2.15. Underlining text  
Esc&d#D (27)(38)(100)#(68)  
<1Bh><26h><64h>#<44h>  
·
·
·
·
This command enables the underline facility.  
# is either 0 or 3. A value of 0 signifies fixed underlining, 3 specifies floating underlining.  
Fixed underlining means that the underline is drawn in the same place for all the characters of a particular font.  
Floating underlining means that the underline is drawn in the same place for all the characters on a particular  
line.  
·
The command below disables the underline facility.  
Esc&d@  
(27)(38)(100)(64) <1Bh><26h><64h><40h>  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.3. Downloadable font manipulation  
Fonts that you have bought on diskette can be downloaded to the printer from diskette or hard disk using the  
DOS COPY command or a font downloading applications program. To create your own fonts you can use PCL  
commands to send the various blocks of data that comprise a downloadable font. There are also a number of PCL  
commands that enable you to manage fonts that you have already downloaded (both those that you have bought  
and those you may have created yourself).  
If you are using commercially available fonts consult the documentation that came with them for information on  
how best to send them to the printer.  
5.3.1. Font ID  
Esc&*c#D (27)(38)(42)(99)#(68)  
<1Bh><26h><2Ah><63h>#<44h>  
·
·
·
This command identifies the numerical ID of the font on which subsequent operations will be performed.  
# is the font ID number.  
Use this command to specify the ID number of a font that you are about to download, or of a font already in  
printer memory that you want to perform a particular operation on.  
·
If you specify the number of a font that already exists in memory and then download a new font from your  
computer, the new font will overwrite the original font and assume the ID number that you specified.  
5.3.2. Operations on downloaded fonts  
Esc*c#F (27)(38)(42)(99)#(70)  
<1Bh><26h><2Ah><63h>#<46h>  
·
·
·
·
This command performs an operation on one or more downloaded fonts.  
# identifies the operation to be performed.  
# = 0 Delete all downloaded fonts from the printer’s memory.  
# = 1 Delete all temporary fonts from the printer’s memory.  
(Fonts can be made permanent so as to be saved when the printer is reset - see below).  
·
·
# = 2 Delete the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) from the printer’s memory.  
# = 3 Delete the character (whose character code was most recently specified) from the font (whose ID number  
was most recently specified).  
(The command for specifying a character code is given in the section entitled Creating Downloadable  
Fonts).  
·
·
·
·
·
·
# = 4 Make the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) temporary  
# = 5 Make the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) permanent  
# = 6 Make/Assign a copy of the current font (primary or secondary) with the last specified ID number.  
# = 1026 Delete the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) from the storage device.  
# = 1028 Delete all download fonts in the storage device.  
# = 1029 Save the font (whose ID number was most recently specified) into the storage device.  
(All download fonts in the storage device are permanent fonts.)  
·
Note: #=1026, 1028, 1029 are available only when a storage device is installed into the printer.  
5.3.3. Selecting a downloaded font  
Esc(#X (27)(40)#(88)  
This command selects a downloaded font as the primary font.  
<1Bh><28h>#<58h>  
·
Esc)#X  
(27)(41)#(88)  
<1Bh><29h>#<58h>  
·
·
This command selects a downloaded font as the secondary font.  
# is the ID number of the downloaded font.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.4. Creating Downloadable Fonts  
5.4.1. Downloading  
You can download existing fonts (that is, ones that you have bought or ones that you have created previously)  
using either a font downloading application program or the DOS command  
COPY/b <filename> PRN  
In addition, some word-processing and DeskTop publishing programs will automatically download the fonts that  
have been used in a document when that document is printed.  
Alternatively, you can create a new downloadable font and download the necessary blocks of data that comprise  
the downloadable font using PCL commands.  
To send a font, you must send  
* a font descriptor block followed by the character code  
* a character descriptor  
* data for each character  
The printer can download 3 types of fonts.  
Bitmap fonts, Bound Scalable fonts and Unbound Scalable fonts.  
5.4.2. Sending the font descriptor  
Esc)s#W (font descriptor data) (27)(40)(115)#(58) <1Bh><28h><73h>#<88h>  
·
·
·
·
This command sends the font descriptor to the printer.  
# should be in the range 0 to 32767.  
# is the number of bytes in the descriptor.  
Characters are designed on a notional grid known as the character cell. The positioning and shape of each  
character on the grid defines its size, shape and alignment to the other characters in the font.  
Cell width  
Cell height  
Baseline distance  
x-height  
Baseline  
Underline distance  
Underline thickness  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
The Font descriptor has information for the whole character set. When this font descriptor is sent to the  
printer with a font header to identify the font ID, the descriptor parameters become the basis of the  
downloaded fonts.  
·
The data format for each type of font descriptor block is shown below.  
<Bitmap font>  
Byte 15 (MSB)  
8
7
(LSB) 0  
0 Font Descriptor Size (64)  
2 Descriptor
 
Format (0)  
4 Style MSB  
Font Type  
Reserved  
6 Base Line Position  
8 Cell Width  
10 Cell
 
Height  
12 Orientation  
Spacing  
14 Symbol Set  
16 Pitch (Default HMI)  
18 Height  
20 x-Height  
22 Width Type  
24 Stroke Weight  
26 Typeface
 
MSB  
28 Quality  
Style LSB  
Typeface LSB  
Serif Style  
Placement  
30 Underline Distance  
32 Text Height  
Underline Height  
34 Text
 
Width  
36 First Code  
38 Last Code  
40 Pitch Extended  
42 Cap
 
Height  
Height Extended  
44 - 47 Font Number  
48 - 63 Font Name  
64 Copyright (optional)  
<Special Bitmap font>  
Byte 15 (MSB)  
0 Font
 
Descriptor Size (68)  
2 Descriptor Format (20)  
4 Style MSB  
8
7
(LSB) 0  
Font Type  
Reserved  
6 Base Line Position  
8 Cell
 
Width  
10 Cell Height  
12 Orientation  
Spacing  
14 Symbol Set  
16 Pitch
 
(Default HMI)  
18 Height  
20 x-Height  
22 Width Type  
24 Stroke
 
Weight  
26 Typeface MSB  
28 Quality  
Style LSB  
Typeface LSB  
Serif Style  
Placement  
30 Underline Distance  
32 Text
 
Height  
Underline Height  
34 Text Width  
36 First Code  
38 Last Code  
40 Pitch
 
Extended  
42 Cap Height  
44 - 47 Font Number  
48 - 63 Font Name  
64 X
 
Resolution  
66 Y Resolution  
Height Extended  
X=Y: 300 or 600  
n
Copyright (Optional)  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
<Intellifont Scalable Bound font>  
Byte 15
 
(MSB)  
0 Font Descriptor Size (>80)  
2 Descriptor Format (10)  
4 Style MSB  
8
7
(LSB) 0  
Font Type  
Reserved  
6 Base
 
Line Position  
8 Cell Width  
10 Cell Height  
12 Orientation  
Spacing  
14 Symbol
 
Set  
16 Pitch (Default HMI)  
18 Height  
20 x-Height  
22 Width
 
Type  
Style LSB  
24 Stroke Weight  
26 Typeface MSB  
28 Quality  
Typeface LSB  
Serif Style  
Placement  
30 Underline
 
Distance  
32 Text Height  
Underline Height  
34 Text Width  
36 First Code  
38 Last
 
Code  
40 Pitch Extended  
42 Cap Height  
Height Extended  
44 - 47 Font Number  
48 - 63
 
Font Name  
64 Scale Factor  
66 Master X Resolution  
68 Master Y Resolution  
70 Master
 
Underline Position  
72 Master Underline Thickness (Height)  
74 OR Threshold  
76 Global Italic Angle  
Desc. size
 
Global Intellifont Data Size  
80 Global Intellifont Data  
n
Copyright (optional)  
Reserved  
Checksum  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
<Intellifont Scalable Unbound font>  
Byte 15 (MSB)  
0 Font Descriptor Size (<88)  
2 Descriptor Format (11)  
4 Style MSB  
8
7
(LSB) 0  
Font Type (10)  
Reserved  
6 Base Line Position  
8 Cell Width  
10 Cell Height  
12 Orientation  
Spacing  
14 Symbol Set  
16 Pitch (Default HMI)  
18 Height  
20 x-Height  
22 Width Type  
24 Stroke Weight  
26 Typeface MSB  
28 Quality  
Style LSB  
Typeface LSB  
Serif Style  
Placement  
30 Underline Distance  
32 Text Height  
34 Text Width  
Underline Thickness  
36 Reserved  
38 Number of Contours (Characters)  
40 Pitch Extended  
Height Extended  
42 Cap Height  
44 - 47 Font Number  
48 - 63 Font Name  
64 Scale Factor  
66 Master X Resolution  
68 Master Y Resolution  
70 Master Underline Position  
72 Master Underline Thickness  
74 OR Threshold  
76 Global Italic Angle  
78-85 Character Complement  
Desc. Size Global Intellifont Data size  
- 2  
Desc. size Global Intellifont Data  
n
Copyright (optional)  
Reserved  
Checksum  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
<TrueType Scalable Bound font>  
Byte 15 (MSB)  
8
7
(LSB) 0  
0 Font Descriptor Size (>72)  
2 Descriptor Format (15)  
4 Style MSB  
Font Type  
Reserved  
6 Base Line Position  
8 Cell Width  
10 Cell Height  
12 Orientation  
Spacing  
14 Symbol Set  
16 Pitch (Default HMI)  
18 Height  
20 x-Height  
22 Width Type  
Style LSB  
24 Stroke Weight  
26 Typeface MSB  
28 Quality  
Typeface LSB  
Serif Style  
Placement  
30 Underline Distance  
32 Text Height  
Underline Thickness  
34 Text Width  
36 First Code  
38 Last Code / Number of characters  
40 Pitch Extended  
42 Cap Height  
Height Extended  
44 - 47 Font Number  
48 - 63 Font Name  
64 Scale Factor  
66 Master Underline position  
68 Master Underline Thickness  
70 Font Scaling Technology  
Variety  
72 [ additional data may be inserted here ]  
Desc. size Segmented Font data  
# - 2 Reserved  
Checksum  
·
Attributes are in one of six numerical formats.  
Unsigned integer (UI) 0 to 65535  
Unsigned long integer (ULI) 0 to 232–1  
Signed integer (SI) –32768 to 32767  
Unsigned byte (UB) 0 to 255  
Signed byte (SB) –128 to 127  
Boolean 0 or 1  
·
·
Font descriptor size (UI) - the size in bytes of the font descriptor block. Minimum size values for each font  
type are shown in the above figure.  
Descriptor format (UB) - format type of the font.  
0
Bitmap font  
10  
11  
15  
20  
Intellifont bound scalable font  
Intellifont unbound scalable font  
TrueType bound scalable font  
Special bitmap font  
·
Font type (UB) - specifies type of symbol set.  
0
1
2
Bound font. A 7-bit font with character codes 20H to 7FH acceptable.  
Bound font. An 8-bit font with character codes 20H to 7FH and 80H to FFH acceptable.  
Bound font. 8-bit all character codes are printable. However, 00H, 07H to 0FH and 1BH are printable  
only when the data is defined as transparent print data.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10  
11  
Unbound font. Character codes corresponding to MSL numbers are acceptable.  
Unbound font. Character codes corresponding to Unicode numbers are acceptable.  
When a 7-bit font or 8-bit font is selected, it is possible for codes 00H to FFH to load characters or delete  
them. It is also possible to print the characters if they are defined as transparent print data.  
·
Style MSB (UW) - combined with the Style LSB to make the style word. The value of the style word is  
calculated as follows: style word = posture + (4 width) + (32 structure).  
Value  
Posture  
0
1
2
3
Upright  
Italic  
Alternate Italic  
Reserved  
Value  
Width  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Normal  
Condensed  
Compressed or Extra Condensed  
Extra compressed  
Ultra compressed  
Reserved  
Extended or Expanded  
Extra Extended or Extra Expanded  
Value  
Structure  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Solid  
Outline  
In-line  
Contour  
Solid with Shadow  
Outline with Shadow  
Inline with Shadow  
Contour with Shadow  
Patterned (Complex patterns, subject to type family )  
Patterned with Shadow  
Inverse  
8-11  
12-15  
16  
17  
18-30  
31  
Inverse in Open Border  
Reserved  
Unknown structure  
The reserved bits should be set to Zero.  
·
Baseline position (UI) -  
Bitmap font -  
the height in dots from the top of the character cell to the baseline. The units of dots is  
the same as the defined font resolution. This number can be in the range 0 to (cell  
height - 1).  
Intellifont scalable - a Y coordinate in the design cell.  
TrueType scalable - the height in dots from the top of the character cell to the baseline. This should be set  
to 0.  
·
·
Cell width (UI) - ignored by these printers. The width in dots of the character cell. This can be from 1 to 65535.  
Cell height (UI) - ignored by these printers. The height in dots of the character cell. This can be from 1 to  
65535.  
·
Orientation (UB) - 0(portrait), 1(landscape), 2(reverse portrait) or 3(reverse landscape). Ignored by these  
printers.  
·
·
Spacing (B) - the type of spacing, 0 (fixed pitch) or 1 (proportional spacing).  
Symbol set (UI) - a symbol set ID consists of a number and a letter. The symbol set attribute value is  
calculated as follows: symbol set = (32 x number) + (ASCII value of letter - 64). For example, Math-8 has the  
symbol set ID ‘8M’ so it would be encoded as (32 x 8) + (77 – 64) = 269.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Symbol set name  
Symbol set ID Symbol set name  
Symbol set ID  
Default Set  
Line Draw-7  
ISO 60: Danish/Norwegian  
Roman Extensions  
ISO 25: French  
HP German  
0@  
0B  
0D  
0E  
Math-7  
0A  
0C  
1D  
1E  
HP Large Characters (264x Terminals)  
ISO 61: Norwegian version 2  
ISO 4: United Kingdom  
ISO 69: French  
ISO 21: German  
Hebrew-7  
ISO 15: Italian  
DeskTop  
PS Text  
Ventura US  
ISO 13: Katakana  
Kana-8  
Line Draw-7 (Same as 0B)  
Tax Line Draw  
Math-7 (Same as 0A)  
PS Math  
Math-8  
ECMA-94 Latin 2 (ISO 8859/2)  
ECMA-113/88 Latin/Cyrillic  
OCR B  
APL (Typewriter Paired)  
Specials  
0F  
1F  
0G  
8G  
8H  
6J  
1G  
0H  
0I  
Greek-8  
Hebrew-8  
Microsoft Publishing  
Document  
Ventura International  
ISO 14: JIS ASCII  
ISO 57: Chinese  
Korean-8  
HP Block Characters  
Line Draw-8  
Tech-7  
7J  
8J  
10J  
14J  
1K  
8K  
0L  
13J  
0K  
2K  
9K  
1L  
2L  
8L  
0M  
5M  
8M  
2N  
10N  
1O  
0P  
xQ  
1R  
0S  
2S  
4S  
6S  
8S  
17S  
8T  
0U  
2U  
7U  
9U  
11U  
17U  
0V  
0Y  
2Y  
5Y  
7Y  
15Y  
1M  
6M  
0N  
5N  
0O  
2O  
1P  
0R  
3R  
1S  
3S  
5S  
7S  
16S  
18S  
0T  
1U  
5U  
8U  
10U  
12U  
15U  
8V  
1Y  
4Y  
6Y  
8Y  
Ventura Math  
ECMA-94 Latin 1 (ISO 8859/1)  
ECMA-128 Latin 5 (ISO 8859/9)  
OCR A  
OCR M  
APL (Bit Paired)  
Cyrillic ASCII (ECMA-113/86, ISO  
PC Cyrillic  
Cyrillic  
ISO 11: Swedish for Names  
ISO 17: Spanish  
ISO 16: Portuguese  
ISO 85: Spanish  
HP Latin Spanish  
HP-GL Drafting  
Turkish-8  
ISO 6: ASCII  
ISO 2: International Reference Version  
OEM-1  
Windows  
PC-8 D/N (Danish/Norwegian)  
PC-852  
Arabic (McKay’s version)  
3 of 9 Barcode  
Matrix 2 of 5 Barcode  
CODABAR Barcode  
Code 11 Barcode  
USPS Zip  
HP Spanish  
ISO 10: Swedish  
ISO 84: Portuguese  
HP European Spanish  
HP-GL Download  
HP-GL Special Symbols  
Thai-8  
Legal  
HP-GL Language Set  
Roman-8  
PC-8  
PC-850  
Pi Font  
Arabic-8  
Industrial 2 of 5 Barcode  
Interleaved 2 of 5 Barcode  
MSI/Plessey Barcode  
UPC/EAN Barcode  
·
Pitch (UI) - This value defines the default spacing for each point size in 1/4 dots. Combined with Pitch  
Extended to specify the pitch of the font in 1/1024 dots. This is available for fixed pitch font characters  
including the space character, and the space character of proportional spacing fonts.  
For example, in case of a 17 cpi font (at 600 dpi),  
1 inch  
600 dpi  
1 inch  
4
= 141.17646  
17 chara.  
1
the value of Pitch (UI) should be 141.  
The remainder of 0.17646 is calculated as pitch extended:  
0.17646  
256  
1
= 45.17376  
4
the value for pitch extended is 45.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
For Intellifont-scalable fonts only, the default HMI is calculated as follows.  
Default HMI (in dots) = (300 x master design pitch x required point size) ÷  
{Master x Resolution ÷(height x 8)}  
Default HMI ( in dots ) =  
(300 x master design pitch x required point size) ÷ {72.307 x scale factor}  
Height (UI) - specifies the height of the font in 1/4 dots. Combined with Height Extended to specify the  
height of the font in 1/1024 dots. This value can be converted to the point size (1/72").  
For example, in case of a 10 point font at 300 dpi,  
4
1
300 dots  
1 inch  
10 point  
= 166.667  
1 dots  
72  
This value is normally set to 2000 for Intellifont and should be set to zero for TrueType fonts.  
·
·
x-height (UI) - ignored by the HL Series printers. This word specifies the height (for Bitmap fonts) or the  
distance from the baseline (for Scalable fonts) of a lower case ‘x’ in 1/4 dots.  
Width type (SB) - ignored by the HL Series printers. This byte specifies the font character width according to  
the table below.  
Value  
–5  
Width type  
Ultra compressed  
Extra compressed  
Compressed or Extra condensed  
Condensed  
–4  
–3  
–2  
0
Normal  
2
Expanded  
3
Extra expanded  
·
·
Style LSB (UB) - see Style MSB.  
Stroke weight (SB) - valid values are from –7 to +7. 0 denotes the normal (Roman) stroke width, –7 is the  
lightest possible stroke and 7 is the boldest.  
Value  
–7  
–6  
–5  
–4  
–3  
–2  
–1  
0
Stroke Weight  
Ultra thin  
Extra thin  
Thin  
Extra light  
Light  
Demi light  
Semi light  
Medium, Book, or Text  
Semi bold  
Demi bold  
Bold  
1
2
3
4
5
Extra bold  
Black  
6
7
Extra black  
Ultra black  
·
Typeface family (UB) – the typeface. This word is made up of the Typeface MSB and the Typeface LSB and  
identifies the typeface by number.  
Bits 0 to 11 specify the typeface family and bits 12 to 15 specify the vending company.  
15  
12 11  
Typeface Family  
Vendor  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Value  
Vendor  
0
1
2
3
4
5
Reserved  
Agfa Division, Miles Inc.  
Bitstream Inc.  
Linotype Company  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Adobe Systems Inc.  
The Typeface family number can be 0 to 4095. This value is calculated as follows;  
(TrueType base value) + (Vendor value x 4096) = Typeface Family  
·
Serif style (UB) -  
Bitmap font - ignored by these printers.  
Scalable font - values for the lower 6 bits are ignored and values for the upper 2 bits indicates the serif style.  
Bit 6 indicates sans serif and bit 7 indicates serif.  
·
·
·
Quality (UB) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This byte specifies the fonts quality according to the  
following table.  
Placement (SB) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This byte specifies the placement of characters relative  
to the baseline according to the following table.  
Underline distance (SB) -  
Bitmap fonts - the distance in dots from the baseline to the underline. A positive value places the underline  
above the baseline, a negative value places it below the baseline. A value of 0 places it on the baseline.  
Scalable fonts - ignored by these printers. This value should be set to 0.  
·
·
·
Underline height (UB) - the height of underline itself.  
Bitmap fonts - this value is fixed at 3 dots.  
Scalable fonts - ignored by these printers. This value should be set to 0.  
Text height (UI) - ignored by these HL Series printers.  
This word specifies the spacing between successive lines of text in 1/4 dots for bitmap fonts and in design  
units for scalable fonts. This is normally about 1.2 times the fonts height.  
Text width (UI) - ignored by these HL Series printers.  
This word specifies the average width of the fonts lowercase characters in 1/4 dots for bitmap fonts and in  
design units for scalable fonts.  
·
·
·
First code (UI) - ignored by these printers. This word specifies the character code of the first (lowest  
numbered) printable character in the font.  
Last code (UI) - specifies the character code of the last (highest numbered) character in the font. If this value  
is less than 255, it is recognized as 00FFH.  
Pitch extended (UB) - the fractional part of the character pitch. For a 17 cpi font the bytes value would be  
calculated as follows:  
-
-
1200/17 = 70.588 The Pitch byte takes the value 70.  
Pitch Extended = 0.588 X 256 = 150 (rounded down).  
( According to HP's manual, this should be set to 0.) This printer ignores the value for scalable fonts.  
·
·
Height extended (UB) - the fractional part of the height of the font. For a 10 point font the bytes value would  
be calculated as follows:  
1200 X 10/72 = 166.667, the Height byte takes the value 166  
Height Extended = 0.667 X 256 = 170 (rounded down).  
Point size = (character height x 256 + extended character height) x 300 / (72 x 1024)  
( According to HP's manual, this should be set to 0.) These printers ignore the value for scalable fonts.  
Cap height data (UI) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This word specifies for the font the distance  
between the baseline and the top of an unaccented capital letter (for example, ‘H’), as a percentage of the  
font’s em rule, ‘—’.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
Font number (ULI) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This 4-byte field specifies the number assigned to  
the font by the vending company. The number is stored as a hexadecimal value in the lower three bytes, bytes  
44, 45 and 46.  
·
·
Font name (16 bytes) - ignored by these HL Series printers. This 16-byte field can be used to specify a name  
for the font.  
X-Resolution (UI) - specifies the resolution in the X-scan direction.  
This value can be 300 or 600 for bitmap fonts, and is normally set to 2540 for Intellifont scalable fonts. This is  
used for scaling the X-coordinates of font data to the required point size.  
After scaling ( in dots ) =  
(300 x the required point size x X-coordinate) ÷ {72.307 x scale factor (8782)}  
After scaling ( in dots ) =  
(300 x the required point size x X-coordinate) ÷ {Master X-resolution x (Height ÷ 8) }  
·
Y-Resolution (UI) - specifies the resolution in the Y-scan direction.  
This value should be set to 300 or 600 dpi for special bitmap fonts and is not available for Bitmap fonts and  
TrueType fonts.  
This is normally set to 2540 for Intellifont -scalable fonts and is used for scaling the Y-coordinates of the font  
data to the required point size.  
This value is calculated as:  
After scaling ( in dots ) = (300 x the required point size x Y-coordinate) ÷ (72.307 x scale factor (8782) )  
After scaling ( in dots ) = (300 x the required point size x Y-coordinate) ÷  
{Master Y-resolution x  
(Height ÷8)}  
·
Scale Factor (UI) - specifies the number of design units per Em. This value can be the unit for the metrics of  
Intellifont / TrueType scalable fonts.  
This is normally set to 8782 and is calculated for Intellifont as follows:  
·
·
·
Scale factor x 72.307 = resolution x height ÷ 8  
This is normally set to 2048 for TrueType fonts.  
Master Underline position (UI) - Specifies the distance from the baseline to the top of the underline in design  
units and this is an alternative for "Underline Position (bit 30)" only for scalable fonts.  
·
Master Underline height (UI) - specifies the height of the underline itself in design units and this is an  
alternative for "Underline Thickness (bit 31)" only for scalable fonts.  
·
·
·
Font Scaling Technology (UB) - specifies the type of font scaling technology for any scalable fonts.  
Variety (UB) - only for TrueType fonts, this value should be set to 0.  
OR (LRE) Threshold (UI) - specifies the pixel size in design units. This is switched on between scaling the font  
and its rasterization.  
·
Global Italic Angle (SI) - specifies the italic angle as a tangent relative to the vertical. The value 0 makes  
upright fonts.  
·
·
·
Global Intellifont Data Size (UI) - indicates the size of the global Intellifont data block.  
Global Intellifont Data - includes the global intellifont data.  
Character Complement (Array of UB) - identifies the symbol set compatibility for unbound fonts used with the  
Character Requirement flag in the symbol set descriptor.  
MSL Symbol Index  
Bit Field  
58 - 63  
55 - 57  
52 - 54  
50 - 51  
48 - 49  
3 - 47  
Designated Use  
Reserved for Latin fonts.  
Reserved for Cyrillic fonts.  
Reserved for Arabic fonts.  
Reserved for Greek fonts.  
Reserved for Hebrew fonts.  
Miscellaneous uses (South Asian, Armenian, other alphabets,  
bar codes, OCR, Math, PC Semi-graphics, etc.)  
Symbol Index field. 111 - MSL Symbol Index  
0 - 2  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Unicode Symbol Index  
Bit Field  
Designated Use  
32 - 63  
Miscellaneous uses (South Asian, Armenian, other alphabets, bar codes,  
OCR, Math, etc.)  
28 - 31  
22 - 27  
3 - 21  
0 - 2  
Reserved for Latin fonts.  
Reserved for platform / application variant fonts.  
Reserved for Cyrillic, Arabic, Greek and Hebrew fonts.  
Symbol Index field. 110 - Unicode Symbol Index  
MSL Symbol Index Character Complement bits  
Bit Field  
Designated Use  
63  
0 if font is compatible with standard Latin character sets (e.g., Roman-8,  
ISO 8859-1 Latin 1); otherwise set to 1.  
62  
0 if font is compatible with East European Latin character sets (e.g., ISO  
8859-2 Latin 2); otherwise set to 1.  
61  
0 if font contains Turkish character sets (e.g., ISO 8859/9 Latin 5);  
otherwise set to 1.  
34  
0 if font has access to the math characters of the Math-8, PS Math and  
Ventura Math character sets; otherwise set to 1.  
0 if font has access to the semi-graphic character of the PC-8, PC-850,  
etc. character sets; otherwise set to 1.  
33  
32  
0 if font is compatible with ITC Zapf Dingbats series 100, 200, etc.;  
otherwise set to 1.  
2,1,0  
111 if font is arranged in MSL symbol Index order.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.4.3. Unicode symbol index character complement bits  
Bit Field  
Designated Use  
31  
30  
0 if font is compatible with 7-bit ASCII; otherwise set to 1.  
0 if font is compatible with ISO 8859/1 Latin 1 (West Europe) character  
sets; otherwise set to 1.  
29  
28  
27  
26  
0 if font is compatible with ISO 8859/2 Latin 2 (East Europe) character  
sets; otherwise set to 1.  
0 if font is compatible with Latin 5 (Turkish) character sets (e.g., ISO  
8859/9 Latin 5, PC-Turkish); otherwise set to 1.  
0 if font is compatible with Desktop Publishing character sets (e.g.,  
Windows 3.1 Latin 1, DeskTop, MC Text); otherwise set to 1.  
0 if font is compatible with character sets requiring a wider  
selection of accents (e.g., MC Text, ISO 8859/1 Latin 1);  
otherwise set to 1.  
25  
0 if font is compatible with traditional PCL character sets (e.g., Roman-8,  
Legal, ISO 4 United Kingdom); otherwise set to 1.  
0 if font is compatible with the Macintosh character set (MS  
Text); otherwise set to 1.  
24  
23  
0 if font is compatible with PostScript Standard Encoding (PS Text);  
otherwise set to 1.  
22  
0 if font is compatible with Code Pages (e.g., PC-8, PC-850,  
PC-Turk, etc.); otherwise set to 1.  
2,1,0  
110 if font is arranged in Unicode Symbol Index order.  
·
·
Checksum - This should be set to a value which, when added to the contents of the 64 bytes of this font  
descriptor data produces a total of 0.  
Descriptor size - segmented font data.  
MSB  
15  
LSB  
0
8
7
x
First segment, segment identifier  
x + 2 First segment, Segment size  
x + 4 First segment, Data segment  
x + 4 + 1st seg. Second segment, segment identifier,  
size  
Size, Data segment  
|
|
# - 6 Null segment identifier  
# - 4 Null segment size  
# - 2 Reserved  
Checksum  
This segment follows just after the font header for TrueType. Each segment is divided into segment identifier,  
segment size and data segment parts.  
*Segment Identifier (UI) -  
Each item in the data segment part has an identification number.  
Value  
Mnemonic  
Data Segment  
17219  
17232  
18260  
20545  
22618  
65535  
CC  
CP  
Character Complement  
Copyright  
GT  
PA  
XW  
Global TrueType Data  
Panose Description  
X windows font name  
Null Segment  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
*Segment Size (UI) - indicates the size of each item in the data segment.  
*Data segment -  
AP - Application support segment (reserved)  
CC - Character Complement  
Function and form are as same as character complement flag in the font descriptor. This is only for  
unbound fonts.  
CP - Copyright  
Value should be ASCII data.  
GI - Global Intellifont data (reserved)  
GT - Global TrueType Data  
This segment consists of a table directory and several tables for the TrueType font scaler.  
The table directory consists of a 12-byte header and 16 bytes pen entry.  
IF - Intellifont Face Data (Reserved)  
PA - PANOSE Descriptor  
This data segment is used for font selection and substitution.  
PF - PS-compatible font name (Reserved)  
XW - X-Windows font name  
5.4.4. Sending a character code  
Esc*c#E (character code) (27)(42)(99)#(69)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<45h>  
·
·
·
This command sends a character code for the bitmap font ( MSL number for unbound fonts ) to the printer.  
The font data must follow immediately.  
# is the character code. # can be from 0 to 65535. The specified character is defined by the data which follows  
the character code.  
Use this command also to designate a character for deletion from a font, using the command for deleting a  
character from a downloaded font.  
5.4.5. Sending a character descriptor and data  
Esc(s#W (character descriptor and character data)  
(27)(40)(115)#(87)  
<1Bh><28h><73h>#<57h>  
·
·
This command sends a character descriptor block and raster data describing the shape of the character to the  
printer.  
# is the total number of bytes (descriptor and data) which will follow this command and can be up to 32767. If  
you need to send more than 32767 bytes to describe a single character you must split it into blocks of 32767  
bytes or less and send each block separately.  
·
The character header for the first block of data describing a character is in the following format.  
[Bitmap font ]  
Byte Data  
0 - 1 Format  
2 - 3 Descriptor size  
4 - 5 Orientation  
Continuation  
Class  
Reserved  
6 - 7 Left offset  
8 - 9 Top offset  
10 - 11 Character width  
12 - 13 Character height  
14 - 15 Delta X  
16 - Raster Character Data  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
<Bitmap continuation data>  
Byte  
Data  
0-1 Format  
Continuation  
2
Raster Character Data  
·
·
The bytes which follow the header are the raster data that make up the character.  
Attributes are in one of four numerical formats.  
Unsigned integer (UI) 0 to 65535  
Signed integer (SI) –32768 to 32767  
Unsigned byte (UB) 0 to 255  
Boolean - 0 or 1  
·
·
Format (UB) - 4 for bitmap fonts.  
Continuation (B) - signifies whether the character data represents a new character (0) or is a continuation of  
the character described by the previous character descriptor block and its data (non-zero). If the continuation  
byte is non-zero the bytes following it are interpreted as character data.  
·
·
Descriptor size (UB) - 14 for bitmap fonts.  
Class (UB) - 1 for bitmap fonts, 2 for compressed bitmap fonts. Bitmap fonts are described using  
uncompressed raster data. Compressed bitmap fonts character data is encoded as follows. The first byte of a  
line of data contains the number of times that the line is successively repeated. The second byte indicates the  
number of successive white pixels that start the line and the third byte indicates the number of successive  
black pixels that follow the white pixels. Subsequent even and odd numbered bytes indicate the number of  
successive white and black pixels respectively that make up the line. If there are more than 255 successive  
pixels of a single color this is indicated by a byte set to 255 followed by a byte set to 0 followed by a byte  
indicating the remaining number of pixels of that color. The width of each line is determined by the character  
width attribute. All rows must contain the same number of pixels. The total number of pixels on each row must  
equal the character width attribute.  
·
·
·
Orientation (UB) - the orientation of the character. 0 = portrait, 1 = landscape, 2 = reverse portrait or 3 =  
reverse landscape. This attribute setting must match the orientation specified in the font descriptor block.  
Left offset (SI) - the distance between the character reference point and the leftmost dot of the character on  
the grid. The offset can be from -16384 to 16383.  
Top offset (SI) - the distance between the character reference point and the topmost dot of the character on  
the grid. The offset can be from -16384 to 16383.  
·
·
·
Character width (UI) - the width of the download character in grid dots. This can be in the range 1 to 16384.  
Character height (UI) - the height of the download character in grid dots. This can be in the range 1 to 16384.  
Delta X (UI) - the horizontal distance from the bottom left hand corner of the character’s grid that the cursor is  
moved after the character is printed. The attribute is specified in units of 1/1200" and can be in the range -  
32768 to 32767.  
[Intellifont scalable font data]  
Byte  
Data  
0-1 Format  
2 - 3 Descriptor size  
4 - 5 Contour Character data  
Continuation  
Class  
Last data Reserved  
Checksum  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
<Intellifont-scalable contour data>  
MSB  
LSB  
4
6
8
Contour Data size  
Metric data offset  
Character Intellifont data  
offset  
10 Contour tree offset  
12 XY data offset  
14  
Metric data  
Character Intellifont Data  
Contour tree data  
XY coordinate data  
<Continuation data for Intellifont scalable contour data>  
Byte  
0-1 Format  
Data  
Continuation  
2 - 3 Continuous contour character data  
Last Reserved  
Checksum  
<Compound character data of Intellifont scalable font>  
Byte Data  
0-1 Format  
Continuation  
Class  
2 - 3 Descriptor size  
4 - 5 Compound character escarpment  
6 - 7 piled character number  
ignore  
8 - ... piled character list ( 6 byte x characters )  
Last Reserved checksum  
Format (UB) - specifies the character format.  
·
·
Value  
4
Format  
Bitmap font  
10  
15  
Intellifont-scalable font  
TrueType scalable font  
Continuation (B) - signifies whether the character data represents a new character (0) or is a continuation of  
the character described by the previous character descriptor block and its data (non-zero). If the continuation  
byte is non-zero the bytes following it are interpreted as character data.  
·
·
Descriptor size (UB) - specifies the character descriptor size in bytes.  
Class (UB) . indicates the character format.  
Value  
Class  
1
Bitmap  
2
3
4
15  
Compressed Bitmap  
Contour (Intellifont scalable)  
Compound Contour (Intellifont scalable)  
TrueType Scalable  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Contour data size (UI) - specifies the contour data size.  
Metric Data offset (SI) - relative to the address of the contour data size field.  
Contour Tree Offset (SI) -relative to the address of the contour data size field.  
XY Data Offset (SI) -relative to the address of the contour data size field.  
Metric Data  
Character Intellifont Scalable Data  
Contour Tree Data  
XY Coordinate Data  
Checksum - this value is placed at the end of the character data.  
Compound character escapement (SI)  
Piled character number (UB)  
Piled character list - includes some piled characters. Each of them is 6 bytes.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
[TrueType scalable font]  
<TrueType character descriptor>  
Byte  
Data  
0-1 Format (15)  
2 - 3 Descriptor size  
Continuation (0)  
Class (15)  
4 ~ Additional descriptor size  
2 + Desc.size Character Data Size  
4 + Desc. size Glyph ID  
6 + Desc. size TrueType Glyph Data  
0-1 Format (15)  
2 - 3 Descriptor size  
Continuation (0)  
Class (15)  
4 ~ Additional descriptor size  
2 + Desc.size Character Data Size  
4 + Desc. size Glyph ID  
6 + Desc. size beginning of TrueType Glyph Data  
0-1 Format (15)  
TrueType Glyph Data  
Continuation (1)  
Last-2 Reserved  
Checksum  
·
The character data follows these header bytes. Characters are represented as raster data and the data bytes  
are used to build up an image of the character from left to right and from top to bottom, according to the  
character width and height settings.  
·
·
Format (UB) - 15 specifies TrueType font.  
Continuation (B) - specifies whether the character data represents a new character (0) or is a continuation of  
the character described by the previous character descriptor block (non-zero). If the continuation byte is non-  
zero the bytes following it are interpreted as character data.  
·
·
Descriptor size (UB) - specifies the character descriptor size in bytes.  
Class (UB) - indicates the character format.  
Value Class  
1
Bitmap  
2
Compressed Bitmap  
3
4
15  
Contour (Intellifont scalable)  
Compound Contour (Intellifont scalable)  
TrueType scalable  
·
Character data size (UI) - should be the same value as (the character data size + Glyph ID + TrueType Glyph  
data) size.  
·
·
Glyph ID (UI) - specifies the ID number for glyph data, which is used by the TrueType font scaler.  
TrueType Glyph data - includes the data segment which is associated with the given character as found in the  
glyph table of the original TrueType font file.  
·
Checksum (UB) - should be a value which, when added to "Character data + Glyph ID + TrueType Glyph  
data" size, produces a zero result.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Portrait character  
Paper motion  
Raster scan  
Top offset  
= 22 dots  
Baseline  
Character height  
= 31 dots  
Cursor position after  
character has been printed  
Character reference  
point  
Left offset  
= 2 dots  
Character width = 26 dots  
Delta X = 30 dots  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Landscape character  
Paper motion  
Top offset = 27 dots  
Character height  
= 26 dots  
Raster scan  
Left offset  
= 22 dots  
Baseline  
Character width  
= 31 dots  
Cursor position after  
character has been printed  
Character reference  
point  
Delta X = 30 dots  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.  
USING GRAPHICS  
This HL Series printer affords the user considerable flexibility in the creation of graphic images. Vector, raster and  
rectangle graphics are available, all of which allow a range of shading and filling options. The HP-GL/2 graphics  
commands that are supported are described in the HP-GL/2 section of this manual.  
6.1. Source, Pattern and Destination  
We refer to a printing model in which a source image (the image to be drawn) is applied to a destination image  
(simply the graphics or text that already exist on the page). The source image consists of white space and non-  
white areas. The non-white areas are covered by a pattern of some description. The pattern may simply be solid  
black or it may itself consist of white and non-white areas, for example the pattern may consist of vertical spaced  
lines. You can specify the way in which the white and dark areas of the entire source image and the white and  
dark areas of the pattern interact with the destination image to produce the finished effect.  
For example  
Pattern  
Source image  
Destination image  
Possible results  
6.1.1. Set source transparency  
Esc*v#N (27)(42)(118)#(78)  
<1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<4Eh>  
·
·
·
This command sets the source image transparency.  
# is either 0 or 1. Set # to 0 to select transparent mode and to 1 to specify opaque mode.  
Transparent mode means that parts of the destination image will be visible through the white space areas of  
the source image when the source image has been printed on top of the destination image.  
·
Opaque mode means that parts of the destination image will not be visible through the white space areas of  
the source image when the source image has been printed on top of the destination image.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
For example  
Pattern  
Source image  
Destination image  
With transparent  
source image  
With opaque  
source image  
Possible results  
6.1.2. Set pattern transparency  
Esc*v#O (27)(42)(118)#(79)  
<1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<4Fh>  
·
·
·
This command sets the pattern transparency.  
# is either 0 or 1. Set # to 0 to select transparent mode and to 1 to specify opaque mode.  
Transparent mode means that parts of the destination image will be visible through the patterned areas of the  
source image when the source image has been printed on top of the destination image. If the pattern is a solid  
black fill obviously you will not be able to see any of the destination image through the patterned areas of the  
source image.  
·
Opaque mode means that the destination image will not be visible through the patterned areas of the source  
image when the source image has been printed on top of the destination image.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
For example  
Pattern  
Source image  
(Source image is transparent)  
Destination image  
With transparent  
pattern  
With opaque  
pattern  
Possible results  
6.1.3. Set area fill identity  
Esc*c#G (27)(42)(99)#(71)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<47h>  
·
This command sets the pattern ID of a shading tone, a fill pattern or a user-defined pattern for subsequent  
selection with the Set Pattern Type command.  
·
·
·
·
# 1 ~ 100 specify the percentage of a gray scale.  
# 1 ~ 6 select a fill pattern.  
# 1 ~ 32767 select a user-defined pattern.  
You can specify a gray scale tone from 1 to 100. To use the specified tone for shading you must then select  
one of the two gray scale pattern options with the Set Pattern Type command.  
For example  
Fill patterns  
# = 1  
# = 4  
# = 2  
# = 5  
# = 3  
# = 6  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.1.4. User-defined pattern command  
Esc*c#W [ data ] (27)(42)(99)#(87)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<57h>  
·
·
·
·
# should be in the range 0 ~ 32767.  
# stands for the number of pattern data bytes.  
User defined patterns can be defined by binary data or an 8 byte pattern descriptor.  
The formats for the pattern descriptor are listed below.  
<For 300 dpi>  
MSB  
LSB  
0 - 1 Format (0)  
Continuation (0)  
Reserved (0)  
2 - 3 Pixel Encoding (1)  
4 - 5 Height in Pixe ls  
6 - 7 Width in Pixels  
8 - Pattern Image  
MSB  
LSB  
0 - 1 Format (20)  
2 - 3 Pixel Encoding (1)  
4 - 5 Height in Pixels  
6 - 7 Width in Pixels  
8 - 9 X resolution  
10 - 11 Y resolution  
12 - Pattern Image  
Continuation (0)  
Reserved (0)  
X=Y: 300 or 600  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
A pattern which is defined at 600 dpi cannot be converted to one at 300 dpi.  
Format - set to 0 or 20.  
Continuation - set to 0.  
Pixel Encoding - set to 1.  
Height in Pixels - specifies the pattern height by the number of rows.  
Width in Pixels - specifies the pattern width by the number of pixels.  
Pattern Image - consists of the raster data for the pattern.  
X resolution - specifies the resolution in the X scan direction.  
Y resolution - specifies the resolution in the Y scan direction.  
6.1.5. Set pattern reference point  
Esc*p#R (27)(42)(112)#(82)  
<1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<52h>  
·
·
·
This command sets the pattern reference point to the current cursor position.  
# specifies whether the pattern rotates with the print direction or remains fixed.  
The Pattern reference point should be placed on a physical page and the base pattern is positioned at the  
pattern reference point for tiling.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.1.6. User-defined pattern control  
Esc*c#Q (27)(42)(99)#(81)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<51h>  
·
·
·
·
·
# = 0 deletes all (temporary and permanent) user-defined patterns from the printer memory.  
# = 1 deletes all temporary user-defined patterns from the printer memory.  
# = 2 deletes the pattern whose ID number was specified most recently.  
# = 4 saves the user-defined pattern as a temporary pattern whose ID number was specified most recently.  
# = 5 saves the user-defined pattern as a permanent pattern whose ID number was specified most recently.  
6.1.7. Set pattern type  
Esc*v#T (27)(42)(118)#(84)  
<1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<54h>  
·
This command selects the fill pattern (black, white, gray scale or cross-hatch pattern) for use with subsequent  
graphics operations.  
·
·
·
·
# is in the range 0 to 4 or 130.  
# = 0 selects solid black as the fill pattern.  
# = 1 selects white as the fill pattern (all source images will be completely white).  
# = 2 selects one of eight gray scales. Specify the gray scale you require as a percentage (0-100%) with the Set  
Area Fill Identity command.  
·
·
·
# = 3 selects the cross-hatch pattern you choose with the Set Area Fill Identity.  
# = 4 selects the user-defined pattern  
# = 130 selects one of the 64 gray scales. You can specify the gray scale you require as a percentage (0-100%)  
with the Set Area Fill Identity command. This feature is unique to these HL-Series printers.  
0%  
100%  
#=130  
#=2  
56-80%  
21-55%  
3 - 10%  
11 - 20 % 36-55%  
81-99%  
1- 2%  
#=0  
#=1  
#=2  
#=3  
#=130  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Pattern example  
10 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
20 ESC$ = CHR$(27)  
30 REM --- RESET PRINTER ---  
40 LPRINT ESC$; "E";  
50 REM --- SET SOURCE=TRANSPARENT ---  
60 REM --- SET PATTERN=OPAQUE ---  
70 LPRINT ESC$; "*v0n1O";  
80 REM --- BACKGROUND ---  
90 LPRINT ESC$; "*c80G"; ESC$; "*v2T";  
100 LPRINT ESC$; "*p100x100Y"; ESC$; "*c1000a300b2P";  
110 REM --- PATTERN ---  
120 LPRINT ESC$; "*p150x300Y";  
130 LPRINT ESC$; "(s1p48v0s0b4101T";  
140 LPRINT ESC$; "*c1G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "P";  
150 LPRINT ESC$; "*c2G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "A";  
160 LPRINT ESC$; "*c6G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "T";  
170 LPRINT ESC$; "*c4G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "T";  
180 LPRINT ESC$; "*c5G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "E";  
190 LPRINT ESC$; "*c3G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "R";  
200 LPRINT ESC$; "*c1G"; ESC$; "*v3T"; : LPRINT "N";  
210 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
220 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
230 END  
<Sample file 6>  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.2. Plotting Rectangles  
Drawing rectangles is a basic case of printing graphics: the source image consists solely of the rectangle itself.  
Thus only the pattern transparency has any bearing on the final effect - the source transparency is irrelevant.  
6.2.1. Cursor position  
Position the cursor using the commands described in the chapter entitled “The Page”. You can use units,  
decipoints or rows and columns as coordinate units. Remember that the y-coordinate value goes up as the cursor  
moves down the logical page.  
6.2.2. Set rectangle width  
Esc*c#A (27)(42)(99)#(65)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<41h>  
This command sets the width of the rectangle to be printed in dots.  
# is the number of dots.  
·
·
Esc*c#H (27)(42)(99)#(72)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<48h>  
This command sets the width of the rectangle to be printed in decipoints.  
# is the number of decipoints.  
·
·
6.2.3. Set rectangle height  
Esc*c#B (27)(42)(99)#(66)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<42h>  
·
This command sets the height of the rectangle to be printed in dots.  
# is the number of dots.  
·
Esc*c#V (27)(42)(99)#(86)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<56h>  
This command sets the height of the rectangle to be printed in decipoints.  
# is the number of decipoints.  
·
·
6.2.4. Draw filled rectangle  
Esc*c#P (27)(42)(99)#(80)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<50h>  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
This command fills a rectangular area with the specified shading option.  
# is 0 to 5 or 130.  
# = 0 uses solid black as the fill pattern.  
# = 1 uses white as the fill pattern.  
# = 2 selects the gray scale you chose with the Set Area Fill Identity command as the fill pattern.  
# = 3 selects the cross-hatch pattern you chose with the Set Area Fill Identity.  
# = 4 selects the user defined pattern, which is the ID number selected by the set Area Fill Identity.  
# = 5 uses the pattern specified by the combination of the most recent Set Area Fill Identity command and the  
most recent Set Pattern Type command.  
·
·
# = 130 selects one of the sixty-four gray scales. You can specify the gray scale you require as a percentage  
(0-100%) with the Set Area Fill Identity command. This feature is unique to these HL Series printers.  
See the following two pages for programming examples using gray scales and patterns  
#
0
Fill  
Solid black  
1
White  
2
3
4
5
Gray scale (1 - 8)  
Cross hatch pattern  
User-defined pattern  
Current pattern  
Gray scale ( 1 - 64)  
130  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Gray scale example  
10 ESC$ = CHR$(27)  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 REM --- DRAW A PATTERN USING 64 GRAY SCALES ---  
40 X = 50: Y = 100: XL=50 :YL=200  
50 FOR GRAY = 0 TO 100 STEP 2  
60 GOSUB 220  
70 X=GRAY*10+50 :XL=X-XL  
80 GOSUB 260  
90 XL=X  
100 NEXT GRAY  
110 REM --- DRAW A PATTERN USING 8 GRAY SCALES ---  
120 Y=400  
130 FOR GRAY = 0 TO 100 STEP 2  
140 GOSUB 220  
150 X=GRAY*10+50 :XL=X-XL  
160 GOSUB 320  
170 XL=X  
180 NEXT GRAY  
190 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
200 LPRINT CHR$(12)  
210 END  
220 REM --- SET THE CURSOR POSITION ---  
230 LPRINT ESC$; "*p"; X; "X";  
240 LPRINT ESC$; "*p"; Y; "Y";  
250 RETURN  
260 REM --- PRINT 64-GRAY SCALE PATTERN ---  
270 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; XL; "A";  
280 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; YL; "B";  
290 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; GRAY; "G";  
300 LPRINT ESC$; "*c130P";  
310 RETURN  
320 REM --- PRINT 8-GRAY SCALE PATTERN ---  
330 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; XL; "A";  
340 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; YL; "B";  
350 LPRINT ESC$; "*c"; GRAY; "G";  
360 LPRINT ESC$; "*c2P";  
370 RETURN  
<Sample file 7>  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.3. Raster Graphics  
6.3.1. Positioning the cursor  
Position the cursor using the commands described in the chapter entitled “The Page”, using dots, decipoints or  
rows and columns as coordinate units.  
6.3.2. Set raster resolution  
Esc*t#R (27)(42)(116)#(82)  
<1Bh><2Ah><74h>#<52h>  
·
·
·
·
This command sets the raster image resolution in dots per inch.  
# is 75, 100, 150, 200, 300 or 600.  
The lower the resolution you specify, the less printer memory your raster image will occupy.  
Use this command before you issue a Begin Raster Graphics command, otherwise the resolution that you  
specify will not take effect until the next time you re-enter raster graphics mode.  
6.3.3. Set high resolution control  
EscCRRO (27)(13)(82)(79)  
<1Bh><0Dh><52h><4Fh>  
·
This command sets high resolution control off.  
EscCRRL (27)(13)(82)(76)  
<1Bh><0Dh><52h><4Ch>  
·
This command sets high resolution control Light level.  
EscCRRM (27)(13)(82)(77)  
<1Bh><0Dh><52h><4Dh>  
·
This command sets high resolution control Medium level.  
EscCRRD (27)(13)(82)(68)  
<1Bh><0Dh><52h><44h>  
·
This command sets high resolution control Dark level.  
6.3.4. Set raster image orientation  
Esc*r#F (27)(42)(114)#(70)  
<1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<46h>  
·
·
·
This command specifies the orientation of the raster image.  
# is 0 or 3.  
# = 0 determines that the image will be printed from left to right and from top to bottom within the current  
logical page.  
·
·
# = 3 determines that the image will be printed from left to right and from top to bottom within the current  
physical page irrespective of logical page orientation.  
The default value of # is 3.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
X
(X1,Y1) = Cursor position  
Y
(X1, Y1)  
X
Y
#=0  
(X1, Y1)  
#=0  
Portrait  
Landscape  
X
Y
(X1, Y1)  
X
Y
(X1, Y1)  
#=3  
#=3  
Landscape  
Portrait  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.3.5. Set raster area height  
Esc*r#T (27)(42)(114)#(84)  
<1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<54h>  
·
·
·
This command sets the height of the raster image to be printed.  
# is the number of raster rows.  
If you use this command after using a Start Raster Graphics or a Transfer Raster Data command, it does not  
take effect until after the next End Raster Graphics command.  
6.3.6. Set raster area width  
Esc*r#S (27)(42)(114)#(83)  
<1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<53h>  
·
·
·
This command sets the width of the raster image to be printed.  
# is the number of dots at the specified dots per inch resolution.  
If you use this command after using a Start Raster Graphics or a Transfer Raster Data command, it does not  
take effect until after the next End Raster Graphics command.  
6.3.7. Set raster y-offset  
Esc*b#Y (27)(42)(98)#(89)  
<1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<59h>  
·
·
·
·
This command sets the offset (number of blank rows to be skipped) for the raster image to be printed.  
# is the number of rows that are left blank at the top of the image.  
# must be in the range 0-32767.  
This command is only effective in raster graphics mode, that is, after a Start Raster Graphics mode command.  
6.3.8. Set compression mode  
Esc*b#M (27)(42)(98)#(77)  
<1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<4Dh>  
Identifies the method of compression used to encode the raster image that is to be sent to the printer.  
·
# is 0, 1, 2, 3, 5, 9, 1152 or 1024.  
·
·
# = 0 signifies no compression is to be used.  
# = 1 indicates that run-length encoding is to be used. The raster data bytes are transmitted in pairs.  
The second byte of each pair specifies the raster output, the first byte specifies the number of times the  
second byte is successively repeated. A value of 0 for the first byte indicates a single occurrence of the  
second byte, a value of 1 indicates two consecutive occurrences of the second byte and so on.  
·
# = 2 indicates that TIFF (tagged image file format) encoding is to be used. In this format the data is  
transmitted in groups of bytes. The first byte of each group is a control byte and defines how the subsequent  
data byte or bytes should be interpreted, and how many data bytes there are before the next control byte. If  
the two’s complement value of the control byte is in the range –1 to –127, the following byte is a repeated  
data byte. The number of successive occurrences of the data byte is given by the absolute value of the  
control byte plus one - that is, if the control byte is -6, the following data byte is repeated 7 times. If the value  
of the control byte is in the range 0-127 the bytes which follow are unencoded raster data. The number of data  
bytes is given by the absolute value of the control byte plus one - that is, if the control byte is 9, the following  
ten bytes are unencoded data. If a control byte has the two’s complement value –128 it is ignored and the next  
byte is treated as a control byte.  
·
# = 3 indicates that delta row compression is to be used. In this method byte sequences identify how  
each raster row differs from the last row that was transmitted. The first byte identifies the number of  
consecutive bytes (the value of the most significant 3 bits plus 1) to be changed and the position in the line at  
which to start substituting the replacement bytes (the least significant 5 bits plus 1). Hence, if the command  
byte has a 3 in the top three bits and 10 in the bottom five bits, the 11th, 12th, 13th and 14th bytes of the last  
row will be replaced by the four data bytes that follow.  
If the least significant 5 bits are all 1, the next byte is treated as a further offset value and its value is added to  
32 to calculate the offset. If this byte in turn is all ones the next byte is also treated as a continuation byte and  
its value is added to the offset and so on until a byte whose value is not 255 is encountered.  
This combination of command bytes and replacement bytes is used to specify all the differences  
between the last raster row sent (the seed row) and the new row to be transmitted. When the new row has  
been sent it becomes the new seed row.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
# = 5 indicates that adaptive compression is to be used.  
This compression compresses multiple rows (a block) into one transfer graphics command.  
Most other compression methods compress only one row to one transfer graphics command.  
One transfer graphic command (ESC *b##W) can contain only up to 32,767 bytes.  
As mode 5 compression compresses multiple rows, the amount of transferred data may become large.  
If compressed data exceeds this limit, reduce the number of rows in the block.  
We can use mode 0 to mode 3 compression to compress each row. We can even compress empty (white) rows  
and duplicate rows with these compression methods.  
Command byte  
Mode 5 compressed data consists of multiple elements. Each element contains 3 header bytes at the  
beginning.  
The first byte of the header bytes is a command byte.  
First byte  
Second, third byte  
0
1
2
3
Unencoded  
Run-length Encoding  
TIFF  
Number of bytes of data  
Delta Row compression  
4
5
Empty Row  
Duplicate Row  
Number of empty row or repetition  
Command byte  
0 -  
1 -  
2 -  
3 -  
4 -  
5 -  
This element is an uncompressed row. The next two bytes contain the byte count of the uncompressed  
data. Uncompressed data follows the header.  
This element identifies a compressed row. Compression method is mode 1. The next two bytes (upper  
byte first) contain the byte count of the compressed data. Compressed data follows the header.  
This element identifies a compressed row. Compression method is mode 2. The next two bytes (upper  
byte first) contain the byte count of the compressed data. Compressed data follows the header  
This element identifies a compressed row. Compression method is mode 3. The next two bytes (upper  
byte first) contain the byte count of the compressed data. Compressed data follows the header  
This element identifies multiple empty rows. The next two bytes (upper byte first) contain the empty  
row count.  
This element identifies duplicate rows. The next two bytes (upper byte first) contain the duplicate row  
count.  
·
# = 9 Mode 9 compression  
Like mode 3 compression, this mode 9 compression data contains only the difference of the current row from  
the preceding row.  
Replacement data often consists of a repetition of a particular byte in mode 3 compression.  
Mode 9 compression is effective in such cases.  
Simple mode 9 compression data consists of a command byte and the replacement data.  
A Command byte consists of 3 parts. These are the control bit, the offset count and the replacement count.  
The Control bit is the most significant bit (bit 7) of a control byte.  
Command byte for mode 9 compression (non repeated replacement data)  
7
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Offset count  
Control bit  
Replacement count-1  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
If the control bit is 0, replacement data is not repeated data. Bits 6 to 3 contain the offset count. This field  
value is from 0 to 15. If this value is 15, the next byte of the control bytes is an optional offset count. The  
value of this optional offset count byte is from 0 to 255. If this optional offset count value is 255, then the  
next byte is another (second) optional offset count byte. Optional offset count bytes will continue until the  
value is less than 255. The total Offset value is the sum of the offset count in the control byte and all the  
optional offset bytes.  
Bits 2 to 0 of the control byte contains the replacement count - 1. The value is from 0 to 7. If this value is 7,  
optional replacement byte(s) follow the control byte or optional offset byte(s) (if any).  
If the first optional replacement count byte is 255, then a second optional count byte follows the first optional  
count byte. Optional offset count bytes will continue until the value becomes less than 255. The addition of  
the replacement count in the control byte and all optional replacement count bytes gives the total replacement  
count.  
Replacement data bytes follow the control byte and any optional offset bytes and any optional replacement  
count bytes.  
<Example>  
Seed row  
Current row  
55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55  
55 55 55 55 55 11 11 22 33 44 55 66 77  
<Different section 11 11 22 33 44 55 66 77>  
Offset count = 5  
Replacement count = 8  
Replacement data = 11 11 22 33 44 55 66 77  
7
6
0
5
1
4
0
3
1
2
1
1
1
0
1
0
Optional offset count byte = 0  
11 11 22 33 44 55 66 77  
8 bytes of repracement data  
Offset count = 5  
Replacement count = 7 + 1 = 8  
Command byte for mode 9 compression (repeated replacement data)  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
Offset count  
Control bit  
Replacement count  
If the control bit is 1, replacement data is repeated data. Bits 6 to 5 contain the offset count and bits 4 to 0  
contain the 'replacement count (repeat count) - 2'.  
If bit 6 and bit 5 are '1', then an optional offset byte follows the control byte. If the value of this optional offset  
byte is 255, another (second) optional offset byte follows the first optional offset byte. The addition of the  
offset count in the control byte and any optional offset bytes gives the total offset count.  
If bits 4 to 0 are all '1', an optional replacement count byte follows the control byte or any optional offset  
byte(s). If the first optional replacement count byte has a value of 255, a second optional replacement count  
byte follows the first optional replacement count byte. Optional replacement count bytes will continue until  
the value becomes less than 255.  
<Example>  
Seed row  
Current row  
55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55  
55 55 55 11 11 11 55 55 66 66 66 66 55  
<First section 11 11 11>  
Offset count = 3  
Replacement count = 3  
Replacement data = 11  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
<Second section 66 66 66 66>  
Offset count = 2  
Replacement count = 4  
Replacement data = 66  
7
6
1
5
1
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
0
1
1
Optional offset count byte = 0  
Replacement data = 11  
Replacement count = 1 + 2 = 3  
Offset count = 3  
7
6
1
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
1
0
0
1
Replacement data = 66  
Replacement count = 2 + 2 = 4  
Offset count = 2  
·
# = 1152 indicates that CCITT G3/G4 data compression is to be used.  
This format is popular in optical document storage areas as this compression is effective to store black and  
white type pictures. As G3/G4 format does not have picture size/resolution information, the printer requires a  
header at the beginning of the picture data. The header size is 94 Bytes. Both the header and the picture data  
are transferred by the ESC*b###W(###=data length) command. The normal PCL transfer graphics data  
command has a limitation on the data size and ### should not exceed 32767. Unlike other modes, this mode is  
special and does not have the 32767 size limitation. The data must have the following structure - Header and  
Picture data. The values in this mode are little endians.  
Header  
94 bytes  
File Length  
Picture  
data  
Picture data  
length  
Byte  
Data  
Description  
position  
0 - 1  
2 - 3  
6E 6E  
0A 00  
'nn' This is header ID.  
Reserved  
4 - 7  
8 - 11  
5E 00 00 00  
File length  
Picture data start offset from header top  
File length including 94 Byte header. If file length is 65,536 byte,  
these 4 bytes become "00 00 01 00"  
12 - 13  
14 - 15  
16 - 19  
20 - 21  
01 00  
01 00  
4A 00 00 00  
Compression mode  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
02 00: Fax MH format  
03 00: Fax MR format  
04 00: Fax G4 format  
22 - 55  
56 - 59  
00 ... 00  
Picture data length  
All zero  
If picture data length is 65,442 (65,536 ~-94) byte, these 4 bytes  
become "A2 FF 00 00."  
60 - 61  
62 - 63  
64 - 65  
66 - 67  
68- 69  
01 00  
01 00  
Pixels/line  
Pixels/line  
Lines/picture  
bit / pixel  
bit / pixel  
If picture dot width = 2,400, these 2 bytes become "60 09"  
Same as above.  
If picture dot count = 3,100, these 2 bytes become "1C 0C."  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
71 - 71  
Lines/picture  
Same as above.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
72 - 73  
74 - 75  
00 00  
Photometrics 00 00  
or 01 00  
Reserved  
00 00 : data 0 = white  
01 00 : data 0 = black  
Reserved  
76 - 77  
78 - 79  
02 00  
Fill order 01 00 or 02 01 00 : filled from MSB  
00  
02 00 : filled from LSB  
Reserved  
Reserved  
80 - 81  
82 - 83  
84 - 85  
86 - 87  
01 00  
00 00  
01 00  
Reserved  
Resolution 200, 300, C8 00 00 00 : 200 dpi,  
400, 600 90 01 00 00 : 400 dpi,  
2C 01 00 00 : 300 dpi,  
58 02 00 00 : 600 dpi  
400 and 600 dpi are available when the printer operates in 600 dpi  
mode.  
88 - 89  
Resolution 200, 300, C8 00 00 00 : 200 dpi,  
2C 01 00 00 : 300 dpi,  
58 02 00 00 : 600 dpi  
400, 600  
90 01 00 00 : 400 dpi,  
400 and 600 dpi are available when the printer operates in 600 dpi  
mode.  
90 - 91  
92 - 93  
02 00  
00 00  
Reserved  
Reserved  
For further information about the CCITT G3/G4 data format, please refer to CCITT (The International  
Telegraph and Telephone Consultative Committee) BLUE BOOK Volume VII.  
# = 1024 indicates TIFF format. This is valid only for 600 dpi data. The raster graphics data is transferred with  
the ESC*b###W (### = data length) command. The TIFF file follows this mode set command. This printer  
does not support LZW compression. Pages that contain TIFF data are printed in gray scale mode. The TIFF  
data contains the header, tag and print data.  
·
This mode supports TIFF Version 5.0 file format. In this mode, the transfer graphics data count does not have  
a limitation of 32,767 bytes. This printer supports both "MM" (big endian) format and "II" (little endian)  
format. The Print model is not applied to this type of data transfer. The printer has some limitations on the  
TIFF format as follows:-  
1. Tag position has to be prior to the picture (strip) data.  
2. Compression tag - Tag ID : 259  
The printer supports 1, 2, 3, 4 and 32773.  
1 : no compression (Bits/Sample=1,4,8)  
2 : CCITT G3 MH (Bits/Sample=1)  
3 : CCITT G3 MR (Bits/Sample=1)  
4 : CCITT G4 (Bits/Sample=1)  
32773 : Pack Bits (Bits/Sample=1)  
3. Sample/pixel - Tag ID : 277  
This value should be 1. This means the printer accepts only monochrome TIFF files.  
4. Bits/Sample - Tag ID: 258  
The printer supports 1,4 and 8.  
If you specify 4 or 8 and the printer resolution is 600 dpi, the printer prints the page using  
APT.  
5. Horizontal resolution (Tag ID=282) and Vertical resolution (Tag ID=283)  
Compression type Bits/Sample  
Available Resolution  
From 1 dpi to 300 dpi  
Printer's Resolution  
(300 or 600 dpi)  
APT  
ON  
OFF  
No Compression  
No Compression  
Pack Bit  
4,8  
1
CCITT G3 & G4  
1
200,300,400,600 dpi  
OFF  
400 & 600 dpi are only available  
when the printer operates in 600  
dpi mode.  
We recommend 150 dpi or less resolution for APT to reduce data size.  
# = 1025 indicates the Brother original Compression Method.  
·
·
# = 1026 indicates the Brother Advanced Data Transfer Mode.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.3.9. Start raster transfer  
Esc*r#A (27)(42)(114)#(65)  
<1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<41h>  
·
·
·
·
·
This command signals the start of the transfer of a raster image to the printer.  
# is 0 or 1.  
# = 0 denotes that the image will be printed starting from the left edge of the logical page.  
# = 1 denotes that the image will be printed starting from the current cursor position.  
The transfer of raster data to the printer continues until either an End Raster Transfer command is sent or a  
command other than Send Raster Data, Set Compression Mode or Set Raster Y-Offset is sent.  
6.3.10. Send raster data  
Esc*b#W<data> (27)(42)(98)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<57h>  
·
·
·
This command sends a single row of the raster image to the printer for printing.  
# signifies the number of bytes to be sent.  
If more data is transmitted than can be fitted onto one row of the specified raster area, the excess data will be  
ignored.  
6.3.11. Compress transfer graphics  
Esc*b#C<image data> (27)(42)(98)#(67) <1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<43h>  
·
As a more efficient alternative to the Send Raster Data command, this command sends a single row of the  
raster image to the printer for printing in a compressed form.  
·
·
·
# signifies the number of data bytes that the uncompressed row consisted of.  
Pairs of bytes describe the data which follows.  
If the MSB of the first byte of a pair is 1, the byte that follows the pair is repeated. The number held in the  
remaining fifteen bits of the byte pair is the number of times the data byte is repeated.  
·
·
If the MSB of the first byte of the pair is 0, the bytes that follow the pair are not repeated. The number held in  
the remaining fifteen bits of the byte pair is the number of bytes of unrepeated raster data that follow.  
A raster row is made up of a sequence of byte pair-image data combinations.  
6.3.12. End raster transfer  
Esc*rB (27)(42)(114)(66)  
<1Bh><2Ah><72h><42h>  
·
·
This command signals the end of a transfer of a raster image to the printer.  
After execution of this command the cursor is positioned a distance of one raster row (at the last specified  
number of dots per inch) down from the bottom of the raster area.  
Esc*rC  
(27)(42)(114)(67)  
<1Bh><2Ah><72h><43h>  
·
·
·
This command signifies the end of the raster graphic data transfer and this is a modified version of the ESC  
*rB command.  
After receiving this command, the printer resets the compression seed, comp ression mode and left-graphics  
margin to 0.  
Also, the cursor is positioned a distance of one raster row (at the last specified number of dots per inch)  
down from the bottom of the raster data.  
·
·
This command resets the compression mode setting to 0.  
This command defaults the left graphics margin to 0.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Raster graphics example  
10 REM ***** A EXAMPLE OF RASTER GRAPHICS *****  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
40 REM --- SET GRAPHICS RESOLUTION TO 300 DPI ---  
50 LPRINT ESC$+"*t300R";  
60 REM --- START RASTER GRAPHICS ---  
70 LPRINT ESC$+"*r1A";  
80 REM --- TRANSFER RASTER GRAPHICS ---  
90 FOR I=1 TO 28  
100 REM --- TRANSFER 1 LINE OF DOTS (4 byte = line) ---  
110 LPRINT ESC$+"*b4W";  
120 FOR J=1 TO 4  
130 READ A$  
140 LPRINT CHR$(VAL("&H"+A$));  
150 NEXT J  
160 NEXT I  
170 REM --- END RASTER GRAPHICS ---  
180 LPRINT ESC$+"*rB"  
190 LPRINT  
200 LPRINT  
210 REM --- CHANGE GRAPHIC RESOLUTION  
220 LPRINT ESC$+"*t75R";  
230 REM --- START RASTER GRAPHICS ---  
240 LPRINT ESC$+"*r1A";  
250 REM --- TRANSFER RASTER GRAPHICS ---  
260 RESTORE 410  
270 FOR I=1 TO 28  
280 REM --- TRANSFER 1 LINE OF DOTS (4 byte = line) ---  
290 LPRINT ESC$+"*b4W";  
300 FOR J=1 TO 4  
310 READ A$  
320 LPRINT CHR$(VAL("&H"+A$));  
330 NEXT J  
340 NEXT I  
350 REM --- END RASTER GRAPHICS ---  
360 LPRINT ESC$+"*rB"  
370 REM --- PAPER EJECT ---  
380 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
390 END  
400 REM --- RASTER DATA ---  
410 DATA 00,1F,E0,00  
420 DATA 00,7F,F8,00  
430 DATA 01,F0,3E,00  
440 DATA 03,C0,0F,00  
450 DATA 07,00,03,80  
460 DATA 0E,00,01,C0  
470 DATA 1C,38,70,E0  
480 DATA 18,70,70,60  
490 DATA 38,38,70,70  
500 DATA 30,00,00,30  
510 DATA 70,00,00,38  
520 DATA 61,00,02,18  
530 DATA 61,00,02,18  
540 DATA 6F,80,07,98  
550 DATA 67,80,07,D8  
560 DATA 61,80,06,18  
570 DATA 61,C0,0E,18  
580 DATA 70,E0,1C,38  
590 DATA 30,70,78,30  
600 DATA 38,3F,F0,70  
610 DATA 18,0F,C0,60  
620 DATA 1C,00,00,E0  
630 DATA 0E,00,01,C0  
640 DATA 07,00,03,80  
650 DATA 03,C0,0F,00  
660 DATA 01,F0,3E,00  
670 DATA 00,7F,F8,00  
680 DATA 00,1F,E0,00  
690 REM --- DATA END ---  
<Sample file 8>  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.3.13. Horizontal 1200-dpi image format mode (Raster Graphic Mode 1027)  
The printer supports 1200 dpi printing for special image formats in 1200 dpi mode. We recommend that the  
installed printer memory is 10 Mbytes or more for 1200 dpi printing.  
To set 1200 dpi mode,  
1. Set 1200 dpi printing mode by using the following PJL command:  
@PJL SET RAS1200MODE = ON  
2. Choose PCL mode with the following PJL command:  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL  
(If you select a mode other than PCL mode, 1200 dpi printing mode cannot be selected.)  
The PCL Mode set command for 1200 dpi Image Format is ESC *b1027M. The transfer raster data command  
(ESC*b###W) then transfers horizontal 1200 dpi data.  
<1200 dpi Graphic Data Compression Format>  
This comp ression format consists of blocks of data 64 dots down the page starting from the leading edge of the  
paper.  
i.e.: If the graphic data extends over three bands as shown in the following diagram, it transfers the data as three  
blocks of data:  
ESC*b##W <Block 1> <Block 2> <Block 3>  
0
Band 1  
64  
Block 1  
Band 2  
128  
Block 2  
Band 3  
192  
Band 4  
Band 5  
Block 3  
256  
320  
In mode 1027, the transfer graphic data command byte count does not have a limitation of 32,767 bytes.  
The block data is composed as follows:  
Position  
0 - 1  
2 - 3  
Data  
Description  
n - 2  
dots from the left of the page  
dots from the leading edge of the  
page  
Block length  
Horizontal position  
Vertical position  
4 - 5  
6
7 - 8  
Height dots  
Width words  
number of image vertical dots  
number of image horizontal 16 bit  
words  
9 - (n - 1) Compression data  
compression image data  
i.e.: Data is at horizontal position = 256, vertical position = 64, height = 32 dots, width = 100 x 16 bit words (1600  
dots), and compression data is 800 bytes;  
ESC*b809W 03h 27h 01h 00h 00h 40h 20h 00h 64h [Data800Byte]  
ë _ û ë _ û ë _ û  
|
ë _ û  
|
a
b
c
d
e
f
0
a: Block length(807)  
Band 1  
Band 2  
(256, 64)  
b: Horizontal position(256)  
c: Vertical position(64)  
d: Height dots(32)  
e: Width words(100)  
f: Compression image data  
64  
128  
32  
1600  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
<Compressed Image Data>  
Data compression compresses the original image data word by word (16 bits).  
The comp ressed data consists of both horizontal compression which uses 16 bit, 8 bit and 4 bit repeating patterns  
within 1 word or 2 words of data and vertical compression which indicates how many times to repeat the same  
data as in the previous line within 1 word of data.  
ŸNon-compressed data  
When the most significant bit in the first 2 bytes is 0, the printer goes into non-compression mode. The following  
11 bits then indicate the number of words of data, the least significant 4 bits are not used. After that, the image  
data follows word by word.  
15 14  
0
4 3  
0
data word count (11 bits)  
data 1 (16 bits)  
:
not used  
data n (16 bits)  
Ÿ16 bit repeating compressed data  
When the most significant 3 bits in the first 2 bytes are in the order 1, 0, 0, the remaining 13 bits indicate the  
number of times to repeat 16 bit data. The following 2 bytes should be the 16 bit data to repeat.  
15 14 13 12  
0
1
0
0
number of repeats(13 bits)  
data to repeat(16 bits)  
Ÿ8 bit repeating comp ressed data  
When the most significant 3 bits in the first 2 bytes are in the order 1, 1, 0, the following 5 bits indicate the number  
of times to repeat 16 bit (two by 8 bits) data. The remaining 8 bits should be the 8 bit data to repeat.  
15 14 13 12  
8
7
0
1
1
0
number of repeats  
data to repeat(8 bits)  
(5 bits)  
Ÿ4 bit repeating compression data  
When the most significant 3 bits in the first 2 bytes are in the order 1, 0, 1, the following 4 bits are the 4 bit data to  
repeat. The remaining 9 bits indicate the number of times to repeat the 16 bit (4 by 4 bits) data.  
15 14 13 12  
9
8
0
1
0
1
data to repeat  
number or repeats(9 bits)  
(4 bits)  
ŸVertical repeating compressed data  
When the most significant 3 bits in the first 2 bytes are in the order 1, 1, 1, the remaining 13 bits indicate the same  
data words as in the previous line.  
15 14 13 12  
0
1
1
1
the same data words as in the previous line (13 bits)  
The printer cannot support the APT and HRC function in the 1200 dpi printing mode.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.4. Vector Graphics  
For large-scale graphic images it is more efficient to use vector graphics. In LaserJet emulation mode you can set  
up the page area on which to print vector graphics images. The vector graphics capabilities of these HL Series  
printers working in HP-GL/2 mode are described in the HP-GL/2 section of this manual.  
6.4.1. Enter HP-GL/2 mode  
Esc%#B  
(27)(37)#(66)  
<1Bh><25h>#<42h>  
·
·
This command enters HP-GL/2 graphics mode.  
# = 0 the cursor is positioned at the previous HP-GL/2 cursor position. If this is the first time you have  
switched to HP-GL/2 mode since switching the printer on, the cursor is placed at the origin of the HP-GL/2  
graphics window.  
·
# = 1 the cursor remains at its current position.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.5. The Picture Frame  
The PCL picture frame is the rectangular area of the page on which you can print graphic images. You can  
position and size the picture frame to suit your requirements and achieve effects such as scaling or distortion of  
vector graphics images.  
6.5.1. The default picture frame  
The default picture frame size and position is determined by the default logical page size and text length for each  
given paper size.  
6.5.2. Set picture frame anchor point  
Esc*c0T (27)(42)(99)(48)(84) <1Bh><2Ah><63h><30h><54h>  
·
This command sets the anchor point (top left hand corner) of the picture frame to the current cursor position.  
6.5.3. Set picture frame vertical size  
Esc*c#Y (27)(42)(99)#(89)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<59h>  
·
·
This command sets the vertical size of the picture frame.  
# is the height of the picture frame in decipoints.  
6.5.4. Set picture frame horizontal size  
Esc*c#X (27)(42)(99)#(88)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<58h>  
·
·
This command sets the horizontal size of the picture frame.  
# is the width of the picture frame in decipoints.  
6.5.5. Specify vertical plot size  
Esc*c#L (27)(42)(99)#(76)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<4Ch>  
·
·
·
·
·
This command specifies the height in inches of an imported image.  
# is the height of the image in inches.  
# can be in the range 0 to 32767 and can have up to four places of decimals.  
This command is only applicable to existing graphic images which are being imported from an application.  
The imported graphic will be scaled so that its height matches that of the HP-GL/2 graphics window.  
6.5.6. Specify horizontal plot size  
Esc*c#K (27)(42)(99)#(75)  
<1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<4Bh>  
·
·
·
·
·
This command specifies the width in inches of the image being imported.  
# is the width of the image in inches.  
# can be in the range 0 to 32767 and can have up to four places of decimals.  
This command is only applicable to existing graphic images which are being imported from an application.  
The imported graphic will be scaled so that its width matches that of the HP-GL/2 graphics window.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.  
MACROS  
7.1. The Purpose of a Macro  
A macro is a sequence of commands that you wish to execute. You can specify the command sequence and  
download it to the printer after which you can execute it with a single command. For example, you might wish to  
draw a raster image at the top of each page you print. Rather than sending the same sequence of commands every  
time you print a new page, it is more efficient to define a macro to draw the image and store the macro in the  
printer’s memory. Having done this, you can draw the picture on each page simply by running the macro, that is,  
with a single command.  
Like downloaded fonts, macros take up printer memory. To alleviate this, some macros are available on cartridges  
that can be plugged into the printer’s cartridge slots. A cartridge-based macro must have a unique ID number or  
else you will not be able to access it. If a downloaded macro has the same ID number as a cartridge macro, all  
references to the ID number will be interpreted as references to the downloaded macro. To access the cartridge  
macro you would first have to delete the downloaded macro.  
Another method of storing Macros is uniquely available on the HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN  
printers. Macros can be saved to these cards as required and then executed from the card. For the HL-2400Ce /  
3400CN printers, Macros can be also saved to and executed from the optional internal hard disk drive installed as  
required. A delete facility is also included to allow the removal of macros when no longer required. The rules for  
identifying and calling Macros from this card are exactly the same as for cartridge stored Macros detailed above.  
For the HL-1270N/1470N printer, Macros can be stored in the incorporated Flash memory.  
One macro can call another, however, only two levels of nesting are permitted.  
A printer reset will delete macros from the printer’s memory unless they have been explicitly designated as  
permanent.  
The PCL picture frame commands, the printer reset command and HP-GL/2 graphic language commands cannot be  
invoked from within a macro.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.2. Defining a Macro  
To define a macro you must first assign an ID number to it, then send to the printer a Start Macro Definition  
command, the macro definition itself (consisting of a sequence of PCL commands) and finally an End Macro  
Definition command.  
7.2.1. Macro ID  
Esc&f#Y (27)(38)(102)#(89)  
<1Bh><26h><66h>#<59h>  
·
This command assigns an identity number to a macro that is to be downloaded, or references an existing  
macro in the printer’s memory.  
·
·
# is the ID number of a macro. The ID number must be in the range 0-32767.  
If you specify the ID number of an existing macro and then download a new macro definition to the printer,  
the new macro will overwrite the existing macro.  
7.2.2. Start macro definition  
Esc&f0X (27)(38)(102)(48)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><30h><58h>  
·
This command signifies that the following commands constitute a macro definition.  
7.2.3. End macro definition  
Esc&f1X (27)(38)(102)(49)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><31h><58h>  
·
This command terminates the macro definition.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.3. Running a Macro  
Macros can be invoked in three different ways: they can be ‘executed’, ‘called’ or ‘enabled for overlay’. When a  
macro is 'executed' it uses the current modified print environment. Any changes it makes to the environment are  
permanent. A macro that is 'called' also uses the current modified print environment, however, any changes it  
makes to the environment are discarded when the macro has performed its function. When a macro is 'enabled' for  
overlay, the macro’s command sequence is performed as the final operation every time a page is printed. Overlaid  
macros use the overlay environment. The overlay environment is a combination of the user default environment  
and the modified print environment. This environment is effective only while the macro is running.  
Page length  
Page size  
Orientation  
Registration  
Paper source  
Number of copies  
Cursor position stack  
7.3.1. Execute macro  
Esc&f2X (27)(38)(102)(50)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><32h><58h>  
·
·
This command executes the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.  
Any changes made to the modified print environment during the execution of a macro, such as font selection  
or margin settings, are retained after macro execution has been completed.  
7.3.2. Call macro  
Esc&f3X (27)(38)(102)(51)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><33h><58h>  
·
·
This command calls the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.  
Any changes made to the modified print environment during a macro call, such as raster graphics settings, are  
temporary and remain in effect only while the macro is running. They are not retained after the macro has  
finished.  
7.3.3. Enable macro for overlay  
Esc&f4X (27)(38)(102)(52)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><34h><58h>  
·
This command overlays the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.  
7.3.4. Disable macro for overlay  
Esc&f5X (27)(38)(102)(53)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><35h><58h>  
·
This command stops overlaying the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.4. Handling Macros  
7.4.1. Delete all macros  
Esc&f6X (27)(38)(102)(54)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><36h><58h>  
·
This command deletes all macros from the printer’s memory.  
7.4.2. Delete all temporary macros  
Esc&f7X (27)(38)(102)(55)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><37h><58h>  
·
This command deletes all temporary macros from the printer’s memory. Temporary macros are those which  
have not been made permanent with the Esc&f10X command.  
7.4.3. Delete macro  
Esc&f8X (27)(38)(102)(56)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><38h><58h>  
·
This command deletes from printer memory the macro whose ID number was specified most recently.  
7.4.4. Make macro temporary  
Esc&f9X (27)(38)(102)(57)(88) <1Bh><26h><66h><39h><58h>  
·
This command makes the macro whose ID number was specified most recently temporary (that is, it will not be  
retained if the printer is reset).  
7.4.5. Make macro permanent  
Esc&f10X (27)(38)(102)(49)(48)(88)  
<1Bh><26h><66h><31h><30h><58h>  
·
This command makes the macro whose ID number was specified most recently permanent (that is, it will be  
retained if the printer is reset).  
7.4.6. Delete all macros from the storage device  
Esc&f1030X (27)(38)(102)(49)(48)(51)(48)(88)  
<1Bh><26h><66h><31h><30h><33h><30h><58h>  
This command deletes all macros and all data from the storage device.  
·
7.4.7. Delete macro from the storage device  
Esc&f1036X (27)(38)(102)(49)(48)(51)(54)(88)  
<1Bh><26h><66h><31h><30h><33h><36h><58h>  
This command deletes the macro whose ID number was specified most recently from the storage device.  
·
7.4.8. Save macro into the storage device  
Esc&f1038X (27)(38)(102)(49)(48)(51)(56)(88)  
<1Bh><26h><66h><31h><30h><33h><38h><58h>  
This command saves the macro whose ID number was specified most recently into the storage device.  
·
Macro example  
10 REM ***** A EXAMPLE OF A MACRO *****  
20 ESC$=CHR$(27)  
30 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
40 REM --- RESET PRINTER ---  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E":  
60 REM --- SET MACRO ID TO 0 ---  
70 LPRINT ESC$+"&f0Y";  
80 REM --- START MACRO DEFINITION ---  
90 LPRINT ESC$+"&f0X";  
100 REM --- SET CURSOR POSITION X=1800 DOT, Y=0 DOT ---  
110 LPRINT ESC$+"*p1800x0Y";  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
120 REM --- SET FONT TO LETTER GOTHIC (18 DOTS WIDE) ---  
130 LPRINT ESC$+"(s0p16.66h8.5v0s0b130T";  
140 REM --- PRINT COMMENT ---  
150 LPRINT "Printed by this printer";  
160 REM --- SET CURSOR POSITION X=1790 DOT, Y=-40 DOT ---  
170 LPRINT ESC$+"*p1790x-40Y";  
180 REM --- PERFORM SHADING ---  
190 REM --- SET SHADING WIDTH TO 23 CHARACTERS + 20 DOTS ---  
200 LPRINT ESC$+"*c";23*18+20;"A";  
210 REM --- SET SHADING HEIGHT TO 30 DOTS ---  
220 LPRINT ESC$+"*c60B";  
230 REM --- DRAW SHADING PATTERN (5% GRAY SCALE) ---  
240 LPRINT ESC$+"*c5g2P";  
250 REM --- END MACRO DEFINITION ---  
260 LPRINT ESC$+"&f1X";  
270 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY ON (PRINT THE MESSAGE ON EVERY PRINTOUT)  
-- 280 LPRINT ESC$+"&f4X";  
290 REM --- SET FONT TO BROUGHAM 10 ---  
300 LPRINT ESC$+"(s0p10h12v0s0b128T";  
310 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY ON, PAPER EJECT ---  
320 LPRINT "MACRO OVERLAY ON"  
330 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
340 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY ON, PAPER EJECT ---  
350 LPRINT "MACRO OVERLAY ON"  
360 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
370 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY OFF (PRINT WITHOUT THE MESSAGE) ---  
380 LPRINT ESC$+"&f5X";  
390 REM --- MACRO OVERLAY OFF, PAPER EJECT ---  
400 LPRINT "MACRO OVERLAY OFF"  
410 LPRINT CHR$(12);  
420 END  
7.4.9. Execute data  
The data saved in the storage device by using Printer's control panel "SAVE DATA" function can be printed by  
the following command. It can also be printed by operation of the Printer control panel.  
EscCR!#E (27)(13)(33)#(69)  
<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<45h>  
·
·
·
·
·
# indicates the DATA ID.  
Execute the data which is saved in the flash memory card or Hard Disk card.  
The printer uses the current environment when this command is executed.  
While executing the data, it is possible to change the emulation or reset the printer.  
If this command is included in the last data which was saved by the "SAVE DATA" operation from the  
printer's control panel, the printer enters a permanent loop so that saved data such as DEMO printing keeps  
printing. To stop it, press the RESET key on the printer's control panel. This function is available only for  
the Flash ROM card.  
7.4.10. AppleTalk configuration  
Esc&b#W[key]<sp>[value]  
(27)(38)(98)#(87)[Key](32)[value]  
<1Bh><26h><62h>#<57h>[Key]<20h>[value]  
·
·
·
# value can be from 0 to 32767.  
# stands for number of bytes in the data which is following this command.  
[key] should be [RENAME], [JOB] or [TYPE].  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
If the key is [RENAME], this command allows the printer to change the name field of the AppleTalk name  
binding protocol.  
<ESC>&b#WRENAME<sp>printername  
printername should be specified with 1 to 31 characters.  
The characters $00 to $FF (except for $00, @, :, *, =, $C5) can be used for the printername.  
$00 is used as the terminator.  
If invalid characters are used, this command is ignored.  
·
·
If the [key] is set to [JOB], this command changes the current job name.  
<ESC>&b#WJOB<sp>jobname  
All characters from $00 to $FF can be used for the jobname.  
jobname can have a maximum of 127 characters.  
If the [key] is set to [TYPE], this command allows the printer to change the type field of the AppleTalk name  
binding protocol.  
<ESC>&b#WTYPE<sp>devicetype  
devicetype should be specified with 1 to 31 characters.  
The characters $00 to $FF (except for $00, @, :, *, =, $C5) can be used for the devicetype.  
$00 is used as the terminator.  
If invalid characters are used, this command is ignored.  
7.4.11. MIO video I/O port control  
The HL-1660e and 2060 printers have only the "VSREQ" signal for vertical synchronization that can be sent to the  
MIO port. This causes a short delay to the actual printing start after sending the VSREQ signal if the video  
controller is processing an interrupt. This delay causes an incorrect vertical printing position. To avoid the  
problem, the following command is useful.  
EscCR!12340M (27)(13)(33)(49)(50)(51)(52)(48)(77)  
<1Bh><0Dh><21h><31h><32h><33h><34h><30h><4Dh>  
·
Laser diode video interface port of the MIO port is closed.  
EscCR!12341M (27)(13)(33)(49)(50)(51)(52)(49)(77)  
<1Bh><0Dh><21h><31h><32h><33h><34h><31h><4Dh>  
·
Laser diode video interface port of the MIO port is opened.  
EscCR!12342M (27)(13)(33)(49)(50)(51)(52)(50)(77)  
<1Bh><0Dh><21h><31h><32h><33h><34h><32h><4Dh>  
·
Laser diode video interface port of the MIO port is opened and the print start command is sent to the printer  
engine immediately after sending the VSREQ signal.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
8.  
STATUS READBACK  
8.1. Introduction  
Status readback features are explained in this section. The printer sends a status response message after  
receiving a request for its status by these commands. You can get the information as shown below from the  
printer.  
- available printer (user) memory  
- current available fonts and symbol sets  
- the ID numbers of downloaded macros and user-defined patterns to verify their  
presence  
The computer system must have a device driver for bi-directional communication to get the printers status  
response. Bi-directional communication is supported on the HL Series laser printers by the printer driver that  
comes with these machines.  
8.2. Memory Status request  
You can identify the capacity of the user memory in the printer by using the memory status request. You can  
determine whether to execute "downloading" or not, by knowing the available memory and thus avoid printer  
memory overrun errors.  
8.3. Entity Status  
You can request the printer to send the status of its entities. A font, symbol set, macro or user-defined pattern in  
the printer can be an entity. In order to request entity status, a position type and a position unit must be  
identified first and then the entity request command must be sent.  
Location type is the memory positions that contain the entities. Memory positions are internal ROM, RAM,  
cartridges/cards, the storage device and one additional position specified as "currently selected". Currently  
selected means the entity is active. However, "currently selected" can be applied only for fonts and user-defined  
patterns.  
Location unit means a more specific position within the location type.  
When the location type and unit are identified, you can request the status with the Inquire Status Readback  
Entity command. The entity (font, symbol set, macro or user-defined pattern) is specified by this command and  
the printer sends the response.  
When an invalid request is sent, the printer sends an error response back.  
8.4. Status Response  
If a status request (command) is received, the printer produces the response data. The printer accumulates this  
data in an I/O status buffer and saves the response in this buffer until a user reads it or you turn off the printer.  
The printer clears the status responses when Printer resolution, Page protection or Emulation language is  
changed.  
The printer processes status requests and their related response in the order in which the printer receives them.  
According to the internal printer operations, the number of responses the printer can accumulate is different. If  
you use multiple applications or share the printer, you should read the response to a request before making a new  
request.  
You should use the Echo command so that your applications request will synchronize with the printer's  
responses, because an earlier application might have requested a status and the printer might retain it.  
A status response gets routed back to the I/O port that it was requested from.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
8.5. Status Response Syntax  
All of the status responses begin with "PCL", Carriage Return control code and a Line Feed control code. The  
response is ended by a Carriage Return and a Line Feed control code. At the end of the transaction, status  
responses are ended by a Form Feed Control code. The fundamental syntax for the status response is as shown  
below.  
PCL<CR> <LF>  
INFO TITLE<CR><LF>  
KEYWORDn=DATAn<CR><LF>  
KEYWORDn=DATAn<CR><LF>  
.
.
.
<FF>  
TITLE, KEYWORDn, and DATAn are strings which differ according to the status readback command being  
operated. One or more keyword lines related to the status readback response accompany every status readback  
response. The Echo command response differs from this and is as shown below.  
PCL<CR><LF>  
ECHO ValueField<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
ValueField is the decimal number which comes from the Echo command value field.  
For future printers, keywords might be added. Applications in which the status readback is used should be made  
to disregard lines with keywords they do not understand.  
8.5.1. Set status readback location type  
ESC*s#T (27)(42)(115)#(84)  
<1Bh><2Ah><73h>#<54h>  
This command determines the status location type according to the value of #.  
The location type is used in association with the location unit in order to specify an entity location for a status  
request.  
·
#=0 specifies an invalid location. When the printer receives an Inquire Entity Command, an error response is  
generated. This is the default value. When you execute a printer reset, this value is reset to 0.  
·
·
·
·
·
# = 1 specifies the currently selected location.  
# = 2 specifies all locations.  
# = 3 specifies the printer's internal location.  
# = 4 specifies the downloaded entity.  
# = 5 specifies the user-installed card/cartridge  
The location type setting is retained by the printer. When the printer does not send the set status readback  
location type command in order to change the setting for an entity request, then the printer uses the currently  
available location type setting.  
8.5.2. Set status readback location unit  
ESC*s#U (27)(42)(115)#(85)  
<1Bh><2Ah><73h>#<55h>  
·
·
The status location unit is selected by the value of #.  
The printer uses the location unit in association with the location type in order to specify an entity location  
for a status request.  
Type  
Unit  
0
1
2
3
-
-
-
invalid location  
currently selected location  
all locations  
0
all internal entities  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4
5
0
1
2
0
1
n
all downloaded entities  
downloaded entity as temporary  
downloaded entity as permanent  
All cartridge/cards  
the cartridge/card which has the highest priority.  
the cartridge/card which has the lowest priority  
·
·
·
When the location value is 0, 1 and 2, it ignores the unit value (which might be set to any value). The default  
value is 0, and whenever you reset the printer, the value is reset to the default value.  
The location unit setting is retained by the printer. If the printer does not send this command to change the  
setting for an entity request, then it uses the currently available location units.  
The printer may set the location type and unit in order. It does not identify any invalid combinations until it  
receives the inquire entity command. Hence, if the unit value is not in the correct range, it sets the unit to the  
value for a proper error response to be sent when the inquire entity command is received.  
8.5.3. Inquire status readback entity  
ESC*s#I (27)(42)(115)#(73)  
<1Bh><2Ah><73h>#<49h>  
·
Specifies the entity type and makes the printer produce a status response for the entity identified in the status  
readback location (type and unit).  
Value  
Entity type  
Font  
Macro  
User-defined Pattern  
Symbol set  
Font extended  
0
1
2
3
4
8.5.4. Entity status response  
The status response for an inquire status readback entity command differs according to the type of the requested  
entity.  
8.5.5. Font response  
Keywords returned from the printer depend on whether the printer font is a bitmap, unbound scalable or bound  
scalable. Below is the list of keywords for a font request.  
SELECT =  
SYMBOLSETS=  
LOCTYPE=  
LOCUNIT=  
Below is an example of a font status response for inquire status command.  
Internal, bitmap, LetterGothic 16.66  
Internal, unbound scalable, PcTennessee italic  
Downloaded, bound scalable, Portugal  
Font status:  
PCL  
INFO FONTS  
SELECT="<Esc>(8U<ESC>(s0p16.66h9.5v0s0b130T"  
SELECT="<Esc>(s1p__v1s0b4101T"  
SYMBOLSETS="0D, 0I, 0N, 0S, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G, ..."  
SELECT="<Esc>(1U<Esc>(s1p__v0s0b5111T<Esc>(22X"  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
In a font status response, the "SELECT=" keyword line specifies the individual fonts. The font is identified by  
this line by specifying the font selection characteristics such as symbol set, spacing, pitch, height, style, stroke  
weight, and typefaces. It returns the "SELECT=" for all font types.  
In a status response, the five characters "<", "E", "s", "c", and "&>" represent an escape character.  
Keywords following a "SELECT=" keyword mean the font specified by that "SELECT=" keyword.  
8.5.6. Bitmap fonts  
For bitmap fonts, the printer returns the "SELECT=" line. This specifies the font selection features. For instance,  
the printer returns the printer's internal, bitmap, Roman-8 LetterGothic font as follows.  
PCL  
INFO FONTS  
SELECT"=<Esc>(8U<Esc>(s0p16.66h8.5v0s0b130T"  
8.5.7. Bound scalable fonts  
For bound scalable fonts, an underscore( "...s1p__v0s...,") in the "SELECT=" line means it is a bound scalable  
font. Also, the related features are indicated. Either the height or pitch is indicated depending upon whether the  
font is proportional or fixed spaced. The printer, for instance, returns the printer's internal scalable Symbol font  
(proportionally spaced) as follows.  
PCL  
INFO FONTS  
SELECT="<Esc>(19M<Esc>(s1p__v0s0b16901T"  
8.5.8. Unbound scalable fonts  
For unbound fonts, the printer adds the "SYMBOLSETS=" keyword to specify the symbol sets which can be  
used, as the symbol sets can also be used with an unbound font, and there is no symbol set sequence in the  
"SELECT=" line. The printer, for instance, returns the printer's internal unbound scalable Brougham (medium,  
fixed spaced) font and Pc Tennessee (bold italic, proportional spaced) fonts as follows.  
PCL  
INFO FONTS  
SELECT="<Esc>(s0p__h0s0b4099T"  
SYMBOLSETS="0D, 0I, 0N, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G, ..."  
SELECT="<Esc>(s1p__v1s1s3b4101T"  
SYMBOLSETS="0D, 0I, 0N, 0S, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G, ..."  
8.5.9. Download fonts  
For download fonts (bitmap, bound scalable or unbound scalable), the font ID number is included at the end of  
the "SELECT=" line. For instance, the printer returns a downloaded bitmap Brougham with a font ID of 40 and a  
downloaded, unbound scalable, Dom Casual typeface with a font ID of 79 as follows.  
PCL  
INFO FONTS  
SELECT="<Esc>(8U<Esc>(s0p11.00h12.0v0s0b3T<Esc>(40X"  
SELECT="<Esc>(s1p__v1s0b5259T<Esc>)79X"  
SYMBOLSETS="0D, 0D, 0N, 0S, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G, ..."  
8.5.10. Location type 1 (currently selected) font  
For a status location type 1 (currently selected) font, the printer returns a single font, the printer font which is  
currently selected. The following are the keywords and data returned.  
The printer returns the "LOCTYPE=" and "LOCUNIT=" after the "SELECT=" line for every font.  
The "SELECT=" line changes for bound and unbound scalable fonts.  
For all scalable fonts, the actual size (height or pitch ) is indicated instead of the underscores. For unbound  
scalable fonts, the symbol set which is bound to the font at present is indicated. For all fonts, when the font is a  
secondary font, ")" replace the "(" characters in the "SELECT=" line.  
"LOCTYPE=" specifies the location type of the font which is selected at present. The value field of the Set Status  
Readback Type command is related to the value returned.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
"LOCUNIT=" specifies the location unit of the font which is selected at present. The value field of the Set Status  
Readback Unit command is related to the value returned.  
For instance, if the printer font which is selected at present is a bold 12 point Presentation bitmap font which is  
selected from a cartridge, and a font entity request with the location type set to 1 is produced, the response will  
be returned as follows.  
PCL  
INFO FONTS  
SELECT="<Esc>(2U<Esc>(s0p10.00h12.0v0s3b11T"  
LOCTYPE=5  
LOCUNIT=1  
For instance, suppose the printer font which is selected at present is unbound scalable Dom Casual font with the  
features below:  
downloaded (font ID of 78)  
temporary  
Roman-8(specified for printing)  
secondary font  
18 point  
When an entity request is produced with the location type set to 1(selected at present), it returns the response  
below.  
PCL  
INFO FONTS  
SELECT="<Esc>)8U<Esc>)s1p18.00v1s0b4148T<Esc>)78X"  
LOCTYPE=4  
LOCUNIT=1  
8.5.11. Font extended response  
The font extended response supplies a method to return the name and internal ID number of the font as well as  
the "SELECT=" line. It is the same as a font status response since "SELECT=", "SYMBOLSETS=", "LOCTYPE=",  
and "LOCUNIT=" are returned in the same way. With regard to a font extended request, it returns the two  
additional keywords, "DEFID=" and "NAME=" as follows.  
"DEFID" specifies the internal ID number of the font which is shown on the test print  
( font list ). This is the  
number which is used to select the font as the default font from the control panel of printer or from PJL. The  
"DEFID=" number is made of two parts, which are a location and an ID number. The locations which are likely are  
as follows;  
I
- Internal  
C
Cn  
S
- Cartridge (printer with single cartridge)  
- Cartridge (printer with multiple cartridge/card when n is specified by printer.)  
- Permanent download fonts  
For temporary download fonts, it returns "DEFID=NONE" because temporary download fonts do not have an  
internal ID number.  
The printer assigns the internal ID number of a temporary download font with the Font ID (ESC*c#D) command.  
This internal ID number differs from the downloaded ID number assigned to a downloaded font.  
It returns "NAME=" only for font extended status requests. The name of the font is the same as shown on the  
font printout.  
For instance, it returns the font extended response for the printer's internal bitmap LetterGothic font and a  
downloaded unbound Portugal temporary font as follows.  
PCL  
INFO FONTS EXTENDED  
SELECT="<Esc>(8U<Esc>(s0p10.00h12.0v0s0b0T"  
DEFID="I 45"  
NAME="Line Printer"  
SELECT="<Ec>(s1p__v1s3b4111T<Esc>(7X"  
SymbolSETS="0D, 0I, 0N, 0S, 0U, 1E, 1F, 1G,..."  
DEFID=NONE  
NAME="CG Palacio BdIt"  
SELECT="...  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
For instance, a font extended response with the location type set to 1( selected at present ) where the font which  
is selected at present is the internal Pc Tennessee (18 point identified for printing) bold, returns the response as  
follows.  
PCL  
INFO FONTS EXTENDED  
SELECT="<Esc>(8U<Esc>(s0p18.00h0s3b4101T"  
DEFID="<Esc>(8U<Esc>s0p18.000s3b4101T"  
DEFID="I 2"  
NAME="PcTennessee Bd"  
LOCTYPE=1  
LOCUNIT=1  
8.5.12. Macro response  
The status response for macros indicates all of the macro IDs ("IDLIST=") for the macros in a particular location.  
Status location type 1( selected at present ) is an unused location for macros and an error is returned.  
A macro status response may be shown as follows.  
PCL  
INFO MACROS  
IDLIST="1, 3, 8, 29, 32"  
8.5.13. Use-defined pattern response  
The status response of user-defined patterns indicates all of the user-defined patterns and all of the user-defined  
pattern IDs ("IDLIST") for the patterns in a particular location.  
A user-defined pattern response may be shown as follows.  
PCL  
INFO PATTERN  
IDLIST="1, 2, 9, 13, 27, 456"  
When the location type is specified to 1 (selected at present), "LOCTYPE=" and "LOCUNIT=" lines are added.  
It returns the "LOCTYPE=" only for a status location type 1 requirement. It specifies the location type of the  
pattern which is selected at present.  
It returns the "LOCUNIT=" only for a status location type 1 requirement. It specifies the location unit of the  
pattern which is selected at present.  
A user-defined pattern response for the pattern selected at present may be shown as follows.  
PCL  
INFO PATTERN  
IDLIST="88"  
LOCTYPE=4  
LOCUNIT=2  
When the pattern selected at present is set to one of the internal HP-specified patterns, there is no number  
available and it returns the response "ERROR=NONE".  
PCL  
INFO PATTERNS  
ERROR=NONE  
8.5.14. Symbol set response  
The symbol set response indicates all of the symbol set IDs ("IDLIST") for all of the symbol sets in the identified  
location. There can be bound and unbound scalable fonts in the identified location (type and unit).  
A symbol set response may be shown as follows.  
PCL  
INFO SYMBOLSETS  
IDLIST="0U, 2K, 8M, 11U"  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Status location type 1 (selected at present) is an incorrect location for unbound font symbol sets and returns an  
error.  
Example responses in this section for "SYMBOLSETS=" do not indicate the complete list of symbol sets which  
are available internally, but only a partial list . The internal symbol sets depend on the printer and might differ  
according to the printer.  
8.5.15. Entity error codes  
When an out-of-range value exists in the command value fields, or when the entity is not supported or does not  
exist, or the request is inadequate, the printer replies with one of four likely errors as follows:  
Invalid Entity  
Invalid Location  
None  
Internal Error  
ERROR=INVALID ENTITY  
When the identified entity type is not in the range or not supported, it returns an invalid entity error.  
PCL  
INFO ENTITY  
ERROR=INVALID ENTITY  
ERROR=INVALID LOCATION  
When the entity type is correct, but the location ( the type, the unit, or the combination) is not, or when the  
identified device is not installed, it returns an invalid location error.  
PCL  
INFO FONTS  
ERROR=INVALID LOCATION  
ERROR=NONE  
When the entity type and location are correct, but there are not any entities of the identified type in the location,  
or when the type is not correct for the identified entity, it generates the NONE error response.  
PCL  
INFO SYMBOLSETS  
ERROR=NONE  
ERROR=INTERNAL ERROR  
The status response for some requirements could be quite big. When status replies are requested, it returns an  
internal error if the printer runs out of memory as follows:  
PCL  
INFO SYMBOL SETS  
ERROR=INTERNAL ERROR  
8.5.16. Free space command  
ESC*s1M (27)(42)(115)(48)(77) <1Bh><2Ah><73h><31h><4Dh>  
The amount of memory which is free for use is returned by this command. Two values are returned: the total  
amount of free memory and the largest block of free memory.  
When you send a value other than 1, an error ( "ERROR = INVALID UNIT" )is returned.  
The Free Space command is sent to check the free memory space and you can acknowledge whether the printer  
has enough memory for a job or not before you execute your job. Also you can check the amount of memory  
which an entity or any other data has already used.  
Free memory space will always be changing during different printing conditions.  
For example, when the printer receives print data, it is stored in the printer memory and so the free space in  
the printer memory becomes smaller. After the data is printed, the printer memory becomes empty, so the  
free space becomes larger again.  
Certain action is needed when you decide there is not enough memory to hold the data to be downloaded.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
8.5.17. Font cache  
In order to print characters from a scalable font, the printer changes the scalable character outlines into sized  
bitmaps. These bitmapped characters are produced on a character-by-character basis and the produced  
bitmapped characters are stored in memory. As it prints more pages using more fonts, more memory is consumed  
by the bitmaps. The bitmap characters used on the first page of a job can stay in memory till the end of a job.  
These stored bitmap characters are known as the font cache.  
If a Brother HL-Series printer encounters a memory low condition, all of the font cache is automatically deleted.  
Also, font cache and temporary entities can be cleared by a Printer Reset command.  
8.5.18. Memory status response  
The total available memory is specified by "TOTAL=" and the largest continuous block size of available memory  
is specified by "LARGEST=".  
PCL  
INFO MEMORY  
TOTAL = 10000  
LARGEST = 3500  
8.5.19. Memory error response  
When the value field of the free memory command is out of range, the response for this command would be as  
follows;  
PCL  
INFO MEMORY  
ERROR = INVALID UNIT  
8.5.20. Flush all pages command  
ESC&r#F (27)(38)(114)#(70)  
<1Bh><26h><72h>#<46h>  
This command suspends accepting data from a PC and clears the user memory.  
·
·
#=0 suspends receiving data and clears all completed data. Incompleted data remains in the printers memory.  
#=1 suspends receiving data and clears all data remaining in the printer memory.  
8.5.21. Echo command  
ESC*s#X (27)(42)(115)#(88)  
<1Bh><2Ah><73h>#<58h>  
This command is used to distinguish each request and response. In networking/sharing environments, some  
requests may be sent from a number of PCs to one printer. This command sends the user selected value to the  
printer and the printer can return the same value. Adding this command before the status request command  
allows this echo value to distinguish the corresponding status response.  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
9.  
INDEX  
change..................................................................................... 19  
exit ............................................................................................ 18  
end-of-line wrap .......................................................................... 12  
entity error code.......................................................................... 97  
entity status................................................................................. 91  
entity status response................................................................ 93  
envelope....................................................................................... 15  
environment................................................................................. 14  
error response  
A
adaptive compression.................................................................75  
anchor point.................................................................................84  
AppleTalk configuration............................................................89  
APT ...............................................................................................78  
area fill...........................................................................................67  
memory .................................................................................... 98  
Esc................................................................................................. 12  
escape........................................................................................... 11  
escape sequence......................................................................... 12  
B
backspace.....................................................................................11  
binding..........................................................................................17  
bitmap font .............................................................................33, 94  
bound font....................................................................................34  
bound scalable font ....................................................................94  
F
factory default environment...................................................... 14  
factory default setting................................................................ 18  
fill pattern ..................................................................................... 69  
filled rectangle  
C
draw......................................................................................... 71  
fixed spacing................................................................................ 41  
fixed underlining.......................................................................... 45  
floating underlining .................................................................... 45  
Flush All Pages command ......................................................... 98  
font................................................................................................ 33  
font cache..................................................................................... 98  
font descriptor............................................................................. 47  
font extended response.............................................................. 95  
font ID........................................................................................... 46  
font orientation............................................................................ 44  
font response............................................................................... 93  
font selection criteria .................................................................. 35  
font source................................................................................... 34  
font type....................................................................................... 33  
form feed....................................................................................... 11  
Free Space command.................................................................. 97  
carriage return ..............................................................................11  
CCITT G3/G4 ................................................................................77  
character code..............................................................................59  
character descriptor and data....................................................59  
character spacing ........................................................................36  
compress transfer graphics........................................................79  
compression mode ......................................................................74  
condensed....................................................................................43  
control code .................................................................................11  
coordinate.....................................................................................23  
cursor  
position..............................................................................28, 30  
cursor position stack..................................................................30  
D
decipoints .....................................................................................23  
default fonts .................................................................................35  
defined symbol set......................................................................37  
destination....................................................................................65  
display function mode................................................................13  
download font..............................................................................94  
downloadable font ......................................................................35  
create........................................................................................47  
manipulation ...........................................................................46  
downloaded font  
G
graphics ........................................................................................ 65  
graphics window......................................................................... 20  
H
half line feed................................................................................. 31  
height...................................................................................... 36, 42  
raster image............................................................................. 74  
select........................................................................................ 42  
high resolution control............................................................... 73  
HMI............................................................................................... 25  
horizontal cursor position.......................................................... 29  
horizontal margin......................................................................... 24  
horizontal motion index.............................................................. 25  
horizontal plot size ...................................................................... 84  
operation .................................................................................46  
select........................................................................................46  
duplex printing.............................................................................17  
E
Echo command.............................................................................98  
emulation mode  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
horizontal tab ...............................................................................11  
HP-GL/2 mode..............................................................................83  
P
page............................................................................................... 20  
page dimensions  
I
landscape................................................................................ 22  
portrait ..................................................................................... 21  
page length .................................................................................. 27  
page size ....................................................................................... 15  
paper side selection.................................................................... 17  
paper source ................................................................................ 16  
paper type .................................................................................... 15  
pattern........................................................................................... 65  
pattern reference point............................................................... 68  
pattern transparency .................................................................. 66  
pattern type.................................................................................. 69  
PCL................................................................................................ 12  
perforation skip ........................................................................... 27  
physical page............................................................................... 20  
picture frame ................................................................................ 84  
horizontal size......................................................................... 84  
vertical size ............................................................................. 84  
pitch ........................................................................................ 36, 41  
select........................................................................................ 41  
portrait .......................................................................................... 31  
primary font............................................................................ 11, 35  
printable area ............................................................................... 20  
proportional spacing .................................................................. 41  
internal font..................................................................................34  
italic ...............................................................................................43  
J
Job separation command............................................................18  
L
landscape......................................................................................31  
left long-edge offset registration ..............................................16  
left margin .....................................................................................23  
line feed.........................................................................................11  
line pitch .......................................................................................25  
line spacing ..................................................................................26  
line termination ............................................................................12  
location type  
status readback......................................................................92  
location unit  
status readback......................................................................92  
logical page ..................................................................................20  
logical page orientation..............................................................31  
lower cassette ..............................................................................16  
R
Raster Graphic Mode 1027......................................................... 81  
raster graphics ............................................................................. 73  
raster image  
send ......................................................................................... 79  
raster resolution .......................................................................... 73  
raster transfer  
end ........................................................................................... 79  
rectangle height........................................................................... 71  
rectangle width............................................................................ 71  
rectangles ..................................................................................... 71  
RESET ..................................................................................... 14, 18  
right margin .................................................................................. 23  
rows and columns....................................................................... 23  
M
macro .............................................................................................85  
call ............................................................................................87  
delete........................................................................................88  
execute.....................................................................................87  
overlay.....................................................................................87  
macro definition  
end............................................................................................86  
start ..........................................................................................86  
macro ID........................................................................................86  
macro overlay environment .......................................................14  
macro response............................................................................96  
manual paper feed .......................................................................16  
measurement ................................................................................23  
memory status request...............................................................91  
MIO video I/O port control........................................................90  
Mode 9 compression ..................................................................75  
modified print environment........................................................14  
multi-purpose tray.......................................................................16  
S
scalable font................................................................................. 33  
scale ......................................................................................... 42  
secondary font ...................................................................... 11, 35  
self test......................................................................................... 18  
simlex printing.............................................................................. 17  
solid............................................................................................... 43  
source ........................................................................................... 65  
source transparency................................................................... 65  
space............................................................................................. 11  
status location type 1 font......................................................... 94  
status readback........................................................................... 91  
O
orientation  
raster image.............................................................................73  
output tray....................................................................................15  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
status response...........................................................................91  
U
memory ....................................................................................98  
status response syntax...............................................................92  
stroke weight................................................................................36  
select........................................................................................43  
style .........................................................................................36, 42  
select........................................................................................42  
symbol collection ........................................................................36  
symbol set ....................................................................................36  
define .......................................................................................37  
select........................................................................................39  
symbol set control command.....................................................39  
symbol set ID code command ...................................................37  
symbol set response...................................................................96  
unbound font............................................................................... 34  
unbound scalable font ............................................................... 94  
underlining text ............................................................................ 45  
unit of measure ............................................................................ 23  
units .............................................................................................. 23  
upper cassette ............................................................................. 16  
upright .......................................................................................... 43  
user default environment........................................................... 14  
user settings ................................................................................ 18  
user-defined pattern command ................................................. 68  
user-defined pattern control...................................................... 69  
user-defined pattern response.................................................. 96  
T
V
test sheet ......................................................................................18  
text area.........................................................................................20  
text direction.................................................................................31  
text length.....................................................................................26  
text wrap........................................................................................12  
TIFF.........................................................................................74, 78  
top margin.....................................................................................24  
top offset registration.................................................................17  
transfer start  
vector graphics............................................................................ 83  
vertical cursor position .............................................................. 28  
vertical motion index................................................................... 25  
vertical plot size........................................................................... 84  
VMI............................................................................................... 25  
W
width  
raster imge...............................................................................79  
transparent print data .................................................................44  
type of character spacing  
raster image............................................................................. 74  
select........................................................................................41  
typeface ........................................................................................36  
select........................................................................................43  
Y
y-offset  
raster image............................................................................. 74  
CHAPTER 2 "PCL" - 110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 3  
PCL5C  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................3  
2. COLOR MODES.....................................................................................................................................4  
2.1. Using Simple Color Mode - Set Simple Color....................................................................................4  
2.2. Using PCL Color Mode - Set PCL Color Setting................................................................................5  
2.3. Using HP-GL/2 Color Mode................................................................................................................9  
3. COLOR PALETTES ........................................................................................................................... 10  
3.1. Set Color #1 .....................................................................................................................................10  
3.2. Set Color #2 .....................................................................................................................................10  
3.3. Set Color #3 .....................................................................................................................................10  
3.4. Set Color to Palette..........................................................................................................................10  
3.5. Select Color......................................................................................................................................10  
3.6. Push/Pop Palette .............................................................................................................................11  
4. COLOR GRAPHICS ........................................................................................................................... 12  
4.1. Start Raster Transfer.......................................................................................................................12  
4.2. Set Destination Raster Width ..........................................................................................................12  
4.3. Set Destination Raster Height..........................................................................................................12  
4.4. Set Scale Algorithm..........................................................................................................................13  
4.5. Send Raster Data by Plane .............................................................................................................13  
4.6. Enter HP-GL/2 Mode........................................................................................................................13  
5. ENHANCE OUTPUT.......................................................................................................................... 14  
5.1. Set Render Algorithm.......................................................................................................................14  
5.2. Set Monochrome Mode....................................................................................................................14  
5.3. Set Gamma Correction....................................................................................................................15  
5.4. Download Dither Matrix....................................................................................................................15  
5.5. User-defined Pattern Command......................................................................................................15  
6. HP-GL/2 ................................................................................................................................................ 16  
6.1. IN (Initialize Set Instruction) Command............................................................................................16  
6.2. PC (Pen Color) Command ..............................................................................................................16  
6.3. NP (Number of Pens) Command ....................................................................................................17  
6.4. CR (Color Range) Command..........................................................................................................17  
7. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 18  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
INTRODUCTION  
This chapter describes the enhanced commands for the PCL5C emulation.  
PCL5C is upwards-compatible with PCL5e. For the commands of PCL5e, refer to “Chapter 2 PCL” which  
describes the PCL5e emulation.  
If you are reading this technical manual for the first time, it is recommended that you read Chapter 2 first before  
reading this Chapter.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
COLOR MODES  
The PCL5C emulation provides a B/W mode, which is the default, and three color modes as follows;  
1) Simple Color Mode  
2) PCL Color Mode  
3) HP-GL/2 Color Mode  
Simple Color Mode allows you to use a maximum of 8 colors easily. PCL Color Mode allows you to use a  
maximum of 16,000,000 colors logically. HP-GL/2 Mode allows you to use vector graphics in color.  
It is possible to switch between these modes in a single page, which enables you to use each of them for your  
purpose.  
When handling colors in those modes, use palette. For details on palette, refer to Section 3 ‘Color Palettes’ of  
this chapter.  
This section describes the details about each color mode.  
2.1. Using Simple Color Mode - Set Simple Color  
Command  
ESC*r#U (27)(42)(114)#(85) <1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<55h>  
# = -4  
# = -3  
# = 1  
*
CMYK mode  
CMY mode  
B/W mode  
# =  
3
RGB mode  
* Default value = 1  
·
·
The # value specifies the palette and the colors for the palette. For specific colors, refer to the table below;  
This command specifies each color corresponding to the index number. The color is fixed and  
unchangeable.  
·
The colors which were specified in the palette by the PCL or HP-GL/2 command are cancelled.  
Index No  
-4 (CMYK)  
White  
Cyan  
-3(CMY)  
White  
Cyan  
1(B/W) *  
3(RGB)  
Black  
Red  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
White  
Black  
Magenta  
Blue  
Magenta  
Blue  
-
-
-
-
-
-
Green  
Yellow  
Blue  
Yellow  
Green  
Yellow  
Green  
Red  
Magenta  
Cyan  
Red  
Black  
Black  
White  
* = default  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.2. Using PCL Color Mode - Set PCL Color Setting  
Command  
ESC*v#W (27)(42)(118)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<57h>  
# = 6, 18  
# stands for the number of bytes of data that follow this command.  
This command sets the palette size and transformation between the entered value and device-specific value.  
This command has two types of format, short format and long format. Here are the formats for the PCL color  
setting.  
1)  
Short Format  
MSB  
LSB  
0 - 1  
Format (0)  
Bits / index  
Encoding mode  
Bits / value #1  
Bits / value #3  
2 - 3  
4 - 5  
Bits / value #2  
§
Format  
This value must be 0.  
§
·
Encoding mode  
This value defines how to send the raster image data.  
·
The value can be from 0 to 3 only, other values are ignored.  
Encoding Mode  
0
1
2
3
Send Index No by Plane *  
Send Index No by Pixel  
Send Direct Value by Plane  
Send Direct Value by Pixel  
* = default  
Send Index No by Plane (= 0 default)  
·
·
This mode assigns the Index No. to the Plane, then sends it.  
The necessary number for the Plane is determined depending on the number of bits/index. 1 (one) plane  
should be needed per 1 (one) bit/index. For instance, 4 planes are needed for 4 bits/index.  
·
·
Bits/index must be 1, 2, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8.  
This mode sends the plane data except the last one using the Send Raster Data by Plane command  
(ESC*b#V).  
·
This mode also sends the last plane data using the Send Raster Data command (ESC*b#W).  
(i.e. 4 bits/index)  
ESC*b#V d1, d1, d1, d1, d1 ...® Plane 1  
ESC*b#V d2, d2, d2, d2, d2 ...® Plane 2  
ESC*b#V d3, d3, d3, d3, d3 ...® Plane 3  
ESC*b#W d4, d4, d4, d4, d4 ...® Plane 4  
ESC*b#V d1, d1, d1, d1, d1 ...® Plane 1  
ESC*b#V d2, d2, d2, d2, d2 ...® Plane 2  
1st raster  
2nd raster  
MSB  
LSB  
Index No. d4  
d3  
d2  
d1  
** The Italic characters shown above are the index No. at the 4th pixel in the 1st raster.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
[Example]  
If you want to send index No. 7,6,5,4,3,2,1,0;  
Enter ’ESC*v6W 00h 00h 04h 08h 08h 08h’, then select Send Index No by Plane.  
Select 4 bits/index. (24 = 16 Palettes)  
ESC*r1A  
Start Raster Transfer  
ESC*b1V 10101010B  
ESC*b1V 11001100B  
ESC*b1V 11110000B  
ESC*b1W 00000000B  
....  
Send Plane1 data (The Index No Bit0 data)  
Send Plane2 data (The Index No Bit1 data)  
Send Plane3 data (The Index No Bit2 data)  
Send Plane4 data (The Index No Bit3 data)  
ESC*rC  
End Raster Transfer  
(xxh: hexadecimal, xxxxxxxxB: binary)  
Send Index No by Pixel (= 1)  
·
·
This mode sends the index No. by pixel.  
Bits/index must be 1, 2, 4, 8.  
(2 bits/index)  
ESC*b#W d1, d2, d1, d2, d1, d2...® 1st raster  
ESC*b#W d1, d2, d1, d2, d1, d2...® 2nd raster  
ESC*b#W d1, d2, d1, d2, d1, d2...® 3rd raster  
ESC*b#W d1, d2, d1, d2, d1, d2...® 4th raster  
MSB  
LSB  
Index No. d2  
d1  
** The Italic characters shown above are the index No. at the 2nd pixel in the 3rd raster.  
[Example]  
If you want to send the index No. below;  
Index No.  
3, 2, 1, 0  
2, 1, 0, 3  
3, 0, 1, 2  
0, 1, 2, 3  
(1st raster)  
(2nd raster)  
(3rd raster)  
(4th raster)  
Enter ‘ESC*v6W 00h 01h 02h 08h 08h 08h’, then select Send Index No by Plane.  
Select 2 bits/index. (22 = 4 Palettes)  
ESC*r1A  
Start Raster Transfer  
Send 1st raster data  
Send 2nd raster data  
Send 3rd raster data  
Send 4th raster data  
ESC*b1V 11100100B  
ESC*b1V 10010011B  
ESC*b1V 11000110B  
ESC*b1W 00011011B  
....  
ESC*rC  
End Raster Transfer  
(xxh: hexadecimal, xxxxxxxxB: binary)  
Send Direct Value by Plane (= 2)  
·
·
·
·
This mode sends each value of RGB by plane.  
Bits/index must be 1.  
This mode sends the plane data except the last one using the Send Raster Data by Plane command.  
This mode sends the last plane data using the Send Raster Data command.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
(i.e.)  
ESC*b#V r, r, r, r, r...® Plane 1  
ESC*b#V g, g, g, g, g...® Plane 2  
ESC*b#W b, b, b, b, b...® Plane 3  
ESC*b#V r, r, r, r, r...® Plane 1  
ESC*b#V g, g, g, g, g...® Plane 2  
1st raster  
2nd raster  
** The Italic characters shown above are the index No. at the 4th pixel in the 1st raster.  
[Example]  
If you want to send RGB=(1,1,1)(0,1,1)(1,0,1)(0,0,1)(1,1,0)(0,1,0)(1,0,0)(0,0,0);  
** The values in the brackets show the RGB value of the pixel.  
Enter ‘ESC*v6W 00h 02h 01h 01h 01h 01h’, then select Send Direct Value by Plane.  
Select 1 bit/index.  
ESC*r1A  
Start Raster Transfer  
ESC*b1V 10101010B  
ESC*b1V 11001100B  
ESC*b1W 11110000B  
ESC*rC  
Send Plane 1 data (Red data)  
Send Plane 2 data (Green data)  
Send Plane 3 data (Blue data)  
End Raster Transfer  
(xxh: hexadecimal, xxxxxxxxB: binary)  
Send Direct Value by Pixel (= 3)  
·
·
This sends each value of RGB pixel by pixel.  
Bits/index must be 8.  
(i.e.)  
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 1st raster  
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 2nd raster  
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 3rd raster  
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 4th raster  
ESC*b#W r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b, r, g, b,...® 5th raster  
** The Italic characters shown above are the index No. at the 4th pixel in the 1st raster.  
[Example]  
If you want to send the RGB value below;  
RGB value.  
1st raster  
(0,0,0)(128,128,128)(128,64,0)(255,128,64)  
(128,128,128)(128,64,0)(255,128,64) (0,0,0)  
(128,64,0)(255,128,64) (0,0,0) (128,128,128)  
2nd raster  
3rd raster  
** The values in the brackets show the RGB value of the pixel.  
Enter ‘ESC*v6W 00h 03h 08h 08h 08h 08h’, then select Send Direct Value by Pixel.  
Select 8 bits/index.  
ESC*r1A  
Start Raster Transfer  
Send Plane 1 data (Red data)  
ESC*b12V 00h 00h 00h 80h 80h 80h 80h 40h 00h ffh 80h 40h  
ESC*b12V 80h 80h 80h 80h 40h 00h ffh 80h 40h 00h 00h 00h  
ESC*b12W 80h 40h 00h ffh 80h 40h 00h 00h 00h 80h 80h 80h  
ESC*rC  
Send Plane 2 data (Green data)  
Send Plane 3 data (Blue data)  
End Raster Transfer  
(xxh: hexadecimal, xxxxxxxxB: binary)  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
§
·
Bits/index  
Specifies the palette size at 2n. n indicates bits/index. (n=4 à24=16 palettes)  
·
When the encoding mode is 0 or 1, the palette size selected by the bits/index value specifies the range of the  
index No., which can be used for raster data.  
·
The values specified by the encoding mode are listed below;  
Encoding Mode  
Bits/Index  
0
1
2
3
0,1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8  
1,2,4,8  
1
8
§
Bits/value (#1, #2, #3)  
Each value indicates a color as follows;  
#1:  
#2:  
#3:  
red  
green  
blue  
·
·
·
·
·
When the encoding mode is 0 or 1, it ignores this setting. The black/white reference, described later, is set.  
When the encoding mode is 2, it shows the number of planes that are required to send each color.  
When the encoding mode is 3, it shows the number of bits that are required to send each color.  
It sets the black reference to 0. (Valid when the Encoding mode is 0 or 1.)  
It sets the white reference to 2n-1. (Valid when the Encoding mode is 0 or 1.)  
2)  
Long Format  
MSB  
LSB  
0 - 1  
Format (0)  
Bits / index  
Encoding mode  
Bits / value #1  
Bits / value #3  
2 - 3  
4 - 5  
Bits / value #2  
6 - 7  
White reference for value #1  
8 - 9  
White reference for value #2  
White reference for value #3  
Black reference for value #1  
Black reference for value #2  
Black reference for value #3  
10 - 11  
12 - 13  
14 - 15  
16 - 17  
The long format allows you make the setting of the white/black reference in addition to the ones available in the  
short format.  
§
·
White reference for value #1, #2, #3  
This mode specifies the white value (the lowest level of density).  
Each value indicates a color as follows;  
·
#1:  
#2:  
#3:  
red  
green  
blue  
Range: -32767 ~ 32767  
·
When the encoding mode is 2 or 3, this setting is valid.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
§
§
§
Black reference for value #1, #2, #3  
This mode specifies the black value (the highest level of density).  
Each value indicates a color as follows;  
#1:  
#2:  
#3:  
red  
green  
blue  
Range: -32767 ~ 32767  
·
When the encoding mode is 2 or 3, this setting is valid.  
2.3. Using HP-GL/2 Color Mode  
Two methods are provided to set the color mode in the HP-GL/2 mode. Set the color mode by the PCL  
command, then transfer to the HP-GL/2 mode. Execute the NP command.  
For the details on how to use the color selections in the HP-GL/2 mode, refer to Section 6 ‘HP-GL/2’.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
COLOR PALETTES  
3.1. Set Color #1  
Command  
ESC*v#A (27)(42)(118)#(65) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<41h>  
Range = -32767 ~ 32767  
Default value = 0  
·
·
This command sets the red value in the palette. Use the Set Color to Palette command to set the value  
The value range to be set varies depending on the specified black/white reference.  
3.2. Set Color #2  
Command  
ESC*v#B (27)(42)(118)#(66) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<42h>  
Range = -32767 ~ 32767  
Default value = 0  
·
·
This command sets the green value in the palette. Use the Set Color to Palette command to set the value.  
The value range to be set varies depending on the specified black/white reference.  
3.3. Set Color #3  
Command  
ESC*v#C (27)(42)(118)#(67) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<43h>  
Range = -32767 ~ 32767  
Default value = 0  
·
·
This command sets the blue value in the palette. Use the Set Color to Palette command to set the value.  
The value range to be set varies depending on the specified black/white reference.  
3.4. Set Color to Palette  
Command  
ESC*v#I (27)(42)(118)#(73) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<49h>  
Range = 0 ~ (2n - 1) (The value n is specified by the Bit/Index setting in the Set PCL Color Setting command.)  
Default value = 0  
·
This command sets the red, green and blue values which are set by the Set Color #1, #2, #3 commands in the  
palette.  
·
·
When an out of range value is set, it is ignored in the palette.  
This command sets the value which was set by the Set Color #1, #2, #3 commands to 0.  
3.5. Select Color  
Command  
ESC*v#S (27)(42)(118)#(83) <1Bh><2Ah><76h>#<53h>  
# = 0 ~ current palette size  
Default value = 0  
·
·
·
This command selects the color as the index number in the palette.  
This command is valid for text, underline, rule and graphics.  
This command does not affect the User-defined color pattern or HP-GL/2. (The HP-GL/2 command selects  
the color using the SP command.)  
·
The value to be selected by this command is never affected by the Set PCL Color Setting, Set Render  
Algorithm, Download Dither Matrix or Set Gamma Correction commands.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.6. Push/Pop Palette  
Command  
ESC*p#P (27)(42)(112)#(80) <1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<50h>  
= 0 * Push palette  
= 1 Pop palette  
* Default value = 0  
#
·
The value of 0 pushes the current palette onto the palette stack. This command does not affect the current  
palette.  
·
·
The value of 1 pops the palette from the top of the palette stack and replacesthe current palette with it.  
If the Pop Palette command is executed without a Push palette having first having been executed, it is  
ignored.  
·
·
The palette stack is controlled as a First In Last Out stack.  
The parameters below are pushed to the palette stack;  
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
Color Mode (Simple Color / PCL Color Mode)  
Parameters to be set by the Set PCL Color Setting command  
Encoding Mode (mode 0, 1, 2, 3)  
Bits / index  
Bits / value #1  
Bits / value #2  
Bits / value #3  
Black and White Reference  
Parameter of Render Algorithm  
Parameter of Gamma Correction  
Color Palette  
Dither to be downloaded by the Download Dither Matrix command  
Pen Width (HP-GL/2)  
·
The data below is pushed to the palette stack;  
w
w
w
Colors to be selected by the Select Color command  
Colors to be selected by the Set #1, #2, #3 command  
Monochrome Print Mode  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
COLOR GRAPHICS  
4.1. Start Raster Transfer  
Command  
ESC*r#A (27)(42)(114)#(65) <1Bh><2Ah><72h>#<41h>  
#
= 0 *  
= 1  
Prints the image from the left edge of the logical page.  
Prints the image from the current cursor position.  
= 2  
= 3  
Executes scaling. Prints the image from the left edge of the logical page.  
Executes scaling. Prints the images from the current cursor position.  
* Default value = 0  
·
·
This command signals the start of the transfer of raster image data to the printer.  
The transfer of raster data to the printer continues until either an End Raster Transfer command is sent or a  
command other than Send Raster Data, Set Compression Mode or Y-Offset is sent.  
·
The source width and height are set by the Set Raster Area Width (ESC*r#S) and Set Raster Area Height  
(ESC*r#T) commands. When the # value is 2 or 3, the data with these source width/height values is  
enlarged or reduced to the width and height set by the Set Destination Raster Width and Set Destination  
Raster Height commands. (Refer to the following sections.)  
4.2. Set Destination Raster Width  
Command  
ESC*t#H (27)(42)(116)#(72) <1Bh><2Ah><74h>#<48h>  
Range = 0 ~ 32767 (number of decipoints in 1/720”)  
Default value = 0  
·
If value 2 or 3 is sent with the Start Raster Transfer command and graphic scaling is set, this command sets  
the destination width.  
·
·
·
Values outside the range are invalid.  
If the setting is 0 or is omitted, this command uses the same width as the source width.  
If the specified width is wider than the page, drawings are clipped by the right physical page boundary. The  
scaling factor is dealt with correctly.  
4.3. Set Destination Raster Height  
Command  
ESC*t#V (27)(42)(116)#(86) <1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<56h>  
Range = 0 ~ 32767 (number of decipoints in 1/720”)  
Default value = 0  
·
If value 2 or 3 is sent with the Start Raster Transfer command and graphic scaling is set, this command sets  
the destination height.  
·
·
·
Values outside the range are invalid.  
If the setting is 0 or is omitted, this command uses the same height as the source height.  
If the specified height is longer than the page, drawings are clipped by the bottom of physical page boundary.  
The scaling factor is dealt with correctly.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.4. Set Scale Algorithm  
Command  
ESC*t#K (27)(42)(116)#(75) <1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<4Bh>  
#
= 0 *  
= 1  
Takes the lighter overlying dots when reducing.  
Takes the darker overlying dots when reducing.  
* Default value = 0  
·
·
This command sets which algorithmthe data is reduced by.  
Any combinations, such as vertical only, horizontal only or vertical and horizontal are allowed to be reduced.  
If the setting is vertical only or horizontal only, this command affects the set direction.  
·
This command should be used after sending the Start Raster Transfer command after setting the scaling  
(ESC*r2A or ESC*r3A).  
4.5. Send Raster Data by Plane  
Command  
ESC*b#V [data] (27)(42)(98)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><62h>#<56h>  
Range = 0 ~ 32767  
Default value = N/A  
·
·
This command sends a plane of data to the printer and goes ahead to the next plane (not to the next row).  
The # value represents the number of data bytes to be sent. The number of planes per row is specified by  
the Set Simple Color command or the Set PCL Color command, depending on which color mode is used.  
The first plane sent represents the least significant bit in the pixel.  
·
·
Since this command does not affect the cursor position, it cannot be used for the last plane or for single-plane  
rows. Only the ESC*b#Wcommand can progress the cursor to the next row.  
The amount of data sent varies depending on the plane, and it is separate from the raster width. When the  
data sent is shorter than the raster width, the data which was not filled within the specified raster width is  
cleared to 0. Empty planes can be sent when the # value is 0.  
4.6. Enter HP-GL/2 Mode  
Command  
ESC%#B (27)(37)#(66) <1Bh><2Ah><25h>#<4Ah>  
#
= 0 *  
= 1  
Position the cursor at the previous HP-GL/2 cursor position.  
Leave the cursor at its current PCL position.  
= 2  
= 3  
Use current PCL coordinate system and previous HP-GL/2 pen position  
Use PCL dot coordinate system and the current cursor position  
Range = 0 ~ 3  
* Default value = 0  
·
·
Immediately after the printer receives this command, it switches to HP-GL/2 mode, interpreting commands as  
HP-GL/2 commands until it receives an Enter PCL Mode, Reset or UEL command, or until the printer is turned  
off and on.  
The # value specifies the cursor position once HP-GL/2 mode is entered. Each value performs the following  
functions;  
• # = 0:  
The cursor is positioned at the previous HP-GL/2 cursor position. If this is the first time you  
have switched to HP-GL/2 mode since switching the printer on, the cursor is placed at the origin  
of the HP-GL/2 graphics windows.  
• # = 1:  
• # = 2:  
The cursor remains at its current position.  
The PCL coordinate system is used when entering into HP-GL/2 mode from PCL mode. The HP-  
GL/2 cursor position uses the previous HP-GL/2 position. It is separate from the P1 and P2  
positions.  
• # = 3:  
The PCL coordinate system is used when entering into HP-GL/2 mode from PCL mode . The PCL  
cursor position is used instead of the HP-GL/2 cursor position. It is separate from the P1 and P2  
positions.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.  
ENHANCE OUTPUT  
5.1. Set Render Algorithm  
Command  
ESC*t#J (27)(42)(116)#(74) <1Bh><2Ah><70h>#<4Ah>  
#
= 0 Scatter dither  
= 1  
Snap to primaries  
= 2  
= 3 *  
= 4  
Snap black to white, all other colors to black  
Scatter dither  
Scatter dither  
= 5  
= 6  
= 7  
Monochrome device best dither  
Monochrome scatter dither  
Clustered dither  
= 8  
= 9  
Monochrome clustered dither  
User-defined dither  
= 10  
= 11  
= 12  
= 13  
= 14  
Monochrome user-defined dither  
Scatter dither  
Monochrome scatter dither  
Scatter dither  
Monochrome scatter dither  
* Default value = 3  
·
This command selects the halftone render algorithm.  
• # = 1:  
This does not use halftones. For 8 bits/pixe l, for instance, any value over 128 is  
transferred to 255, and any value under 127 is transferred to 0.  
This transfers black to white and other colors to black.  
This selects the scatter dither. The scatter dither is the most crisp dither (device best  
dither) for the HL-2400C/Ce and HL-3400CN.  
• # = 2:  
• # = 3:  
• # = 0, 4, 11, 13: These show halftones using a dither method, which places dots in a dither pattern to  
make the spacial frequency higher.  
• # = 7:  
• # = 9:  
This shows halftones using a dither method, which enlarges dots from their center.  
This shows halftones using the dither which is specified by the Download Dither  
Matrix command.  
• # = 5, 6, 8, 10,  
12, 14, 1025:  
This replaces the color value with gray scale data using the formula below;  
gray value = 0.30 x red + 0.59 x green + 0.11 x blue  
5.2. Set Monochrome Mode  
Command  
ESC&b#M (27)(38)(98)#(77) <1Bh><26h><62h>#<4dh>  
= 0 * Monochrome mode off  
= 1 Monochrome mode on  
#
* Default value = 0  
·
·
·
·
This command prints the color data by replacing it with gray scale data.  
This command replaces the color data with gray scale data using the formula below;  
gray value = 0.30 x red + 0.59 x green + 0.11 x blue  
This command should be sent before sending the data to be printed. Failure to do so will cause the current  
page to be closed and printed. This command may be sent on a page-by-page basis.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.3. Set Gamma Correction  
Command  
ESC*t#I (27)(42)(116)#(73) <1Bh><2Ah><74h>#<49h>  
#
= 0.0 ~ 32767.0 (command is ignored for invalid values)  
Default value = 0 (gamma correction off)  
This command does not destroy the contents of the current palette, but setting a gamma value replaces any  
lookup table input in either Device CMY or Device RGB.  
5.4. Download Dither Matrix  
Command  
ESC*m#W [data] (27)(42)(109)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><6dh>#<57h>  
Range = 7 ~ 32767 (Any other value is ignored.)  
# stands for the number of pattern data bytes.  
·
·
This command specifies a single matrix for the R, G, and B colors.  
The dither which is specified by this command is valid when selecting the # value to 9 or 10 with the Set  
Render Algorithm command.  
·
The table below shows the format for a dither matrix that is applied to all three primary colors.  
MSB  
LSB  
0 - 1  
2 - 3  
4 - 5  
Format (0)  
Dither matrix height in pixels  
Dither matrix width in pixels  
Number of planes (1)  
w
w
w
w
Format:  
set to 0.  
set to 1.  
Number of planes:  
Dither matrix height in pixels: specifies the dither matrix height by the number of pixels.  
Dither matrix width in pixels: specifies the dither matrix width by the number of pixels.  
** The values for ‘Dither matrix height in pixels’ and ‘Dither matrix width in pixels’ should not be 0. The  
multiple of these two values should not be more than 32767.  
5.5. User-defined Pattern Command  
Command  
ESC*c#W (22)(42)(99)#(87) <1Bh><2Ah><63h>#<57h>  
Range = 0 ~ 32767.  
# stands for the number of pattern data bytes.  
MSB  
LSB  
0 - 1  
2 - 3  
4 - 5  
6 - 7  
8 - 9  
Format (1)  
Continuation (0)  
Reserved (0)  
Pixel Encoding (1/8)  
Height in Pixels  
Width in Pixels  
Pattern Image  
w
NOTE:  
w
Format:  
set to 1. This command downloads the color pattern.  
If the Format is set to 0 or 20, it sends monochrome format. For details, refer to ‘Chapter 2 PCL’.  
Pixel encoding: set to either of 1 bit or 8 bits. If selecting 1 bit, 1 pixel is assigned to 1 bit (2 colors). If  
selecting 8 bit, 1 pixel is assigned to 8 bits (256 colors).  
w
w
w
Height in pixels: specifies the pattern height by the number of rows.  
Width in pixels: specifies the pattern width by the number of pixels.  
Pattern Image: sends the pattern image data as an index number of the palette. It uses the colors of  
the current palette when the pattern is used.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.  
HP-GL/2  
A few HP-GL/2 commands are added for the HL-2400C/Ce, HL-3400CN color laser printer, and the features of  
some existing commands are also expanded.  
The new or revised HP-GL/2 commands as follows are described in this chapter;  
§
§
§
§
Initialize Set Instruction (IN) - resets all programmable functions to their default settings  
Pen Color (PC) - changes the palette colors  
Number of Pens (NP) - changes the palette size  
Color Range (CR) - sets the range for specifying relative color data  
For the basic commands of HP-GL/2, refer to ‘Chapter 8 HP-GL/2 Graphics Language’.  
6.1. IN (Initialize Set Instruction) Command  
Command  
IN [;]  
This command returns the graphics mode to initial conditions. It initializes the parameters listed on Page.9 of  
‘Chapter 8 HP-GL/2’ and also those shown below.  
Function  
Equivalent  
Instruction  
NP  
Condition  
Number of Pens  
Color Range  
8
CR  
Black reference (red, green, blue) ----> 0  
White reference (red, green, blue) ----> 255  
This command also initializes the parameters of the palette as follows;  
Palette No.(Pen No.)  
Color  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
White  
Black  
Red  
Green  
Yellow  
Blue  
Magenta  
Cyan  
6.2. PC (Pen Color) Command  
Command  
PC [pen, red, green, blue]  
PC [pen;]  
PC [;]  
This command changes the pen colors in the palette and sets the colors of all pens to their default settings.  
·
pen:  
represents the palette number specified by this command. It ignores the command if it is out of the  
range of the specified parameter.  
·
red, green, blue: specifies the color. The range of the specified value is determined by the CR command.  
Default range is 0 ~ 255.  
·
PC [;]:  
initializes all palettes.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
PC [pen;]: sets the pen to the default color.  
Number of pens in palette  
2 (“NP 2;”)  
Pen number  
Color  
0
1
0
1
2
3
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
White  
Black  
White  
Black  
Red  
4 (“NP 4;”)  
Green  
White  
Black  
Red  
8 (“NP 8;”)  
Green  
Yellow  
Blue  
Magenta  
Cyan  
** If the number of pens in the palette is over 8, the color is set to black.  
6.3. NP (Number of Pens) Command  
Command  
NP [n;]  
NP [;]  
Range = 2 ~ 32768  
Default value = 8  
·
·
This command makes the palette the specified size after the Initialize Set Instruction command or Set PCL  
Color Setting command is executed.  
The n value represents the palette number with the value of 2n. When it cannot be indicated with the value  
of 2n, the next value, 2n+1 is selected.  
·
·
·
When a value over 257 is specified, 256 is selected.  
When a value less than 2 is specified, it is ignored.  
The specified palette can be selected by the Select Pen command. When the value specified by the Select  
Pen command is bigger than the palette number specified by this command, the value of the remainder is used.  
6.4. CR (Color Range) Command  
Command  
CR [....]  
Range = - 32768 ~ 32767  
Default value is listed below;  
R
G
B
Black reference  
White reference  
0
255  
0
255  
0
255  
Black reference:  
White reference:  
specifies the black value (the highest level of density)  
specifies the white value (the lowest level of density)  
·
·
This command sets the range for specifying relative color data.  
The value specified by this command is reset to the default value by the CR [;]or IN [;]command.  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.  
INDEX  
A
M
algorithm....................................................................................13  
monochrome mode................................................................... 14  
B
N
B/W mo de....................................................................................4  
black value...................................................................................9  
blue value ..................................................................................10  
NP command............................................................................. 17  
number of pens......................................................................... 17  
P
C
palette .......................................................................................... 4  
palette size................................................................................... 5  
PC command ............................................................................. 16  
PCL color mode .......................................................................... 5  
pen color.................................................................................... 16  
pixel.............................................................................................. 6  
Plane............................................................................................. 5  
pop palette ................................................................................ 11  
push palette .............................................................................. 11  
color palette...............................................................................10  
color range.................................................................................17  
CR command .............................................................................17  
D
destination raster height .........................................................12  
destination raster width...........................................................12  
dither matrix...............................................................................15  
R
G
raster data  
send ...................................................................................... 13  
raster image................................................................................. 5  
raster transfer  
gamma ........................................................................................15  
green value................................................................................10  
start ....................................................................................... 12  
red value.................................................................................... 10  
render algorithm....................................................................... 14  
H
HP-GL/2 color mode...................................................................9  
HP-GL/2 command....................................................................16  
HP-GL/2 mode  
S
enter......................................................................................13  
short format................................................................................. 5  
simple color mode ...................................................................... 4  
I
U
IN command ..............................................................................16  
initialize set instruction............................................................16  
User-defined Pattern command.............................................. 15  
L
W
long format ..................................................................................8  
white value.................................................................................. 8  
CHAPTER 3 "PCL5C" - 18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 4  
HP-GL/2  
GRAPHICS  
LANGUAGE  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................4  
2. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................6  
3. TERMINOLOGY......................................................................................................................................7  
3.1. Picture Frame....................................................................................................................................7  
3.2. Anchor Point.......................................................................................................................................7  
3.3. Graphics Window...............................................................................................................................7  
3.4. Hard Clip Limits..................................................................................................................................7  
3.5. Soft Clip Limits ...................................................................................................................................7  
3.6. Graphics Units....................................................................................................................................7  
3.7. User Units...........................................................................................................................................7  
3.8. Current Units ......................................................................................................................................7  
3.9. Pens ...................................................................................................................................................7  
3.10. Absolute and Relative Plotting..........................................................................................................8  
3.11. Fills ...................................................................................................................................................8  
4. COMMAND SYNTAX.............................................................................................................................9  
4.1. Mnemonic...........................................................................................................................................9  
4.2. Parameters ........................................................................................................................................9  
4.3. Separators..........................................................................................................................................9  
4.4. Terminator..........................................................................................................................................9  
5. THE HP-GL GRAPHICS WINDOW.................................................................................................. 10  
5.1. Units .................................................................................................................................................10  
5.2. The Scaling Points P1 and P2.........................................................................................................10  
5.3. Scaling..............................................................................................................................................10  
5.4. Transformation.................................................................................................................................10  
6. PREPARING TO PRINT GRAPHIC IMAGES ................................................................................ 11  
6.1. Setting Up the Graphics Window.....................................................................................................11  
6.2. Using Existing Image Plots ..............................................................................................................11  
6.3. Printing an Image .............................................................................................................................11  
6.4. Entering HP-GL/2 Mode ...................................................................................................................11  
6.5. Quitting HP-GL/2 Mode ....................................................................................................................11  
7. COMMANDS........................................................................................................................................ 12  
7.1. Initialize Commands.........................................................................................................................12  
7.2. Plot Area and Unit Setting Instructions.............................................................................................14  
7.3. Pen Control and Plot Instructions ....................................................................................................18  
7.4. The polygon group............................................................................................................................25  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.5. Plot Function Instructions.................................................................................................................30  
7.6. Character Plot Instructions ..............................................................................................................39  
7.6.1. Introduction ................................................................................................................................... 40  
8. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 54  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
COMMAND LIST  
DF  
IN  
IP  
Default set instruction  
Initialize set instruction  
Input scaling point  
Input relative scaling points  
Scale  
Window  
Rotate coordinate system  
Pen up  
12  
13  
14  
14  
15  
17  
17  
18  
18  
19  
19  
20  
21  
21  
22  
22  
24  
24  
25  
25  
26  
26  
26  
27  
28  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
34  
35  
35  
35  
36  
37  
37  
39  
42  
42  
42  
43  
43  
43  
44  
44  
IR  
SC  
IW  
RO  
PU  
PD  
PA  
PR  
AA  
AR  
AT  
RT  
PE  
BR  
BZ  
PM  
EA  
ER  
EP  
Pen down  
Plot absolute  
Relative coordinate pen move  
Draw absolute arc  
Draw relative arc  
Absolute arc three point  
Relative arc three point  
Polyline encoded  
Bezier relative  
Bezier absolute  
Polygon mode  
Edge rectangle absolute  
Edge rectangle relative  
Edge polygon  
EW  
RA  
RR  
WG  
FP  
Edge wedge  
Fill rectangle absolute  
Fill rectangle relative  
Fill wedge  
Fill polygon  
Anchor corner  
Fill type  
Line attribute  
Line type selection  
Pen width  
Raster fill definition  
Symbol mode  
AC  
FT  
LA  
LT  
PW  
RF  
SM  
SP  
SV  
TR  
UL  
WU  
SD  
AD  
SS  
SA  
FI  
FN  
LB  
DT  
LO  
Select pen  
Screened vectors  
Transparency mode  
User-defined line type  
Select unit for pen width  
Define standard font  
Define alternate font  
Select standard font  
Select alternate font  
Select primary font  
Select secondary font  
Character plot  
Define label terminator  
Label origin  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
DI  
Absolute direction  
Relative direction  
45  
46  
47  
47  
48  
48  
49  
49  
50  
50  
50  
DR  
DV  
CP  
CF  
SI  
SR  
SL  
SB  
ES  
TD  
Define variable text path  
Relative character movement  
Character fill mode  
Set absolute character size  
Set relative character size  
Character slant  
Scalable or bitmap fonts  
Extra space  
Transparent data  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
INTRODUCTION  
Some of the HL series printers can be used in HP-GL/2 graphics mode to produce vector graphics output  
using the commands of the HP-GL/2 graphics language or to print out existing HP-GL/2 format images.  
HP-GL/2 is a part of the PCL emulation, which includes graphics command.  
The Default plotting measurement unit in the HP-GL/2 graphics mode is 1/1016" ( 0.025 mm).  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
TERMINOLOGY  
3.1. Picture Frame  
The printer frame is the rectangular area of the page on which graphic output can be printed. This is based  
on the logical page defined for the selected paper size.  
3.2. Anchor Point  
The anchor point of the picture frame is the top left hand corner of the frame. This can be moved on the  
page using PCL language page control commands.  
3.3. Graphics Window  
The graphics window is the rectangular area of the page on which you can generate graphic output using  
HP-GL/2 commands. Initially the graphics window is the same as the picture frame but may be altered using  
the HP-GL/2 IW command.  
3.4. Hard Clip Limits  
Hard clip limits are the physical restrictions which define where printed output can appear on a page.  
3.5. Soft Clip Limits  
Soft clip limits are the user-defined restrictions which define where printed output can appear on a page.  
3.6. Graphics Units  
The initial coordinate system employs units of 1/1016" in both the x- and y-axes.  
3.7. User Units  
The HP-GL/2 graphics language uses a coordinate system. You can impose your own x- and y-scale units  
on this system using the SC command.  
3.8. Current Units  
The units in use at a given time are called the current units. Current units are either user units or graphics  
units, depending on whether scaling has been turned on or not. The SC command is used to turn scaling  
on, that is, to make user units the current units.  
3.9. Pens  
By convention, certain HP-GL/2 graphics language commands are thought of as using a pen, which can be  
either up or down. To produce plotted output the pen must be down. To move to a location on the page  
without producing output the pen must be in the up position. Some HP-GL/2 commands require you to  
specify the pen position before you use them, others have implied pen positions built into them, so that  
you do not need to specify "Pen up" or "Pen down".  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.10. Absolute and Relative Plotting  
Drawing commands are of two distinct types: absolute commands, in which the coordinates specified are  
the absolute user or graphics coordinates and relative commands, whose coordinates are relative to the  
coordinate position at which the previous graphics command terminated.  
3.11. Fills  
You can fill in the shapes you have drawn with the plotting commands by using the fill commands.  
number of different shading options are available.  
A
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
COMMAND SYNTAX  
An HP-GL and HP-GL/2 command can consist of up to four items: a mnemonic, a parameter field, a  
separator and a terminator.  
4.1. Mnemonic  
The two-letter mnemonic is the name of the command and should help remind you of its function.  
4.2. Parameters  
Some commands have parameters following the instruction mnemonic. Multiple parameters must have  
separators between them. Parameters are shown in italics. Optional parameters are surrounded by square  
brackets. Parameters that can be repeated are followed by "...".  
·
Integer - integers are allowed in the range -230 and 230 - 1. Real numbers specified for a parameter that should  
be an integer are rounded to the nearest integer.  
·
Clamped integer - integers are allowed in the range -32768 and 32767. Parameters outside this range are  
converted (clamped) to the nearest integer within the range, for example 40,000 will be clamped to 32767.  
Non-integers are converted to the nearest integer.  
30  
30  
·
·
Real number - real numbers whose integer part is in the range -2 to 2 - 1. Accuracy to at least 6  
significant digits is guaranteed. If a number outside the range is specified the entire command is ignored.  
The decimal point can be omitted when the number has no fractional part.  
Clamped real number - real numbers whose integer part is in the range -32768 to 32767. Parameters outside  
this range are converted (clamped) to the nearest real number within the range. The decimal point can be  
omitted when the number has no fractional part.  
Text parameters are referred to as labels and can consist of any sequence of characters.  
4.3. Separators  
If an HP-GL/2 instruction accepts more than one parameter, you must put spaces or a comma between the  
parameters to separate them.  
4.4. Terminator  
Most commands are terminated implicitly by the first letter of the next instruction mnemonic. A semi-colon  
may be used to explicitly terminate a command. However, the final command issued before quitting HP-  
GL/2 mode must be terminated with a semi-colon. Since a terminator is almost always optional it is shown  
surrounded by square brackets.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.  
THE HP-GL GRAPHICS WINDOW  
5.1. Units  
When you first enter graphics mode, the prevailing coordinate system has its origin in the bottom left hand  
corner of the graphics window and has x- and y-units of 1/1016". Using the SC command you can divide the  
axes into more convenient units. The size of the graphics window remains unaltered.  
5.2. The Scaling Points P1 and P2  
Many instructions use two reference scaling points, P1 and P2. Initially these are in the bottom left and top  
right hand corners of the graphics window respectively. You can alter the position of these points relative to  
the graphics window, or relative to one another, by using the IP or IR commands.  
5.3. Scaling  
You can easily scale images up or down by increasing or decreasing the distance between P1 and P2. You  
can do this both with existing images that are to be imported and with images that are generated by a string of  
HP-GL and HP-GL/2 commands, identical commands can be used to create the same image in different sizes.  
5.4. Transformation  
You can transform images horizontally or vertically by changing the relative positions of P1 and P2. You can  
do this both with existing images that are to be imported and with images that are generated by a string of HP-  
GL/2 commands.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.  
PREPARING TO PRINT GRAPHIC IMAGES  
6.1. Setting Up the Graphics Window  
Before entering HP-GL/2 mode you will probably want to set the dimensions and position of the PCL picture  
frame and hence the graphics window. (Remember that when you enter HP-GL/2 mode they are initially the  
same). To do this you will need to send some preparatory PCL commands while in LaserJet mode. Use the  
Esc*c0T command to position the picture frame and the Esc*c#X and Esc*c#Y commands to determine it's  
horizontal and vertical dimensions respectively. These commands are described fully in the sub-section  
Vector Graphics in the LaserJet section of this manual. ( Section 2 )  
If you do not specify a position and dimensions for the picture frame, the default picture frame is used. This  
is described in the sub-section ‘The Page in LaserJet mode’ section of this manual.  
6.2. Using Existing Image Plots  
If you are importing an existing HP-GL/2 plot you can easily determine the size and position on the page of the  
resulting printed graphic. Images are automatically scaled and fitted to the picture frame ( the HP-GL/2  
graphics window ) in either of the following two cases.  
1)  
If you use the Esc*c#K and Esc*c#L PCL commands to specify the width and height of the original plot  
before entering HP-GL/2 mode. These commands are explained in the sub-section ‘Vector Graphics in  
LaserJet mode’ section of this manual. Only use these commands if you are importing an existing  
plot.  
2)  
If the imported image code is page-size independent.  
An image is page-size independent if it's HP-GL/2 code satisfies the following conditions.  
·
·
User units are used exclusively, that is, an SC command is used before any drawing commands  
are issued. Note in particular that if the graphics window is changed from the default using the IW  
command, it must be specified in user units.  
No absolute units are used or implied, that is, drawing commands use relative movement only and  
character size, pattern length and pen width are always specified as relative measurements.  
Commands like IP and PA, which imply the use of absolute units even if none are explicitly supplied,  
should not be used at all.  
If you import an image without fulfilling these two criteria, that is, the image is not page size independent  
and you do not specify its horizontal and vertical plot sizes, the plot will be drawn actual size. Any part of  
the plot that falls outside the effective window will not appear on the printed page.  
6.3. Printing an Image  
When you have carried out any necessary preliminary steps that your particular application requires, as  
described in the preceding sections, enter HP-GL/2 mode using the Esc%#B command and send the  
sequence of HP-GL/2 commands to generate the image.  
6.4. Entering HP-GL/2 Mode  
To enter graphics mode from PCL printer control language use the Esc%#B command. Set # to 0 if you want  
the pen to start from the previous HP-GL/2 pen position. Set # to 1 if you want to the pen to start from the  
current PCL cursor position. You must specify either one setting or the other.  
6.5. Quitting HP-GL/2 Mode  
To quit graphics mode use the Esc%#A command. Set # to 0 if you want to place the cursor at the previous  
PCL cursor position. This is the default setting. Set # to 1 if you want to place the cursor at the current HP-  
GL/2 pen position.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.  
COMMANDS  
7.1. Initialize Commands  
DF - Default set instruction  
DF[;]  
·
Returns the graphics mode to default conditions. The following are the default settings.  
Function  
Equivalent  
Instruction  
PA;  
Condition  
Plot mode  
Absolute plotting  
Absolute direction  
Line type  
DI 1,0;  
LT;  
Horizontal  
Solid line  
Line pattern length  
Anchor corner  
Line Attributes  
User-Defined line type  
Window  
Symbol mode  
Character Fill Mode  
Character set  
Scalable or Bitmap  
Fonts  
LT;  
AC;  
LA;  
UL;  
IW;  
SM;  
CF ;  
SS;  
4% of distance from P1 to P2  
Lower left corner of picture frame  
Butt cap, mitered joints, miter limit = 5  
All line types set to default  
Set at limits of printable area according to paper size  
Off  
Solid, Fill, no edging  
Standard character set selected  
Scalable font only  
SB 0;  
Character slant  
Scaling  
SL 0;  
SC ;  
0 degrees  
Off  
Label terminator  
Raster fill  
Fill type  
DT chr$(3)  
RF;  
chr$(3), non-printing  
Solid black  
solid fill  
FT;  
Transparency mode  
Screened vectors  
Polygon mode  
Standard font  
Alternate font  
Character size  
transformation  
Label origin  
TR1;  
SV;  
PM0PM2;  
SD;  
Transparency mode on  
No screening  
Polygon buffer empty  
Stick font  
Stick font  
Off  
AD;  
SI;  
LO1;  
DV;  
ES;  
Current pen location  
Left to right with normal line feed  
No extra space  
Text path  
Extra space  
Transparent data  
TD;  
Normal printing mode  
NOTE:  
The location of the scaling points(P1, P2) remains constant.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
IN - Initialize set instruction  
IN[;]  
·
Returns the graphics mode to initial conditions;  
Function  
Equivalent  
Instruction  
PA;  
DR 1,0;  
LT;  
Condition  
Plot mode  
Relative character direction  
Line type  
Absolute plotting  
Horizontal  
Solid line  
Line pattern length  
Window  
LT;  
IW;  
4% of distance from P1 to P2  
Set at limits of printable area according to  
paper size  
Symbol mode  
Anchor corner  
Line attributes  
User-defined line type  
Pen  
SM;  
AC;  
LA;  
UL;  
SP;  
PA0,0;  
SS;  
SI;  
SB0;  
SL 0;  
CF;  
Off  
Lower left corner of picture frame  
Butt caps, mitered joins, miter limit = 5  
All line types set to default  
Select white pen  
HP-GL/2 origin  
Standard character set selected  
Off  
Scalable only  
Pen position  
Character set  
Character size transformation  
Scalable or bitmap fonts  
Character slant  
Character fill  
0 degrees  
Solid fill  
Scaling  
SC ;  
Off  
Label terminator  
Raster fill  
DT chr$(3)  
RF;  
chr$(3)  
Solid black  
Fill type  
FT;  
TR1;  
SV;  
Bi-directional fill, type 1  
Transparency mode on  
No screening  
Polygon buffer empty  
Stick font  
Stick font  
Pen up  
Metric  
Set at 0.35 mm  
Transparency mode  
Screened vectors  
Polygon mode  
Standard font  
Alternate font  
Pen condition  
Pen width type  
Pen width  
PM0PM2;  
SD;  
AD;  
PU;  
WU;  
PW;  
LO1;  
DV;  
Label origin  
Text path  
Rotation  
Current pen location  
Left to right with normal line feed  
Set at 0 degrees  
RO;  
Extra space  
ES;  
No extra space  
Transparent data  
Scaling points  
TD;  
IP;  
Normal printing mode  
Initialized according to paper size  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.2. Plot Area and Unit Setting Instructions  
Instruction  
Function  
IP  
Scaling point  
IR  
Input relative scaling points  
Scale  
SC  
IW  
RO  
Input window  
Rotate coordinate system  
IP - Input scaling point  
IP [ P1X, P1Y [,P2X, P2Y]] [;]  
P1X ; X coordinate of P1  
P2X ; X coordinate of P2  
P1Y ; Y coordinate of P1  
P2Y ; Y coordinate of P2  
·
·
·
·
The coordinates used are absolute values in graphics units.  
Set the location of the scaling points(P1,P2).  
Coordinate values for P1X,P1Y, P2X and P2Y are given as integer numbers.  
You can set P1 and P2 to be anywhere that the range of allowable coordinates permits. However, only  
parts of resulting images that lie within the effective window will be printed.  
·
·
·
The default location of P1 is the lower left corner and P2 is the upper right corner of the PCL picture frame.  
Using this instruction without a parameter field initializes the scaling points(P1,P2) to the default location.  
P2X and P2Y may be omitted. If P2X and P2Y are omitted, P2 is set automatically so as not to alter the  
distance between P1 and P2.  
·
·
If P2x and P2y are omitted P2 is set to be in the same position relative to P1 that it was before the command  
was invoked.  
The IP command remains in effect until another IP command, an IR command or an IN command is used.  
IR - Input relative scaling points  
IR [ P1x, P1y [, P2x, P2y]][;]  
P1x ; x-coordinate of P1  
P2x ; x-coordinate of P2  
P1y ; y-coordinate of P1  
P2y ; y-coordinate of P2  
·
The coordinate values are percentages relative to the bottom left and top right hand corners of the picture  
frame.  
·
·
Coordinate values for P1x, P1y, P2x, and P2y are treated as clamped real numbers.  
Using this instruction without parameters sets the scaling points (P1, P2) to their initial positions, the bottom  
left and top right hand corners of the picture frame.  
·
·
·
If P2x and P2y are omitted P2 is set to be in the same position relative to P1 that it was before the command  
was invoked.  
You can set P1 and P2 to be anywhere that the range of allowable coordinates permits. However, only  
parts of resulting images that lie within the effective window will be printed.  
The IR command remains in effect until another IR command, and IP command or an IN command is used.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
SC - Scale  
<HP-GL/2>  
SC [ Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, Ymax [, type ]] [;] (Type = 0)  
SC [ Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, Ymax , type [ left, bottom]] [;] (Type =1)  
SC [ Xmin, X factor, Y  
Y
[, type ]] [;] (Type = 2)  
factor  
min  
Xmin ; X coordinate of P1  
Ymin ; Y coordinate of P1  
Type ; type of scaling  
Xmax ; X coordinate of P2  
Ymax ; Y coordinate of P2  
Left ; percentage of unused space to be left to the left of the scaling area  
bottom ; percentage of unused space to be left below the scaling area  
Xfactor ; number of graphics units per user unit on the x-axis.  
Yfactor ; number of graphics units per user unit on the y-axis.  
·
·
This command turns scaling on and establishes a user unit coordinate system. The coordinate system is  
specified relative to the points P1 and P2. The origin need not necessarily be at P1. Three different types  
of scaling are available.  
The technical terms, user unit and graphics unit, as used in this manual are defined as follows:  
User unit  
: the unit of the coordinates set by the SC instruction.  
Graphics unit  
: the unit(1/1016 of an inch) of the coordinates not set by the SC  
instruction.  
All coordinates are in user units.  
Coordinate values for Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax are given as real numbers.  
·
·
·
Xmin, Ymin, Xmax and Ymax specify the range of the X- and Y-axes.  
and Ymax should be P2.  
Xmin and Ymin value should be P1 and Xmax  
·
·
·
Xmin must be different from Xmax, and Ymin must be different from Ymax.  
Using this instruction without a parameter field turns the scaling off.  
Type can be 0, 1 or 2, which select scaling types known as anisotropic, isotropic and point factor scaling  
respectively.  
·
Type 0 scaling (anisotropic scaling, the default) allows you to specify different sized x-axis and y-axis units.  
Hence the area specified by Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax will occupy the entire area defined by P1 and P2.  
P2 (7,6)  
P1 (0,0)  
·
·
left and bottom settings have no effect in type 0 scaling.  
Type 1 scaling (isotropic scaling) forces x-axis and y-axis units to be the same size. As a result the area  
specified by Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax (the isotropic area) may not fit exactly into the rectangular area  
defined by P1 and P2.  
(6,7)  
P2  
(0,0)  
P1  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
·
With type 1 scaling you can specify the percentage of unused space that is to lie below, or to the left of,  
the isotropic area.  
left specifies the percentage of unused space you want to lie to the left of the isotropic area and can be from 0  
to 100. If you do not specify the value for left, it is automatically set to the default value = 50%.  
bottom specifies the percentage of unused space you want to lie below the isotropic area and can be from 0 to  
100. If you do not specify the value for bottom, it is automatically set to the default value = 50%.  
P2  
P2  
(10,10)  
(10,10)  
(0,10)  
Extra space  
Extra space  
P1(0,0)  
P1  
SC0,20,0,10,1,100,100  
SC 0,10,0,10,1,0,0  
(10,10)  
P2  
P2  
Extra space  
Extra space  
(20,10)  
(10,0)  
P1  
P1(0,0)  
SC 0,20,0,10,1,0,0  
SC 0,10,0,10,1,100,100  
·
·
·
You must either specify both left and bottom, or specify neither. However, the printer can only use one of  
these two parameters at a time, depending where the extra space is on a page. \  
If you do not specify a percentage for unused space to the left or at the bottom, the isotropic area is centred  
in the rectangle defined by P1 and P2.  
Type 2 scaling (point factor scaling) specifies the ratio of graphics units to user units and sets user units  
coordinates for P1.  
·
·
·
·
Xfactor specifies the number of graphics units that comprise a single user x-axis unit.  
Yfactor specifies the number of graphics units that comprise a single user y-axis unit.  
Valid values for Xfactor and Yfactor are real numbers.  
An SC command remains in effect until another SC command is issued, until default settings are restored  
with the DF command or until the printer is initialized with an IN command.  
10 '-Scale-'  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"  
60 '-- Anisotropic scaling --  
70 LPRINT "PA1500,6000;EA3500,8000;"  
80 LPRINT "IP1500,6000,3500,8000;SC0,200,0,100,0;PA50,50;CI50;"  
90 LPRINT "IN;PA1500,3000;EA3500,5000;"  
100 LPRINT "IP1500,3000, 3500,5000;SC0,100,0,200,0;PA50,50;CI50;"  
110 LPRINT"IN;PA1300,8200;DT#;LBAnisotropic scaling#";  
120 '--Isotropic scaling--  
130 'Left,Bottom= 0,0  
140 LPRINT "PA4500,6000;EA6500,8000;"  
150 LPRINT"IP4500,6000,6500,8000;SC0,200,0,100,1,0,0;PA50,50;CI50;"  
160 'Left, Bottom = 100,100  
170 LPRINT "IN;PA4500,3000;EA6500,5000;"  
180 LPRINT"IP4500,3000,6500,5000;SC0,100,0,200,1,100,100;PA50,50;CI50;"  
190 LPRINT "IN;PA4000,82;DT#;LBIsotrop00ic scaling#";  
200 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";  
210LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
220 END  
<Sample 21>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
IW - Window  
IW [ X , Y , X , Y ] [;]  
1 1 2 2  
X1-Window lower left X coordinate  
X2-Window upper right X coordinate  
Y -Window lower left Y coordinate  
Y -Window upper right Y coordinate  
2
1
·
·
·
·
This instruction sets the window inside which drawing can be performed (the soft clip limits).  
Coordinates are specified in current units.  
Using this instruction with no parameters sets the window to be the same as the picture frame.  
You can set the corners of the window to lie outside the picture frame. However, only the portion of the  
image which lies within both the picture frame and the window will appear on the page.  
If scaling is turned on with the SC command before the window is defined with the IW command, you can  
move the window on the physical page by specifying different locations for P1 and P2 with the IP and IR  
commands. The user unit coordinates that bound the window remain the same.  
·
·
·
If an SC command is used after the IW window definition, the window is fixed on the physical page and  
does not move when subsequent IP and IR commands are invoked.  
An IW command remains in effect until another IW command is issued, until default settings are restored  
with the DF command or until the printer is initialized with an IN command.  
10 '--Input Window--  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "SI0.2,0.35,PA2000,3200;;LBTHIS IS AN EXAMPLE OF IW";CHR$(3)  
70 LPRINT "IW3000,1300,4500,3700;PD2000,1700;LBTHIS IS AN EXAMPLE OF  
IW";CHR$(3)  
80 LPRINT "PU3000,1300;PD4500,1300,4500,3700;PD3000,3700,3000,1300;PU;"  
90 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
110 END  
<Sample 22>  
RO - Rotate coordinate system  
RO [q][;]  
q : Angle in degrees through which the coordinate system is rotated.  
·
·
This instruction is used to rotate the graphics coordinate system anti-clockwise.  
Using this instruction with no parameter sets the rotation of the coordinate system to 0 degrees (default  
value).  
·
·
·
The pen position does not change.  
P1 and P2 rotate with the coordinate system and retain the same coordinate values.  
To relocate P1 and P2 at the lower left and upper right hand corners of the picture frame, use the IP or IR  
commands.  
·
·
·
If you have previously used an IW command, the window is also rotated. Any part of the window that  
falls outside the hard clip limits will be clipped.  
The command remains in effect until another RO command is used or until the printer is initialized with the IN  
instruction.  
Valid values of q are 0, 90, 180 or 270.  
10 '--Rotate Coordinate System--  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 FOR I = 0 TO 270 STEP 90  
70 LPRINT "RO"; I; "PA1000,2000;PD3000,2000,2000,3000,1000,2000;PU;"  
80 LPRINT "LB RO ="; I; CHR$(3)  
90 LPRINT "PA600,1500;LBRotate Coordinate System";CHR$(3)  
100 NEXT I  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
130 END  
<Sample 23>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.3. Pen Control and Plot Instructions  
Instruction  
PU  
Function  
Pen Up  
PD  
Pen Down  
PA  
Plot Absolute  
PR  
Relative Coordinate Pen Move  
Absolute Arc Plot  
Relative Arc Plot  
Absolute Three Point Arc  
Relative Three Point Arc  
Polyline Encoded  
Circle  
AA  
AR  
AT  
RT  
PE  
CI  
BR  
Bezier Relative  
Bezier Absolute  
BZ  
PU - Pen up  
PU [ X,Y [,...]] [;]  
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
·
·
X and Y are either relative or absolute, depending on whether a PA or a PR was the last plot command  
executed. The absolute coordinates are set as default.  
You can specify as many coordinate pairs as you wish. The cursor moves to each point in turn without  
drawing.  
·
·
·
·
·
Using this instruction without a parameter field raises the pen without changing the cursor position.  
Coordinates are specified in the currently selected unit.  
In symbol mode PU draws the specified symbol at each point in the parameter list.  
In polygon mode the specified coordinate pairs are placed in the polygon buffer.  
If an odd number of coordinates are specified, the final (unpaired) coordinate is ignored.  
PD - Pen down  
PD [ X, Y [,...]] [;]  
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
·
·
X and Y are either relative or absolute, depending on whether a PA or a PR was the last plot command  
executed. The absolute coordinates are the default setting.  
You can specify as many coordinate pairs as you wish. The cursor moves to each point in turn, drawing  
lines on the page.  
·
·
·
·
·
Using this instruction without a parameter lowers the pen without changing the cursor position.  
Coordinates are specified in the currently selected unit.  
In symbol mode PD draws the specified symbol at each defined point on the x- and y-axis.  
In polygon mode the specified coordinate pairs are placed in the polygon buffer.  
If an odd number of coordinates are specified, the final (unpaired) coordinate is ignored.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
PA - Plot absolute  
PA [ X, Y [,...]] [;]  
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
·
·
·
Coordinates are absolute values in user or current units.  
Whether used with or without parameters the command establishes absolute plotting as the plotting mode.  
The command moves the cursor to the specified coordinates, drawing straight lines, only when the pen is  
down.  
·
·
·
In symbol mode PA draws the specified symbol at each point in the parameter list.  
In polygon mode the specified coordinate pairs are placed in the polygon buffer.  
If an odd number of coordinates are specified, the final (unpaired) coordinate is ignored.  
10 ' -- Plot Absolute --  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA2000,6000;PD0,6000,2000,7500,2000,6000;PU2500,6000;";  
70 LPRINT "PAPD4500,6000,2500,7500,2500,6000;PU10365,500;";  
80 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";  
90 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
100 END  
<Sample 24>  
PR - Relative coordinate pen move  
PR [X, Y [,...]] [;]  
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
·
·
·
Coordinates used are relative values in current units.  
Whether used with or without parameters the command establishes relative plotting as the plotting mode.  
The command moves the cursor to the specified coordinates, drawing straight lines, only when the pen is  
down.  
·
You can specify any number of coordinated pairs and plotting is performed in the order the coordinates are  
specified.  
·
·
·
In symbol mode PR draws the specified symbol at each point in the parameter list.  
In polygon mode the specified coordinate pairs are placed in the polygon buffer.  
If an odd number of coordinates are specified, the final (unpaired) coordinate is ignored.  
10 ' - Plot Relative -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
20 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
40 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"  
50 LPRINT "PA5000,4500,;PDPR-2000,0,2000,2000,0,-2000;PU500,0;"  
60 LPRINT "PD2000,0,-2000,2000,0,-2000;PU;"  
70 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
80 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
90 END  
<Sample 25>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
AA - Draw absolute arc  
AA [ X, Y, qc [, qd ]] [;]  
X ; Arc centre X coordinate  
Y ; Arc centre Y coordinate  
qc ; Arc angle in degrees  
qd ; Chord angle in degrees  
·
·
Coordinates are absolute coordinates in current units.  
Starting from the current position, this command plots an arc centred on the absolute coordinates X, Y having  
the specified arc angle and chord angle, with the radius being the distance between the current position and  
the point X,Y.  
·
After execution of the command the cursor position is at the opposite end of the arc from the point at which  
plotting started.  
·
·
Plotting takes place only when the pen is down.  
If the command is invoked with the pen up, plotting is not performed, but the cursor position moves to  
what would have been the plot end point.  
qc = Arc Angle  
qd = Chord Angle  
(X,Y)  
·
·
·
·
The value for qc is a clamped real number.  
When qc is positive, plotting is counterclockwise.  
When qc is negative, plotting is clockwise.  
The value for qd is a clamped real number in the range 0.5° to 180°. The default value is 5°.  
10 '-- Draw Absolute Arc --  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP1000,1000,6000,6000;"  
60 LPRINT "SC0,100,0,100;"  
70 LPRINT "PA0,30;"  
80 LPRINT "PD;PA0,45;AA0,50,180;PA0,70;"  
90 LPRINT "AA0,100,900;PA100,55;AA100,50,180;PA100,30;"  
100 LPRINT "AA100,100,90;PA45,100;AA50,100,180;PA80,100;"  
110 LPRINT "AA100,0,90;PA55,0;AA50,0,180;PA30,0;AA0,0,90;"  
120 LPRINT "PU;PA50,50,CI20;"  
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
140 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
150 END  
<Sample 26>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
AR - Draw relative arc  
AR X, Y, qc(, qd)[;]  
X ; Arc centre X coordinate  
qc ; Arc angle in degrees  
Y ; Arc centre Y coordinate  
qd ; Chord angle in degrees  
·
·
Coordinates are relative values in current units.  
Starting from the current cursor position the command plots an arc whose centre is at the relative coordinate  
position (X,Y) and which has the specified arc and chord angles. The radius of the arc is the distance  
between the current position and the point (X,Y).  
·
After execution of the command the cursor position is at the opposite end of the arc from the point at which  
plotting started.  
·
·
Plotting takes place only when the pen is down.  
If the command is invoked with the pen up, plotting is not performed, but the cursor position moves to  
what would have been the plot end point.  
·
·
·
·
The value for qc is a clamped real number.  
When qc is positive, plotting is counterclockwise.  
When qc is negative, plotting is clockwise.  
The value for qd is a clamped real number in the range 0.5° to 180°. The default value is 5°.  
10 '--Draw Relative Arc --  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP1000,1000,6000,6000;"  
60 LPRINT "SC-100,100,-100,100;"  
70 LPRINT  
"PA-100,70;PD;PR30,0;AR0,-70,-90,15;AR70,0,90;PR60,0;PU;"  
80 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
100 END  
<Sample 27>  
AT - Absolute arc three point  
AT X1, Y1, X2, Y2 [,qd] [;]  
X1 ; x-coordinate of intermediate point  
X2 ; x-coordinate of end point  
Y ; y-coordinate of intermediate point  
y2 ; y-coordinate of end point  
2
qd ; the chord angle used to draw the arc  
·
·
All coordinates are absolute and in current units.  
The command draws an arc from the current position, through the specified intermediate position and  
finishing at the specified end position.  
·
·
·
·
·
After completion of the command the current cursor position is at the end of the arc.  
An arc can be drawn clockwise or anti-clockwise.  
If the current scaling mode is not isotropic, the arc may be elliptical rather than circular.  
The chord angle must be in the range 0.5° to 180°.  
The default chord angle is 5°.  
10 '--Absolute Arc Three Point--  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA1000,100;PD2500,100;"  
70 LPRINT "PU650,1150;PD1000,1150;"  
80 LPRINT "PU650,450;PD1000,450;"  
90 LPRINT "PU1000,100;PD1000,1500,2500,1500;"  
100 LPRINT "AT3200,800,2500,1500;"  
110 LPRINT "PU3200,900;PD;"  
120 LPRINT "AT3300,800,3200,700;"  
130 LPRINT "PU3300,800;PD3500,800;"  
140 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";  
150 LPRINT CHR&(27);"E";  
160 END  
<Sample 28>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
RT - Relative arc three point  
RT X1, Y1, X2, Y2 [,qd] [;]  
X1 ; x-coordinate of intermediate point  
Y ; y-coordinate of intermediate point  
2
X2 ; x-coordinate of end point  
y2 ; y-coordinate of end point  
qd ; the chord angle used to draw the arc  
·
·
The specified coordinates of the two points are relative to the current pen position.  
The command draws an arc from the current position, through the specified intermediate position and  
finishing at the specified end position.  
·
·
·
·
·
After completion of the command the current cursor position is at the end of the arc.  
An arc can be drawn clockwise or anti-clockwise.  
If the current scaling mode is not isotropic, the arc may be elliptical rather than circular.  
The chord angle must be in the range 0.5° to 180°.  
The default chord angle is 5°.  
10 '--Relative Arc Three Point--  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "&0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA1000,100;PR;PD1500,0;"  
70 LPRINT "PU-1850,1050;PD350,0;"  
80 LPRINT "PU-350,-700;PD350;0;"  
90 LPRINT "PU0,-350;PD0,1500,1500,0;"  
100 LPRINT "RT800,-750,0,-1500;"  
110 LPRINT "PU700,850;PD;"  
120 LPRINT "RT100,-100,0,-200;"  
130 LPRINT "PU100,100;PD200,0;"  
140 LPRINT CHR&(27); "%0A";  
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
160 END  
<Sample 29>  
PE - Polyline encoded  
PE [ [flag] [value] | XiYi ... [flag] [value] | XiYi ] ];  
flag ; a command or mode that applies to the data that follows  
value; parameter data for the preceding flag  
X
Y
; X-coordinate of a cursor movement destination  
; Y-coordinate of a cursor movement destination  
·
·
This command allows you to combine a sequence of PA, PR, PU, PD and SP commands into a coded format.  
This reduces file size and transmission time.  
Do not use commas within the PE command. Parameters either have their own terminators or do not require  
them.  
·
·
·
The PE command must be terminated with a semi-colon.  
The command draws lines using the current line type and current units.  
The command draws lines to all coordinate points specified unless you precede the coordinate pair with a pen  
up flag.  
·
·
·
·
On completion of the command, the pen is down unless the final move was made with the pen up.  
All coordinate points are interpreted as relative unless preceded by the absolute flag (=).  
On completion of the command, the previous plotting mode is restored.  
Flags are not encoded. They are sent as ASCII characters. The MSB of the code is ignored, thus 60 and  
188 can both represent <, the flag for pen up.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
The following flags are used:  
':' - Select pen. The number which follows is the required pen number. A PE command that does not  
include a select pen command uses the currently selected pen.  
'<' - Pen up. The pen is raised and moved to the specified coordinate pair. All coordinate pair values  
not preceded by this flag are automatically interpreted as pen down plotting commands.  
'>' - Fractional data. The value following the flag specifies the number of fractional binary bits in the  
coordinate data.  
'=' - Absolute plotting mode. The pair of coordinates which follow this flag are absolute coordinates.  
'7' -  
7 bit mode. All subsequent coordinate values within this PE command are to be interpreted as 7-bit  
values, that is, encoded in base 32.  
·
·
If you use the ':' flag in polygon mode it is ignored as the SP command has no effect in this mode.  
Values and coordinates are encoded in base 64 or base 32. Values determine the setting of the immediately  
preceding flag. Legal values and coordinates are as follows:  
Pen number -  
0 (white) or 1(black)  
Number of fractional binary bits -  
x- and y-coordinates -  
-26 to 26. The default is 0.  
30  
30  
(-2 ) to 2 - 1 current units. If the pen position is moved  
outside this range, subsequent plotting commands are ignored  
until an absolute coordinate pair within the allowable range is  
specified.  
·
·
Flag and coordinate values are encoded as either base 64 or base 32 numbers and then transmitted as ASCII  
character codes. Base 64 is the default. Use Base 64 if your computer can send data without a parity bit.  
Use base 32 if your system requires a parity bit.  
To encode an integer proceed as follows. If the number is negative, take the absolute value, multiply by  
2 and add 1. Hence -x : = 2x+1. If the number is positive simply multiply by 2. Hence x :=2x. Convert  
the new number into base 64 or base 32 according to your system and encode each base 64 or base 32 digit  
as the corresponding ASCII character.  
·
·
To encode a real number proceed as follows. Multiply the number of decimal places in your coordinate's  
data by 3.33 and round the result up to the next highest integer (for example round 6.66 up to 7). This gives  
the number of binary bits needed to represent the number's fractional part - the value that you will supply with  
the '>' flag. Call this number n. Now multiply the number you are encoding by 2n. Round this number to  
the nearest integer and then follow the procedure described above for encoding an integer.  
Transmit each number to the printer least significant digits first. Terminate each number with the most  
significant digit. This must be specified from a different ASCII range from the preceding digits in the  
number. In base 64, non-terminating digits are represented by the numbers 63-126 and terminating digits by  
the numbers 191-254. In base 32, non-terminating digits are represented by the numbers 63-94 and  
terminating digits by the numbers 95-126. Hence if using a base 32 number whose least significant digit is  
14, and whose most significant digit is 5, encode 14 as 77 (63+14) and 5 as 100 (95+5).  
Non-terminator  
63-126  
63-94  
Terminator  
191-254  
95-126  
Base 64  
Base 32  
·
·
In symbol mode the PE command draws the specified symbol at each specified point.  
In polygon mode the points specified within the PE command are not plotted. Instead they are stored in the  
polygon buffer and used when a FP (Fill Polygon) or EP (Edge Polygon) command is used.  
·
The PE command with no parameters simply updates the carriage return point.  
CI - Circle plot  
CI r(, qd)[;]  
r ; Radius of circle ( in current units )  
qd ; Chord angle ( in degrees )  
·
·
·
·
·
The command plots a circle with the current position as the centre, with a radius r and chord angle qd.  
After plotting, the cursor returns to the centre of the circle.  
Plotting takes place irrespective of whether the pen is up or down.  
Valid values for r are specified in the current unit.  
Valid values for qd are clamped real numbers in the range 0.5° to 180°. The default value is 5°.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
To avoid placing an unwanted dot at the centre of the circle precede the CI command with a PU command.  
10 '-- Circle --  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27);"E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "SC-75,75,-75,75,1;"  
70 LPRINT "PA0,0;LT;CI5;LT0;CI-12;"  
80 LPRINT "LT1;CI19;LT2;CI-26;"  
90 LPRINT "LT3;CI33;LT4;CI-40;"  
100 LPRINT "LT5;CI47;LT6;CI54;"  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27);"%0A";  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
130 END  
<Sample 30>  
BR - Bezier relative  
BR [ X1, Y1, X2, Y2, X3, Y3 . . . [X1, Y1, X2, Y2, X3, Y3]] [;]  
X1, X2, X3 ; X coordinate of the second (X1), third (X2), and forth (X3) control point  
Y1, Y2, Y3 ; Y coordinate of the second (Y1), third (Y2), and forth (Y3) control point  
·
·
Coordinates are relative values in current units.  
Using the current pen position as the starting point, the bezier curve is geometrically drawn referring to the  
other three points. The start point of the curve is at (X0,Y0), and the curve is tangential to the line from (X0,  
Y0) to (X1, Y1) at that point, and it leaves the point in that direction. The end point of the curve is at  
(X3,Y3), and the curve is tangential to the line from (X2,Y2) to (X3,Y3).  
·
·
After execution of this command the cursor position is at the end of the bezier curve.  
When drawing a bezier curve is repeated, the last (fourth) control point of the first curve is used as the first  
control point for the second curve.  
·
·
Plotting takes place only when the pen is down.  
If the command is invoked with the pen up, plotting is not performed, but the cursor position moves to  
what would have been the plot end point.  
·
·
If the curve extends to the outside of the soft/hard clip limit, it is clipped.  
This command can only be used in polygon mode.  
BZ - Bezier absolute  
BZ [ X1, Y1, X2, Y2, X3, Y3 . . . [X1, Y1, X2, Y2, X3, Y3]] [;]  
X1, X2, X3 ; X coordinate of the second (X1), third (X2), and forth (X3) control point  
Y1, Y2, Y3 ; Y coordinate of the second (Y1), third (Y2), and forth (Y3) control point  
·
·
Coordinates are absolute values in current units.  
Using the current pen position as the starting point, the bezier curve is geometrically drawn referring to the  
other three points. The start point of the curve is at (X0,Y0), and the curve is tangential to the line from (X0,  
Y0) to (X1, Y1) at that point, and it leaves the point in that direction. The end point of the curve is at  
(X3,Y3), and the curve is tangential to the line from (X2,Y2) to (X3,Y3).  
·
·
After execution of this command the cursor position is at the end of the bezier curve.  
When drawing a bezier curve is repeated, the last (fourth) control point of the first curve is used as the first  
control point of the second curve.  
·
·
Plotting takes place only when the pen is down.  
If the command is invoked with the pen up, plotting is not performed, but the cursor position moves to  
what would have been the plot end point.  
·
·
If the curve extends to the outside of the soft/hard clip limit, it is clipped.  
This command can only be used in polygon mode.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.4. The polygon group  
Instruction  
PM  
Function  
Polygon Mode  
EA  
Edge Absolute Rectangle  
Edge Relative Rectangle  
Edge Polygon  
ER  
EP  
EW  
Edge Wedge  
RA  
Fill Absolute Rectangle  
Fill Relative Rectangle  
Fill Wedge  
RR  
WG  
FP  
Fill Polygon  
PM - Polygon mode  
PM [ ms ] [;]  
·
This command is used for entering and leaving polygon mode, the mode that allows you to access the  
polygon buffer.  
·
When in polygon mode you can use any of the vector group commands to define the vertices of a polygon.  
The following commands can be used;  
DF, IN, AA, AR, AT, BR, BZ, CI, PA, PD, PE, PR, PU, RT  
·
·
The polygon you have defined is not printed until you exit polygon mode and fill or edge the polygon.  
ms, the mode status, can have the value 0, 1 or 2. If ms = 0 the command empties the polygon buffer and  
enters polygon mode. A value of 1 closes the current polygon and remains in polygon mode. All  
commands sent following a PM1 before a PM2 or a further PM1 are used to build one sub-polygon. A value  
of 2 closes the current polygon or sub-polygon and exits polygon mode.  
·
Having exited polygon mode you can use the EP and FP commands to edge or fill the polygons you have  
defined.  
·
·
The EP command only draws between points defined when the pen was in the down position.  
The FP command fills the area between the polygon vertices irrespective of whether the pen was up or down  
when the polygon was defined.  
·
·
·
·
The first point in the polygon buffer is the pen position when the PM0 command was invoked.  
The next pen position specified after a PM1 command becomes the first vertex of the next sub-polygon.  
When plotting a polygon the pen always moves to the first point in the up position.  
Using the command with no parameters clears the polygon buffer and enters polygon mode. This is  
equivalent to the PM0; command.  
·
·
If a DF or IN command is invoked in the polygon mode, the printer quits polygon mode, clears the  
polygon buffer and executes the subsequent command.  
If an ESC E reset command is invoked while the printer is in polygon mode, the printer quits polygon  
mode, clears the polygon buffer, exits HP-GL/2 and ejects the page.  
EA - Edge rectangle absolute  
EA X, Y[;]  
X ; X coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle  
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle  
·
·
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in current units.  
Plots the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite corner specified by X and Y.  
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin and pen up/down status remains as selected.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10 '-Edge Rectangle Absolute-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "SC0,150,0,150,1;"  
70 LPRINT "PA25;105;EA65;130;"  
80 LPRINT "PA30;110;EA70,135;"  
90 LPRINT "PA35;115;EA75;140;"  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
120 END  
<sample 31>  
ER - Edge rectangle relative  
ER X, Y[;]  
X ; X coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle  
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle  
·
·
·
·
Coordinates are relative to the current position in current units.  
Plots the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite corner specified by X and Y.  
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
10 '-Edge Rectangle Relative -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "SC0;150;0;150;1;"  
70 LPRINT "PA25,105;ER40,25;"  
80 LPRINT "PR 5, 5;ER40,25;"  
90 LPRINT "PR 5, 5;ER40,25;"  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
120 END  
<Sample 32>  
EP - Edge polygon  
EP [;]  
·
·
·
·
·
This command plots the outline of the polygon currently stored in the polygon buffer.  
The command only plots between points defined when the pen was down.  
The command plots an outline irrespective of whether the pen is currently up or down.  
The command does not affect the data in the polygon buffer.  
On completion of the plot the cursor returns to the original position.  
EW - Edge wedge  
EW r,q1,qc(,qd)[;]  
r ; Radius in current units  
q1; Start point angle  
qc ; Arc angle  
qd ; Chord angle  
·
Plots a wedge centred on the current position with radius r, start point angle q1, arc angle qc and chord angle  
qd.  
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
You should use this command with the type "isotropic". Anisotropic type may make the wedge stretch.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
r specifies the radius of the circle. A positive value for r places the 0° reference point onto the positive x-  
axis and a negative value for r places the 0° reference point onto the negative x-axis.  
The value for q1 is a clamped real number.  
qc  
q1  
0° reference point  
current  
position  
r
·
·
q1 specifies the wedge starting point relative to the 0 degree reference point.  
When q1 is positive, the positive direction of the X axis relative to the current position is set at 0 degrees and  
the start point is sought in the counterclockwise direction. The opposite occurs when q1 is negative: the  
negative X axis is set at 0 degrees and the start point is sought by going clockwise.  
·
·
·
·
·
qc specifies the angle of the wedge in degrees.  
The value for qc is a clamped real number.  
Plotting proceeds counterclockwise when qc is positive and clockwise when negative.  
The value for qd must be an integer from -32,768 to +32,767.  
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees )  
10 '- Edge Wedge -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"  
60 LPRINT "PA2000,5000;"  
70 LPRINT "EW1250,90,180,5;"  
80 LPRINT "EW1250,270,120;"  
90 LPRINT "EW1250,30,60;"  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
120 END  
<Sample 33>  
RA - Fill rectangle absolute  
RA X, Y[;]  
X ; X coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle  
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle  
·
·
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in current units.  
Fill the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite corner specified by X and Y.  
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
10 ' - Fill Absolute Rectangle -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,4000;"  
60 LPRINT "FT1;RA4250,3250;"  
70 LPRINT "FT3,100;RA5750,3250;"  
80 LPRINT "FT2;RA5750,4750;"  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
90 LPRINT "FT4,100,45;RA4250,4750;"  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
120 END  
<Sample 34>  
RR - Fill rectangle relative  
RR X, Y[;]  
X ; X coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle  
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite corner for the rectangle  
·
·
·
·
Coordinates relative to the current position in current units.  
Fill the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite corner specified by X and Y.  
After plotting the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
10 ' - Fill Relative Rectangle -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,4000;"  
60 LPRINT "FT1;RR750,750;"  
70 LPRINT "PR750,0;"  
80 LPRINT "FT3,100;RR750,750;"  
90 LPRINT "PR0,750;"  
100 LPRINT "FT2;RR750,750;"  
110 LPRINT "FT4,100,45;RR-750,750;"  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
140 END  
<Sample 35>  
WG - Fill wedge  
WG r,q1,qc(,qd)[;]  
r ; Radius in current units  
q1 ; Start point angle  
qc ; Arc angle  
qd ; Chord angle  
·
Fill in a wedge centred on the current position with radius r, start point angle q1, arc angle qc and chord angle  
qd.  
·
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
You should use this command with the type "isotropic". Anisotropic type may make the wedge stretch.  
r specifies the radius of circle. A positive value places the 0° reference point onto the positive x-  
axis and the negative value places it onto the negative x-axis.  
·
·
·
The value for q1 is a clamped real number.  
q1 specifies the wedge starting point related to the 0° reference point.  
When q1 is positive, the positive direction of the X axis relative to the current position is set at 0 degrees and  
the start point is sought in the counterclockwise direction. The opposite occurs when q1 is negative: the  
negative X axis is set at 0 degrees and the start point is sought by going clockwise.  
·
·
·
·
·
qc specifies the angle of the wedge.  
The value for qc is a clamped real number.  
Plotting proceeds counterclockwise when qc is positive and clockwise when negative.  
The value for qd is a clamped real number.  
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees ).  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10 ' - Fill Wedge -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP2;FT3,100;"  
60 LPRINT "PA2000,5000;"  
70 LPRINT "WG1250,90,180,5;"  
80 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,90,180,5;"  
90 LPRINT "SP4;FT4,100,45;"  
100 LPRINT "WG1250,270,120;"  
110 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,270,120;"  
120 LPRINT "SP1;FT1;"  
130 LPRINT "WG1250,30,60;"  
140 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,30,60;"  
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
160 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
170 END  
<Sample 36>  
FP - Fill polygon  
FP [;]  
FP [ n ] [;]  
n ; fill method  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
This command fills the polygon currently stored in the polygon buffer.  
The command does not clear the buffer or alter the data at all.  
The command fills between points defined when the pen was up or down.  
If a polygon is composed of sub-polygons, the command fills alternate areas.  
On completion of the plot the cursor returns to the original position.  
The command performs a fill irrespective of whether the pen is currently up or down.  
You can specify the fill method. There are two types of fill method.  
0 specifies the even/odd fill method.  
Places a point within the polygon and draws a straight line from it to the outside of polygon. If the cross  
point of the straight line and polygon edges are an odd count, the polygon which includes the start point is  
filled.  
1 time  
*
*
2 times  
*
·
1 specifies Non-zero winding fill method.  
10 '- Fill Polygon -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA1500,1500;PM0;CI1000,60;PM1;"  
70 LPRINT "CI500;PM1;PM2;"  
80 LPRINT "LT4;FT3,50,45;"  
90 LPRINT "FP;"  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
120 END  
<Sample 37>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.5. Plot Function Instructions  
Instruction  
AC  
FT  
Function  
Anchor Corner  
Fill Type  
LA  
Line Attribute  
Line Type  
LT  
PW  
RF  
Pen Width  
Raster Fill Definition  
Symbol Mode  
Select Pen  
SM  
SP  
SV  
Screened Vectors  
Transparency Mode  
User-defined Line Type  
Select Unit for Pen Width  
TR  
UL  
WU  
AC - Anchor corner  
AC [ X, Y ] [;]  
X ; x-coordinate of starting point of fill pattern  
Y ; y-coordinate of starting point of fill pattern  
·
·
This command specifies the anchor corner which is the starting position of a fill pattern.  
If no parameters are specified the lower left hand corner of the PCL picture frame, according to the current  
coordinate system, becomes the anchor position. This is equivalent to AC0,0;  
·
·
User units or graphics units may be used.  
The value of the coordinates are real numbers in the range (-230) to 230 - 1.  
10 '-Anchor Corner -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA3000,3000;FT3,400,45;"  
70 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"  
80 LPRINT "PR1000,0;FT4,400,45;"  
90 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"  
100 LPRINT "PR1000,0;FT3,400,45;"  
110 LPRINT "RR1000,1000,ER1000,1000;"  
120 LPRINT "PA3000,1500;AC3000,1500;"  
130 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"  
140 LPRINT "PA4000,1500;AC4000,1500;FT4,400,45;"  
150 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"  
160 LPRINT "PA5000,1500;AC5000,1500;FT3,400,45;"  
170 LPRINT "RR1000,1000;ER1000,1000;"  
180 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
190 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
200 END  
<Sample 38>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
FT - Fill type  
FT n(, d(, q))[;]  
n ; Fill type  
d ; option 1  
q ; option 2  
·
·
Sets the fill type, interval and angle when filling an area. This setting is effective for the commands FP, RA,  
RR, WG and CF.  
The value for n must be a clamped integer number  
Fill type Description  
Option 1  
Option 2  
1
2
Solid black (bi-directional fill)  
Solid black (single directional fill)  
hatching (parallel line)  
cross-hatching  
3
fill interval  
fill angle  
fill angle  
4
fill interval  
10  
11  
21  
22  
130  
shading  
shading level  
raster-fill index  
pattern type  
pattern ID  
HP-GL/2 user-defined  
PCL cross-hatching  
PCL user-defined  
shading (one of sixty-four gray scales)  
Shading level  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
option 1 for n=3 or 4 is the setting for the interval of the lines in the fill. This is specified in current units.  
If d is omitted or 0, it is set to the default value which is 1% of the diagonal distance between P1 and P2.  
Option 2 for n=3 and 4 is the setting of the angle for the lines in degrees.  
If q is omitted, the fill angle already specified will be used.  
The value of q is a clamped real number.  
Option 1 for n=10 is the setting for the shading density. It is specified as a percentage from 0 to 100.  
Option 2 for n=10 is ignored.  
Option 1 for n=11 specifies the HP-GL/2 user-defined raster fill pattern. This uses the index number which is  
defined by the RF command.  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Option 2 for n=11 is ignored.  
Option 1 for n=21 specifies the PCL cross-hatch patterns. There are 6 types of PCL cross-hatch patterns.  
Option 2 for n=21 is ignored.  
Option 1 for n=22, the PCL user-defined patterns defined by the ESC*c#W command with a unique ID code.  
Option 2 for n=22 is ignored.  
Option 1 for n=130, the 64 gray scale shading density. It is specified as a percentage from 0 to 100.  
Option 2 for n=130 is ignored.  
10 ' - Fill Type -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA2000,2000;FT;PR2500,300;ER2500,300;"  
70 LPRINT "PR0,300;FT3,80,30;RR2500.300;"  
80 LPRINT "PR0,300;FT10,36;RR2500,300;ER2500,300;"  
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
110 END  
<Sample 39>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
LA - Line attribute  
LA [ l, v [ , l , v [ , l , v]]] [;]  
l; line attribute  
v : value  
This command specifies the shape of line joins and line ends.  
These settings are effective for the line widths thicker than 0.35 mm.  
·
·
· lspecifies the line attribute for which you are setting a value.  
·
There are three line attributes - line end type, line join type and miter limit, specified by line attribute  
values of 1, 2 and 3 respectively.  
·
·
·
·
v specifies the value of the particular attribute.  
Line ends are either butt (1), square (2,), triangular (3) or round (4).  
Line joins are either mitered (1), mitered/beveled (2), triangular (3), round (4), beveled (5), or have no join (6).  
Miter limit is the ratio of miter length to line width. When the miter limit is exceeded, the join is clipped to  
the miter limit.  
·
·
The miter limit is specified as a clamped real number.  
If no parameters are specified, the line attributes are set as follows: line ends are butt, line joins are mitered  
and the miter limit is 5. This is equivalent to the command LA1, 1, 2, 1, 3, 5;  
Line width  
Miter length  
Miter limit = Miter length / Line width  
·
·
Labels are always drawn with rounded ends and joins.  
An LA command remains in effect until another LA command is issued, until default settings are restored  
with the DF command or until the printer is initialized with an IN command.  
10 '-Line Attributes-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA4000,3000;PW2;LA1,3;PD3500,2500,4000,2000;"  
70 LPRINT "PU3500,200;LA2,2,3,20;PD3000,2500,3000,2300;"  
80 LPRINT "PU2500,2300;LA1,4;PD3500,2300;"  
90 LPRINT "PU2700,2100;PD3300,2100;"  
100 LPRINT "PU2900,1900;PD3100,1900;"  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
130 END  
<Sample 40>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
LT - Line type selection  
LT [, n [, p [,m ]]] [;]  
n ; Line pattern number  
p ; Line pattern length (percentage or millimeters of distance between P1 and P2)  
m : mode  
·
·
·
This command specifies the line pattern for use when drawing lines with the vector group commands.  
n defines the line type to be used. n is either in the range -8 to 8 or is 99.  
Values of n from 1 to 8 specify a line type (as defined with the UL command) and use a fixed pattern length.  
Any residual part of the pattern not used on a particular drawing operation is stored and used at the start of  
the next line drawn.  
·
Values of n from -1 to -8 specify a line type (as defined with the UL command) and use an adaptive pattern  
length - that is, the pattern is scaled so as to fit one or more complete patterns into the line.  
·
·
If n is 0, a dot is placed at the (X, Y) coordinates specified with any vector commands used.  
p, the pattern length, specifies the length of one complete pattern, either as a percentage of the distance  
between P1 and P2 or in millimeters. The unit system used is determined by the mode setting. If the length  
is omitted, the printer uses the most recently specified pattern length.  
·
·
If a zero or negative pattern length is specified the command is ignored.  
m, the mode, defines whether the pattern length parameter, p, is interpreted as a reading in millimeters, (m=1),  
or as a percentage of the distance between P1 and P2, (m=0). If no mode number is included in the  
command, the most recently specified mode is used.  
·
·
·
LT99; restores the previous line type (and, if it is a fixed line type, the residue), provided that the current line  
type is solid and that the pen position is the same as it was when the current, solid line type was selected.  
An LT command remains in effect until another LT command is issued, until the default settings are restored  
with the DF command or until the printer is initialized with an IN command.  
If no parameters are specified the line type is set to be solid. The previous line type, pattern length and  
any line residue are saved.  
10 ' - Line Type -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;IP1000,1000,9000,7000;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA2000,7100;PDPR400,0;PU;" 'REM DEFAULT LINE = 400  
70 LPRINT "LT8;PA2000,7000;PD5000,7000;PU;"  
80 LPRINT "LT8,4,0;PA2000,6900;PD5000,6900;PU;"  
90 LPRINT "LT8,8,1;PA2000,6800;PD5000L6800;PU;"  
100 '  
110 LPRINT "LT4,PA2000,6600;PD5000,6600;PU;"  
120 LPRINT "LT4,4,0;PA2000;6500;PD5000;6600;PU;"  
130 LPRINT "LT4,10,1;PA2000,6400;PD5000,6400;PU;"  
140 '  
150 LPRINT "LT0;PA2000,6300;PD5000,6200; PU;"  
160 LPRINT "LT0,4,0;PA2000,6100;PD5000,61000;PU;"  
170 LPRINT "LT0,10,1;PA2000,6000;PD5000,6000;PU;"  
180 '  
190 LPRINT "LT-4;PA2000,5800;PD5000,5800;PU;"  
200 LPRINT "LT-4,4,0;PA2000,5700;PD5000;5700;PU;"  
210 LPRINT "LT-4,10,1;PA2000,5600;PD5000,5600;PU;"  
220 '  
230 LPRINT "LT-8;PA2000,5400;PD5000,5400;PU;"  
240 LPRINT "LT-8,4,0;PA2000,5300;PD5000,5300;PU;"  
250 LPRINT "LT08,10,1;PA2000,5200;PD5000,5200;PU;"  
260 '  
270 LPRINT "LT99;PA2000,5000;PD5000,5000;PU;"  
280 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
290 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
300 END  
<Sample 41>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
PW - Pen width  
PW [w, [,p]] [;]  
w ; width  
p ; pen  
·
·
This command specifies the width of the pen.  
Pen width can either be specified as a fixed width in millimeters ( the default ) or relative to the distance  
between the scaling points P1 and P2.  
·
·
If a width of zero is specified the thinnest width possible ( 1 dot wide ) is set.  
Metric widths are scaled by the ratio of the PCL picture frame to the HP-GL/2 plot size. If the ratio for the  
two axes is different, the smaller one is used. If this is less than the thinnest width available then a width  
of 1 dot is selected.  
·
·
If no pen number is specified the new width applies to both pens.  
If a pen number other than 0 or 1 is specified the command is ignored. There are six pens in the  
specification.  
·
If no parameters are specified the pen width defaults to either 0.35mm or 0.1% of the distance from P1 to P2  
according to the current width unit setting.  
·
·
·
Pen width settings are not affected by a DF command.  
Pen width does not set the width of the lines that make up the characters in a label.  
A PW command remains in effect until another PW command is issued, until a WU command is used or  
until the printer is initialized with an IN command.  
10 '-Pen Width-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA3500,2500;PW1.5;"  
70 LPRINT "PD4500,2800,4500,1800,3500,1500,3500,2500;"  
80 LPRINT "PW0.8;PD2300,2900,2300,1900,3500,1500;"  
90 LPRINT "PW0.5;PU2300,2900;PD3300,3200,4500,2800;"  
100 LPRINT "PW0.25:PU4500,1800;PD3500,2100;"  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
130 END  
<Sample 42>  
RF - Raster fill definition  
RF [ i [, w, h, p [,...]]] [;]  
i : index  
p: pen number  
w : width  
h : height  
·
·
This command defines a rectangular pattern which may be used to fill the area.  
i is the index number of the pattern that is to be defined and must be in the range 1-8. 8 patterns can exist  
concurrently.  
·
·
·
·
If used with an index parameter and no others, the pattern is defined as a solid black fill.  
w is the width in pixels of the pattern that is to be defined and must be in the range 1- 255.  
h is the height in pixels of the pattern that is to be defined an must be in the range 1 - 255.  
p stands for a pixel in the defined fill. p = 0 signifies a white pixel, p>0 signifies a black pixel. The number  
of pixels specified should equal the number of pixels in the fill pattern (w, h). The parameter defines  
successive pixels' colors from left to right, top to bottom. If you do not supply enough pixel parameters  
the trailing pixels default to white.  
·
·
Use the FT command to select a fill type from those defined with the RF command.  
Omitting parameters sets all raster fill patterns to solid fill.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10 '--Raster Fill Definition==  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PU5,5;PA3500,2500;"  
70 LPRINT  
"RF2,8,4,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,1,1,0,0,0,0,0,1,1,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0,  
0,;"  
80 LPRINT "FT11,2;RR4000,800;EP;"  
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
110 END  
<Sample 43>  
SM - Symbol mode  
SM c[;]  
c ; ASCII character or symbol code  
·
·
The command specifies the symbol to be drawn.  
The specified symbol will be drawn at the end of each vector, irrespective of whether the pen is up or down  
when the PA, PR, PD, PU or PE instructions are used.  
·
·
·
·
·
Characters in the character code ranges 33 - 58, 60 - 126 and characters 161 and 254 can be used.  
Character code 59 stands for the ';', which is the HP-GL/2 terminator. You cannot use it as a symbol.  
The current character size, slant and direction settings affect the way the symbol is drawn.  
Omitting the parameter cancels the symbol mode.  
On quitting symbol mode the original pen up/down state is restored.  
SP - Select pen  
SP [ n ] [;]  
n ; pen number  
·
·
·
·
The command selects a pen for drawing.  
You must use this command before performing any drawing or filling commands.  
n should be either 0 or 1 ( although any other integers will be interpreted as 1.)  
If n is 0 the white pen is selected. In this case drawing commands will have no effect, unless you are  
plotting onto a dark background and transparency mode is off.  
·
·
If n is 1 the black pen is selected and printing can proceed normally. Use SP1 at the start of HP-GL/2  
programs.  
Invoking the command with no parameter is equivalent to SP0.  
SV - Screened vectors  
SV [ s [, option_1[, option_2]]] [;]  
s : screen type  
option_1 and option_2: dependent on the screen type  
·
·
This command selects the type of screening that will be applied to vectors, arcs, circles and edges of  
polygons, rectangles and wedges.  
The screen type must have the value 0, 1, 2, 21, 22 or 130. 0 = no screen, 1 = shaded fill ( one of eight gray  
scales ), 2 = raster fill as defined by the RF command, 21 = a pre-defined PCL cross-hatch pattern and 130 =  
shaded fill ( one of sixty-four gray scales ).  
·
·
With screen type 1 option_1 specifies the percentage of shading (0-100): option_2 is ignored.  
With screen type 2 option_1 is used to specify the index number of the fill pattern created using the RF  
command. Option_2 is set to either 0 or 1: 0 means that the fill will appear in the colour of pen number 1, 1  
means it should appear in the current pen's colour.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
With screen type 21 option 1 specifies one of six predefined PCL cross-hatch patterns (patterns 1 - 6).  
option 2 is ignored.  
With screen type 22, option 1 specifies the ID number of PCL user-defined pattern which is defined by the  
ESC*c#W command. option 2 is ignored.  
·
·
With fill screen type 130 option 1 specifies the percentage of shading ( 0 - 100 ): option 2 is ignored.  
If option 1 and option 2 are omitted, the most recently specified values for these parameters, for the  
specified screen type, are used.  
·
·
All screening patterns use the current anchor corner.  
Invoking the command with no parameter turns screening off. This is equivalent to SV0;  
10 '-Screened Vectors-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "SV1,15;PA4000,5000;CI500;"  
70 LPRINT "SV1,50;PA5000,4000;CI400;"  
80 LPRINT "SV1,100;PA6000,6000;CI300;"  
90 LPRINT "PW10;SV21,5;PA2000,1000;PD;AA0,0,90;PC;"  
100 LPRINT "PW5;SV21,3;PA6000,6000;CI500;"  
110 LPRINT "PW7;SV21,6;PA2000,8000;PDPA5000,8000;PU;"  
120 LPRINT "PW7;SV21,6;PA2000,8000;PDPA5000,8000;PU;"  
130 LPRINT "1,1,0,0,0,0,0,0,1,1,";  
140 LPRINT "0,0,1,1,0,0,1,1,0,0,";  
150 LPRINT "0,0,0,0,1,1,0,0,0,0,";  
160 LPRINT "0,0,1,1,0,0,1,1,0,0,";  
170 LPRINT "1,1,0,0,0,0,0,0,1,1;";  
180 LPRINT  
"PW15;SV2,3;PA4000,2000;PM0;PD6000,2000,6000,4000,4000,4000;PM1;PM2;EP;  
"
190 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
200 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
210 END  
<Sample 44>  
TR - Transparency mode  
TR [ n ] [;]  
n ; transparency type  
·
This command turns transparency mode on and off. Transparency mode defines how source and  
destination graphics images interact.  
·
·
n is either 0 (off) or 1(on).  
When transparency mode is on, the white parts of a source image (the image that is being superimposed on  
the destination image) do not affect the destination image - that is, part of the destination image will be  
visible beneath the source image.  
·
·
·
When transparency mode is off the destination image is not visible beneath the source image.  
Invoking the command with no parameter turns transparency mode on. This is equivalent to TR1;  
An Esc E reset, a control panel reset, the IN command and the DF command all turn transparency mode  
on.  
10 'Transparency Mode-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0b";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 'PART1 TR1  
70 'Original Destination 1  
80 LPRINT "TR1;PA1900,4900;PM0;PM3100;4900,2500,6100;PM1;"  
90 LPRINT "PM2;FP;"  
100 'Source 1  
110 LPRINT "FT10,50;PA2000,5000;RR500,500;PA2500,5500;RR500,500;"  
120 LPRINT "FT10,1;PA2500,5000;RR500,500;PA2000,5500;RR500,500;FT;"  
130 'PART2 TR0  
140 'Original Destination 2  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
150 LPRINT "TR0;PA3900,4900;PM0;PA5100,4900,4500,6100;PM1;"  
160 LPRINT "PM2;FP;"  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
170 'Source 2  
180 LPRINT "FT10,50;PA4000,5000;RR500,500;PA4500,5500;RR500,500;"  
190 LPRINT "FT10,1;PA4500,5000;RR500,500;PA4000,5500;RR500,500;FT;"  
200 '  
210 '( POLYGON )  
220 LPRINT "PA2000,1000;PM0;PDPA4000,1000,3000,3000;PM1;"  
230 LPRINT "PA2500,1200,3500,1200,3000,2500;PM1;"  
240 LPRINT "PA3000,800,3700,2500,2300,2500;PM1;"  
250 LPRINT "PM2;FP;"  
260 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
270 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
280 END  
<Sample 45>  
UL - User-defined line type  
UL [ i ] [,g [...,]] [;]  
i ; unit type  
g : gap length  
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to define line types which you can then subsequently select with the LT command.  
i must be in the range 1-8. i identifies the line type that is to be defined.  
The index parameter uses absolute values.  
g (the gap length) alternately specifies pen up and pen down parts of the defined line type. A maximum of  
twenty line sections are permitted, the first of which is a pen down section. Numbers must be integers in  
the range 0~32767. These numbers are converted to percentages by the LT command.  
·
·
·
Maximum definition for the gap of each line type is 20.  
The sum of the gap parameters must be greater than 0.  
Specifying an index number with no gap parameters sets the line type to the default pattern for that index  
number.  
·
Using the command with no parameter sets all line types to the defaults.  
10 '-User Defined Line Type-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;;"  
60 LPRINT "UL8,0,15,0,15,0,15,40,15;"  
70 LPRINT "LT8,5;PA2000,2500;PDPA5000,2500;PU;"  
80 LPRINT "UL4,40,15,0,15,0,15,40,15,0,15;"  
90 LPRINT "LT4,10;PA2000,3000;PDPA5000,3000;PU;"  
100 LPRINT "UL1,40,40,40,40,40;"  
110 LPRINT "LT1,10;PA2000,3500;PDPA5000,3500;PU;"  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
140 END  
<Sample 46>  
WU - Select unit for pen width  
WU [ t ] [;]  
t ; unit type  
·
·
·
This command specifies the pen width unit. It applies to all pens.  
t must be either 0 or 1.  
If t is 0 the pen width parameter which accompanies subsequent PW commands will be treated as a reading in  
millimeters.  
·
If t is 1 the pen width parameter which accompanies subsequent PW commands will be treated as percentage  
of the distance between the scaling points P1 and P2. The default width is 0.1% of the diagonal distance  
from P1 to P2.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
·
The command sets all pen widths to a default of 0.35mm. Hence it should be used before the PW command.  
Using the command with no parameter defaults the type to 0 (metric) and all pen widths to 0.35mm.  
The unit type is not affected by a DF command.  
10 '-Pen Width Unit Selection-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 'metric  
70 LPRINT PA2000,6000;PDPA6000,6000;PU;" 'Default 0.35mm  
80 LPRINT "WU0;PA2000,5700;PDPA6000,5700;PU;"'0.35mm  
90 LPRINT "WU0;PW1.5;PA2000,5400;PDPA6000,5400;PU;"'1.5mm  
100 LPRINT "WU0;PW0.8;PA2000,5100;PDPA6000,5100;PU;"'0.8mm  
110 "-relative unit  
120 LPRINT "PW;PA2000,4600;PDPA6000,4600;PU;"'Default 0.35mm=4dot  
130 LPRINT "IP1000,1000,9000,7000;"  
140 LPRINT "WU1;PA2000,4300;PDPA6000,4300;PU;"'300*10/1016=2dot  
150 LPRINT "IP1000,1000,5000,4000;"  
160 LPRINT "WU1;PA2000,4000;PDPA6000,4000;PU;"'300*5/1016=1dot  
170 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
180 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
190 END  
<Sample 47>  
7.6. Character Plot Instructions  
Instruction  
SD  
AD  
SS  
Function  
Define Standard Font  
Define Alternate Font  
Select Standard Font  
Select Alternate Font  
Select Primary Font  
Select Secondary Font  
Define Label  
SA  
FI  
FN  
LB  
DT  
LO  
DI  
Define Label Terminator  
Label Origin  
Absolute Direction  
Relative Direction  
Define Variable Text Path  
Character Plot  
DR  
DV  
CP  
CF  
Character Fill Mode  
Set Absolute Character Size  
Set Relative Character Size  
Set Character Slant  
Scalable or Bitmap Fonts  
Extra Space  
SI  
SR  
SL  
SB  
ES  
TD  
Transparent Data  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.6.1. Introduction  
The character group commands enable you to print text to accompany your HP-GL/2 generated graphics  
without leaving graphics mode. You can use any font that would be available to you in LaserJet emulation  
mode and you can modify various printing characteristics of the text such as the size, direction and slant of  
the characters.  
SD - Define standard font  
SD [ attribute, value ] [..] [;]  
attribute ; a font attribute to be defined  
value ; the value of the attribute  
·
·
This command allows you to define the standard font and its attribute.  
attribute takes a value from 1-7. 1=symbol set, 2=spacing, 3=pitch, 4=height, 5=posture, 6=stroke weight and  
7=typeface.  
·
·
value selects an option for the specified attribute.  
If the defined font is not available another font is selected that matches the defined font's specified attributes  
as closely as possible. The symbol set attribute has the highest priority for matching and typeface has the  
lowest.  
·
If you omit all parameters, the default standard font attributes are used. These are shown below.  
Attribute  
Meaning  
Symbol set  
Spacing  
Default value  
Description  
Roman-8  
1
2
277  
0
Monospacin  
g
3
4
5
Pitch  
Height  
Posture  
9
11.5  
0
9 cpi  
11.5 point  
Upright  
characters  
6
7
Stroke  
weight  
0
Medium  
Typeface  
48  
Stick font  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
attribute = 1 : Symbol set  
Value  
Name  
ISO  
Value  
Name  
ISO  
number  
number  
1
3
Math - 7  
HP Large Characters  
Roman Extensions  
HP German  
-
2
4
Line Draw - 7  
Norwegian v1  
French v1  
Hebrew - 7  
JIS ASCII  
Math - 7  
-
60  
25  
-
-
5
-
6
7
-
15  
8
9
Italian  
11  
13  
15  
14  
-
12  
14  
Line Draw - 7  
-
ECMA-94 Latin1 (8-bit  
version)  
8859/1  
OCR - A  
-
16  
19  
21  
25  
36  
38  
43  
45  
48  
51  
57  
76  
79  
85  
APL (typewriter paired)  
Swedish for names  
ASCII  
-
11  
6
18  
20  
22  
26  
37  
39  
44  
47  
50  
53  
75  
78  
83  
89  
Cyrillic ASCII  
Thai - 8  
-
-
Arabic (MacKay's Version)  
Not used  
-
3 of 9 Barcode  
Danish/Norwegian v2  
French v2  
-
-
61  
69  
13  
-
United Kingdom  
German  
4
21  
Katakana  
HP Block Characters  
OCR - B  
-
Tech - 7  
-
APL (bit paired)  
HP Spanish  
-
Cyrillic  
-
-
Legal  
-
57  
Industrial 2 of 5 Barcode  
Tax Line Draw  
OCR-M  
-
Chinese  
-
ECMA-94 Latin 2  
Spanish  
8859/2  
17  
-
International Reference  
Version  
2
Matrix 2 of 5 Barcode  
-
114  
147  
173  
179  
185  
205  
217  
243  
263  
266  
268  
275  
277  
281  
309  
332  
341  
405  
PC Cyrillic  
Portuguese  
-
16  
-
115  
153  
174  
181  
202  
211  
234  
249  
264  
267  
269  
276  
278  
299  
330  
334  
373  
428  
Swedish  
Interleaved 2 of 5 Barcode  
ECMA-128 Latin 5  
HPL Language Set  
Microsoft Publishing  
Spanish  
10  
-
PS Math  
8859/9  
Portuguese  
84  
-
-
CODABAR Barcode  
Ventura Math  
MSI/Plessey Barcode  
HP European Spanish  
Greek - 8  
-
-
85  
-
DeskTop  
-
-
Code 11 Barcode  
Hebrew - 8  
-
-
-
Document  
-
Kana - 8  
-
Line Draw 8  
-
Math - 8  
-
HP Latin Spanish  
Roman - 8 (Default)  
UPC/EAN Barcode  
Windows  
-
Turkish - 8  
-
-
Arabic - 8  
-
-
Korean - 8  
-
-
PS Text  
-
PS ITC Zapf Dingbats  
PC-8  
-
ECMA-113/88 Latin/Cyrillic  
PC-8 D/N  
8859/5.2  
-
-
-
PC-850  
-
ITC Zapf Dingbats Series  
300  
458  
505  
563  
Ventura U.S.  
USPS Zip  
-
-
-
501  
531  
595  
Pi Font  
-
-
-
HP-GL Download  
HP-GL Special Symbols  
HP-GL Drafting  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
attribute = 2 : Spacing  
Value  
Meaning  
0
1
Monospacing  
Proportional spacing  
·
·
attribute = 3 : Pitch  
Specify pitch in characters per inch (cpi). The pitch value you specify can be in the range 0 to 32767.9999.  
Pitch only applies to monospaced fonts.  
attribute = 4 : Height  
Specify height in points. One point is 1/72". The height value you specify can be in the range 0 to  
32767.9999. Proportionally spaced fonts are scaled according to the height you select. Monospaced fonts  
ignore this setting value.  
·
·
attribute = 5 : Posture  
value  
Meaning  
Upright  
0
1
2
Italic  
Alternate italic  
attribute = 6 : Stroke weight  
Attribute  
Meaning  
Ultra Thin  
Extra thin  
thin  
-7  
-6  
-5  
-4  
-3  
-2  
-1  
Extra light  
Light  
Demi light  
Semi light  
0
1
Medium, Book or Text  
Semi bold  
Demi bold  
2
3
Bold  
4
Extra bold  
5
Black  
6
Extra black  
7
Ultra black  
9999  
Stick font at current pen width*  
* This attribute value is only effective if the stick font is the current font.  
·
attribute = 7 : Typeface  
You can select any typefaces available in LaserJet mode, from the internal fonts, card/cartridge fonts or  
download fonts.  
10 '-Standard Font Definition-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA2200,7000;SD2,0,4,11.5,5,0;"  
70 LPRINT "DT#;LBLaser printer#"  
80 LPRINT "PA2000,5000;SD2,1,4,20,5,1;"  
90 LPRINT "LBLaser printer#"  
100 LPRINT "PA1000,3000;SD2,1,4,50,5,1;"  
110 LPRINT "LBLASER PRINTER#"  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
130 LPRINT CHR$927); "%0A";  
140 END  
<Sample 48>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
AD - Define alternate font  
AD [ attribute, value ] [..] [;]  
attribute : a font attribute to be defined  
value : the value of the attribute  
·
·
This command allows you to define the alternate font and its attribute.  
attribute takes a value from 1-7.  
1 = symbol set, 2 = spacing, 3 = pitch, 4 = height, 5 = posture, 6 = stroke weight and 7 = typeface.  
·
·
value selects an option for the specified attribute. For further explanation about attribute values see the  
previous SD command.  
If the defined font is not available, another font is selected that matches the defined font's specified attributes  
as closely as possible. The symbol set attribute has the highest priority for matching and typeface has the  
lowest.  
·
If you omit all parameters, the default alternate font attributes are used.  
10 '-Define Alternate Font -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 '- Standard font -  
70 LPRINT "PA1000,5000;"  
80 LPRINT "LBStandard font"; CHR$(3);  
90 ' - Alternate font -  
100 LPRINT "AD2,1,4,24,7,4101;"  
110 LPRINT "PA1000,4000;"  
120 LPRINT "SA";  
130 LPRINT "LBAlternate font"; CHR$(3);  
140 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
160 END  
<Sample 49>  
SS - Select standard font  
SS [;]  
·
This command allows you to select the standard font, as defined by the SD command. All subsequently  
printed labels will appear in the standard font.  
·
·
·
The SS command is equivalent to including the SI control code (ASCII 15) in a label.  
The default standard font is the HP-GL stick font.  
The font remains current until the printer is initialized with an IN command, until the default conditions are  
resorted with the DF command or until an SA command is used.  
SA - Select alternate font  
SA [;]  
·
This command allows you to select the alternate font, as defined by the AD command. All subsequently  
printed labels will appear in the alternate font  
·
·
The SA command is equivalent to including the SO control code (ASCII 14) in a label.  
The font remains current until the printer is initialized with an IN command, until the default conditions are  
restored with the DF command or until an SS command is used.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
FI - Select primary font  
FI font-ID [;]  
font-ID ; the identity number of any accessible font.  
·
This command allows you to select any accessible font, which has previously been given an identity  
number in LaserJet mode, as the primary (standard) font. All subsequently printed labels will appear in the  
primary font.  
·
·
For scalable fonts this command must be preceded by an SD command specifying the font's point size or  
pitch.  
When the FI command is issued the primary (standard) font's attributes are set to be those of the selected  
font (provided it is available).  
10 '-Select Primary Font & Select standard Font -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "*c15D";  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27); "(s1p18v0s3b52T";  
60 LPRINT CHR$(27); "*c6F";  
70 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
80 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"  
90 LPRINT "PA1500,1500;DT#;LBLaser Printer"; CHR$(13);CHR$(10); "#"  
100 LPRINT "SD4,18;FI15;LBLaser Printer#"  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
130 END  
<Sample 50>  
FN - Select secondary font  
FN font-ID [;]  
font-ID : the identity number of any accessible font  
·
This command allows you to select any accessible font, which has previously been given an identity  
number in PCL mode, as the secondary (alternate) font. All subsequently printed labels will appear in the  
secondary font.  
·
·
For scalable fonts the FN command must be preceded by an AD command specifying the font's point size or  
pitch.  
When the FN command is issued the secondary (alternate) font's attributes are set to be those of the selected  
font (provided it is available).  
LB - Character plot  
LB [ cs ] < terminator > [;]  
cs : character string  
·
·
This command enables you to print character strings.  
You must supply a terminator at the end of your string. You can either use the default terminator, ETX  
(ASCII 3), or define your own terminating character using the DT command.  
·
·
·
A label can include non-printing characters such as a carriage return or line feed.  
Printing takes place irrespective of whether the pen is currently up or down.  
The label is printed starting from the current cursor position and using any label origin setting that you have  
made with the LO command.  
10 '-Label-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA2500,2500;DT*;"  
70 LPRINT "SD1,21,2,1,4,25,5,0,6,3,7,52;SS;"  
80 LPRINT "LBLaser printer*"  
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
110 END  
<Sample 51>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
DT - Define label terminator  
DT [ c [, m ]] [;]  
c : Character  
m : mode  
·
·
This command allows you to specify the character that terminates strings printed with the LB instruction.  
The character immediately following DT is taken to be the terminator. Hence, do not put a space between  
the DT and your chosen character. If you do, space will be interpreted as the terminator in all subsequent  
LB commands.  
·
m, the mode, determines whether the terminating character is printed as part of the label or not. If m = 0 the  
character is printed ; if m = 1 it is not.  
·
·
·
If you do not specify a value for m the terminating character is not printed.  
If you leave out the character parameter the default character ETX (ASCII 3 ) is used as the terminator.  
This setting is effective until the another DT is invoked or IN or DF is performed.  
10 REM - Define Label Terminator -  
20 WIDTH "LPT:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP2;";  
60 LPRINT "IN;SP2;SC0,5000,0,5000;"  
70 LPRINT "PA0,4500;LBDefault control character ETX"; CHR$(13);CHR$(3);  
80 LPRINT "LBterminates by performing end-"; CHR$(13);CHR$(3);  
90 LPRINT "LBof-text function.";CHR$(3);  
100 LPRINT "PA0,3500;DT@;LBPrinting characters terminate,"; CHR$(13);  
"@";  
110 LPRINT "LBbut are also printed.@";  
120 LPRINT "PA0,3000;DT"; CHR$(7); "LBcontrol characters terminate";  
CHR$(13);chr(7);  
130 LPRINT "LBand perform their function."; CHR$(7)  
140 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%01";  
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
160 END  
<Sample 52>  
LO - Label origin  
LO [ p ] [;]  
·
·
This instruction allows you to position labels in different ways relative to the current pen location.  
You can centre, left justify or right justify labels relative to the current pen location and print them on,  
above or below the current location.  
·
·
You can combine an offset distance, equal to 25% of the current font's point size, with any of the above  
origin positions.  
p must either be in the range 1 - 9, 11 - 10 and 21. The label origin position specified by each p parameter  
value is shown below. 21 sets the label origin to the same one in PCL.  
P=1  
P=2  
P=3  
P=4  
P=5  
P=6  
P=7  
P=8  
P=9  
P=11  
P=12  
P=13  
P=14  
P=15  
P=16  
P=17  
P=18  
P=19  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
When you use an LO instruction the carriage return point is set to be the new label origin. To send the pen  
back to a label's origin when you have finished printing it, include a carriage return between the last character  
of the label and the terminating character.  
·
·
·
If a label contains embedded carriage returns, each character string following a carriage return is printed  
starting from the label origin.  
If you omit the parameter the label origin is the bottom left hand corner of the first character's character cell -  
equivalent to LO11;.  
The command remains in effect until the printer is initialized with an IN command, until the default  
conditions are restored with the DF command or until another LO command is used.  
10 '-Label Origin-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP;";  
60 LPRINT "SC-4000,4000,-5000,5000;SI0.17,0.26;"  
70 LPRINT "PA0,500;PD-500,0,0,-500,500,0,0,500;DT#;"  
80 LPRINT "CI10;LO4;LBCentred on point#"  
90 LPRINT "PU-500,0;CI10;LO18;LBleft centre offset#"  
100 LPRINT "PU0,-500;CI10;LO13;LBRight offset from point#"  
110 LPRINT "PA500,0;CI10;LO3;LBright hang from point#"  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
140 END  
<Sample 53>  
DI - Absolute direction  
DI [ run, rise ] [;]  
run : X direction component rise : Y direction component  
·
This command determines the direction in which subsequent labels will be printed.  
rise  
run  
·
·
gives the tangent of the angle between the base line of a label's characters and the horizontal.  
run is equivalent to cos q and rise is equivalent to sin q.  
sin q  
tan  
q=  
rise  
cosq  
q
run  
·
·
·
·
Values for run and rise are clamped real numbers.  
When you issue a DI instruction the carriage return point is set to the current pen location.  
The instruction is ignored if run and rise are both 0.  
Any text path that you set with the DV instruction will combine with the current printing direction to  
determine the layout of characters on the page.  
·
·
If you omit the parameters the printing direction is horizontal.  
The label direction which is specified by this command is not affected by changes in the location of P1 and  
P2.  
10 ' -Absolute Direction -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 DEG = -45  
70 RAD = 3.1416 / 180 * DEG  
80 LPRINT "IN;SP2;PA3050,4450;"  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
90 LPRINT "DT";"  
100 LPRINT "DT0,2;LB_*_1988#"; "DI2,2;LB_*_1989#";  
110 LPRINT "DT2,0;LB_*_1990#"; "DI2,-2;LB_*_1991#";  
120 LPRINT "DT0,-2;LB_*_1992#"; "DI-2,-2;LB_*_1993#";  
130 LPRINT "DT-2,0;LB_*_1994#"; "DI-2,2;LB_*_1995#";  
140 LPRINT "PA3500,5350;DI", COS(0),SIN(0); "LB_*_2000"; CHR$(13); "#";  
150 LPRINT "DI", COS(RAD); SIN(RAD); "LB_RETURN POINT"; CHR$(13); "#";  
160 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
170 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
180 END  
<sample 54>  
DR - Relative direction  
DR [ run, rise ] [;]  
run : X-component of the printing direction expressed as a percentage of the x-component of the distance  
between P1 and P2.  
rise : Y-component of the printing direction expressed as a percentage of the y-component of the distance  
between P1 and P2.  
·
·
·
·
·
This command determines the direction in which subsequent labels will be printed.  
Values for run and rise are clamped real numbers.  
The instruction is ignored if run and rise are both 0.  
When you issue a DR instruction the carriage return point is set to the current pen location.  
Any text path that you set with the DV instruction will combine with the current printing direction to  
determine the layout of characters on the page.  
·
·
·
If you change the positions of P1 and P2 the printing direction will change accordingly.  
If you omit the parameters the printing direction is horizontal and the run = 1% of |P2X-P1X|.  
Actual values for run and rise are changed relative to the P1 and P2 value. It is calculated as below:  
actual run = run parameter ÷ 100 x (P2x - P1x)  
actual rise = rise parameter ÷ 100 x (P2y - P1y)  
(0, 100)  
(100, 100)  
(0,60)  
rise = 60%  
q
(70,0)  
(0, 100)  
run=70%  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
DV - Define variable text path  
DV [ path [,line]] [;]  
path : text printing path - horizontal or vertical, and left to right, right to left, upwards or downwards.  
line: the effect of a line feed.  
·
·
This command determines the printing direction for labels and the carriage return point.  
Permissible values of path are 0, 1, 2 and 3. If path = 0 labels are printed horizontally and left to right -  
normal printing. If path = 1 labels are printed vertically downwards - characters appear in a vertical  
column. If path = 2 labels are printed horizontally and right to left - words appear backwards. If path =  
3 labels are printed vertically upwards - characters appear in a vertical column, reading from bottom to  
top.  
·
The value of line must be either 0 or 1. If line = 0, each time a line feed is encountered the current pen  
position is moved at an angle of 90° to the path in a clockwise direction. Hence, if path = 1 the second  
line of text is printed to the left of the first line. If line = 1 each time a line feed is encountered the  
current pen position is moved at an angle of 90° to the path in an anticlockwise direction. Hence, if  
path = 2 the second line of text is printed below the first line.  
·
·
If you do not use a DV command the default text path is horizontal, left to right: line feeds will move the  
pen position at 90° to the text clockwise. This is equivalent to using the command DV0,0;  
If you omit both parameters the text path is horizontal, left to right.  
CP - Relative character movement  
CP [ spaces [,lines]] [;]  
spaces ; the number of text spaces the pen position is moved.  
lines ; the number of text lines the pen position is moved.  
·
Use this command to re-position the pen. The command moves the pen the specified number of lines  
and spaces corresponding to the currently selected font's pitch and line spacing. (For proportionally  
spaced fonts the width of the space character is used to determine the distance moved horizontally). All  
movement is relative to the current label printing direction.  
·
·
spaces is the number of spaces that the pen moves. A positive value of spaces moves the pen right  
from the current pen location: a negative value moves it to the left.  
lines is the number of lines that the pen moves. A negative value offset moves the pen down from the  
current pen location: a positive value moves it upwards.  
·
·
Values for spaces and lines are clamped real numbers.  
The command only moves the pen and does not draw lines, irrespective of whether the pen is currently  
up or down.  
·
·
On completion of the command, the previous pen status (up or down) is restored.  
The height of text lines (the vertical distance that a line feed moves the pen position) is fixed for every  
font. However, it can be adjusted using the ES instruction.  
·
If you omit all parameters, the pen position moves to the carriage return point and then down one line -  
hence CP; is equivalent to a carriage return followed by a line feed.  
10 '-Character Plot -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA1000,5000;";  
70 LPRINT "PD;PR2000,0;PU;";  
80 LPRINT "CP-15,1;";  
90 LPRINT "LBAbove the line"; CHR$(3);  
100 LPRINT "CP-14,-2;";  
110 LPRINT "LBBelow the line"; CHR$(3);  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
140 END  
<Sample 55>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CF - Character fill mode  
CF [ fill [, pen ]] [;]  
fill : the fill pattern used to fill characters  
pen : the pen used to edge characters  
·
·
This command determines how characters are edged and filled.  
Only scalable fonts can be both filled and edged - bitmap fonts and the stick font cannot be edged and  
can only be filled with raster fill, shading or PCL cross-hatch patterns. Scalable characters can be filled  
with any pattern specified by the FT command.  
·
·
Permissible values of fill are 0, 1, 2 and 3. If fill = 0 characters are filled with a solid fill and edged. If  
fill = 1 characters are edged but not filled. (Bitmap characters and stick font characters are filled as they  
cannot be edged.) If fill = 2 characters are filled using the current fill type, but not edged. If fill = 3  
characters are filled, using the current fill type and edged.  
pen can be either 0 or 1. A value of 0 specifies the edging pen to be white; a value of 1 selects the  
black pen for edging. If no pen is specified in the instruction the current pen, as selected with the SP  
command, is used.  
·
·
·
·
·
The width of the edging pen is proportional to the character's point size.  
The fill line width used for cross hatch patterns is set with the PW command.  
If you omit both parameters solid fill and the white edging pen are selected - this is equivalent to CF0.0;  
If the command is not used all characters are solid and unedged.  
A CF command remains in effect until an IN command is used to initialize the printer, a DF command is  
used to restore the default settings or another CF command is invoked.  
10 '-Character Fill Mode -  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "SD1,21,2,1,4,140,5,0,6,3,7,52;SS;"  
70 LPRINT "PA1000,3000;DT*;FT3,50,45;"  
80 LPRINT "CF1,1;LBA*;"  
90 LPRINT "PW0.1;CF3,1;LBB*;"  
100 LPRINT "PW0.5;LBC*;"  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
130 END  
<sample 56>  
SI - Set absolute character size  
SI [ width, height ] [;]  
width : the width in centimeters of printed characters  
height : the height in centimeters of printed characters  
·
·
·
This command allows you to specify the size of the characters that you print with the LB instruction in  
centimeters.  
width specifies character width and is a clamped real number. Negative values of width produce right-to-left  
mirror image characters.  
height specifies the height of a capital letter and is a clamped real number. Negative values of height  
produce upside-down mirror image characters.  
·
·
·
If you change character size, the line width used to draw stick font characters may also change.  
If you omit the parameters, the character size is as specified by the most recent SD or AD command.  
If an SB1; command has previously been issued, printed characters may not be exactly the size that you  
specify.  
·
If an SB1; command has been issued, specifying a negative value will not produce mirror image characters.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10 ' -Absolute Character Size-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "PA700,3000;DT#;LBPrinter#"  
70 LPRINT "PA700,2000;SI0.75,1;LBPrinter#"  
80 LPRINT "SI;SD1,21,2,1,3,12,5,0,6,0,7,52;SS;"  
90 LPRINT "PA40003000;LBPrinter#"  
100 LPRINT "PA4000,2000;SI1,1.5;LBPrinter#"  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
130 END  
<Sample 57>  
SR - Set relative character size  
SR [ width, height ] [;]  
width ; the width of printed characters expressed as a percentage of the x-component of the distance between  
P1 and P2.  
height ; the height of printed characters expressed as a percentage of the y-component of the distance  
between P1 and P2.  
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to specify the size of the character that you print with the LB instruction  
relative to the scaling points P1 and P2.  
width sets the character width to a percentage of |P2x-P1x| and is a clamped real number. Negative  
values of width produce right-to-left mirror image characters  
height sets the character height to a percentage of |P2y-P2y| and is a clamped real number. Negative  
values of height produce upside-down mirror image character.  
If you change the positions of P1 and P2, the character size will change unless the scaling points remain  
in the same relative positions.  
·
·
·
If you move P2 to the left of, or below P1, characters will appear in mirror image.  
If you change the character size, the line width used to draw stick font characters may also change.  
If you omit the parameters, the character size is as specified by the most recent SD or AD command.  
10 '-Relative Character Size-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "IP2000,2000,6500,6500;DT@;"  
70 LPRINT "SR;PA0,2700;LBRELATIVE LABEL SIZE@"  
80 LPRINT "IP0,0,5500,5500;PA0,2000;"  
90 LPRINT "LBNEW P1 AND P2 CHANGE LABEL SIZE@"  
100 LPRINT "PA0,1000;SR2.5;LBNEW SR INSTRUCTION`;CP;"  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
140 END  
<Sample 58>  
SL - Character slant  
SL [ tan f ] [;]  
tan f - tangent of character slant angle (f)  
·
·
This command determines the slant of characters printed with subsequent LB commands.  
f is the angle between characters and the vertical. A positive value of f ( and tan f ) produces forward  
sloping characters, while a negative value results in characters which slant backwards.  
·
·
·
Values of tan f are clamped real numbers.  
A value of 0 for tan f results in upright characters.  
If you omit the parameter, tan f is take to be 0 and any characters printed will be upright.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10 ' -Character Slant-  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27; "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;";  
60 LPRINT "SD1,21,2,1,4,25,5,0,6,0,7,5;SI0.7,1;"  
70 LPRINT "PA1000,1000;DT#,1;SL0.36,LBPrinter#"  
80 LPRINT "PA1000,300;SL-0.36;LBPrinter#"  
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
100 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
110 END  
<Sample 59>  
SB - Scalable or bitmap fonts  
SB [ n ] [;]  
n : font category selection  
·
·
This command enables you to restrict the range of selectable fonts to scalable fonts and the stick font only.  
n can be 0 or 1. If n = 0 you may only select scalable fonts (or the stick font). If n = 1 you may select any  
type of font.  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
An SB command can alter the current standard and alternate font selections.  
Setting n to 1 allows the selection of bitmapped fonts and has the following side-effects:  
Bitmap characters cannot be edged.  
Bitmap characters can only be printed in orientations of 0°, 90°, 180° or 270°.  
The SL (character slant) command is not applied to bitmap fonts.  
Bitmap font character sizes are approximate only.  
The DF and IN commands set n to 0, - only scalable fonts and the stick fonts may be selected.  
The FI and FN commands implicitly set n to 1 if you use either of them to select a bitmap font.  
If you omit n from the command, only scalable fonts and the stick font may be selected. This is equivalent  
to an SB0; command.  
·
The default setting is scalable fonts and stick font only.  
ES - Extra space  
ES [ width [,height]] [;]  
width : factor by which character spacing is changed.  
height : factor by which line spacing is changed  
·
·
This command enables you to adjust the space between label characters and lines.  
width specifies the factor by which to increase or decrease the character spacing. Positive numbers specify  
an increase and negative numbers a decrease.  
·
·
·
height specifies the factor by which to increase or decrease the line spacing. Positive numbers specify an  
increase and negative numbers a decrease.  
If you use the command without parameters, no extra space is used when labels are printed. This is  
equivalent to ES0,0;  
An ES command remains in effect until another ES command is executed, a DF or IN command is executed or  
the printer is reset, either with the EscE command or from the control panel.  
TD - Transparent data  
TD [ mode ] [;]  
mode : normal or transparent data mode.  
·
This command enables you to specify whether control characters should perform their normal function or  
should be printed.  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
mode is set to either 0 or 1. If mode is set to 0, control codes perform their normal functions and are  
not printed. If mode=1, all characters are printed, if possible. No control characters perform any  
function except the label terminator. Any non-printing or undefined characters appear as a space.  
If you use the command without parameters, control codes will perform their normal functions and will  
not be printed. This is equivalent to TD0;  
10 '-Transparent Data-  
20 WIDTH "LPT:", 255  
30 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0B";  
50 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"  
60 '-TD=1 (Transparent) -  
70 LPRINT "PA1000,5000;LBMODE : TD1 (Transparent)"; CHR$(13)  
80 LPRINT "<Print as characters when labeling>"; CHR$(3)  
90 X=1000  
100 FOR I = &H0 O &H8  
110 LPRINT "SD1,341,2,1,4,10,7,5;PA";X;",4000;TD1;DT@;LB";CHR$(I);"@";  
120 X = X + 150  
130 NEXT I  
140 LPRINT "TD0;"  
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "%0A";  
160 LPRINT CHR$(27); "E";  
170 END  
<Sample 60>  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
8.  
INDEX  
graphics window............................................................ 7, 10, 11  
A
H
Absolute arc three point .........................................................21  
absolute commands ...................................................................8  
Absolute direction ...................................................................45  
Anchor corner...........................................................................30  
anchor point................................................................................7  
hard clip limits............................................................................. 7  
I
image plots ................................................................................ 11  
Initialize command.................................................................... 12  
Initialize set instruction........................................................... 13  
Input relative scaling points................................................... 14  
Input scaling point................................................................... 14  
B
Bezier absolute..........................................................................24  
Bezier relative............................................................................24  
C
L
Character fill mode....................................................................48  
Character plot............................................................................43  
Character slant..........................................................................49  
Circle plot...................................................................................23  
current units ................................................................................7  
Label origin ............................................................................... 44  
Line attribute............................................................................. 32  
Line type selection................................................................... 33  
M
mnemonic .................................................................................... 9  
D
Default set instruction.............................................................12  
Define alternate font ................................................................42  
Define label terminator.............................................................44  
Define standard font................................................................39  
Define variable text path..........................................................47  
Draw absolute arc.....................................................................20  
Draw relative arc .......................................................................21  
P
parameters ................................................................................... 9  
pen................................................................................................ 7  
Pen down................................................................................... 18  
Pen up........................................................................................ 18  
Pen width................................................................................... 34  
Plot absolute............................................................................. 19  
Polygon mode........................................................................... 25  
Polyline encoded...................................................................... 22  
printer frame ................................................................................ 7  
E
Edge polygon............................................................................26  
Edge rectangle absolute..........................................................25  
Edge rectangle relative ............................................................26  
Edge wedge...............................................................................26  
Extra space.................................................................................50  
R
Raster rill definition.................................................................. 34  
Relative arc three point ........................................................... 22  
Relative character movement ................................................. 47  
relative commands ..................................................................... 8  
Relative coordinate pen move................................................ 19  
Relative direction ..................................................................... 46  
Rotate coordinate system....................................................... 17  
F
fill commands ..............................................................................8  
Fill polygon ...............................................................................29  
Fill rectangle absolute..............................................................27  
Fill rectangle relative................................................................28  
Fill type ......................................................................................31  
Fill wedge...................................................................................28  
S
Scalable or bitmap fonts.......................................................... 50  
Scale ........................................................................................... 15  
scaling point ............................................................................. 10  
Screened vectors...................................................................... 35  
G
graphic units ...............................................................................7  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Select alternate font .................................................................42  
Select pen ..................................................................................35  
Select primary font ...................................................................43  
Select secondary font..............................................................43  
Select standard font.................................................................42  
Select unit for pen width .........................................................37  
separators ....................................................................................9  
Set absolute character size......................................................48  
Set relative character size ........................................................49  
soft clip limits ..............................................................................7  
Symbol mode.............................................................................35  
syntax...........................................................................................9  
T
terminator.....................................................................................9  
Transparency mode .................................................................36  
Transparent data ......................................................................50  
U
user units .....................................................................................7  
User-defined line type .............................................................37  
W
Window.....................................................................................17  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 4 HP-GL/2 - 56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 5  
PJL  
PRINTER JOB LANGUAGE  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................4  
1.1. About PJL............................................................................................................................................4  
1.2. In Case of Using PJL with a Non-PJL Printer.....................................................................................5  
1.2.1. PCL jobs......................................................................................................................................... 5  
1.2.2. Postscript jobs ................................................................................................................................ 5  
1.2.3. Other printer languages .................................................................................................................... 5  
1.3. PJL Syntax and Format ......................................................................................................................6  
1.4. Variables .............................................................................................................................................7  
1.4.1. Alphanumeric variables..................................................................................................................... 7  
1.4.2. Numeric variables............................................................................................................................. 7  
1.4.3. Strings............................................................................................................................................ 7  
1.5. Invalid Commands ..............................................................................................................................7  
1.5.1. Syntax errors................................................................................................................................... 7  
1.5.2. Syntax warning and semantic warning ............................................................................................... 7  
2. HOW TO USE PJL.................................................................................................................................8  
2.1. Overview .............................................................................................................................................8  
2.2. PJL Job Requirement .........................................................................................................................8  
3. COMMAND GROUP..............................................................................................................................9  
4. KERNEL COMMANDS...................................................................................................................... 10  
4.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................10  
4.2. UEL Command.................................................................................................................................10  
4.3. EXECUTE Command.......................................................................................................................10  
4.4. ENTER Command............................................................................................................................11  
4.5. COMMENT Command......................................................................................................................11  
4.6. Printer Language Switching..............................................................................................................12  
4.6.1. Explicit switching........................................................................................................................... 12  
4.6.2. Implicit switching ........................................................................................................................... 12  
4.6.3. Context switching .......................................................................................................................... 12  
5. JOB SEPARATION COMMANDS.................................................................................................... 13  
5.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................13  
5.2. JOB Command.................................................................................................................................13  
5.3. EOJ Command.................................................................................................................................14  
6. ENVIRONMENT COMMANDS......................................................................................................... 15  
6.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................15  
6.1.1. Print environment ........................................................................................................................... 15  
6.1.2. PJL reset conditions....................................................................................................................... 16  
6.1.3. Remember these points about environments..................................................................................... 16  
6.1.4. PJL environment variables............................................................................................................... 17  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.2. Variables ...........................................................................................................................................18  
6.2.1. Variables for HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500 .............................................................. 18  
6.2.2. Variables for HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN......................................................................... 31  
6.3. Default Command.............................................................................................................................35  
6.4. Initialize Command ...........................................................................................................................35  
6.5. Reset Command ..............................................................................................................................36  
6.6. Set Command...................................................................................................................................36  
7. STATUS READBACK COMMANDS............................................................................................... 38  
7.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................38  
7.1.1. Synchronization with the printer....................................................................................................... 38  
7.1.2. Basic format of status readback responses ...................................................................................... 38  
7.2. Inquire Command .............................................................................................................................39  
7.3. DINQUIRE Command.......................................................................................................................40  
7.4. ECHO Command .............................................................................................................................41  
7.5. INFO Command................................................................................................................................42  
7.5.1. ID category.................................................................................................................................... 43  
7.5.2. CONFIG category .......................................................................................................................... 43  
7.5.3. MEMORY category........................................................................................................................ 46  
7.5.4. STATUS category .......................................................................................................................... 47  
7.5.5. VARIABLES category .................................................................................................................... 47  
7.5.6. USTATUS category........................................................................................................................ 49  
7.6. USTATUS Command .......................................................................................................................50  
7.6.1. Device variable............................................................................................................................... 51  
7.6.2. JOB variables ................................................................................................................................ 52  
7.6.3. PAGE variable............................................................................................................................... 53  
7.6.4. TIMED variable............................................................................................................................... 53  
7.7. USTATUSOFF Command................................................................................................................54  
7.8. JOB Recovery...................................................................................................................................54  
8. DEVICE ATTENDANCE COMMANDS........................................................................................... 55  
8.1. Introduction........................................................................................................................................55  
8.2. RDYMSG Command ........................................................................................................................55  
8.3. OPMSG Command...........................................................................................................................56  
8.4. STMSG Command ...........................................................................................................................56  
9. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 58  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
INTRODUCTION  
1.1. About PJL  
Printer Job Language(PJL) provides job status control by sending the printer status information to the  
application. PJL can be a valuable tool for the single-user environment, but is a much more useful tool for the  
networking / sharing environment.  
PJL  
Emulations ( BR-Script,  
PCL, IBM, EPSON etc... )  
Printer  
PJL allows job-level control that cannot be accomplished with PCL, Postscript or other emulations. PJL  
includes five major features.  
(1)  
Printer language switching  
With PJL, it is possible to switch positively between the printer languages such as PCL, Postscript, Epson,  
IBM and Diablo directly from applications.  
(2)  
Printer status readback  
PJL can provide information such as printer model, configuration, printer feature setting, error information and  
other status information to the application.  
(3)  
Front panel control  
PJL can remotely control the printer's control panel settings and messages.  
(4)  
Easy of utilization  
All PJL commands except the UEL command have a user-friendly construction using printable characters and  
English words.  
(5)  
Spooler control  
PJL provides an improved spooler which can manage the printer better, particularly in a network environment.  
Note :  
The commands for Printer status readback or Front panel control can be invoked in modes other than PCL  
or BR-Script. However, the commands for printer status readback get the information from PCL or BR-  
Script and the commands for front panel control perform the settings for PCL or BR-Script.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.2. In Case of Using PJL with a Non-PJL Printer  
Our recent printer models support PJL, however, earlier models do not . If the PJL commands are sent to a  
non-PJL printer, the printer acts as follows;  
1.2.1. PCL jobs  
For a PCL printer which does not support the PJL language, the PJL command is printed as ASCII text until  
initial PCL printer reset command (<ESC>E) is received. After receiving the PCL reset command, the printer  
ejects the page and proceeds with the PCL print job on a new page.  
The print job is possibly followed by more printed PJL commands.  
Without the PCL reset command, the PJL commands are printed as ASCII text on the same page as the PCL  
print job.  
1.2.2. Postscript jobs  
For Postscript printers, when the printer receives a PJL command, a Postscript error is reported. The  
Postscript job is discarded.  
1.2.3. Other printer languages  
According to the active emulation, the PJL command is understood differently. To avoid the problem, you  
should not use PJL commands on any non-PJL printer.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.3. PJL Syntax and Format  
Syntax  
<For Example>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = emulation [<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL  
PJL Prefix  
ENTER  
Command name  
Option name  
LANGUAGE  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE  
[ ]  
Enter this portion verbatim  
The words in brackets [ ... ] indicates optional parameters. You should not  
type the brackets themselves in the command.  
< .. >  
<LF>  
The words in < .. > indicates a control code character  
Required line feed  
< HT >  
< LF >  
< CR >  
< SP >  
< ESC >  
< FF >  
< WS >  
Horizontal tab character (ASCII 9)  
Line feed character ( ASCII 10 )  
Carriage Return ( ASCII 13 )  
Space ( ASCII 32 )  
Escape ( ASCII 27 )  
Form Feed ( ASCII 12 )  
White space which consists of some < SP >  
and < HT >  
< words >  
Printable characters  
Format  
PJL commands have 4 types of formats as shown below.  
Format 1 <ESC>%-12345X  
This format is only used for the Universal Exit Language(UEL) command.  
Format 2 @PJL[<CR>]<LF>  
This format allows a PJL line without a command, and is used to break several PJL command lines visually, to  
make it easier to see the PJL command lines.  
Format 3 @PJL command [<words>] [<CR>] <LF>  
This format is used only for the COMMENT and ECHO commands.  
Format 4 @PJL command [command modifier : value]  
option=value[<CR>]<LF>  
This format is used for all other PJL commands.  
PJL Syntax Rules:  
PJL Syntax should be written according to the following rules.  
·
·
"@PJL" must be uppercase. The other words of a PJL command are not case-sensitive.  
Spacing between characters consists of one or more of either the space character (ASCII 32) or the  
horizontal tab character(ASCII 9).  
·
White space should be placed as follows, depending on the location within the command.  
w
White space must be placed between @PJL and the PJL command name and between the PJL command  
and command modifiers.  
w
w
If a white space is placed in any other place in a command, it is optional.  
If a white space is not placed between two portions of a command, the command is not valid.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.4. Variables  
PJL can use alphanumeric variables, numeric variabless and strings.  
1.4.1. Alphanumeric variables  
The first character must always be a character in the allowable range of letters and digits. Letters consists  
of the uppercase characters (ASCII 65-90) and lowercase characters (ASCII 97-122). Digits consists of the  
numbers 0-9 (ASCII 48-57).  
<Example>  
Brother2245  
1.4.2. Numeric variables  
The number consists of digits with one optional decimal point and an optional + or - sign preceding the  
first digit.  
<Example>  
0.1234  
<Wrong>  
-123.4  
+123.0  
+.05  
-.05  
1.4.3. Strings  
Strings consist of any combination of characters from ASCII 32 to 255, plus ASCII 9, except ASCII 34  
(quotation marks), which are used to define the start and end of a string.  
<Example>  
"Print Job KKK"  
"This is a sample string"  
1.5. Invalid Commands  
There are two general types of invalid commands. Each type operates differently.  
Syntax errors include :  
· unrecognized command and command modifier  
· strings which are missing quotation marks  
· numeric values which are missing digits before the decimal point  
1.5.1. Syntax errors  
Commands received with Syntax errors cause the printer to ignore the entire PJL command.  
1.5.2. Syntax warning and semantic warning  
Syntax warnings and semantic warnings are issued for commands which include unsupported options, values  
which are out of range, or wrong or missing commands, etc. When the printer receives commands which  
would create a syntax warning or semantic warning, it operates the command as long as possible, however,  
the portion of the command which would create a warning is ignored.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
HOW TO USE PJL  
2.1. Overview  
PJL resides "above" printer languages such as Postscript and PCL. Each job can be distinguished from the  
other jobs by PJL, and it can switch between PJL commands and printer language commands for each job.  
PJL Code  
PCL Job  
PJL Code  
Postscript Job  
PJL Code  
2.2. PJL Job Requirement  
Some conditions are required in order for PJL commands to work correctly. Jobs which follow these  
conditions will work correctly with a PJL printer in both single user and network environments.  
·
·
All PJL jobs must begin and end with a UEL command.  
The @PJL prefix must be placed immediately after the UEL command which starts PJL jobs, and can be  
followed by <CR> and <LF>. Characters, including control characters, must not be placed between the UEL  
command and the @PJL prefix.  
·
·
Nothing must be placed after the UEL command which ends a PJL job.  
<LF> is required to terminate all PJL commands. <CR> can be placed before <LF>, however, <CR> is  
optional and is ignored.  
·
Blank lines must not exist. If a blank line is required, the @PJL <CR><LF> line can be used.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
COMMAND GROUP  
Command Group  
Command  
Command Description  
Kernel Commands  
UEL  
Exits current printer language and returns control  
to PJL.  
EXECUTE  
Orders the printer to execute the specified  
operation.  
SUPERUSER  
SUPERUSEROFF  
WNVRAM  
Moves to the SUPERUSER mode.  
Exit from the SUPERUSER mode.  
Write the specified data to the specified address  
of the printer’s NVRAM.  
RNVRAM  
Retrieve the data from the specified address of the  
printer’s NVRAM.  
COMMENT  
ENTER  
JOB  
Comments can be placed in the command line  
Selects a printer language  
Informs printer of job start  
Job Separation  
Commands  
EOJ  
DEFAULT  
Informs printer of job end  
Sets default value  
Environment  
Commands  
SET  
Sets an environment value which is available  
during a PJL job  
INITIALIZE  
Resets the current and default PJL variables to  
factory values  
RESET  
INQUIRE  
Resets current PJL variables to default values  
Requests the current value for a specified  
environment  
Status Readback  
Commands  
DINQUIRE  
Requests the default value for a specified  
environment  
ECHO  
INFO  
USTATUS  
Returns the <words> to the host computer  
Requests a specified category.  
Allows the printer to send unsolicited status  
information  
USTATUSOFF  
RDYMSG  
OPMSG  
Stops the printer sending all unsolicited status  
information  
Replaces the READY message on the control  
panel  
Displays altered message on the control panel and  
takes the printer off-line  
Device Attendance  
Commands  
STMSG  
Displays altered message on the control panel and  
takes the printer off-line. If status readback is  
enabled, returns name of the key.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
KERNEL COMMANDS  
4.1. Introduction  
This section explains three PJL command, UEL, ENTER and COMMENT. These commands provide the  
minimum set of tools to operate job control.  
UEL command (Universal Exit Command)  
ENTER command  
COMMENT command  
4.2. UEL Command  
The Universal Exit Command causes the printer to exit the current printer language and sets the printer into  
PJL mode.  
Syntax  
<ESC>%-12345X  
·
·
The UEL command is a data stream sequence.  
The UEL command indicates to the current printer language to finish a job. If PJL is available, PJL commands  
which have not yet been executed are cancelled and the printer is ready to accept the next PJL command.  
·
·
The UEL command must be placed in the first and last position of all PJL job command sequences.  
Printers which have an Automatic I/O switching feature can use the UEL command in order to set job  
boundaries.  
·
·
·
The @PJL prefix which is placed at the beginning of a PJL job must follow immediately after the UEL  
command .  
If the printer receives codes other than the PJL prefix, it enables the default printer language and prints the  
job.  
ENTER command should be used in order to specify the printer language.  
Example  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC>E.......PCL JOB........<ESC>E  
<ESC>%-12345X  
4.3. EXECUTE Command  
The EXECUTE command orders the printer to execute the specified operation.  
This command is supported only by HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500 printers.  
Syntax  
@PJL ENTER operation [<CR>]<LF>  
Parameters  
·
operation  
SHUTDOWN : The printer goes into sleep mode.  
DEMOPAGE :  
RESIFONT :  
PERMFONT:  
PRTCONFIG:  
The printer prints the demo page.  
The printer prints the list of resident fonts.  
The printer prints the list of permanent download fonts.  
The printer prints the list of printer settings.  
·
·
If the printer receives this command, it immediately executes the specified operation.  
If this command specifies an operation which is not supported, this command is ignored.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Example  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL EXECUTE DEMOPAGE <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
4.4. ENTER Command  
The ENTER command specifies which emulation the printer uses to print data.  
Syntax  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = emulation [<CR>]<LF>  
Parameters  
·
emulation  
The variables depend on the printer model.  
·
·
·
The ENTER command must be placed immediately before print data.  
The specified emulation will be used immediately after the terminating <LF> of the ENTER command.  
If the printer does not receive the ENTER command, it uses the default printer language which is set by the  
control panel or the printer language which is set by the SET PERSONALITY command.  
·
·
When a printer emulation is selected by the ENTER command, the printer must switch to the defined printer  
language.  
If this command specifies an emulation which is not supported, data after this command is ignored until the  
next UEL command.  
Example  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC>E.......PCL JOB........<ESC>E  
<ESC>%-12345X  
@PJL COMMENT Start of Postscript job <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = POSTSCRIPT <CR><LF>  
%!PS-ADOBE......Postscript JOB.....^D  
<ESC>%-12345X  
@PJL COMMENT End of Postscript job <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
4.5. COMMENT Command  
The COMMENT command is used to add an information line, such as an explanation for the PJL command.  
Syntax  
@PJL COMMENT remarks [<CR>]<LF>  
Parameters  
·
remarks  
Printable characters (ASCII 33-255) and White space which contains <HT> and <SP>)  
·
·
The COMMENT command is helpful for placing an explanation of a PJL command.  
The COMMENT command can be placed on the PJL line anywhere between the UEL command and the  
ENTER command.  
·
·
The COMMENT command is terminated by <LF>.  
Comments can only be one line long. If you wish to add more text, start a new comment line.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Example  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT -----------------------------<CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT -- PCL & PS JOB --<CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT -----------------------------<CR><LF>  
@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL SET RET = ON <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC>E.......PCL JOB........<ESC>E  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT Start of Postscript job <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = POSTSCRIPT <CR><LF>  
%!PS-ADOBE......Postscript JOB.....^D  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT End of Postscript job <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
4.6. Printer Language Switching  
There are three methods of switching printer languages.  
4.6.1. Explicit switching  
Explicit switching means the method which uses the PJL ENTER LANGUAGE command to switch to the  
desired emulation. As the desired emulation is explicitly specified, this method is the most reliable.  
4.6.2. Implicit switching  
If a default printer language is configured, and the PJL ENTER command is not described on a PJL line, the  
printer uses the default printer emulation. This may not always select your desired emulation.  
4.6.3. Context switching  
If the printer is set to 'automatic emulation selection' and the PJL ENTER command is not described in the PJL  
command, the printer investigates the incoming data and decides the required printer emulation. The printer  
can select the printer language by this switching, however, the PJL ENTER command is recommended to  
select the printer language accurately.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.  
JOB SEPARATION COMMANDS  
5.1. Introduction  
This section explains two PJL command, JOB and EOJ. These commands are used to determine the  
boundaries of a job. When these commands are used with status readback, the printer also can send status  
information at the beginning and end of each job.  
5.2. JOB Command  
The JOB Command sends information at the start of a PJL job to the printer and aligns the job with the page  
status information. It also specifies which pages of a job are to be printed.  
Note:  
JOB and EOJ command are always used in pairs. You must not use one without the other.  
Syntax  
@PJL JOB [NAME = "job name"][START = first page] [END = last page]  
[PASSWORD = "password"][<CR>]<LF>  
·
·
·
NAME = "job name"  
This option NAME describes the print job as a job name. Printable characters (ASCII 33-255) and spaces or  
horizontal tab characters can be used for the job name. It can contain 80 characters max. and must be  
enclosed in double quotes. If the NAME option is set, the job name is included in the unsolicited job.  
START = first page  
This option START is used to provide a non-printing mode. You can specify from which page printing is to  
start. If the START option is not set, the printer starts printing at the beginning of the job.  
first page = 1 to 2,147,483,647 Default value = 1  
END = last page  
The END option indicates the page number of the last page to be printed. If the END option is not set, the  
printer prints to the end of the job. If the end of job is encountered before the START page, no pages are  
printed. If the end of job is encountered before the END page, printing terminates.  
last page = 1 to 2,147,483,647 Default value = prints entire job  
·
PASSWORD = password ( HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN only )  
When the password is set by the DEFAULT command, modifying the NVRAM by using the DEFAULT or  
INITIALIZE commands is locked with the password. Sending the correct password with this command can  
unlock this until the EOJ command is executed.  
password = 0 to 65,535 Default value = 0  
When the printer receives the JOB command, the UEL command is not recognized as a job boundary until an  
EOJ command is received.  
·
If the UEL command is placed between the PJL JOB and EOJ commands, it is handled as a printer language  
reset. In this case, UEL resets the printer environment to the PJL Current environment, not to the User  
Default Environment.  
·
·
If your application supports status readback capabilities, you can monitor the job status by the USTATUS  
command with the JOB option.  
If job status is available and a JOB command is received, the printer returns a job status message.  
Note:  
Resetting the page count according to unsolicited page status information does not affect the current page.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Example  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL JOB NAME = "KKK data from spooler" <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT Postscript Job <CR><LF>  
@PJL JOB NAME = "YYY data from spooler 2" <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = POSTSCRIPT <CR><LF>  
%!PS.......PS JOB........^D  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of YYY data" <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC>E.........PCL JOB........<ESC>E  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of KKK" <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
5.3. EOJ Command  
The EOJ command indicates to the printer that the job is completed. You must use this command whenever  
you use the JOB command.  
Note:  
JOB and EOJ command always are used in pairs. You must not use one without the other.  
Syntax  
@PJL EOJ [NAME = "job name"] [<CR>]<LF>  
·
NAME = "job name"  
The EOJ command can name the print job. The job name is a string and must be enclosed in double quotes in  
the command syntax. The job name need not be same as the "job name" of the JOB command. If the NAME  
option is described, the unsolicited end-of-job status includes the job name. Job names can use printable  
characters (ASCII 33-255) and spaces or horizontal tab characters up to a maximum of 80 characters.  
·
·
·
·
·
The EOJ command indicates the end of a job.  
Resets the PJL Current Environment variables to the default values.  
Terminates the non-printing mode.  
When the EOJ command is received, the printer returns unsolicited job status information.  
The EOJ command resets the page number associated with unsolicited page status.  
Example  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL JOB NAME = "KKK data from spooler" <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT Postscript Job <CR><LF>  
@PJL JOB NAME = "YYY data from spooler 2" <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = POSTSCRIPT <CR><LF>  
%!PS.......PS JOB........^D  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of YYY data" <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC>E.........PCL JOB........<ESC>E  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of KKK" <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.  
ENVIRONMENT COMMANDS  
6.1. Introduction  
Our recent printers have many features which you are able to set using printer commands, through the printer  
control panel or by using the remote printer console program. A combination of PJL commands and printer  
emulation commands allows you to set printer features to the desired state.  
This chapter describes the setting of printer features known as printer environments, PJL commands you are  
able to use to set printer features to a desired state are as follows;  
·
·
·
·
DEFAULT  
Set the default value for environment variables. (storing them in non volatile RAM , so called NV-RAM)  
INITIALIZE  
Reset the current and default PJL variables to the factory default values  
RESET  
Reset the current PJL values to the default values  
SET  
Set an environment variable to a specified value until the next PJL reset condition.  
6.1.1. Print environment  
The printer constantly maintains four environments, which are listed below in priority order  
1.  
Factory Default Environment  
These environment setting values are permanently stored in the printer. The printer uses these settings when  
it is powered on for the first time after shipping from the factory, and after the  
@PJL INITIALIZE command is performed.  
2.  
User Default Environment  
These environment setting values are stored in the printer's NV-RAM and can be altered through the printer's  
control panel or by using the Remote Printer Console software or the @PJL DEFAULT command. These  
values are placed into the PJL Current Environment following any PJL reset condition.  
3.  
PJL Current Environment  
These environment setting values contain the current PJL feature settings. Current settings are based on the  
User Default values and include any settings modified by the @PJL SET command. These settings are  
changed to the User Default values when a PJL reset occurs.  
4.  
Modified Print Environment  
These environment settings become active just after a printer language is entered. At that time, the PJL  
Current environment values are loaded into the Modified Print Environment and act as a base set of features.  
Then, Printer language commands are used to change or modify feature settings to the desired state.  
Whenever an emulation is activated or a reset command is received (a reset command includes any printer  
language reset or PJL reset), the PJL Current environment settings are loaded into the Modified Print  
environment.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
The diagram below illustrates how the environments interact and how the modified print environment is  
affected.  
FACTORYDEFAULT ENVIRONMENT  
@PJL INITIALIZE  
CONTROL PANEL  
USER DEFAULT ENVIRONMENT  
OR @PJL DEFAULT  
@PJL RESET  
@PJL SET  
PJL CURRENT ENVIRONMENT  
LANGUAGE RESET, @PJL ENTER, OR ANY LANGUAGE SWITCH  
MODIFIED PRINT ENVIRONMENT  
6.1.2. PJL reset conditions  
The result of PJL reset condition is different from that of a printer language reset (for example, ESC E). Printer  
language reset loads the PJL Current Environment values into the Modified Print Environment. PJL reset  
conditions load the User Default values into the PJL Current Environment, which are then loaded into the  
Modified Print Environment.  
PJL reset occurs on the following events.  
1.  
2.  
3.  
4.  
5.  
6.  
7.  
8.  
9.  
Power on  
UEL command (when not between a JOB and EOJ command pair)  
@ PJL INITIALIZE command  
@ PJL RESET command  
@ PJL JOB or EOJ command  
Other printer-specific events  
Reset from Control Panel  
Language specific exit command  
Emulation switching command  
6.1.3. Remember these points about environments  
Remember the following points when you use PJL to set the printer to a desired state.  
1. The current feature settings are the same as the control panel values ( or values in the remote printer  
console program) when beginning a PJL job.  
2. The current feature settings (Modified Print Environment) become the same as the PJL Current  
Environment when the printer enters a printer language. The feature settings are modified by the printer  
language command once a printer language is started. All other settings are overridden by printer  
language commands.  
3. The SET command changes the PJL Current Environment settings. These settings are effective until the  
next PJL reset condition.  
4. Control Panel settings, the remote printer console program settings or the DEFAULT command changes  
the User Default Environment.  
5. Printer language commands change the Modified Print Environment. These settings are effective during a  
printer language job. The PJL Current Environment settings are loaded into the Modified Print  
Environment by a printer language specific reset, for example, ESC E for PCL.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6. Always use the PJL RESET command after a job is completed if the SET command is used in the PJL job.  
6.1.4. PJL environment variables  
This section lists the PJL environment variables. There are two kinds of PJL environment variables, General  
PJL environment variables and Printer language -specific variables. For all variables, except the read-only  
variables, value settings can be modified using @PJL SET, @PJL RESET, @PJL DEFAULT, and @PJL  
INITIALIZE.  
By using the @ PJL INQUIRE and @ PJL DINQUIRE, you can request value settings for the printer features.  
For the details of these commands, see the next section.  
Note:  
1. Use PJL commands only when no printer language commands are available for a desired feature.  
2. When setting printer features with PJL, use the SET and RESET commands when you want to affect the  
current PJL job only.  
If you want to affect more than the current job, use the DEFAULT and INITIALIZE commands.  
3. Supported variables depend on your printer model.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.2. Variables  
6.2.1. Variables for HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1670N/3260N/2460  
1. General PJL Environment Variables  
The PJL environment variables which are not printer language-specific are listed in the following table. When  
using these variables, do not use LPARM.  
Variables  
COPIES  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
Number of uncollated copies for each  
page of the job.  
1 to 200 (HL-1050/1070)  
1 to 99 (HL-  
1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)  
1 to 999 (HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
ON or OFF  
MANUALFEED  
ECONOMODE  
Feeds the paper from manual feed slot.  
Turn the economy mode (toner saving  
mode) ON or OFF.  
ON or OFF  
ECONOLEVEL  
PERSONALITY  
Selects the toner saving level from 1  
(high) to 3 (low).  
1 to 3  
0 to 3  
(HL-1670N/3260N/HL-2460)  
Sets the emulation mode.  
AUTO, PCL, IBM, EPSON,  
POSTSCRIPT (All models)  
HPGL (HL-3260N/2460)  
1 to 15 (HL-2460)  
INPUTBUF  
XOFFSET  
Sets the receiving buffer size value.  
Sets the X offset ( horizontal offset )  
value.  
-500 to 500 dots  
(HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/  
P2500/1670N/2460  
-104 to 500 (HL-3260N)  
-500 to 500 dots  
ON or OFF  
YOFFSET  
Sets the Y offset ( vertical offset ) value.  
Auto Continue Mode  
AUTOCONT  
TIMEOUTEMU  
Sets the time-out value for automatic  
emulation switching.  
1 to 99 seconds  
PRIORITY  
Sets the priority between EPSON or IBM  
for automatic emulation switching.  
EPSON or IBM  
HPFSEL  
ALL, LJ4 (HL-2460)  
ON or OFF  
AUTOFF  
Sets the auto FF setting to ON or OFF.  
Sets the timeout value for auto FF.  
TIMEOUTFF  
TIMEOUT  
1 to 99 seconds  
1 to 99 seconds  
Sets the timeout value for Automatic  
interface switching  
CDCCHIGH  
DTRCTRL  
Sets the high-speed transfer mode of the  
Centronics interface to ON or OFF.  
ON or OFF  
(HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/  
P2500)  
Selects when DTR becomes low.  
0 to 2  
(HL-  
0 = the printer is turned off-line by the SEL  
switch, the input buffer is full, or when a  
printer error occurs.  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/  
P2500/1670N)  
1 = the printer is turned off-line by the SEL  
switch or when a printer error occurs.  
2 = the printer is turned off-line by the SEL  
switch.  
AUTOSLEEP  
Sets the automatic sleep mode ON or  
OFF.  
ON or OFF  
TIMEOUTSLEEP  
Sets the timeout value for automatic  
sleep mode.  
1 to 00 minutes  
1 to 99 minutes (HL-1670N/2460)  
1 to 240 minutes (HL-3260N)  
BETA or ESSZET  
IBMCHARE1  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Variables  
REPRINT  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
Sets the reprint function ON or OFF.  
ON or OFF  
(HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/  
P2500)  
ON, OFF or JOB  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
DEMOPRINT  
Enables the Demo page printing.  
ON or OFF  
(HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/  
P2500/2460)  
PAGEPROTECT  
RESOLUTION  
Configuration of the Page protection  
mode. This mode reserves a block of  
printer memory to avoid 31 PRINT  
OVERRUN errors.  
AUTO, OFF, LETTER, LEGAL, A4  
Printer resolution setting. If the printer  
can not print a large file at 600 dpi  
because of insufficient memory, the  
printer decreases the resolution to 300  
dpi automatically  
300, 600 (All models)  
1200 (HL-1670N/2460)  
LANG  
Selects the language for the RPC  
program.  
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,  
DUTCH, NORWEGIAN  
(HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N  
P2500)  
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,  
DUTCH, NORWEGIAN,  
SPANISH, ITALIAN, SWEDISH,  
DANISH, JAPANESE  
(HL-1670N)  
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,  
DUTCH, SPANISH, ITALIAN,  
DANISH (HL-3260N)  
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,  
DUTCH, SPANISH, ITALIAN,  
NORWEGIAN, DANISH,  
SWEDISH (HL-2460)  
KEEP PCL  
If set to ON, the printer keeps the  
permanent fonts and macros of PCL  
when the emulation is changed to  
another mode.  
ON or OFF  
CONTEXTSWITCH  
DOUBLESTRIKE  
Auto emulation mode  
ON or OFF (HL-2460)  
ON or OFF  
Enables bold printing in IBM or EPSON  
mode  
CPLOCK  
Returns the lock status of the control  
panel. If OFF, the control panel is  
unlocked. If ON, the control panel is  
locked.  
OFF, ON  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
PASSWORD  
Password for panel lock to write to the  
0 to 65535  
NVRAM with the DEFAULT/INITIALIZE (HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
command.  
BIDI  
ON or OFF  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
POWERSAVE  
POWERSAVETIME  
Sets the power save mode ON or OFF.  
ON or OFF  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
Sets the time saving value for power  
save mode.  
1 to 99 (HL-1670N/2460)  
1 to 240 (HL-3260N)  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Variables  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
MEDIATYPE  
Media Type. The temperature of fixing  
unit is adjusted depending on this  
setting.  
REGULAR, THICK, THICK2,  
THIN, BOND, TRANSPARENCY  
(HL-1670N)  
REGULAR, THICK,  
TRANSPARENCY (HL-3260N)  
REGULAR, THICK  
TRANSPARENCY,THICK2,  
ENVELOPES, BOND (HL-2460)  
LIGHT, MEDIUM, DARK, OFF  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
OFF, ON AUTO  
RET  
Configuration of the High Resolution  
Control hardware.  
IMAGEADAPT  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
INTRAY 1  
(Read Only)  
INTRAY 2  
(Read Only)  
INTRAY 3  
(Read Only)  
INTRAY 4  
(Read Only)  
INTRAY 5  
(Read Only)  
INTRAY1SIZE  
Returns the auto-selection lock status for  
the MP tray.  
Returns the auto-selection lock status for  
the upper paper tray.  
Returns the auto-selection lock status for  
the optional lower paper cassette.  
Returns the auto-selection lock status for  
the optional lower paper cassette.  
Returns the auto-selection lock status for  
the optional lower paper cassette.  
Selects the paper size in Tray1.  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,  
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,  
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,  
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-  
3260N)  
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,  
A4, JISB5, B5, A5, B6, A6, COM10,  
DL, MONARC, C5, A4LONG,  
CUSTOM  
INTRAY2SIZE  
INTRAY3SIZE  
INTRAY4SIZE  
Selects the paper size in Tray2.  
Selects the paper size in Tray3.  
Selects the paper size in Tray4.  
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,  
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,  
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,  
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-  
3260N)  
A4, LETTER, B5, EXECUTIVE,  
ENVELOPES, LEGAL, A5, B6, A6,  
A4LONG, NO CASSETTE (HL-  
2460)  
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,  
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,  
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,  
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-  
3260N)  
A4, LETTER, B5, EXECUTIVE,  
ENVELOPES, LEGAL, A5, B6, A6,  
A4LONG, NO CASSETTE (HL-  
2460)  
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,  
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,  
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,  
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-  
3260N)  
A4, LETTER, B5, EXECUTIVE,  
ENVELOPES, LEGAL, A5, B6, A6,  
A4LONG, NO CASSETTE (HL-  
2460)  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Variables  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
INTRAY5SIZE  
Selects the paper size in Tray5.  
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,  
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,  
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,  
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-  
3260N)  
A4, LETTER, B5, EXECUTIVE,  
ENVELOPES, LEGAL, A5, B6, A6,  
A4LONG, NO CASSETTE (HL-  
2460)  
SOURCETRAY  
MPTRAYSIZE  
Selects the paper source tray.  
AUTO, MPTRAY, TRAY1, TRAY2  
(HL-1670N)  
AUTO, TRAY1, TRAY2, TRAY3,  
TRAY4, MPTRAY  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
TRAYID1, TRAYID2, TRAYID3,  
TRAYID4 (HL-2460)  
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,  
A3, A4, B5, A5, A6, COM10, C5,  
DL, MONARCH, LEDGER, JISB4,  
LTRS, A4S, XECUTIVES, B5S (HL-  
3260N)  
MPTRAY  
MP tray priority for AUTO feeder  
selection mode.  
CASSETTE, FIRST  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
MPPAPERIN  
TRAY1SIZE  
Continues printing by holding down Go  
switch for manual feeding.  
STOP, CONTINUE  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,  
B5, B5S, LEGAL, LETTER, LTRS,  
EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES (HL-  
3260N)  
TRAY2SIZE  
TRAY3SIZE  
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,  
B5, B5S, A6, LEGAL LETTER,  
LTRS, EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES,  
COM10, C5, DL MONARCH (HL-  
3260N)  
<PS400 installed>  
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,  
B5S, LEGAL, LETTER, LTRS,  
EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES  
<PS420 installed>  
A4, LETTER  
<PS440 installed>  
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,  
B5, B5S, LEGAL, LETTER, LTRS,  
EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES  
(HL-3260N)  
TRAY4SIZE  
A3, JISB4, LEDGER, A4, A4S, A5,  
B5, B5S, LEGAL, LETTER, LTRS,  
EXECUTIVE, EXECUTIVES (HL-  
3260N)  
APT  
ON or OFF  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
DENSITY  
Returns the printing density level setting  
from 1 to 15. The default value is 8.  
-6, -5, -4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6  
(HL-1670N)  
-2, -1, 0, 1, 2 (HL-3260N/2460)  
LOWTONER  
Continues printing when the toner is low.  
STOP, CONTINUE  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Variables  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
RAS1200MODE  
OFF, ON, TRUE  
(HL-1670N)  
PSBINARY  
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)  
PSQUOTEBIN  
ON or OFF  
(HL-1670N)  
DOWNFPROD  
Creates bold and italic fonts from  
download fonts.  
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)  
BITMAPFPROD  
Creates bold and italic fonts from bitmap  
fonts.  
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)  
OEMFONT  
Enables EC font  
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)  
ON or OFF (HL-1670N/2460)  
COMPABITMAP  
FSEL300DPI  
LOW or HIGH  
(HL-1670N)  
DEFPAPER  
A4, LETTER, DEFAULT  
(HL-1670N/2460)  
PSIMAGEMASK  
ON or OFF  
(HL-1670N/2460)  
HPESCE  
RESET, FF (HL-1670N/2460)  
PROTECTOFF  
AUTO, NORMAL  
(HL-1670N/2460)  
ISRFONT  
Sets the Israeli font ON or OFF.  
Selects the  
ON or OFF  
(HL-1670N/2460)  
TRANSFER  
AUTO, LOW, HIGH  
(HL-1670N)  
PARALLEL  
FAST, SLOW  
(HL-1670N)  
ERRORPRINT  
BOISEIDMODE  
CONDENCESIZE  
FXLFSETMODE  
FXLFITAMODE  
OFF, ON, EXCEPTCDCC  
(HL-1670N)  
WIN95, IEEE  
(HL-1670N)  
P1666, P1714  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
NORMAL, ALL  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
OBLIQUE, ITALIC  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
0, 1, 2, 3 (HL-1670N)  
0 to 255 (HL-1670N)  
DTRCTRL  
ENVINTERVAL  
PSCEILMODE  
FLOOR, CEIL  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
PS300RESO  
DUPLEX  
NO, IF2M, FORCE  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
Duplex mode  
ON or OFF  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
BINDING  
Returns the setting of binding edge  
selection for duplex printing.  
LONGEDGE, SHORTEDGE  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
TRAYPRIORITY  
MPT1T2T3T4, MPT4T3T2T1,  
T1T2T3T4 MP, T4T3T2T1MP (HL-  
2460)  
FFSUPPRESS  
ON or OFF (HL-3260N/2460)  
0 to 2 (HL-2460)  
LCDDENSITY  
Sets the LCD angle value.  
FAXRINGDELAY  
FAXREDUCTION  
0 to 4 (HL-3260N/2460)  
AUTO, OFF, FIX90  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
FAXRAMSIZE  
RECEIVEMODE  
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)  
ON or OFF (HL-3260N/2460)  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
FAXINTERVAL  
OFF, ON6H, ON12H, ON24H,  
ON2D, ON4D, ON7D  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
GLPENSIZE1  
GLPENSIZE2  
GLPENSIZE3  
GLPENSIZE4  
GLPENSIZE5  
GLPENSIZE6  
GLPENGRAY1  
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)  
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)  
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)  
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)  
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)  
1 to 16 (HL-3260N/2460)  
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
GLPENGRAY2  
GLPENGRAY3  
GLPENGRAY4  
GLPENGRAY5  
GLPENGRAY6  
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
G15, G30, G45, G75, G90, G100 (%)  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
STBBUSY  
RISE, FALL (HL-2460)  
RISE, FALL (HL-2460)  
OFF, ON (HL-2460)  
SCKBUSY  
PSQUOTEBIN  
DEFPAPER  
A4, LETTER, DEFAULT  
(HL-2460)  
PICKUPRETRY  
COLLATE  
0 to 7 (HL-2460)  
Sets the collate printing.  
ON or OFF (HL-2460)  
1998 to 2039 (HL-2460)  
1 to 12 (HL-2460)  
TIMESETYEAR  
TIMESETMONTH  
TIMESETDAY  
TIMESETHOUR  
TIMESETMIN  
TIMESETSEC  
TIMESTYLE  
SUMMERTIME  
ZONESET  
1 to 31 (Hl-2460)  
0 to 23 (HL-2460)  
0 to 59 (HL-2460)  
0 to 59 (HL-2460)  
UMD, MDY, DMY (Hl-2460)  
ON or OFF (HL-2460)  
ON or OFF (HL-2460)  
-24 to 24 (HL-2460)  
TIMEZONE  
OUTBIN  
ALLSTACKER, ALLSORTER,  
UPPER, OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN1,  
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN2,  
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN3,  
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN4,  
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN5,  
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN6,  
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN7,  
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN8,  
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN9,  
OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN10  
(HL-2460)  
MAILBOXPROTECT  
AVOIDMAILBOXFULL  
TOWERFEED  
ON or OFF (HL-2460)  
ON or OFF (HL-2460)  
0 to XX Mbyte(s)  
RAMDISKSIZE  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
TRANSFERVOLT  
MODE1, MODE2, MODE3,  
MODE4  
MODE1: Normal,  
MODE2: Low,  
MODE3: Middle,  
MODE4: High  
(HL-2460)  
COLDSTARTMODE  
Sets the cold start mode.  
OFF, MODE1, MODE2  
MODE1:  
MODE2  
(HL-2460)  
TNCHARGETIME  
TNCHARGEMODE  
O9FF, SHORT, NORMAL, LONG  
(HL-2460)  
OFF, MODE1, MODE2, MODE3,  
MDE4, MRDE5, MODE6, MODE7  
(HL-2460)  
FUSERSLEEPCTRL  
THICKPRDLY  
ON or OFF (HL-2460)  
OFF, SHORT, NORMAL, LONG  
(HL-2460)  
BONDPRDLY  
OFF, SHORT, NORMAL, LONG  
(HL-2460)  
FLICKER MODE  
0 to 63 (HL-2460)  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
PCL-Specific Variables  
The following values are PCL (HP LaserJet emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL. These  
variables must be set using the LPARM : PCL option.  
Variables  
PAPER  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
Sets the paper size.  
LETTER, A4, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE,  
COM10, MONARCH, C5, DL,  
JISB5, A4LONG (All models)  
B5, DL, A5, A6, B6 (HL-1670N)  
A3, B5, A5, A6, LEDGER, JISB4,  
LTRS, EXECUTIVES, B5S  
(HL-3260N)  
B5, A5, B6, A6 (HL-2460)  
ORIENTATION  
LEFTMARIN  
Sets the orientation.  
Sets the left margin.  
PORTRAIT or LANDSCAPE  
0 to 126 columns (HL-1050/1070/  
1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/3260  
N/2460)  
0 to 145 columns (HL-1670N)  
RIGHTMARGIN  
Sets the right margin  
0 to 136 columns (HL-1050/1070/  
1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)  
10 to 155 columns (HL-1670N)  
10 to 136 columns  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
TOPMARGIN  
BOTMARGIN  
FORMLINES  
FONTSOURCE  
Sets the top margin  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
5 to 128 lines  
Sets the bottom margin.  
Sets the number of lines.  
Sets the font source to Internal  
fonts or Permanent Soft Fonts  
I or S (HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/  
P2500/1670N)  
I, C1, C2, S (HL-3260N/2460)  
FONTNUMBER  
Sets the font number  
0 to n (HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/  
P2500)  
0 to 0x7FFFFFFF  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
PITCH  
Pitch of the default font in units of  
characters per inch. The pitch value  
can be specified to two decimal  
places  
0.44, 0.45,.......99.99  
PTSIZE  
Height of the default font in units of  
points. The point size can be  
4.00, 4.25, .......999.75  
specified to a quarter of a point  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
SYMSET  
Sets the symbol set.  
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2, ISOL5,  
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC8TK,  
WINL1, WINL2, WINL5,  
DESKTOP, PSTEXT, VNINTL,  
VNUS, MSPUBL, MATH8,  
PSMATH, VNMATH, PIFONT,  
LEGAL, ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,  
ISO11, ISO 14, ISO15, ISO16, ISO17,  
ISO21, ISO 25, ISO 57, ISO60,  
ISO61, ISO69, ISO84, ISO85,  
WIN30, HPGERM, HPSPAN,  
MCTEXT (All models )  
OCRA, OCRB, SYMBOL, WDINGS  
(HL-1050/1070/  
1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1670  
N)  
PC1004, WINBALT, ISOL6, PC775  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
HERBREW7 (HL-1670N)  
ON or OFF  
AUTOLF  
Sets AUTO LF  
AUTOCR  
Sets AUTO CR  
Sets AUTO WRAP  
Sets AUTO SKIP  
ON or OFF  
AUTOWRAP  
AUTOSKIP  
ON or OFF  
ON or OFF  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
EPSON-Specific Variables  
The following values are EPSON (EPSON FX-850 emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL.  
These variables must be set using the LPARM : EPSON option.  
Variables  
PAPER  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
Sets the paper size.  
LETTER, A4, LEGAL, B5,  
EXECUTIVE, COM10, MONARCH,  
C5, DL, JISB5, A4LONG (All  
models)  
A5, A6, B6 (HL-1670N/2460)  
A3, A5, A6, LEDGER, JISB4, LTRS,  
EXECUTIVES, B5S (HL-3260N)  
ORIENTATION  
LEFTMARIN  
Sets the orientation.  
Sets the left margin  
PORTRAIT, LANDSCAPE  
0 to 126 (HL-1050/1070/1250/  
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/3260N/246  
0)  
0 to 145 (HL-1670N)  
RIGHTMARGIN  
Sets the right margin  
0 to 136 (HL-1050/1070/1250/  
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)  
10 to 155 (HL-1670N)  
10 to 136 (HL-3260N/2460)  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
5 to 128 lines  
TOPMARGIN  
BOTMARGIN  
FORMLINES  
FONTSOURCE  
Sets the top margin  
Sets the bottom margin.  
Sets the number of lines.  
Sets the font source to Internal  
fonts or Permanent Soft Fonts  
I C1, C2, S (HL-3260N/2460)  
FONTNUMBER  
Sets the font number  
0 to n (HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/  
P2500)  
0 to 0x7FFFFFFF  
(HL-1670N/3260N/2460)  
PITCH  
Pitch of the default font in units of  
characters per inch. The pitch value  
can be specified to two decimal  
places  
0.44, 0.45, .......99.99  
PTSIZE  
Height of the default font in units  
of points. The point size can be  
specified to a quarter of a point  
4.00, 4.25, .......999.75  
SYMSET  
Sets the symbol set.  
USASCII, GERMAN, UKASCI1,  
FRENCH1, DANISH1, ITALY,  
SPANISH, SWEDISH, JAPAN,  
NORWEG, DANISH2, UKASCI2,  
FRENCH2, DUTCH, SAFRICA,  
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC860,  
PC863, PC865, PC8TK (All models)  
SYMBOL, WDINGS, OCRA, OCRB  
(HL-1050/1070/1250/  
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)  
UKASCIT1, JAPANESE,  
NORWEGIAN, UKASCIT2,  
SOUTHAFRICAN (HL-1670N)  
USASCII, GERMAN, UKASCII1,  
FRENCH1, DANISH1, ITALY  
SPANISH, SWEDISH, JAPANESE,  
NORWEGIAN, DANISH2,  
UKASCII2, FRENCH2, DUTCH,  
SOUTHAFRICAN, PC8, PC8DN,  
PC850, PC852, PC860, PC863, PC865,  
PC8TK (HL-3260N/2460)  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
AUTOLF  
Sets AUTO LF  
ON or OFF  
ON or OFF  
ON or OFF  
AUTOMASK  
SELREADOUT  
Sets AUTO MASK  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
IBM-Specific Variables  
The following values are IBM (IBM Proprinter XL emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL.  
These variables must be set using the LPARM : IBM option.  
Variables  
PAPER  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
Sets the paper size.  
LETTER, A4, LEGAL, B5,  
EXECUTIVE, COM10, MONARCH,  
C5, DL, JISB5, A4LONG (All  
models)  
A5, A6, B6 (HL-1670N/2460)  
A3, A5, A6, LEDGER, JISB4, LTRS,  
EXECUTIVES B5S (HL-3260N)  
ORIENTATION  
LEFTMARIN  
Sets the orientation.  
Sets the left margin  
PORTRAIT, LANDSCAPE  
0 to 126 (HL-1050/1070/1250/  
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/3260N/246  
0)  
0 to 145 (HL-1670N)  
RIGHTMARGIN  
Sets the right margin  
0 to 136 (HL-1050/1070/1250/  
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)  
10 to 155 (HL-1670N)  
10 to 136 (HL-3260N/2460)  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
5 to 128 lines  
TOPMARGIN  
BOTMARGIN  
FORMLINES  
FONTSOURCE  
Sets the top margin  
Sets the bottom margin.  
Sets the number of lines.  
Sets the font source to Internal  
fonts or Permanent Soft Fonts  
I, C1, C2, S (HL-3260N)  
FONTNUMBER  
Sets the font number  
0 to n (HL-  
1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/  
P2500)  
0 to 0x7FFFFFFF  
(HL-1670N/3260N)  
PITCH  
Pitch of the default font in units of  
characters per inch. The pitch value  
can be specified to two decimal  
places  
0.44, 0.45, .......99.99  
PTSIZE  
Height of the default font in units of  
points. The point size can be  
4.00, 4.25, .......999.75  
specified to a quarter of a point  
SYMSET  
Sets the symbol set.  
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC860,  
PC863, PC865, PC8TK (All models)  
OCRA, OCRB, SYMBOL, WDINGS  
(HL-1050/1070/1250/  
1270N/1450/1470N/P2500)  
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC860,  
PC863, PC865, PC8TK (HL-  
3260N/2460)  
AUTOLF  
Sets AUTO LF  
ON or OFF  
ON or OFF  
ON or OFF  
AUTOCR  
Sets AUTO CR  
Sets AUTO MASK  
AUTOMASK  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.  
PostScript-Specific Variables  
The following values are PostScript ( BR-Script ) specific and can be set and requested using PJL. The BR-  
Script mode is standard in some models but may be available only when the optional BR-Script 2 ROM board  
is installed into the printer. These variables must be set using the LPARM : IBM option.  
Variables  
PAPER  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
Sets the paper size.  
LETTER, A4, LEGAL, B5,  
EXECUTIVE, COM10, MONARCH,  
C5, DL, JISB5, A4LONG (All models)  
A5, A6, B6 (HL-1670N/2460)  
A3, A5, A6, LEDGER, JISB4, LTRS,  
A4S, EXECUTIVES, B5S  
(HL-3260N)  
ORIENTATION  
PRTPSERRS  
Sets the orientation.  
PORTRAIT, LANDSCAPE  
ON or OFF  
The printing of a PostScript error  
page is enabled or disabled by this  
variable  
CRLFCONV  
When set to ON, CR codes in the  
PostScript data are converted to LF  
codes.  
ON or OFF  
ON or OFF  
(HL-1050/1070/  
1250/1270N/1450/1  
470N/  
P2500)  
APPLETALKPS  
When set to ON, the printer fixes  
the emulation to BR-Script 2 mode  
for accepting data from AppleTalk.  
When set to OFF, the printer's auto  
emulation switching function  
judges the emulation.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.  
HPGL-Specific Variables  
The following values are HPGL (HP LaserJet emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL.  
These variables must be set using the LPARM: HPGL option.  
Variables  
PAPER  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
Sets the paper size.  
LETTER, LEGAL, EXECUTIVE, A4,  
JISB5, B5, A5, B6, A6, COM10, DL,  
MONARCH, C5, A4LONG (HL-  
3260N/2460)  
A3, LEGER, JISB4, LTRS, A4S,  
EXECUTIVES, B5S  
(HL-3260N)  
ORIENTATION  
SYMSET  
Sets the orientation.  
Sets the symbol set.  
PORTRAIT or LANDSCAPE  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
ANSIASCII, CHRSET9825,  
FRENCHGERMAN,  
SCANDINAVIAN,  
SPANISHLATIN, JISASCII,  
ROMAN8EXT, ISOIRV,  
ISOSWEDISH, ISOSWEDISHN,  
ISONORWAY1, ISOGERMAN,  
ISOFRENCH, ISOUK,  
ISOITALIAN, ISOSPANISH,  
ISOPORTUGUESE, ISONORWAY2  
(HL-3260N/2460)  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.2.2. Variables for HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN  
1. General PJL Environment Variables  
The PJL environment variables which are not printer language-specific are listed in the following table. When  
using these valuables, do not use the LPARM command.  
Variables  
COPIES  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
1 to 999  
Number of uncollated copies for  
each page of the job.  
Paper size.  
PAPER  
LETTER, LEGAL, A4, EXECTIVE,  
COM 10, MONARCH, C5, DL, B5, A5,  
A6, B6,  
ORIENTATION  
FORMLINES  
MANUALFEED  
RET  
Page orientation.  
Number of lines per page.  
Manual feed mode.  
PORTRAIT, LANDSCAPE  
5 to 128  
ON, OFF  
Configuration of the High  
Resolution Control hardware.  
Configuration of the Page  
protection mode. This mode  
reserves a block of printer memory  
to avoid 31 PRINT OVERRUN  
errors.  
Printer resolution setting. If the  
printer cannot print a large file at  
600 dpi because of insufficient  
memory, the printer decreases the  
resolution to 300 dpi automatically  
Personality (emulation) can be  
switched with the @ PJL ENTER  
command or ESC CR ## command.  
If the AUTO option is selected  
(factory default), the printer senses  
the data from the computer and  
switches the emulation  
LIGHT, MEDIUM, DARK, OFF  
PAGEPROTECT  
RESOLUTION  
PERSONALITY  
AUTO, OFF, LETTER, LEGAL, A4  
300, 600  
AUTO, PCL , POSTSCRIPT, IBM,  
EPSON, HPGL  
automatically.  
TIMEOUT  
The time out is the duration during  
which another automatic emulation  
change is not allowed. Duration of  
the timeout is set in seconds.  
Returns the configuration of the  
Continue mode.  
Returns the configuration for  
TONER EMPTY message action. If  
STOP, the printer stops printing. If  
CONTINUE, the printer continues  
printing.  
1 to 99  
AUTOCONT  
LOWTONER  
ON, OFF  
CONTINUE, STOP  
INTRAY 1  
(Read Only)  
INTRAY 2  
(Read Only)  
INTRAY 3  
(Read Only)  
Returns the auto-selection lock  
status for the MP tray.  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
LOCKED, UNLOCKED  
Returns the auto-selection lock  
status for the upper paper tray.  
Returns the auto-selection lock  
status for the optional lower paper  
cassette.  
INTRAY1SIZE  
(Read Only)  
Returns the size of the paper  
currently installed in the standard  
paper tray.  
LETTER, LEGA L, A4, EXECTIVE,  
COM10, MONARCH, C5, DL, B5, A5,  
A6, B6  
INTRAY2SIZE  
(Read Only)  
Returns the size of the paper  
currently installed in the lower  
paper tray.  
LETTER, LEGAL, A4, EXECTIVE,  
COM10, MONARCH, C5, DL, B5, A5,  
A6, B6  
INTRAY3SIZE  
(Read Only)  
Returns the size information for the  
optional lower paper cassette.  
LETTER, LEGAL, A4, EXECTIVE,  
COM10, MONARCH, C5, DL, B5, A5,  
A6, B6  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Variables  
DUPLEX  
BINDING  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
ON, OFF  
Duplex mode  
Returns the setting of binding edge  
selection for duplex printing.  
LONGEDGE, SHORTEDGE  
FIRSTPRINT  
First print mode. This makes the  
first print speed faster by starting  
the polygon mirror motor at Power  
On. Setting to MIDDLE is effective  
only for the first page after Power  
ON. Setting to HIGH makes the  
scanner motor rotate continuously.  
NORMAL, MIDDLE, HIGH  
DENSITY  
LANG  
Returns the printing density level  
setting from 1 to 15. The default  
value is 8.  
1 (lighter) to 15 (darker)  
Returns the language for control  
panel and status readback  
information.  
ENGLISH, FRENCH, GERMAN,  
DUTCH, SPANISH, ITALIAN,  
FINNISH, NORWEGIAN,  
PORTUGUESE, DANISH  
CPLOCK  
Returns the lock status of the  
control panel. If OFF, the control  
panel is unlocked. If ON, the control  
panel is locked.  
OFF, ON  
PASSWORD  
Password for panel lock to write to  
the NVRAM with the  
0 to65535  
DEFAULT/INITIALIZE command.  
ECONOMODE  
ECONOLEVEL  
Toner Saving Mode  
OFF, ON  
1, 2  
Level for Toner saving mode. If set  
to 1, approx. 50 % toner is saved. If  
set to 2, approx. 25% toner is saved.  
MPTRAY  
MP Tray Priority For AUTO feeder  
selection mode.  
CASSETTE, FIRST  
AUTOSLEEP  
Power Save Mode  
ON, OFF  
1 to 99  
TIMEOUTSLEEP  
Timeout for Power Save mode. The  
printer goes into the power save  
mode after this time-out period  
(minutes).  
MEDIATYPE  
HUMIDITY  
Media Type. The temperature of  
fixing unit is adjusted depending on  
this setting.  
REGULAR, THICK,  
TRANSPARENCY  
Depending on this setting, the fixing LOW, HIGH  
voltage of the printer is adjusted.  
COLLATE *  
HOLD *  
Sets collated printing.  
ON, OFF  
Specifies whether the received data  
is stored in the hard disk or printed.  
PROOF, STORE  
HOLDTYPE *  
Specifies the document type of the  
received data which has been stored  
in the optional hard disk. If  
PRIVATE is selected, a password is  
required for the data to be printed or  
deleted.  
PUBLIC, PRIVATE  
HOLDKEY *  
Specifies the password when the  
document type is set to PRIVATE.  
0 to 9 (4 digits to be selected)  
TIMESETYEAR *  
Clock: year setting  
1998 to 2039  
1 to 12  
TIMESETMONTH  
*
Clock: month setting  
TIMESETDAY *  
TIMESETHOUR *  
Clock: date setting  
Clock: hour setting  
1 to 31  
0 to 23  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Variables  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
0 to 59  
TIMESETMIN *  
TIMESETSEC *  
TIMESTYLE *  
Clock: minute setting  
Clock: second setting  
Sets the display style of the clock.  
0 to 59  
YMD (YYYY/MM/DD hh/mm), MDY  
(MM/DD/YYYY hh/mm), DMY  
(DD/MM/YYYY hh/mm)  
SUMMERTIME *  
ZONESET *  
Clock: summer time setting  
Clock: time zone setting  
OFF, ON  
OFF, ON  
-24 to +24  
TIMEZONE *  
Clock: time setting of time zone  
NOTE:  
The variables marked * are available for HL-2400Ce and HL-3400CN only.  
2. PCL-Specific Variables  
The following values are PCL (HP LaserJet emulation) specific and can be set and requested using PJL. These  
variables must be set using the LPARM : PCL option.  
Variables  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
I, C, C1, S,  
FONTSOURCE  
The valid values for FONTSOURCE  
are  
I (Internal Fonts)  
C (Cartridge Fonts)  
C1 (Card Fonts)  
S (Permanent Soft Fonts)  
If the specified value becomes  
invalid, it is automatically changed  
to the default value.  
FONTNUMBER  
Font number. This value can be  
seen on the Print Font Test selected  
from the Control Panel. This value  
is automatically changed to the  
lowest value whenever the  
0, 1, 2, ..n  
FONTSOURCE setting is changed.  
PITCH  
Pitch of the default font in units of  
characters per inch. The pitch value  
can be specified to two decimal  
places  
0.44, 0.45,  
99.99  
PTSIZE  
Height of the default font in units of  
points. The point size can be  
4.00, 4.25, .......999.75  
specified to a quarter of a point  
SYMSET  
Symbol set  
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2, ISOL5, PC8,  
PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC8TK, WINL1,  
WINL2, WINL5, DESKTOP, PSTEXT,  
VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL, MATH8,  
PSMATH, VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL,  
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10, ISO11, ISO 14,  
ISO15, ISO16, ISO17, ISO21, ISO 25, ISO 57,  
ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84, ISO85, WIN30,  
HPGERM, HPSPAN, MCTEXT  
3.  
PostScript-Specific Variable  
The currently defined PostScript specific variable is listed as follows. This variable can be set using the  
LPARM : POSTSCRIPT option.  
Variable  
Description  
Sample Value Range  
OFF, ON  
PRTPSERRS  
The printing of a PostScript error  
page is enabled or disabled by this  
variable  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.3. Default Command  
The DEFAULT command changes the User-Default environment which is stored in NV-RAM and it is  
activated following a PJL reset condition. The current print environment is not affected by the DEFAULT  
command, but when a PJL reset condition happens, this command takes effect. This doesn't change the  
current print environment, but is activated when a PJL reset condition happens.  
It is recommended to restrict the use of the DEFAULT command when the printer is shared by several users  
such as in a network environment. This allows use of the standard print environment and avoids changing  
default features for each print job. If you have to change the default for a particular print job, use the SET  
command.  
Syntax  
@PJL DEFAULT [LPARM : personality] variable = value [<CR>]<LF>  
·
·
LPARM : Personality  
This optional parameter is used to set personality-specific (emulation) environment variables.  
variable = Value  
This parameter is used to set one of the environment variables to the specified value. For example, the @  
PJL DEFAULT RESOLUTION = 300 command sets the user-default resolution to 300 dpi. Use the @PJL  
INFO VARIABLES command to obtain valid variables and the range of values for each variable. This  
command can request the information directly from the printer.  
Example  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT Control Panel Defaults <CR><LF>  
@PJL DEFAULT PAGEPROTECT = LEGAL <CR><LF>  
@PJL DEFAULT LPARM : PCL SYMSET = PC850 <CR><LF>  
@PJL RESET <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
6.4. Initialize Command  
The INITIALIZE command resets the PJL Current Environment and User Default Environment variables to the  
Factory Default values. I/O configuration values and the unsolicited status settings are not affected by this  
command.  
It is recommended to restrict the use of the INITIALIZE command when the printer is shared by several users  
such as in a networking environment in order to use a standard environment and avoid having default  
features changed by different print jobs.  
Syntax :  
@PJL INITIALIZE [<CR>]<LF>  
Parameters :  
·
·
·
The INITIALIZE command has no parameters.  
The INITIALIZE command resets the following environment variables to the Factory Default values.  
If any additional personality (emulation) is added to the printer, the printer may support more personality-  
specific variables than the variables listed. In any case, the INITIALIZE command resets the PJL Current and  
User Default environment values for all personalities to their factory default.  
Example :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT setting to <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT factory defaults <CR><LF>  
@PJL INITIALIZE <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.5. Reset Command  
The PJL RESET command resets the PJL Current Environment variables to the User Default values.  
Use this command at the end of any PJL jobs in which the PJL SET command was used.  
Syntax  
@PJL RESET [<CR>]<LF>  
Parameters  
·
·
The RESET command has no parameters  
When an application such as a Spooler or Print Data Generator uses the SET command to set PJL variables,  
the application has to conclude with the RESET command (before the UEL command) to return the variables  
to the previous state.  
·
·
The RESET command resets the environment variables to their user default values.  
In any case, the RESET command resets the PJL Current settings for all personalities to the User Default  
values.  
Use the @PJL INFO VARIABLES command to obtain valid variables and the range of values for each  
variable. This command requests this information directly from the printer.  
Examples  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT Reset variables to <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT control panel settings <CR><LF>  
@PJL SET RESOLUTION = 300 <CR><LF>  
@PJL SET RET = DARK <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC>E ....PCL job ...<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT Reset to return to <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT control panel settings <CR><LF>  
@PJL RESET <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
6.6. Set Command  
The SET command enables you to change the value of PJL Current Environment variables during a PJL job  
until a PJL reset condition resets the default values.  
Use this command to make a job-specific environment.  
Syntax  
@PJL SET [LPARM : personality] variable = value  
[<CR>]<LF>  
·
·
LPARM : Personality  
This optional parameter is used to set personality(emulation) -specific environment variables.  
variable = value  
This parameter sets one of the environment variables to the specified value.  
For example, @ PJL SET RESOLUTION = 300 command sets the current resolution to 300 dpi. For a list of  
variables and values, see the following table.  
·
Use the @PJL INFO VARIABLES to obtain valid variables and the range of values for each variable. This  
command can request this information directly from the printer.  
Parameters  
·
The printer control panel setting values and the feature settings stored in NV-RAM are not affected by the  
values modified with the SET command.  
·
·
The setting values selected with the SET command are valid until the next PJL reset condition occurs.  
If the SET command is used in a job, use the RESET command after the job to reset the printer to User default  
settings.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Examples:  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT Setting PCL job <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT to desired state <CR><LF>  
@PJL SET RET = DARK <CR><LF>  
@PJL SET PAGEPROTECT = OFF <CR><LF>  
@PJL SET RESOLUTION = 600 <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC> E....PCL job .... <ESC>E  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL RESET <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.  
STATUS READBACK COMMANDS  
7.1. Introduction  
Applications can request, by sending a PJL command to the printer, information such as the configuration  
and status of the printer. The printer can be programmed to send back this information when requested and  
also can send back voluntarily unsolicited information of its status such as cover open, off-line state, toner  
empty, displayed prompt message on the LCD and other necessary information.  
PJL Status Readback will help you to program the application to appropriately set the printer settings.  
In this chapter, you can learn how to use PJL Status Readback in programming an application. The following  
Status Readback Commands are described :  
·
·
·
INQUIRE ... requests the information of the specified PJL Default setting (PJL Current Environment) set by  
@PJL SET or @PJL RESET command  
DINQUIRE ... requests the information of the specified User Default setting (User Default Environment)  
set by @PJL DEFAULT or @PJL INITIALIZE command or control panel  
ECHO ... request the printer to send back to the host computer a comment for the purpose of  
synchronization with each other in order to start communication  
·
·
·
INFO ... requests a specified category of information from the printer  
USTATUS ... gives the printer permission to send back unsolicited information.  
USTATUSOFF ... turns off all unsolicited status information set by USTATUS  
Job Recovery is also described in this chapter.  
7.1.1. Synchronization with the printer  
The printer sends the status responses to the same I/O port as it received the request from. Therefore, in a  
shared or network environment, if the I/O port was used by another user and the printer is still processing the  
previous job, the printer may send a response of the status of the previous user's job against the request from  
the current application. In order to make sure that an application can receive correct responses for its request,  
it must synchronize itself with the printer by sending the ECHO command so as to be assured that the printer  
is ready for communication to you.  
7.1.2. Basic format of status readback responses  
The printer sends its status information to the host computer in the following format :  
·
·
·
starts with the @PJL prefix  
ends with a <FF> character  
All the data is in a readable ASCII format.  
Each line in the PJL status responses is in the following format :  
·
·
starts with a specific keyword  
ends with <CR><LF>  
For example, the readback response against the @PJL DINQUIRE is :  
@PJL DINQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable<CR><LF>  
value<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
The application must read all the data between the @PJL and <CR><LF> codes. If the application can not  
understand the meaning of the lines, it must ignore them. Future printers may send currently unused  
keywords.  
Refer to each command description to learn about the format of responses from the printer.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.2. Inquire Command  
The INQUIRE command is used in order to get the information of the current value of a specified variable in  
the PJL DEFAULT setting. (PJL environment). It is possible to get the information for variables the value of  
which PJL cannot change (Read-only).  
This INQUIRE command can request only one variable at a time. If you would like to get the information from  
multiple variables, send multiple INQUIRE commands or the PJL INFO VARIABLES command which  
responds with all the variables in the PJL Default settings (PJL Default Environment).  
Syntax  
@PJL INQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable [<CR>]<LF>  
Response Syntax  
@PJL INQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable <CR><LF>  
value <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
If the variable is not supported by the printer, it returns the response in the following syntax :  
@PJL INQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable <CR><LF>  
"?" <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
·
·
LPARM : personality  
This optional parameter must be used when requesting the information of printer language-specific variables,  
such as the font number in the PJL DEFAULT setting.  
variable : variable  
This is a parameter which specifies which variable you would like to get the information about among the PJL  
Default settings (PJL Current Environment). The variables which can be used in this command are listed in  
Appendix A. You can also check by sending the @PJL INFO VARIABLES command to the printer.  
·
value  
This is the value of the parameter requested by the variable parameter.  
Examples  
Example 1 :  
This example requests the current print environment settings for RET, PAPER, and ORIENTATION :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT ***Requesting*** <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT about PJL Default Settings** <CR><LF>  
@PJL ECHO 19:15:00 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>  
@PJL INQUIRE RET <CR><LF>  
@PJL INQUIRE PAPER <CR><LF>  
@PJL INQUIRE ORIENTATION <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may return, for examp le, the following response against the above INQUIRE commands :  
@PJL ECHO 19:15:00 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL INQUIRE RET<CR><LF>  
LIGHT<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL INQUIRE PAPER<CR><LF>  
LETTER<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL INQUIRE ORIENTATION<CR><LF>  
PORTRAIT<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Example 2 :  
This example requests the PCL-specific settings.  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT ***Inquiring PCL settings*** <CR><LF>  
@PJL ECHO 19:20:05 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>  
@PJL INQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTSOURCE<CR><LF>  
@PJL INQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTNUMBER<CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may return the following response for the above INQUIRE commands :  
@PJL ECHO 19:20:05 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL INQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTSOURCE <CR><LF>  
I<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL INQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTNUMBER <CR><LF>  
13<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
7.3. DINQUIRE Command  
The DINQUIRE command is used to get the information of the default value of a specific variable in the PJL  
Environment. (User Default Settings). It is also possible to get the value for variables which PJL cannot  
change (Read-only).  
The returned value of User Default Settings is identical to the Control Panel Setting.  
This DINQUIREcommand can request only one variable at a time. If you would like to get information from  
more variables, send multiple DINQUIRE commands.  
Syntax:  
@PJL DINQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable [<CR>]<LF>  
Response Syntax:  
@PJL DINQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable <CR><LF>  
value <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
If the variable is not supported by the printer, it returns the response in the following syntax :  
@PJL DINQUIRE [LPARM : personality] variable <CR><LF>  
"?" <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
·
·
·
LPARM : personality  
This optional parameter must be used when requesting information about printer language-specific variables  
such as the font number in the User Default setting.  
variable  
Variable is a parameter which specifies what you would like to get the information about among the User  
Default settings (User Default Environment). The valid variables are listed in the following tables.  
value  
Value is the returned value for the requested variable. See the following tables to learn about values for  
specific variables.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Examples  
Example 1 :  
This example requests the current print environment settings for RET, PAPER, and ORIENTATION :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT ***Requesting*** <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT about User Default Settings** <CR><LF>  
@PJL ECHO 20:30:00 02-20-1993<CR><LF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE RET<CR><LF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE PAPER<CR><LF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE ORIENTATION<CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may return, for example, the following response against the above DINQUIRE commands:  
@PJL ECHO 20:30:00 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE RET<CR><LF>  
LIGHT<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE PAPER<CR><LF>  
LETTER<CR>LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE ORIENTATION<CR><LF>  
LANDSCAPE<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
Example 2 :  
This example requests the PCL-specific settings.  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT ***Inquiring PCL settings*** <CR><LF>  
@PJL ECHO 20:33:05 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTSOURCE <CR><LF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE LPARM:PCL FONTNUMBER <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may return the following response for the above DINQUIRE commands :  
@PJL ECHO 20:33:05 02-20-1993 <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE LPARM : PCL FONTSOURCE <CR><LF>  
I<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL DINQUIRE LPARM : PCL FONTNUMBER <CR><LF>  
15<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
7.4. ECHO Command  
The ECHO command requests the printer to send back a specified message, in order to ensure that the printer  
is ready for communication with the application and that the received answer from the printer is what the  
application requested. The application must send this command before starting PJL communication.  
After sending the ECHO command, the application must ignore any status information from the printer before  
it receives the response from this command, because not receiving the response from this command means  
that the printer is still processing the previous job and its status information is for the previous job  
environment. When the application receives the correct response for the requested ECHO command, the  
printer is now ready for the application and you can be sure that the status information following is for the  
requested command by the application.  
Syntax  
@PJL ECHO [< words >] [<CR>]<LF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Response Syntax  
@PJL ECHO [< words >] <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
·
< words >  
The beginning of this parameter must be a printable character. Then this parameter consists of characters  
from ASCII 33 to 255, space characters and horizontal tab characters.  
This < words > parameter can be written without quotation marks as this is not a string of variables.  
The parameter is recommended to be unique, distinguishable words from other print jobs, such as the time  
determined by the real time clock and user name, so as to confirm the received message from the printer is  
definitely the answer for the ECHO command which the application sent.  
The length of the < word > must be within 80 characters.  
Parameters  
Parameter  
Valid characters  
< words >  
ASCII 33 to 255, <SP>, <HT>  
Example  
The application sends the following example to the printer :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT the ECHO command follows <CR><LF>  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 22:03:00 <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer sends back the answer for the above ECHO command :  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 22:03:00 <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
After receiving the above answer, all the messages from the printer are the requested information from the  
application, except for unsolicited status information.  
7.5. INFO Command  
The INFO command requests the printer to send back information on a specific category of the printer such  
as 'ID' (model name), 'CONFIG' (printer configuration), 'MEMORY' (available printer memory), 'STATUS'  
(current printer status), 'VARIABLES' (list of setting variables), 'USTATUS' (list of unsolicited status  
variables), 'PAGECOUNT' (total printing page number of the printer), 'PHYSICALMEMORY' (Physical memory  
size of printer) as shown in the following table.  
This INFO command can request the information from only one category at a time. If you would like to get  
the information from more categories, send multiple INFO commands.  
Syntax  
@PJL INFO category [<CR>]<LF>  
Response Syntax  
@PJL INFO category <CR><LF>  
[lines of printable characters or <WS> with <CR><LF> at the end of  
each line]  
<FF>  
If the variable is not supported by the printer, it returns the response in the following syntax :  
@PJL INFO category <CR><LF>  
"?"<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Parameters  
Category  
Information requesting  
ID  
The printer model number. For example the HL-1660e will return 'Brother  
HL-1660e'.  
CONFIG  
A list of the printer configuration information (available options) within  
the format of the number of types and/or the description of each  
available type of;  
paper sources  
paper sizes  
languages  
USTATUS (unsolicited status) commands  
font sources  
RAM  
number of lines and characters on the LCD  
MEMORY  
STATUS  
The total number of bytes of free memory space (user memory) and the  
largest free memory block.  
The printer status of the current message displayed on the LCD, on-  
line/off-line status and the status code.  
VARIABLES  
A list of the current settings of all the environmental & language-specific  
variables and the selectable values for each variable  
USTATUS  
A list of the current settings of all the unsolicited status variables and  
selectable values for each variable  
PAGECOUNT  
Total number of pages the printer has printed.  
PHYSICALMEMORY  
Physical printer memory. This value is the same as the response for  
INFO CONFIG.  
FEATURES  
OPTIONS  
The list of the printer features.  
The information of the options (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)  
The information of the paper cassette (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)  
The information of the paper output tray (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)  
The information of the Duplex unit (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)  
The information of the memory device (HL-2460,3260N,1650/1670N)  
INTRAYCONFIG  
OUTTRAYCONFIG  
DXCONFIG  
STORAGECONFIG  
7.5.1. ID category  
The application can use @PJL INFO ID command to find out the printer model name. As the features of the  
printer may be changed by future revisions, the application should check them by using the @PJL INFO  
CONFIG command.  
Example  
The application sends the following command to the printer :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL INFO ID <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer sends back the answer for the above INFO command if the printer name is HL-1660e:  
@PJL INFO ID<CR><LF>  
"Brother HL-1660e"<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
7.5.2. CONFIG category  
The application can use @PJL INFO CONFIG command to have the printer return a list of printer  
configuration information. The list consists of the information on paper sources, paper sizes, languages,  
USTATUS (unsolicited status) commands, font sources, RAM size, number of lines and characters on the  
LCD supported by the printer, with the format of the number of available types and/or the description of each  
type. The printer sends back a list of multiple information for one @PJL INFO CONFIG command.  
Syntax:  
@PJL INFO CONFIG <CR><LF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Response Syntax:  
@PJL INFO CONFIG <CR><LF>  
feature[=value][value feature information] <CR><LF>  
[<HT>returned option[ attribute] <CR><LF>]  
...  
...  
...  
...  
feature[=value][value feature information] <CR><LF>  
[<HT>returned option[ attribute] <CR><LF>]  
<FF>  
Parameters  
Parameter  
Range of Characters  
Description  
feature  
alphabetical letters  
(ASCII 65-90 or 97-122),  
numbers (ASCII 48-57)  
Name of an item of the printer configuration :  
for example )  
IN TRAYS (paper sources)  
OUT TRAYS (output trays)  
PAPER (paper sizes)  
* Beginning with a letter  
LANGUAGES (printer languages)  
USTATUS (unsolicited status)  
FONT CARTRIDGE SLOTS  
MEMORY (RAM size)  
DISPLAY LINES (number of lines available on the  
LCD)  
DISPLAY CHARACTER SIZE (number of characters  
available on the LCD)  
etc.  
value  
numbers  
Value for the feature, or value which shows a  
number or range of options to follow  
feature  
alphabetical letters  
Type of the following information:  
(ASCII 65-90 or 97-122),  
numbers (ASCII 48-57)  
information  
ENUMERATED  
RANGE  
* separated from others  
by spaces  
READONLY  
etc.  
returned  
option  
alphabetical letters  
(ASCII 65-90 or 97-122),  
numbers (ASCII 48-57)  
An option of the item, such as PCL of the item of  
LANGUAGES  
attribute  
alphabetical letters  
(ASCII 65-90 or 97-122),  
numbers (ASCII 48-57)  
Further information for a returned option. For  
example, a PC attribute following an INTRAY2  
returned option indicates INTRAY2 means LC  
(optional tray2)  
Example  
The application sends the following command to the printer :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL INFO CONFIG<CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
The printer may send back the answer for the above INFO command :  
@PJL INFO CONFIG<CR><LF>  
IN TRAYS [1 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
INTRAY1 PC<CR><LF>  
INTRAY2 LC<CR><LF>  
OUT TRAYS [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
NORMAL FACEDOWN<CR><LF>  
PAPER [9 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
LETTER<CR><LF>  
LEGAL<CR><LF>  
A4<CR><LF>  
EXECUTIVE<CR><LF>  
MONARCH<CR><LF>  
COM10<CR><LF>  
DL<CR><LF>  
C5<CR><LF>  
B5<CR><LF>  
LANGUAGES [5 EMULATED]<CR><LF>  
PCL<CR><LF>  
POSTSCRIPT<CR><LF>  
IBM<CR><LF>  
EPSON<CR><LF>  
HPGL<CR><LF>  
USTATUS [4 ENUMERATED]  
DEVICE<CR><LF>  
JOB<CR><LF>  
PAGE<CR><LF>  
TIMED<CR><LF>  
FONT CARTRIDGE SLOTS [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
CARTRIDGE<CR><LF>  
CARTRIDGE1<CR><LF>  
MEMORY=2097152<CR><LF>  
DISPLAY LINES=1<CR><LF>  
DISPLAY CHARACTER SIZE=16<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
In this example, IN TRAYS [2 ENUMERATED] indicates that there are two options in IN TRAYS (paper  
sources) and MEMORY=2097152 indicates the RAM size in the printer is 2097152 bytes.  
7.5.3. MEMORY category  
The application can use the @PJL INFO MEMORY command to check the size of total free memory and the  
largest free memory block in the printer.  
The free memory size may vary according to the personality (printer language). In order to know the free  
memory size in PCL, use the <ESC>*s1M(Free Space command) in the PCL status readback commands.  
Example  
The application sends the following command to the printer :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT the INFO MEMORY command follows<CR><LF>  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:03:00<CR><LF>  
@PJL INFO MEMORY<CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer sends back the answer for the above command :  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:03:00<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL INFO MEMORY<CR><LF>  
TOTAL=159984<CR><LF>  
LARGEST=53322<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.5.4. STATUS category  
The application can use the @PJL INFO STATUS command to check the printer on-line/off-line status, the  
current message on the LCD and a status code. The ONLINE=TRUE indicates the printer is online, while the  
ONLINE=FALSE shows it is off-line. Refer to the list of the PJL Status Codes in the Appendix for the  
meanings of the returned status codes.  
Example  
The application sends the following command to the printer :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT the INFO STATUS command follows<CR><LF>  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:10:00<CR><LF>  
@PJL INFO STATUS<CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer sends back the answer for the above command when BR-Script mode and letter sized paper are  
selected and it is in idle status:  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:10:00<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL INFO STATUS<CR><LF>  
CODE=10001<CR><LF>  
DISPLAY="00 IDLE 001P LT"<CR><LF>  
ONLINE=TRUE<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
7.5.5. VARIABLES category  
The application can send the @PJL INFO VARIABLES command to get a list of possible variables for printer  
environment settings, possible language-specific variables, the current settings for both and the possible  
values or range for those variables. Refer to the "Environment Variables" in Chapter 6 for more information  
about the variables for the environment settings.  
The language-specific variables returned from the printer depend on the current environment and are  
indicated with LPARM: personality.  
The value and options for the FONTSOURCE variable depend on the installed font sources such as cartridge,  
downloaded permanent soft fonts.  
The range of fonts listed for FONTNUMBER variable is only for the current font source. The upper limit  
value of the range varies according to the number of fonts in the current font source.  
Example  
The application sends the following command to the printer :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT the INFO VARIABLES command <CR><LF>  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:35:00 <CR><LF>  
@PJL INFO VARIABLES <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may send back the answer for the above command :  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 19:35:00 <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL INFO VARIABLES<CR><LF>  
COPIES=3 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>  
1<CR><LF>  
999<CR><LF>  
PAPER=LETTER [9 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
LETTER<CR><LF>  
LEGAL<CR><LF>  
A4<CR><LF>  
EXECUTIVE<CR><LF>  
MONARCH<CR><LF>  
COM10<CR><LF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
C5<CR><LF>  
DL<CR><LF>  
B5<CR><LF>  
ORIENTATION=PORTRAIT [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
PORTRAIT<CR><LF>  
LANDSCAPE<CR><LF>  
FORMLINES=60 [2 RANGE]  
5<CR><LF>  
128<CR><LF>  
MANUALFEED=OFF [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
OFF<CR><LF>  
ON<CR><LF>  
RET=MEDIUM [4 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
OFF<CR><LF>  
LIGHT<CR><LF>  
MEDIUM<CR><LF>  
DARK<CR><LF>  
PAGEPROTECT=OFF [4 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
OFF<CR><LF>  
LETTER<CR><LF>  
LEGAL<CR><LF>  
A4<CR><LF>  
RESOLUTION=600 [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
300<CR><LF>  
600<CR><LF>  
PERSONALITY=AUTO EPSON [8 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
AUTO<CR><LF>  
PCL<CR><LF>  
POSTSCRIPT<CR><LF>  
Interactive<CR><LF>  
IBMProprinterXL<CR><LF>  
EPSONFX850<CR><LF>  
HPGL<CR><LF>  
TIMEOUT=10 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>  
1
99  
INTRAY1=UNLOCKED [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
UNLOCKED<CR><LF>  
LOCKED<CR><LF>  
INTRAY2=UNLOCKED [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
UNLOCKED<CR><LF>  
LOCKED<CR><LF>  
AUTOCONT=ON [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
OFF<CR><LF>  
ON<CR><LF>  
LOWTONER=OFF [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
OFF<CR><LF>  
ON<CR><LF>  
INTRAY1SIZE=LETTER [9 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
LETTER<CR><LF>  
LEGAL<CR><LF>  
A4<CR><LF>  
EXECUTIVE<CR><LF>  
MONARCH<CR><LF>  
COM10<CR><LF>  
C5<CR><LF>  
DL<CR><LF>  
B5<CR><LF>  
INTRAY2SIZE=LEGAL [9 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
LETTER<CR><LF>  
LEGAL<CR><LF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
A4<CR><LF>  
EXECUTIVE<CR><LF>  
MONARCH<CR><LF>  
COM10<CR><LF>  
C5<CR><LF>  
DL<CR><LF>  
B5<CR><LF>  
LPARM:PCL FONTSOURCE=I [4 EMULATED]<CR><LF>  
I<CR><LF>  
C<CR><LF>  
C1<CR><LF>  
S<CR><LF>  
LPARM:PCL FONTNUMBER=0 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>  
0<CR><LF>  
70<CR><LF>  
LPARM:PCL PITCH=10.00 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>  
0.44<CR><LF>  
99.99<CR><LF>  
LPARM:PCL PTSIZE=12.00 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>  
4.00<CR><LF>  
999.75<CR><LF>  
LPARM:PCL SYMSET=ROMAN8 [43 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
ROMAN8<CR><LF>  
ISOL1<CR><LF>  
ISOL2<CR><LF>  
....  
....  
WIN30<CR><LF>  
HPGERM<CR><LF>  
HPSPAN<CR><LF>  
MCTEXT<CR><LF>  
LPARM:POSTSCRIPT PRTPSERRS=OFF [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
OFF<CR><LF>  
ON<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
7.5.6. USTATUS category  
The application can send the @PJL INFO USTATUS command to check the possible unsolicited status  
types of the printer and the current setting value and possible values for them.  
Syntax  
@PJL INFO USTATUS [<CR>]<LF>  
Response Syntax  
@PJL INFO USTATUS <CR><LF>  
variable=value [value feature information] <CR><FF>  
[<HT>returned option <CR><LF>]  
...  
...  
...  
...  
variable=value [value feature information] <CR><FF>  
[<HT>returned option <CR><LF>]  
<FF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Parameters  
Variable  
Value  
Description  
DEVICE  
ON  
Makes unsolicited device status valid for any status  
change  
VERBOSE  
OFF  
Makes unsolicited device status valid for any of PJL  
parser warning, error and status change  
Makes unsolicited device status invalid for any  
status change  
JOB  
ON  
Makes unsolicited job status (reporting job start/job  
end) valid  
OFF  
ON  
Makes unsolicited job status invalid  
PAGE  
TIMED  
Makes unsolicited page status (reporting respective  
page printed and ejected) valid  
OFF  
Makes unsolicited page status invalid  
5 to 300  
Makes timed unsolicited status (allowing the printer  
to send back unsolicited status after an interval  
specified in seconds) valid  
0
Turns TIMED USTATUS off (Makes timed  
unsolicited status invalid)  
Example  
The application sends the following command to the printer :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT the INFO USTATUS command <CR><LF>  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 21:15:00 <CR><LF>  
@PJL INFO USTATUS <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may send back the following answer for the above command :  
@PJL ECHO This is a sample 2-28-1993 21:15:00 <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL INFO STATUS<CR><LF>  
DEVICE=VERBOSE [3 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
OFF<CR><LF>  
ON<CR><LF>  
VERBOSE<CR><LF>  
JOB=ON [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
OFF<CR><LF>  
ON<CR><LF>  
PAGE=ON [2 ENUMERATED]<CR><LF>  
OFF<CR><LF>  
ON<CR><LF>  
TIMED=0 [2 RANGE]<CR><LF>  
5<CR><LF>  
300<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
7.6. USTATUS Command  
Sending the USTATUS command makes unsolicited printer status (sending the printer status information to  
the host computer automatically without being requested for it) valid or invalid. If the unsolicited status is set  
to ON with the USTATUS command, the printer sends unsolicited status information to the host computer at  
the time interval set by USTATUS TIMED command from when the status changes. On the other hand, the  
DINQUIRE, INQUIRE and INFO commands make the printer send a response only once, just after they are  
received.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
The printer status to be sent to the host computer are ;  
·
·
·
Device status changes - printer cover open, paper jams, paper out, etc  
Job status changes - completion of the printing of a job, receiving a JOB command  
Page status changes - ejecting a printed page  
All the unsolicited status information (USTATUS DEVICE, JOB, PAGE and TIMED) is turned off at once by  
the USTATUSOFF command. Each status can be turned off individually by the corresponding USTATUS  
command.  
The USTATUS TIMED command specifies after which time period the printer sends the unsolicited status  
information and is turned off by setting the time increment to zero with this command.  
To get information about the current settings or possible settings for unsolicited status, use the INFO  
USTATUS command.  
Syntax  
@PJL USTATUS variable = value [<CR>]<LF>  
Response Syntax  
@PJL USTATUS variable <CR><LF>  
returned option [printable characters or <WS>] <CR><LF>  
...  
...  
...  
...  
returned option <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
Parameters  
Variable  
Value  
Description  
DEVICE  
ON  
Makes unsolicited device status valid for any status change (printer  
errors)  
VERBOSE  
Makes unsolicited device status valid for any PJL parser warning, error  
and status changes  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
Makes unsolicited device status invalid for any status change  
Makes unsolicited job status (reporting job start/job end) valid  
Makes unsolicited job status invalid  
Makes unsolicited page status (reporting respective page printed and  
ejected) valid  
JOB  
PAGE  
OFF  
Makes unsolicited page status invalid  
TIMED  
5 to 300  
Makes timed unsolicited status (allowing the printer to send back  
unsolicited status after an interval specified in seconds) valid  
Turn TIMED USTATUS off (Makes timed unsolicited status invalid)  
0
7.6.1. Device variable  
The @PJL USTATUS DEVICE command allows the printer to send status messages when the printer status  
changes. The printer will send the status by the status code shown in the table below.  
Status code  
10000 - 10999  
11000 - 11999  
Status  
Status information such as printer on-line or off-line.  
Status of available paper in paper input sources, such as paper empty and auto-  
switching to another paper source.  
20000 - 20999  
PJL parser errors. The entire command line of a PJL command is ignored when an  
error (except for code 20004 ) occurs.  
25000 - 25999  
27000 - 27999  
PJL parser errors. Part of a PJL command is ignored when the error occurs.  
PJL semantic errors, which means that they are grammatically acceptable but  
cannot be executed. For example, attempting to lock the only unlocked paper  
tray causes this error.  
30000 - 30999  
Errors which do not stop the printing procedure if the CONTINUE is set to AUTO  
(auto continue mode). If the CONTINUE mode is set to STOP, the printer stops  
printing and goes to off-line status and only resumes when the CONTINUE or  
SEL key are pressed.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Status code  
Status  
35000 - 25999  
Errors which may cause incorrect printing results, such as loss of some print data  
on a page. The operator's intervention may be required.  
40000 - 40999  
41000 - 41999  
Errors such as paper empty, cover open or paper jams which suspend printing  
until the operator takes the corresponding corrective action.  
Errors in the paper source such as running out of paper in the current paper tray  
and none available from any other paper sources.  
Example  
Example 1 :  
The application sends the following command to the printer :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE = VERBOSE <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may send back the answer for the above command :  
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE<CR><LF>  
CODE=40021<CR><LF>  
DISPLAY='12 COVER OPEN '<CR><LF>  
ONLINE=FALSE<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
Example 2 :  
When the following wrong PJL command is sent :  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE = VERBOSE <CR><LF>  
@PJL ECO wrong sample 3-6-1993 23:12:00 <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may send back the answer for the above command :  
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE<CR><LF>  
CODE=20002<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
7.6.2. JOB variables  
The @PJL USTATUS JOB = ON command allows the printer to send the job processing status. This is sent  
to the application whenever a JOB and EOJ command is issued so that the application knows when a job  
starts and ends.  
Example  
The application sends the following commands to the printer.  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL USTATUS JOB = ON <CR> <LF>  
@PJL JOB NAME = "JOB 88554" <CR> <LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR> <LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR> <LF>  
<ESC>E . . . PCL Job . . . <ESC>E <ESC>%-12345X  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL EOJ NAME = "JOB 88554" <CR> <LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may send back the answer for the above command.  
@PJL USTATUS JOB<CR><LF>  
START<CR><LF>  
NAME="JOB 88554"<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
[ . . time period while job is printing . . . ]  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
@PJL USTATUS JOB<CR><LF>  
END<CR><LF>  
NAME = "JOB 88554"<CR><LF>  
PAGES=5<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
7.6.3. PAGE variable  
The @PJL USTATUS PAGE = ON command allows the printer to send the information about the print  
completion of a particular page. Using this command, you can monitor the job process on a page-by-page  
basis.  
Example  
The application sends the following commands to the printer.  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL USTATUS PAGE = ON <CR> <LF>  
@PJL JOB <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC>E . . . Four-page PCL Job . . . <ESC>E  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL EOJ <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may send back the answer for the above command.  
@PJL USTATUS PAGE<CR><LF>  
1<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL USTATUS PAGE<CR><LF>  
2<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL USTATUS PAGE<CR><LF>  
3<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
@PJL USTATUS PAGE<CR><LF>  
4<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
7.6.4. TIMED variable  
The @PJL USTATUS TIMED = XXX command enables the printer to send printer status information to the  
application at the specified time period.  
This time interval can be set to 0 and from 5 to 300 seconds. If set to 0, this function is turned off. If set to  
any value between 5 and 300, the printer automatically sends to the application "CODE = XXXXX" (a status  
code number), "DISPLAY = XXXXXXXXXX" (the message currently displayed on the printer's control  
panel), and "ON LINE = XXXXXXX" ( printer's on-line/off-line status) at the specified time interval.  
Example  
The application sends the following commands to the printer.  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL USTATUS TIMED = 30 <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
The printer may send back the answer for the above command.  
@PJL USTATUS TIMED<CR><LF>  
CODE=10001<CR><LF>  
DISPLAY="00 READY 001P LT"<CR><LF>  
ONLINE=TRUE<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.7. USTATUSOFF Command  
The @PJL USTATUSOFF command makes all unsolicited status reporting inactive.  
Syntax  
@PJL USTATUSOFF [<CR>]<LF>  
Parameters  
There are no parameters for this command.  
Example  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL USTATUSOFF <CR><LF>  
@PJL USTATUS DEVICE = ON <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
7.8. JOB Recovery  
You can recover a failed job with the combination of JOB and EOJ commands and the USTATUS PAGE  
command. JOB/EOJ commands inform the printer of the beginning and ending of each job and the  
USTATUS PAGE command informs the application of completion of printing of each page of a job.  
When the spooler finds a job failure, it can recover the failed job. It can send the JOB command with the  
START option. The START page should be set to the last printed page, which can be found by the  
USTATUS PAGE command.  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
8.  
DEVICE ATTENDANCE COMMANDS  
8.1. Introduction  
You can change dis play messages on the printer control panel by using PJL. The Operator can be alerted by  
this feature to what specific actions should be taken. This chapter shows you three device attendance  
commands.  
RDYMSG  
By using this command, you can change the message "00 READY" on the printer control panel into whatever  
message you like. This command does not change the printer's online/offline state.  
OPMSG  
By using this command, the printer can display a message you specify on the printer switch panel LCD and  
set the printer to off-line ( non-ready state for printing ).  
STMSG  
By using this command, the printer can display a message you specify on the printer control panel LCD and  
the printer will go off-line. After the operator puts the printer back on-line by the on-line / off-line key, the  
printer name is returned by the printer to the application.  
8.2. RDYMSG Command  
With the RDYMSGcommand, you can change the message "00 READY" on the printer control panel into a  
specified message. The printer will be kept online.  
Syntax  
@PJL RDYMSG DISPLAY = "message" [<CR>]<LF>  
Parameters  
Parameter  
Functional Range  
Default  
N/A  
DISPLAY = "message"  
ASCII 33 and ASCII  
35 through 255, <SP>,  
<HT>  
DISPLAY = "message"  
You can use any combination of characters available on the printer except for the quotation marks (ASCII 34)  
up to 16 characters total including spaces or horizontal tab. Characters must be enclosed in double quotes.  
Comments :  
·
·
This RDYMSG command keeps the printer online. You can display whatever message you like, for example,  
job name, person name etc..  
@PJL RDYMSG DISPLAY = ""  
This command returns the display to "00 READY".  
Example :  
The following example shows how to display the name of person who is printing the job.  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL JOB NAME = "Tom's job" <CR><LF>  
@PJL RDYMSG DISPLAY = "TOM'S JOB" <CR><LF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
The following is an example of how to restore the display to the normal ready message.  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL COMMENT Normal READY message <CR><LF>  
@PJL RDYMSG DISPLAY = "" <CR><LF>  
@PJL EOJ NAME = "End of Tom's Job" <CR><LF>  
<ESC>%-12345X  
8.3. OPMSG Command  
With the OPMSGcommand, you can display any message you like on the printer switch panel LCD. The  
printer will go off-line and stop printing until the operator presses the ON LINE key or resets the printer (Press  
SHIFT key and RESET key, then press SET key.)  
Syntax  
@PJL OPMSG DISPLAY = "message" [<CR>]<LF>  
Parameters  
Parameter  
Functional Range  
Default  
N/A  
DISPLAY = "message"  
ASCII 33 and ASCII  
35 through 255, <SP>,  
<HT>  
DISPLAY = "message"  
You can use any combination of characters available on the printer except for the quotation marks (ASCII 34)  
up to 16 characters in total including spaces or horizontal tab. Characters must be enclosed in double quotes.  
Example  
The following example shows how to display "LOAD C5 ENVELOPE" on the printer switch panel.  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL JOB NAME = "JOB C5 envelope" <CR><LF>  
@PJL OPMSG DISPLAY = "LOAD C5 ENVELOPE" <CR><LF>  
@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC>E This is C5 Envelope<ESC>E  
8.4. STMSG Command  
With the STMSGcommand, you can display any message you like on the printer switch panel LCD. The  
printer will go off-line and stop printing until the operator presses the ON LINE key or resets the printer (Press  
SHIFT key and RESET key, then press SET key.) When the printer is put back to on-line by the operator, the  
printer returns a status message giving the name of the key.  
Syntax  
@PJL STMSG DISPLAY = "message" [<CR>]<LF>  
Return Syntax  
@PJL STMSG DISPLAY = "message" <CR><LF>  
key <CR><LF>  
<FF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Parameters  
Parameter  
Functional Range  
Default  
N/A  
DISPLAY = "message"  
ASCII 33 and ASCII  
35 through 255, <SP>,  
<HT>  
key  
ONLINE, RESET  
N/A  
DISPLAY = "message"  
You can use any combination of characters available on the printer except for the quotation marks (ASCII 34)  
up to 16 characters total including spaces or horizontal tab. Characters must be enclosed in double quotes.  
key  
After the operator presses the key in order to put the printer back to on-line, this variable will be returned with  
the status response.  
Example  
Following example shows how to display "LOAD LETTER SIZE" on the printer switch panel LCD.  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL STMSG DISPLAY = "LOAD LETTER SIZE" <CR><LF>  
@PJL <CR><LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = PCL <CR><LF>  
<ESC>E... PCL job ...<ESC>E<ESC>%-12345X  
If the operator press the ONLINE key,  
@PJL STMSG DISPLAY = "LOAD LETTER SIZE"<CR><LF>  
ONLINE<CR><LF>  
<FF>  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
9.  
INDEX  
C
K
COMMENT command..................................................................................K...e..r.n..e..l...c.o...m...m...a..n..d..........................................................................1..1.............  
conditions............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 8  
context switching .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 12  
O
OPMSG command....................................................................................  
D
DEFAULT command......................................................................................................................................................................................... 25  
P
DEMOPAGE....................................................................................................................................................................................................... 10  
Device Attendance command ......................................................................................................................................................................... 44  
PCL-specific variables .............................................................................  
DINQUIRE command........................................................................................................................................................................................ 30  
PERMFONT..............................................................................................  
PJL RESET command...............................................................................  
PostScript-specific variable ....................................................................  
print environment.....................................................................................  
E
ECHO command.............................................................................................P..R...T..C...O...N...F...I.G.................................................................................3..1.............  
emulation switching.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 11  
end of Job........................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14  
R
ENTER command............................................................................................................................................................................................... 11  
Environment commands................................................................................................................................................................................... 15  
RDYMSG command.................................................................................  
EOJ command..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 14  
reset conditions........................................................................................  
EPSON-specific variables................................................................................................................................................................................. 20  
RESIFONT.................................................................................................  
EXECUTE command ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 10  
explicit switching............................................................................................................................................................................................... 12  
S
F
SET command...........................................................................................  
SHUTDOWN............................................................................................  
format .................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 6  
start of job.................................................................................................  
Status Readback commands...................................................................  
STMSG command ....................................................................................  
syntax.........................................................................................................  
I
IBM-specific variables.......................................................................................r..u..l.e..s.........................................................................................2..1.............  
implicit switching............................................................................................................................................................................................... 12  
INFO command.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 32  
U
CONFIG category......................................................................................................................................................................................... 33  
ID category ................................................................................................................................................................................................... 33  
UEL command...........................................................................................  
MEMORY category ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 35  
Universal Exit Command .........................................................................  
STATUS category ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 36  
USTATUS command...............................................................................  
USTATUS category .................................................................................................................................................................................... 38  
Device variable....................................................................................  
VARIABLES category................................................................................................................................................................................. 36  
JOB variables.......................................................................................  
information line.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 11  
PAGE variables ...................................................................................  
INITIALIZE command...................................................................................................................................................................................... 25  
TIMED variable...................................................................................  
INQUIRE command........................................................................................................................................................................................... 29  
USTATUSOFF command .......................................................................  
invalid command.................................................................................................................................................................................................. 7  
V
J
variable ......................................................................................................  
JOB Command.................................................................................................................................................................................................... 13  
variables ....................................................................................................  
job name.............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 13  
JOB recovery...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 43  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 5 PJL - 59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 6  
EPSON FX-850  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................3  
2. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................5  
3. EMULATION DETAILS.........................................................................................................................6  
3.1. Ignored Commands ................................................................................................................................ 6  
3.2. Resolution............................................................................................................................................. 6  
4. TERMINOLOGY......................................................................................................................................7  
4.1. Syntax.................................................................................................................................................. 7  
4.2. Conventions........................................................................................................................................... 7  
5. CONTROLLING THE PRINTER .........................................................................................................8  
5.1. The Control Panel .................................................................................................................................. 8  
5.2. Control codes ........................................................................................................................................ 8  
5.3. Escape sequence.................................................................................................................................. 8  
6. COMMANDS...........................................................................................................................................9  
6.1. Basic printer operations.......................................................................................................................... 9  
6.2. Page set up......................................................................................................................................... 12  
6.3. Line Spacing ....................................................................................................................................... 14  
6.4. Using Tabs.......................................................................................................................................... 16  
6.5. Using Standard Characters ................................................................................................................... 17  
6.6. Using customized characters................................................................................................................ 22  
6.7. Graphics............................................................................................................................................. 24  
7. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 30  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
COMMAND LIST  
NUL  
BEL  
Null  
Bell  
9
9
SP  
Space  
9
BS  
Backspace  
9
CR  
Carriage return  
9
LF  
Line Feed  
9
FF  
Form Feed  
9
Esc SP n  
Esc a n  
Esc $ n1 n2  
Esc \ n1 n2  
Esc <  
Esc U  
Esc =  
Esc >  
Esc #  
Set inter-character space  
Select justification mode  
Set absolute print position  
Set relative print position  
Select unidirectional printing  
Select / cancel unidirectional printing  
Set data MSB to 0  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
11  
11  
11  
11  
11  
11  
11  
11  
12  
12  
12  
12  
12  
13  
13  
13  
13  
13  
13  
13  
14  
14  
14  
14  
14  
15  
Set data MSB to 1  
Cancel MSB setting  
Select near letter quality or draft  
Select / cancel half speed mode  
Enable printer  
Disable printer  
Initialize printer  
Reset printer / change emulation mode  
User reset  
Paper input control  
Enable out-of-paper sensor  
Disable out-of-paper sensor  
Set page length  
Esc x n  
Esc s n  
DC1  
DC3  
Esc @  
Esc CR mode  
Esc CR ! # R  
Esc EM n  
Esc 9  
Esc 8  
Esc C n  
Esc C NUL n  
Esc n  
Esc Q n  
Esc N n  
Esc O  
Esc 2  
Esc 0  
Esc 1  
Esc A n  
Esc 3 n  
Esc J n  
Esc j n  
Set page length  
Set left margin  
Set right margin  
Set perforation skip  
Cancel perforation skip  
Select 1/6" line spacing  
Select 1/8" line spacing  
Select 7/72" line spacing  
Select n/72" line spacing  
Select n/216" line spacing  
Perform n/216" line feed  
Perform n/216" reverse line feed  
Esc D n1 n2 n3 ... NUL  
Set horizontal tab stops  
Horizontal tab  
Esc B n1 n2 n3 ... NUL  
Set vertical tab stops  
Esc b n m1 m2 m3 ... NUL  
Set vertical channel tab stops  
HT  
15  
15  
15  
Esc / n  
VT  
Esc P  
Esc M  
Esc p n  
SI  
Select vertical tab channel  
Vertical tab  
16  
16  
16  
16  
16  
17  
17  
Set pitch to 10 characters per inch  
Set pitch to 12 characters per inch  
Select / cancel proportional spacing  
Select condensed character mode I  
Select condensed character mode II  
Esc SI  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
DC2  
Cancel condensed character mode  
Select emphasized character mode  
Cancel emphasized character mode  
Select double-strike mode  
17  
17  
17  
17  
17  
17  
18  
18  
18  
18  
18  
18  
19  
19  
19  
19  
20  
20  
20  
20  
20  
21  
Esc E  
Esc F  
Esc G  
Esc H  
Esc W n  
SO  
Esc SO  
DC4  
Esc 4  
Cancel double-strike mode  
Select / Cancel double-width printing  
Select single-line double-width printing (I)  
Select single-line double-width printing (II)  
Cancel single-line double-width printing  
Select italic mode  
Esc 5  
Cancel italic mode  
Esc S n  
Esc T  
Esc w n  
Esc - n  
Esc ! n  
Esc 6  
Select superscript / subscript mode  
Cancel superscript / subscript mode  
Select / cancel double-height printing  
Select / cancel underline mode  
Select printing mode  
Select expansion of printable code area  
Cancel expansion of printable code area  
Expand printable code area  
Esc 7  
Esc l n  
Esc R n  
Esc t n  
Select international character set  
Select italic / graphic character table  
Esc & NUL n1 n2 ( n3 <character definition data> )  
Define characters  
Esc % n NUL  
Esc : 0 0 0  
Esc * m n1 n2 < image data >  
Select image mode  
Select standard / downloaded characters  
Copy ROM character to RAM  
21  
22  
22  
Esc ? n m  
Esc ^ a n1 n2  
Reassign image mode  
Print 9 bit image  
22  
23  
24  
Esc K n1 n2 <image data>  
Print single-density image  
Esc L n1 n2 <image data>  
Print double-density image  
Esc Y n1 n2 <image data>  
Print double-speed double-density image  
Esc Z n1 n2 <image data>  
Print quadruple-density  
24  
25  
25  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
INTRODUCTION  
In this mode you can control the HL-Series printers that support this emulation directly by incorporating  
control codes and escape sequences into your program. Alternatively, applications software (for example,  
your word-processing or spreadsheet software) may send the necessary commands to the printer  
automatically. Check the manual that came with your software for instructions on how to use your  
application with an Epson FX-850 printer.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
EMULATION DETAILS  
The following points should be borne in mind when using the printer in Epson FX-850 mode.  
3.1. Ignored Commands  
The following commands are ignored: the BEL control code (ASCII code 7) which is normally used to  
sound a printer’s bell, the DC1 (ASCII 17) and DC3 (ASCII 19) control codes, used to enable and disable  
a printer, the Esc 9 and Esc 8 commands, which normally enable and disable the out-of-paper sensor, the  
Esc < and Esc U commands for enabling unidirectional printing and the Esc x control code for choosing  
between near letter quality and draft printing.  
In addition, commands that try to change the printer’s printing speed cannot do so, since the HL-Series  
printers always print as fast as they can. Hence, the Esc s command, to select or cancel half-speed  
printing mode, is also ignored, and the Esc Y escape sequence (Print Double-Speed, Double-Density  
Image), performs the same function as the Esc L (Print Double-Density Image) command.  
3.2. Resolution  
The resolution of our recent printers is 600 dots per inch. (HL-2060 supports 1200dpi.) Some instructions  
use fractions of an inch by which 600 is not exactly divisible, for example Esc J performs a line feed using  
a line spacing of n/216". Similarly, there are graphics commands which specify resolutions of 72, 120 and  
240 dots per inch. When a line spacing or graphic cannot be implemented exactly at 600 dots per inch the  
printer approximates as closely as possible using 600 dots per inch.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
TERMINOLOGY  
4.1. Syntax  
The following conventions are used in this description of the Epson FX-850 mode software commands:  
A single letter, two or three-letter control code mnemonic, or number in upright bold text is a literal  
character and should be sent to the printer as the character code.  
A letter or word in italics is a variable and you must substitute an appropriate value when you use the  
command.  
A statement element enclosed in angle brackets <> consists of a stream of data whose length is defined  
within the same command. The data consists of numbers represented by bytes which are sent to the  
printer as if they were ASCII character codes.  
4.2. Conventions  
Although the machine is a laser printer and does not physically have a print head, for the purposes of this  
emulation description, we refer to the location on the page at which the printer is currently positioned to  
print as the print position.  
The printable area is the area of the page where the printer can place a dot.  
The bits that comprise a byte of data are numbered 1 to 8. Bit 1 is the least significant bit (LSB) and bit 8  
is the most significant bit (MSB).  
The lower case ‘L’ character is shown as an ‘ l ’ in the Esc l printer command, to distinguish it from the  
character ‘1’ (one).  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.  
CONTROLLING THE PRINTER  
Commands are invoked using either control codes or escape sequences. You can send them to the printer  
as part of a program using the same command that you would use to print a string on the printer. For  
example in BASIC you would use the LPRINT command.  
The printer’s control panel can also be used to set various operating parameters. Try to ensure that the  
control panel settings and computer generated settings do not conflict with one another, or you may not  
get the results you require.  
5.1. The Control Panel  
Refer to the printer User’s Guide for a description of how to use the printer’s control panel switches. You  
should be aware, however, that the following can be set using the control panel: automatic line feed (a line  
feed is performed with every carriage return), auto mask (two-line top and bottom margins are  
automatically used on every page), paper size, top, bottom, left and right margins, the number of lines of  
text per page, orientation (portrait or landscape), the current font and the emulation mode. Conflict  
between control panel settings and the settings you establish with software commands (or from  
applications software) is by far the most likely cause of unexpected printing results. Use this manual in  
conjunction with the printer User's guide to resolve these conflicts.  
5.2. Control codes  
Control codes are ASCII codes that instruct the printer to perform a particular operation, such as a line  
feed. You can send a control code to the printer by sending the same type of instruction you would use  
to print a character using its ASCII code number. For example, the ASCII code for a form feed is 12, so to  
make the printer perform a form feed use the following BASIC statement:  
LPRINT CHR$(12);  
The CHR$ operator is normally used to convert an ASCII code into its corresponding character.  
5.3. Escape sequence  
Escape sequences tell the printer what Epson FX-850 mode function to perform. An escape sequence  
consists of the Esc character followed by one or more characters which define the operation to be  
performed. Send an escape sequence to the printer by sending the same type of instruction you would  
use to print characters using their ASCII codes. Some escape sequences require parameter values or data  
following them, for example, commands which turn a particular feature on and off, or commands for  
printing graphic images. Numerical parameter data, too, is sent to the printer as if it were a character code  
to be printed. For example, to move the print position to the third column position on the page the  
required escape sequence is Esc HT 3. In BASIC this would be:  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(9); CHR$(3);  
In some instances where a numerical parameter can only take the values 0 or 1, you have a choice between  
sending the number or the character code itself as the numerical parameter. Hence you can use CHR$(0)  
or CHR$(48) to represent 0, and use CHR$(1) or CHR$(49) to represent 1. The practice of using character  
code numbers CHR$(48) and CHR$(49) is not recommended, however, as it is not conducive to clear  
programming and, in any case, is not universally available on commands whose parameters can only be  
either 0 or 1.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.  
COMMANDS  
6.1. Basic printer operations  
The most common printer operations are described in this section. Some are invoked using control codes  
alone - the rest require escape sequences. For the sake of completeness, several instructions which are  
part of the Epson FX-850 mode instruction sets, but which an HL Series printer ignores are included.  
Null  
NUL  
(0)  
<00h>  
NUL (ASCII code 0) is ignored.  
Bell  
BEL  
(7)  
<07h>  
BEL (ASCII code 7) is ignored.  
Space  
SP  
(32)  
<20h>  
The SP control code (ASCII code 32) moves the current print position one space to the right.  
LPRINT CHR$(32); 'Print a space  
Backspace  
BS  
(08)  
<08h>  
·
·
The BS control code (ASCII code 8) moves the current print position one space to the left.  
This code is only effective when used with left justification, which is the default justification mode.  
LPRINT CHR$(8); 'Backspace  
Carriage return  
CR  
(13)  
<0Dh>  
·
·
The CR control code (ASCII 13) moves the print position to the left margin on the current line.  
If automatic line feed is on, this code moves the current print position to the left margin on the next  
line. On some printers you can turn on automatic line feed using the control panel switches.  
LPRINT CHR$(13); 'Carriage return  
Line feed  
LF  
(10)  
<0Ah>  
·
The LF control code (ASCII code 10) moves the current print position down one line, using the  
current line space setting.  
·
·
This code does not cause a carriage return to be performed.  
If the print position is such that this operation would move it below the bottom margin, the current  
page is ejected and the print position is moved to the top of the next page instead.  
Form feed  
FF  
(12)  
<0Ch>  
·
·
·
The FF control code (ASCII code 12) ejects the current page and moves the current print position to  
the top of the next page, unless the current page is blank.  
This code does not cause a carriage return to be performed, hence the print position does not change  
horizontally.  
If the current page is blank this control code has no effect.  
LPRINT CHR$(12); 'Form feed  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Set inter-character space  
EscSPn (27)(32)n <1Bh><20h>n  
This command allows you to set the space between successive characters.  
·
·
·
n is the space between characters in multiples of 1/120".  
n must be in the range 0 to 127.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(32); CHR$(5); 'Set 1/24" char space  
Select justification mode  
Escan (27)(97)n  
<1Bh><61h>n  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to select the justification mode for subsequent text.  
Set n to 0 to select left justification.  
Set n to 1 to centre subsequent text.  
Set n to 2 to select right justification.  
Set n to 3 to select full justification (text will be both left and right justified).  
The default justification mode is left justification.  
The horizontal tab, HT, and backspace, BS, control codes can only be used in left justification mode.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(97); CHR$(2); 'Right justify text  
Set absolute print position  
Esc$n1n2 (27)(36)n1n2  
<1Bh><24h>n1n2  
·
·
·
This command allows you to print characters a specified distance in from the left margin.  
The unit of movement is 1/60".  
The specified distance to be moved is n1+(n2*256)/120".  
·
If the specified position is to the right of the right margin the command is ignored.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(36); CHR$(120); CHR$(0); 'Print a line 2" in  
Set relative print position  
Esc\n1n2 (27)(92)n1n2  
<1Bh><5Ch>n1n2  
·
This command allows you to print characters a specified distance to the left or right of the current  
print position.  
·
·
The unit of movement is 1/120".  
If you wish to move the print position to the right, the distance the print position is to be moved is  
calculated as (n1+(n2*256))/120".  
·
·
If you wish to move the print position to the left, the distance the print position is to be moved is  
calculated as (65536 – (n1+(n2*256)))/120".  
If the specified position is beyond the left or right margin the command is ignored.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(36); CHR$(180); CHR$(0); 'Print a line 1.5" to  
the right  
Select unidirectional printing  
Esc< (27)(60)  
This command has no effect.  
<1Bh><3Ch>  
Select / cancel unidirectional printing  
EscU  
(27)(85)  
<1Bh><55h>  
This command has no effect.  
Set data MSB to 0  
Esc=  
(27)(61)  
<1Bh><3Dh>  
·
·
This command enables you to set the most significant bit of incoming data bytes to 0.  
This command does not affect data comprising a graphics image or data that defines a downloadable  
character.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(61); 'Set MSB to 0  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Set data MSB to 1  
Esc> (27)(62)  
<1Bh><3Eh>  
·
·
This command enables you to set the most significant bit of incoming data bytes to 1.  
This command does not affect data comprising a graphics image or data that defines a downloadable  
character.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(62); 'Set MSB to 1  
Cancel MSB setting  
Esc# (27)(35)  
<1Bh><23h>  
This command cancels the two commands that set the most significant bit of incoming data bytes (Esc =  
and Esc >).  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(35); 'Cancel MSB setting  
Select Near Letter Quality or Draft  
Escxn  
(27)(120)n  
<1Bh><78h>n  
<1Bh><73h>n  
The printer ignores this command.  
Select / cancel half speed mode  
Escsn  
(27)(115)n  
The printer ignores this command.  
Enable printer  
DC1  
(17)  
<11h>  
The printer ignores this command.  
Disable printer  
DC3  
(19)  
<13h>  
The printer ignores this command.  
Initialize printer  
Esc@  
(27)(64) <1Bh><40h>  
·
·
This command resets the printer.  
All remaining data is printed out and the printer default settings are restored.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(64); 'Printer reset  
Reset printer / change emulation mode  
EscCR<mode> (27)(13)mode  
<1Bh><0Dh>mode  
·
·
This command enables you to switch emulation mode or to reset the printer.  
Change emulation mode by setting mode to the appropriate letter or pair of letters. Set mode to ‘D’ to  
switch to Diablo mode, ‘H’ to switch to LaserJet mode, ‘I’ to switch to IBM Proprinter XL mode, 'AB'  
to switch to BR-Script Batch mode, 'AI' to switch BR-Script Interactive mode, 'GL' to switch to HP-GL  
mode.  
·
·
If you set mode to ‘E’ in Epson FX-850 mode , a printer reset is performed.  
If you set mode to ‘FD’, to reset the printer to its factory default settings, LaserJet mode (the factory  
default emulation mode) is selected and the LaserJet factory default environment is restored. For a list  
of the factory default settings see the sub-section “Factory default environment” in Chapter 2 "PCL"  
of this manual.  
·
On receiving this command the printer prints any remaining data and performs a page eject (unless the  
current page is blank). The newly selected emulation mode’s default settings come into effect, except  
when mode is set to ‘FD’.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(13); CHR$(73); 'Change to IBM Proprinter mode  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
User reset  
EscCR!#R  
(27)(13)(33)#(82)  
<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<52h>  
·
·
·
# = 0, the printer restores to the current user setting.  
# = 1, the printer restores to user settings 1.  
# = 2, the printer restores to user settings 2.  
Paper Input Control  
EscEMn  
(27)(25)n  
<1Bh><19h>n  
n Value  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/3260N/2460  
n = 0  
n = 1  
n = 2  
n = 3  
n = 4  
n = 5  
n = R  
Initialize the feeder mode.  
Feed from the MP tray.  
Feed from Tray 1.  
Feed from Tray 2.  
Feed from Tray 3.  
Feed from Tray 4.  
Eject paper.  
n Value  
HL-1050  
n = 0  
Initialize the feeder mode.  
Feed from the tray.  
Eject paper.  
n = 1/2  
n = R  
n Value HL-1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1650/1670N  
n = 0  
n = 1  
n = 2  
n = R  
Initialize the feeder mode.  
Feed fromthe Tray 1.  
Feed from the Tray 2.  
Eject paper.  
Enable out-of-paper sensor  
Esc9 (27)(57)  
<1Bh><39h>  
<1Bh><38h>  
The printer ignores this command.  
Disable out-of-paper sensor  
Esc8  
(27)(56)  
The printer ignores this command.  
6.2. Page set up  
Set page length  
EscCn  
(27)(67)n  
<1Bh><43h>n  
This command sets the page length in lines.  
or  
EscCNULn (27)(67)(00)n <1Bh><43h><00h>n  
·
·
·
This command sets the page length in inches.  
The top of form position is set to be the current line.  
n is the number of lines that make up one page, or the length of the page in inches, according to which  
form of the command is used.  
·
·
If the first form of the command is used (n = the number of lines in the page) the current line spacing  
setting is used to determine the length of the page.  
If the first form of the command is used, n must be in the range 1 to 127.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
If the second form of the command is used (n = page length in inches), n must be in the range 1 to 14.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(67); CHR$(40); '40 lines per page  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(67); CHR$(0); CHR$(11); '11 inches per page  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Set left margin  
Escln (27)(108)n  
<1Bh><6Ch>n  
·
This command sets the left margin in columns from the left edge of the page. The width of a column is  
the current character width.  
·
·
·
In proportional spacing mode a column width of 1/10" is adopted.  
This command clears all tab settings.  
The minimum space allowed between the left and right margins is 1/5".  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(108); CHR$(10); 'Left margin 1" at 10 cpi  
Set right margin  
EscQn (27)(81)n  
<1Bh><51h>n  
·
This command sets the right margin in columns from the left edge of the page. The width of a column  
is the current character width.  
·
·
·
In proportional spacing mode a column width of 1/10" is adopted.  
This command clears all tab settings.  
The minimum space allowed between the left and right margins is 1/5".  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(81); CHR$(72); 'Right margin 6" at 12 cpi  
Set perforation skip  
EscNn (27)(78)n  
<1Bh><4Eh>n  
·
This command sets the bottom margin and enables perforation skip, that is, whenever the print  
position reaches the bottom margin the printer performs a page eject and moves the print position to  
the top of the next page.  
·
n = the number of lines at the current line spacing setting between the bottom margin and the bottom  
edge of the paper.  
·
·
·
n must be in the range 1 to 127.  
Esc C (Set Page Length) and Esc O (Cancel Perforation Skip) cancel automatic perforation skip.  
If the bottom margin specified by this command would be located above the top margin, the command  
is ignored.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(78); CHR$(4); 'Set bottom margin to 4 lines.  
Cancel perforation skip  
EscO (27)(79)  
<1Bh><4Fh>  
This command cancels the automatic perforation skip feature.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(79); 'Cancel perforation skip.  
6.3. Line Spacing  
Select 1/6" line spacing  
Esc2  
(27)(50)  
<1Bh><32h>  
·
This command sets the line spacing to 1/6". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print  
position 1/6" down the page.  
·
This line spacing is the default setting when the printer is switched on or reset.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(50); 'Set line spacing to 1/6".  
Select 1/8" line spacing  
Esc0 (27)(48)  
<1Bh><30h>  
This command sets the line spacing to 1/8". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print  
position 1/8" down the page.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(48); 'Set line spacing to 1/8".  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Select 7/72" line spacing  
Esc1 (27)(49)  
<1Bh><31h>  
·
This command sets the line spacing to 7/72". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print  
position 7/72" down the page.  
·
Since the printer resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing will not be exactly 7/72".  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(49); 'Set line spacing to 7/72".  
Select n/72" line spacing  
EscAn (27)(65)n  
<1Bh><41h>n  
·
This command sets the line spacing to n/72". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print  
position n/72" down the page.  
·
·
·
Since the printer’s resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing will not be exactly n/72".  
n must be in the range 1 to 85.  
If n is outside the range 1 to 85 the default line spacing, 1/6" is selected.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(65); CHR$(10); 'Set line spacing of 10/72".  
Select n/216" line spacing  
Esc3n (27)(51)n  
<1Bh><33h>n  
·
This command sets the line spacing to n/216". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print  
position n/216" down the page.  
·
·
Since the printer’s resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing will not be exactly n/216".  
n must be in the range 1 to 255.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(51); CHR$(25); 'Select line spacing of 25/216".  
Perform n/216" line feed  
EscJn (27)(74)n  
<1Bh><4Ah>n  
·
·
·
·
·
This command performs a single line feed, moving the print position down the page by n/216".  
This command does not perform a carriage return.  
The current line spacing setting is not affected.  
n must be in the range 0 to 255.  
The actual vertical distance moved may not be exactly the distance you specify due to the printer’s  
600 dots per inch resolution.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(74); CHR$(54); '1/4" line feed  
Perform n/216" reverse line feed  
Escjn (27)(106)n  
This command performs a single reverse line feed, moving the print position up the page by n/216".  
<1Bh><6Ah>n  
·
·
·
·
This command does not perform a carriage return.  
The current line spacing setting is not affected.  
n must be in the range 0 to 255.  
The actual vertical distance moved may not be exactly the distance you specify due to the printer’s  
600 dots per inch resolution.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(106); CHR$(108); '1/2" line feed  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.4. Using Tabs  
Set horizontal tab stops  
EscDn1n2n3...NUL  
(27)(68)n1n2n3...(00)  
<1Bh><44h>n1n2n3...<00h>  
·
·
This command enables you to set up to 32 horizontal tab stops based on the current character width.  
The character width setting is determined by the combination of the current pitch (10 or 12 characters  
per inch) and the current character mode (condensed, normal or double-width). If proportional  
spacing is being used the character width is based on a pitch of 10 characters per inch.  
·
The tab stops must be set in ascending order. If you invoke the command with the tabs in any other  
order all horizontal tab settings are cleared.  
·
·
The value of ni must be in the range 0 to 255.  
Once you have selected the tab settings they remain fixed - their position does not change if you  
change the character pitch or character width settings.  
·
·
·
To set up a group of equally spaced tab stops use the Esc e 0 command.  
Esc D 0 clears all horizontal tab settings.  
The default tab stop settings are at every eighth column, starting at the ninth column. The default  
column width is 1/10".  
·
·
The default settings are adopted when the printer is first switched on or when you perform a reset with  
the Esc @ instruction.  
You can move the print position to the tab stops using the HT control code.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(68); CHR$(10); CHR$(20); CHR$(0);  
'Set tab stops at columns 10 and 20.  
Horizontal tab  
HT  
(09)  
<09h>  
·
·
The HT control code (ASCII code 9) moves the current print position one tab stop to the right.  
The command is ignored if there are no tab stops to the right of the current print position or if the next  
tab stop is beyond the right margin.  
LPRINT CHR$(9); 'Tab  
Set vertical tab stops  
EscBn1n2n3...NUL  
(27)(66)n1n2n3...(00) <1Bh><42h>n1n2n3...<00h>  
·
·
·
This command enables you to set up to sixteen vertical tab stops based on the current line space  
setting.  
The tab stops must be set in ascending order. If you specify the tab settings in any other order, any  
settings made with a previous Esc B command are cleared.  
The value of ni must be in the range 0 to 255.  
·
·
·
·
Vertical tab settings are not affected by subsequent changes in the line spacing setting.  
To set up a group of equally spaced tab stops use the Esc e 1 command.  
Esc B 0 clears the vertical tab settings set with a previous Esc B command.  
You can move the print position to the tab stops using the VT control code.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(66); CHR$(12); CHR$(24); CHR$(0);  
'Set tab stops at lines 12 and 24.  
Set vertical channel tab stops  
Escbnm1m2m3...NUL (27)(98)nm1m2m3...(00) <1Bh><62h>nm1m2m3...<00h>  
·
You can set up to eight different sets of vertical tab stops and select any of these sets for use at any  
time. Each set of tab stops is called a channel - channels are numbered from 0 to 7.  
·
Channel 0 normally holds the settings you have selected with the Esc B command, or equally spaced  
tab settings that you have set with the Esc e 1 command. However, you can also set the channel 0 tab  
settings using the Esc b command.  
·
·
To set the tab stops held in channels 1 to 7 you must use the Esc b command.  
This command enables you to set up to sixteen vertical tab stops for each channel based on the  
current line space setting.  
·
n is the channel number whose tab stops are to be set.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
·
mi specifies the tab based on the current line space setting.  
The value of mi must be in the range 0 to 255.  
The tab stops must be set in ascending order. If you specify a channel’s tab settings in any other  
order, any previous settings made for that channel are cleared.  
·
·
·
Vertical tab settings are not affected by subsequent changes in the line spacing setting.  
Esc b n 0 clears the vertical tab settings set for channel n.  
You can select a channel using the Esc / command and move the print position to its tab stops using  
the VT control code.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(98); CHR$(1); CHR$(10); CHR$(20); CHR$(0);  
'Set tab stops at lines 10 and 20.  
Select vertical tab channel  
Esc/n (27)(47)n  
<1Bh><2Fh>n  
·
This command allows you to select a set of vertical tabs (or channel) that you defined using the Esc b  
command.  
·
·
·
All subsequent vertical tab commands use the selected tab channel’s settings.  
n must be in the range from 0 to 7.  
The default channel is channel 0. Channel 0 is the current channel when the printer is first switched  
on or after a reset with the Esc @ command.  
·
There are no default vertical tab settings for any channel.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(47); CHR$(5); 'Select vertical tab channel 5  
Vertical tab  
VT  
(11)  
<0Bh>  
·
·
·
The VT control code (ASCII 11) moves the current print position one vertical tab stop down the page.  
The current vertical tab channel’s settings are used.  
If you have not previously selected a vertical tab channel with the Esc / command, channel 0, the  
default channel is used.  
If you have not set any vertical tab stops for the current channel with either the Esc B, Esc b, or Esc e  
1 commands, the print position is moved down one line using the current line space setting.  
·
·
If there are no tab stops below the current print position a line feed is performed.  
If no tab stops have been set a carriage return and line feed are performed.  
LPRINT CHR$(11); ' Vertical tab  
6.5. Using Standard Characters  
Set pitch to 10 characters per inch  
EscP  
(27)(80)  
<1Bh><50h>  
This command sets the printing pitch to 10 characters per inch (cpi).  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(80); 'Set pitch to 10 cpi  
Set pitch to 12 characters per inch  
EscM  
(27)(77)  
<1Bh><4Dh>  
This command sets the printing pitch to 12 characters per inch (cpi).  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(77); 'Set pitch to 12 cpi  
Select / cancel proportional spacing  
Escpn  
(27)(112)n  
<1Bh><70h>n  
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to turn proportional spacing on or off.  
Setting n to 1 turns proportional spacing on. Subsequent text is printed proportionally spaced.  
Setting n to 0 turns proportional spacing off. Subsequent text is printed monospaced.  
When you specify the value for n you can use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49) instead  
of 0 and 1.  
·
Selecting proportional spacing cancels condensed character mode.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
You cannot use the backspace, BS, code in proportional spacing mode.  
If you change the character pitch using Esc P or Esc M, proportional spacing is automatically turned  
off.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(112); CHR$(1); 'Turn proportional spacing on  
Select condensed character mode I  
SI  
(15)  
<0Fh>  
·
This command selects condensed character mode. Subsequent text characters are condensed  
horizontally when printed.  
·
Selecting proportional spacing cancels condensed character mode.  
LPRINT CHR$(15); 'Set condensed character mode  
Select condensed character mode II  
EscSI (27)(15) <1B><0F>  
·
This command selects condensed character mode. Subsequent text characters are condensed  
horizontally when printed.  
·
·
Selecting proportional spacing cancels condensed character mode.  
This command functions exactly like the SIcontrol code.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(15); 'Set condensed character mode  
Cancel condensed character mode  
DC2 (18) <12h>  
This command cancels condensed character mode. Subsequent text characters are printed normally.  
LPRINT CHR$(18); 'Cancel condensed character mode  
Select emphasized character mode  
EscE  
(27)(69)  
<1Bh><45h>  
This command turns emphasized character mode on. Subsequent text is printed with a bold stroke width.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(69); 'Turn emphasized character mode on  
Cancel emphasized character mode  
EscF  
(27)(70)  
<1Bh><46h>  
This command turns emphasized character mode off. Subsequent text is printed with a medium stroke  
width.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(70); 'Turn emphasized character mode off  
Select double-strike mode  
EscG  
(27)(71)  
<1Bh><47h>  
This command turns double-strike mode on. Subsequent text is printed with a bold stroke width.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(71); 'Turn double-strike printing mode on  
Cancel double-strike mode  
EscH  
(27)(72)  
<1Bh><48h>  
This command turns double-strike mode off. Subsequent text is printed with a medium stroke width.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(72); 'Turn double-strike printing mode off  
Select / cancel double-width printing  
EscWn  
(27)(87)n  
<1Bh><57h>n  
·
·
This command turns double-width printing on or off.  
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed using double-width characters. The line spacing setting is  
doubled.  
·
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters. The previous character pitch  
setting is restored.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
When you specify a value for n you may also use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49)  
instead of 0 and 1.  
·
·
Only Esc W 0 can be used to cancel double-width printing mode set using the Esc W 1 instruction.  
Esc W 0 cancels double-width printing mode set using the Esc W 1 instruction, the SO control code  
or the Esc SO instruction.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(87); CHR$(1); 'Set double-width printing mode  
Select single-line double-width printing (I)  
SO  
(27)  
<0Eh>  
·
This command turns double-width printing mode on for one line only. The subsequent line of text is  
printed using double-width characters and with the line spacing setting doubled.  
·
·
The following commands cancel double-width printing mode set using the SO control code: LF, FF,  
VT, Esc W 0, DC4, and ESC @.  
If the “auto LF” (automatic line feed) function has been turned on from the control panel, the carriage  
return control code, CR, will also cancel double-width printing mode selected with the SO control  
code.  
LPRINT CHR$(14); 'Set double-width printing mode for one line  
Select single-line double-width printing (II)  
EscSO (27)(14) <1Bh><03h>  
·
·
·
This command turns double-width printing mode on for one line only. The subsequent line of text is  
printed using double-width characters and with the line spacing setting doubled.  
The following commands cancel double-width printing mode set using the SO escape sequence: LF,  
FF, VT, Esc W 0, DC4, and ESC @.  
If the “auto LF” (automatic line feed) function has been turned on from the control panel, the carriage  
return control code, CR, will also cancel double-width printing mode selected with the Esc SO escape  
sequence.  
·
This command functions exactly like the SO control code.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(14); 'Set double-width printing mode for one line  
Cancel single-line double-width printing  
DC4 (20) <14h>  
·
This control code cancels single-line double-width mode set with the SO control code or with the Esc  
SO escape sequence. Subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters.  
·
The previous character pitch is restored.  
LPRINT CHR$(20); 'Cancel enlarged character mode set with SO  
Select italic mode  
Esc4 (27)(52)  
<1Bh><34h>  
·
·
This command enables the italic printing mode. Subsequent text is printed in italic style.  
You can still use italic text even after selecting the extended character set with the Esc t command.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(52); 'Italic mode  
Cancel italic mode  
Esc5 (27)(53)  
<1Bh><35h>  
This command cancels the italic printing mode. Subsequent text is printed upright.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(53); 'Cancel italic mode  
Select superscript / subscript mode  
EscSn  
(27)(83)n  
<1Bh><53h>n  
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to print superscripts or subscripts.  
Set n to 0 to print subsequent text using superscript characters.  
Set n to 1 to print subsequent text using subscript characters.  
When you specify the value for n you may use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49) instead  
of 0 and 1.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
Selecting either superscript or subscript mode cancels double-height printing mode.  
You can cancel either superscript or subscript mode with the Esc T command.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(83); CHR$(0); 'Turn on superscript mode  
Cancel superscript / subscript mode  
EscT (27)(84) <1Bh><54h>  
·
·
This command cancels superscript or subscript printing mode.  
Subsequent text is printed using normal characters.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(84); 'Turn off superscript mode  
Select / cancel double-height printing  
Escwn (27)(119)n <1Bh><77h>n  
·
·
This command turns double-height printing on or off.  
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed using double-height characters. The line space setting is  
doubled.  
·
·
·
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters. The previous line spacing is  
restored.  
When you specify a value for n you may also use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49)  
instead of 0 and 1.  
You cannot use superscript, subscript or condensed printing modes in conjunction with double-  
height printing. If you try to select any of these three modes while in double-height printing the  
command will be ignored.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(119); CHR$(1); 'Set double-height printing mode  
Select / cancel underline mode  
Esc–n (27)(45)n  
<1B><2D>n  
·
·
This command turns character underlining on or off.  
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed underlined. All characters, including space characters, are  
underlined with a continuous line.  
·
·
·
Horizontal tabbed spaces are never underlined.  
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is not underlined.  
When you specify a value for n you may also use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49)  
instead of 0 and 1.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(45); CHR$(1); 'Underline following text  
Select printing mode  
Esc!n (27)(33)n  
<1Bh><21h>n  
·
·
This command allows you to select a combination of printing modes with just one command.  
The various modes are weighted as shown. Add the numbers that correspond to each mode you  
require and set n to the total.  
10 characters per inch  
12 characters per inch  
Proportional spacing  
Condensed mode  
Emphasized mode  
Double-strike mode  
Double-width mode  
Italic printing  
0
1
2
4
8
16  
32  
64  
128  
Underline mode  
·
·
·
Double-strike and emphasized modes are identical.  
Proportional spacing overrides either character pitch setting (10 cpi or 12 cpi).  
Proportional spacing and condensed mode cannot be combined. Proportional spacing has  
precedence.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(33); CHR$(138); 'Proportionally space, emphasize  
& underline following text.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Select expansion of printable code area  
Esc6 (27)(54) <1Bh><36h>  
·
·
This command enables you to print characters whose character codes are in the range 128 to 159.  
You can define your own characters and assign codes in this range to them.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(54); 'Expand printable area  
Cancel expansion of printable code area  
Esc7 (27)(55) <1Bh><37h>  
This command prevents you from printing characters with codes in the range 128 to 159.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(55); 'Cancel codes 128–159  
Expand printable code area  
EscIn  
(27)(73)n  
<1Bh><49h>n  
·
This command permits you to enable or disable the printing of characters whose character codes are in  
the ranges 0 to 31 and 128 to 159. You can define your own characters and assign codes in these  
ranges to them.  
·
·
·
Set n to 1 to enable printing of characters in the ranges 0 to 31 and 128 to 159.  
Set n to 0 to disable printing of characters in the ranges 0 to 31 and 128 to 159.  
When you specify the value for n you can use the character codes for ‘0’ and ‘1’ (48 and 49) instead  
of 0 and 1 if you wish.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(73); CHR$(1); 'Expand printable area  
Select international character set  
EscRn (27)(82)n <1Bh><52h>n  
·
·
·
·
·
This command selects one of the available international character sets, refer to the printer User Guide  
for supported character sets.  
Each character set varies slightly from the others and contains a small number of special characters  
necessary for printing in that particular language.  
The selection you make with this command does not affect any italic or graphics character table  
selection that you may have made with the Esc t command.  
The character sets listed below, plus several others, can also be selected from the printer’s control  
panel.  
The character sets available and the corresponding values of n are as follows:  
US ASCII  
French I  
German  
UK ASCII I  
Danish I  
Swedish  
Italy  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Japanese  
Norwegian  
Danish II  
UK ASCII II  
French II  
Dutch  
8
9
10  
13  
14  
15  
South African 16  
Spanish  
·
If you have selected the graphics character table with the Esc t 1 command the following additional  
character sets are available.  
Norwegian set I  
Norwegian set II  
17  
18  
IBM set I  
IBM set II  
19  
20  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(82); CHR$(3); 'Select British char set  
Select italic / graphics character table  
Esctn (27)(116)n <1Bh><74h>n  
·
This command allows you to choose between two character tables - the italic character table and the  
graphics character table.  
·
·
The two tables are shown in the Epson FX-850 section of the appendix at the end of this manual.  
Set n to 0 to select the italic character table. Character codes in the range 160 to 255 are now italic  
characters.  
·
·
Set n to 1 to select the extended character table. Character codes in the range 128 to 255 are now  
foreign language and graphics characters.  
You can still print italic characters using the Select Italic Mode, Esc 4, command even when you have  
selected the graphics character table.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.6. Using customized characters  
Define characters  
Esc&NULn1n2(n3<character definition data>) (27)(38)(00)n1n2(n3....)  
<1Bh><26h><00h>n1n2(n3...)  
·
·
This command enables you to define and download characters for printing.  
Monospaced characters are designed on a grid eleven dots wide by nine dots high. Characters either  
occupy the top 8 rows of the grid (ascending characters) or rows 2 to 9 of the grid (descending  
characters).  
Character width  
Blank columns  
1
2
3
4
Rows 1 - 8  
5
6
7
Rows 2 - 9  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
Replication area  
·
Proportionally spaced characters are subject to the same height constraints (that is, eight dots high  
and either ascending or descending). The width of proportionally spaced characters is specified by  
the value in n3.  
·
·
·
n1 is the character code of the first character in the sequence to be defined.  
n2 is the character code of the last character in the sequence to be defined.  
It is assumed that you are defining a sequence of characters whose code numbers increment by one  
for each character as default. If this is not the case, you must split the characters you are defining  
into sets of characters with contiguous code numbers and use a separate command for each set.  
Each character is defined as a series of bytes - each byte defining a column of dots. The columns are  
read from left to right in the order in which they occur in the definition. The most significant bit of  
each byte represents the top dot of the column, and the least significant bit represents the bottom dot.  
Simply set a bit to 1 to print a dot in that position on the grid, or to 0 to print white space.  
·
·
·
The MSB (bit 8) of n3 specifies whether the defined character is an ascender or a descender. Set bit 8  
to 0 when defining an ascender, and to 1 for a descender. Ascending characters occupy the top 8  
rows of the grid while descending characters occupy rows 2 to 9 of the grid.  
Bits 5 to 7 of n3 specify the number of columns left blank to the left of the defined character in  
proportional spacing mode. The number of columns to skip is the number held in bits 5 to 7 minus 1.  
Up to six columns can be skipped. Hence, if you set this number to 4 it is equivalent to setting the first  
three character definition data bytes to 0.  
·
·
Bits 1 to 4 of n3 specify the width in columns of the defined character in proportional spacing mode.  
The width in columns is the number held in bits 1 to 4. Characters can be up to fifteen columns wide,  
including skipped blank columns.  
Downloaded characters are selected using the Esc % 1 NUL command and then printed by sending  
the appropriate character codes.  
Select standard / downloaded characters  
Esc%nNUL (27)(37)n(00) <1Bh><25h>n<00h>  
·
Once you have defined and downloaded one or more customized characters using the Esc &  
command, you can choose between the normal characters contained in the printer ROM and the  
characters you have downloaded.  
Set n to 0 to select the printer standard characters. In this mode you cannot print any of your own  
defined characters.  
·
·
Set n to 1 to select your own downloaded characters for printing. Now you can print using your user-  
defined characters but you cannot print any of the printer standard characters unless you have  
previously downloaded them to RAM as well, using the Esc : Copy ROM to RAM command.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(37); CHR$(1); CHR$(0); 'Select downloaded  
characters  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Copy ROM character to RAM  
Esc:000 (27)(58)(00)(00)(00)  
<1Bh><3Ah><30h><30h><30h>  
·
In order to use your own customized characters in conjunction with the standard characters contained  
in the printer, you must first download the printer standard ROM characters to the printer RAM, then  
define and download your own customized characters, and finally select the downloaded characters  
for printing using the Esc % 1 NUL escape sequence. This has the effect of inserting your custom  
characters into the standard character set in place of the standard characters with the same character  
codes.  
This command enables you to download the printer current character set to its RAM. The printer  
current character set consists of whichever combination of international character set and italic or  
graphic character table you have selected.  
·
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(58); CHR$(0); CHR$(0); CHR$(0); 'Copy printer’s  
characters to its RAM  
6.7. Graphics  
Select image mode  
Esc*mn1n2<image data>  
(27)(42)mn1n2....  
<1Bh><2Ah>mn1n2....  
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line at a  
selected horizontal resolution.  
·
·
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.  
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of  
4/30".  
·
m defines the horizontal resolution at which the image will be printed. m must be in the range 0 to 7. A  
value of 0 selects 60 dots per inch, 1 and 2 select 120 dots per inch, 3 selects 240 dots per inch, 4  
selects 80 dots per inch, 5 selects 72 dots per inch, 6 selects 90 dots per inch and 7 selects 144 dots per  
inch.  
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at  
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white  
space to appear.  
·
·
Images are printed left to right.  
Images are printed at a horizontal resolution determined by your selection and at an approximate  
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch. The printer attempts to match your chosen horizontal  
resolution as best it can using its 600 dpi resolution.  
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.  
10 WIDTH “LPT1:”,255  
20 LPRINT “*** ESC * m n1 n2 ***”  
30 FOR M=0 TO 6  
40 LPRINT “m=”;M  
50 ‘* SELECT BIT IMAGE MODE *  
60 LPRINT CHR$(27);”*”;CHR$(M);CHR$(240);CHR$(0);  
70 FOR I=1 TO 8  
80 N=2^I-1  
90 FOR J=1 TO 30  
100 LPRINT CHR$(N);  
110 NEXT J:NEXT I:LPRINT  
120 NEXT M:END  
*** ESC * m n1 n2 ***  
Sample 9  
Reassign image mode  
Esc?cm (27)(63)cm  
<1Bh><3Fh>cm  
·
This command enables you to redefine the horizontal resolution attached to a particular image mode.  
Hence, you could assign a density of 90 dots per inch to the image mode normally associated with 60  
dots per inch, which is selected with the Esc K command. All subsequent Esc K commands would  
then generate images with a horizontal density of 90 dots per inch.  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
c is the character which signifies the graphics mode: K = single-density (60 dpi), L = double-density  
(120 dpi), Y = double-speed, double-density (120 dpi) and Z = quadruple-density (240 dpi).  
m defines the new horizontal resolution to be assigned to the specified graphics mode. m must be in  
the range 0 to 7. A value of 0 selects 60 dots per inch, 1 and 2 select 120 dots per inch, 3 selects 240  
dots per inch, 4 selects 80 dots per inch, 5 selects 72 dots per inch 6 selects 90 dots per inch and 7  
selects 144 dots per inch.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(63); CHR$(90); CHR$(7); 'Change quad density to  
144 dpi  
Print 9 bit image  
Esc^an1n2  
(27)(92)an1n2  
<1Bh><5Eh>an1n2  
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.  
n1 and n2 define the number of vertical 9-dot columns that comprise the image.  
·
a defines the horizontal density of the image. Set a to 0 for a horizontal density of 60 dots per inch,  
and to 1 for an approximate horizontal density of 120 dots per inch.  
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 columns of data, each column representing a single vertical column  
of 1/8".  
·
Each pair of bytes represents a vertical column of nine dots, the most significant bit of the first byte  
representing the dot at the top of the column, the least significant bit of the first byte representing the  
second dot from the bottom, and the MSB of the second byte representing the dot at the bottom of  
the column. Bits 1 to 7 of the second byte are not used. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to  
appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white space to appear.  
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.  
Images are printed at a horizontal resolution of 60 or approximately 120 dots per inch and at an  
approximate vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.  
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.  
10 WIDTH “LPT1”, 255  
20 LPRINT “*** ESC ^ m n1 n2 ***”  
30 LPRINT “--STANDARD DENSITY--”  
40 M=0  
50 GOSUB 120  
60 LPRINT  
70 LPRINT  
80 LPRINT “--DOUBLE-DENSITY--”  
90 M=1  
100 GOSUB 120  
110 END  
120 FOR A=1 TO 10  
130 LPRINT CHR$(27); “^”;CHR$(M);CHR$(10);CHR$(0);  
140 LPRINT CHR$(8);CHR$(128);CHR$(20);CHR$(0);  
150 LPRINT CHR$(34);CHR$(128);CHR$(65);CHR$(0);  
160 LPRINT CHR$(128);CHR$(128);CHR$(65);CHR$(0);  
170 LPRINT CHR$(34);CHR$(128);CHR$(20);CHR$(0);  
180 LPRINT CHR$(8);CHR$(128);CHR$(0);CHR$(0);  
190 NEXT A  
200 RETURN  
** ESC ^ m n1 n2 ***  
Sample 10  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Print single-density image  
EscKn1n2<image data>  
(27)(75)n1n2....  
<1Bh><4Bh>n1n2....  
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.  
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comp rise the image.  
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of  
4/30".  
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at  
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white  
space to appear.  
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.  
Images are printed at a horizontal resolution of 60 dots per inch and at an approximate vertical  
resolution of 72 dots per inch.  
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.  
10 WIDTH “LPT1:”, 255  
20 LPRINT “*** ESC K n1 n2 ***”  
30 FOR I=1 TO 5  
40 ‘* STANDARD DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);”K”;CHR$(160);CHR$(0);  
60 FOR J=1 TO 8  
70 FOR K=1 TO 20  
80 N=2^J-1  
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);  
100 NEXT K  
110 NEXT J  
120 LPRINT  
130 NEXT I:END  
*** ESC K n1 n2 ***  
Sample 11  
Print double-density image  
EscLn1n2<image data> (27)(76)n1n2....  
<1Bh><4Ch>n1n2....  
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.  
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.  
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of  
4/30".  
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at  
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white  
space to appear.  
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.  
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 120 dots per inch and at an approximate  
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.  
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.  
10 WIDTH “LPT1:”,255  
20 LPRINT “*** ESC L n1 n2 ***  
30 FOR I=1 TO 5  
40 ‘* DOUBLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);”L”;CHR$(160);CHR$(0);  
60 FOR J=1 TO 8  
70 FOR K=1 TO 20  
80 N=2^J-1  
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);  
100 NEXT K  
110 NEXT J  
120 LPRINT  
130 NEXT I:END  
*** ESC L n1 n2 ***  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Sample 12  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Print double-speed double-density image  
EscYn1n2<image data> (27)(89)n1n2.... <1Bh><59h>n1n2....  
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.  
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.  
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of  
4/30".  
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at  
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white  
space to appear.  
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.  
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 120 dots per inch and at an approximate  
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.  
·
·
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.  
The printer always prints as fast as possible, hence this command is the exact equivalent of the Esc L  
command.  
10 WIDTH “LPT1:”,255  
20 LPRINT “*** ESC Y n1 n2 ***”  
30 FOR I=1 TO 5  
40 ‘* DOUBLE-SPEED & DOUBLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);”Y”;CHR$(160);CHR$(0);  
60 FOR J=1 TO 8  
70 FOR K=1 TO 20  
80 N=2^J-1  
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);  
100 NEXT K  
110 NEXT J  
120 LPRINT  
130 NEXT I:END  
** ESC Y n1 n2 ***  
Sample 13  
Print quadruple-density image  
EscZn1n2<image data> (27)(90)n1n2....  
<1Bh><5Ah>n1n2....  
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.  
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.  
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of  
4/30".  
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at  
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white  
space to appear.  
·
·
Images are printed from left to right.  
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 240 dots per inch and at an approximate  
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.  
You can only use this command in portrait orientation.  
10 WIDTH “LPT1;”,255  
·
20 LPRINT “*** ESC Z n1 n2 ***”  
30 FOR I=1 TO 5  
40 ‘* QUADRUPLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);”Z”,CHR$(160);CHR$(0);  
60 FOR J=1 TO 8  
70 FOR K=1 TO 20  
80 N=2^J-1  
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);  
100 NEXT K  
110 NEXT J  
120 LPRINT  
130 NEXT I:END  
*** ESC Z n1 n2 ***  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Sample 14  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
7.  
INDEX  
italic / graphics character table .............................................. 20  
italic mode ................................................................................. 18  
9
9 bit image..................................................................................23  
J
justification mode..................................................................... 10  
A
absolute print position ............................................................10  
L
left margin.................................................................................. 13  
Line feed................................................................................ 9, 14  
line spacing............................................................................... 13  
B
Backspace....................................................................................9  
P
C
page length ............................................................................... 12  
perforation skip ........................................................................ 13  
pitch ........................................................................................... 16  
printable code area................................................................... 20  
printing mode............................................................................ 19  
proportional spacing ............................................................... 16  
Carriage return ............................................................................9  
characters  
define.....................................................................................21  
condensed character................................................................17  
control codes ..............................................................................8  
control panel...............................................................................8  
Q
D
quadruple-density image ........................................................ 25  
data MSB...................................................................................10  
double-density image ..............................................................24  
double-height printing.............................................................19  
double-speed double-density image.....................................25  
double-strike mode...................................................................17  
double-width printing..............................................................17  
downloaded characters ...........................................................21  
R
relative print position .............................................................. 10  
resolution .................................................................................... 6  
reverse line feed ....................................................................... 14  
right margin ............................................................................... 13  
ROM character......................................................................... 22  
E
emphasized character mode....................................................17  
emulation mode.........................................................................11  
Escape sequences ......................................................................8  
S
single-density image................................................................ 24  
single-line double-width printing .......................................... 18  
space............................................................................................ 9  
subscript mode......................................................................... 18  
superscript mode...................................................................... 18  
syntax........................................................................................... 7  
F
feeder mode...............................................................................12  
Form feed.....................................................................................9  
U
H
underline mode......................................................................... 19  
unidirectional printing............................................................. 10  
user reset................................................................................... 12  
horizontal tab stops .................................................................15  
I
image mode................................................................................22  
Initialize ......................................................................................11  
inter-character space................................................................10  
international character set.......................................................20  
V
vertical tab channel.................................................................. 16  
vertical tab stops...................................................................... 15  
CHAPTER 6 EPSON - 30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 7  
IBM PROPRINTER  
XL  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................3  
2. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................5  
3. EMULATION DETAILS.........................................................................................................................6  
3.1. Ignored Commands ...........................................................................................................................6  
3.2. Resolution ..........................................................................................................................................6  
3.3. Character Set selection .....................................................................................................................6  
3.4. Controlling the Printer.........................................................................................................................6  
3.5. Control Codes ....................................................................................................................................6  
3.6. Escape sequences ............................................................................................................................6  
4. NOTATION USED IN THIS EMULATION DESCRIPTION .............................................................7  
4.1. Syntax.................................................................................................................................................7  
4.2. Data Conventions...............................................................................................................................7  
5. COMMANDS...........................................................................................................................................8  
5.1. Basic Printer Operation......................................................................................................................8  
5.2. Page Format ....................................................................................................................................11  
5.3. Using Characters.............................................................................................................................14  
5.4. Graphics...........................................................................................................................................18  
6. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 21  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
COMMAND LIST  
NUL  
BEL  
Null  
Bell  
8
8
ESC  
Escape  
8
SP  
Space  
8
BS  
Backspace  
8
LF  
Line Feed  
8
FF  
Form Feed  
8
CR  
Carriage return  
8
Esc5n  
DC1  
Automatic line feed  
Enable printer  
9
9
EscQ22  
EscQ3  
EscCRmode  
EscCR!#R  
EscEMn  
EscCn  
EscCNULn  
EscXmn  
EscNn  
EscO  
Esc0  
Esc1  
EscAn  
Esc2  
Esc3n  
EscJn  
Disable printer  
Disable printer  
Reset printer / change emulation mode  
User reset  
Paper input control  
Set page length  
9
9
9
9
10  
11  
11  
11  
11  
11  
12  
12  
12  
12  
12  
12  
13  
Set page length  
Set left and right margins  
Set perforation skip  
Cancel perforation skip  
Set 1/8" line spacing  
Set 7/72" line spacing  
Save n/72" line spacing  
Activate n/72" line spacing  
Set n/216" line feed  
Execute n/216" line feed  
EscDn1n2n3...NUL  
Set horizontal tab stops  
EscBn1n2n3...NUL  
13  
Set vertical tab stops  
HT  
VT  
Horizontal tab  
Vertical tab  
Restore default tab settings  
Select character set I  
Select character set II  
Set pitch to 10 cpi  
Set pitch to 12 cpi  
Proportional spacing  
Set condensed character mode  
Set emphasized character mode  
Cancel emphasized character mode  
Set enlarged character mode for a single line  
Cancel enlarged character mode  
Cancel  
Enlarged character mode  
Set superscript or subscript character mode  
Cancel superscript or subscript character mode  
Underline mode  
13  
13  
13  
14  
14  
14  
14  
14  
14  
14  
14  
15  
15  
15  
15  
15  
15  
16  
16  
16  
EscR  
Esc7  
Esc6  
DC2  
Esc:  
EscPn  
SI  
EscE  
EscF  
SO  
DC4  
CAN  
EscWn  
EscSn  
EscT  
Esc-n  
Esc_n  
Continuous overline mode  
Esc[@n1n2n3n4n5n6  
Select double-height / double-width mode  
Esc\n1n2<character data>  
Select character from the All Character Code table  
16  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Esc^<char-code> Select a character from the All Character Code table  
EscI Select character font  
Esc=n1n220n3(n4n5<character definition data>...)  
Define characters  
17  
17  
17  
EscKn1n2<image data>  
Set single-density image mode  
EscLn1n2<image data>  
Set double-density image mode  
EscYn1n2<image data>  
Set double-speed, double-density image mode  
EscZn1n2<image data>  
Set quadruple-density image mode  
18  
18  
19  
20  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
INTRODUCTION  
Some of these HL Series printers offer a complete emulation of the IBM Proprinter. In Proprinter XL mode  
you can drive the printer directly by incorporating control codes and escape sequences in your program,  
or alternatively, applications software (for example, your word-processing software) may send the  
necessary commands to the printer automatically. Check the manual that came with your software  
package for instructions on how to use your software with an IBM Proprinter XL.  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
EMULATION DETAILS  
The following points should be borne in mind when running the HL Series printers in IBM Proprinter XL  
mode.  
3.1. Ignored Commands  
A few IBM Proprinter XL commands have reduced effect, or no effect at all. In some cases this is due to  
the physical nature of an HL Series printer. These commands are as follows. The BEL control code  
(ASCII 7) which is used to sound the Proprinter’s bell, is ignored. The DC3 control code (ASCII 23), used  
to disable the Proprinter, is also ignored. The Esc Y escape sequence, which enables double-speed,  
double-density graphics mode has no effect on the printing speed, as HL Series printers always operate as  
fast as they can. Hence the Esc Y has the same effect as the Esc L (enable double-density graphics mode)  
sequence.  
3.2. Resolution  
The resolution of the HL Series printers is 600 dots per inch. Some IBM Proprinter commands use  
fractions of an inch that not exactly divisible by 600, for example Esc 0 sets line spacing to 1/8" of an inch.  
Similarly, the Proprinter graphics commands specify resolutions of 72, 120 and 240 dots per inch. When a  
graphic cannot be represented exactly at 600 dots per inch the printer prints the closest possible  
approximation to the specified image using 600 dots per inch.  
3.3. Character Set selection  
Using software commands you can select IBM character set I, IBM character set II or the IBM All  
Character Code table. Using the printer control panel you can select a number of other character sets  
depending on the printer model, consult the User's Guide to see if this emulation is supported and for a  
description of how to do this. All available character sets are shown in the IBM Proprinter XL mode  
section of the appendix at the end of this manual.  
3.4. Controlling the Printer  
Commands are invoked using either control codes or escape sequences. You can send them to the printer  
as part of a program, using the same command that you would use to print a text string on the printer. For  
example, in BASIC you would use the LPRINT command.  
3.5. Control Codes  
Control codes are ASCII codes that tell the printer to perform a particular function such as a line feed.  
Send a control code to the printer by sending the same type of instruction you would use to print a  
character using its ASCII code number. For example, the ASCII code for a form feed is 12, so to get the  
printer to perform a form feed use the following BASIC statement:  
LPRINT CHR$(12);  
The CHR$ operator is normally used to convert an ASCII code into its corresponding character.  
3.6. Escape sequences  
Escape sequences tell the printer which Proprinter function to perform. An escape sequence consists of  
the ESC character followed by one or more characters which define the operation to be performed. Send  
an escape sequence to the printer by sending the same type of instruction you would use to print  
characters using their ASCII codes. Some escape sequences require parameter values or data following  
them, for example, commands which turn a particular feature on and off and commands for downloading  
character descriptions to the printer or for printing graphic images. Numerical parameter data, too, is sent  
to the printer as if it were a character code to be printed. For example, to set the left and right margin  
settings to be at 10 and 70 columns across the page the required escape sequence is Esc X 10 70. In  
BASIC this would be:  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(88); CHR$(10); CHR$(70);  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
NOTATION USED IN THIS EMULATION DESCRIPTION  
4.1. Syntax  
The following conventions are used in this description of the Proprinter XL software commands.  
A letter, word or number in upright bold text is the literal character which and should be sent to the printer  
as a character code.  
A letter or word in italics is a variable and you must substitute the appropriate value or values when using  
the command.  
An ellipsis, ..., indicates that an element may be repeated any number of times.  
4.2. Data Conventions  
The bits that comprise a byte of data are numbered 1 to 8. Bit 1 is the least significant bit (LSB) and bit 8 is  
the most significant bit (MSB).  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.  
COMMANDS  
5.1. Basic Printer Operation  
The most common printer operations are described in this section. Most are invoked using control codes.  
For the sake of completeness the instructions which HL Series printers ignore are included.  
Null  
NUL  
(0)  
<0h>  
NUL (ASCII 0) is ignored.  
Bell  
BEL  
(07)  
<07h>  
BEL (ASCII 7) is ignored.  
Escape  
ESC  
(27)  
<1Bh>  
The ESC control code (ASCII 27) marks the start of an escape sequence.  
LPRINT CHR$(27);  
Space  
SP  
(32)  
<20h>  
The SP control code (ASCII 32) moves the current print position one space to the right.  
LPRINT CHR$(32);  
Backspace  
BS  
(08)  
<08h>  
The BS control code (ASCII 8) moves the current print position one space to the left.  
LPRINT CHR$(8);  
Line feed  
LF  
(10)  
<0Ah>  
The LF control code (ASCII 10) moves the current print position down one line.  
LPRINT CHR$(10);  
Form feed  
FF  
(12)  
<0Ch>  
·
The FF control code (ASCII 12) ejects the current page (unless it is blank) and moves the current print  
position to the top of the next page.  
·
If the current page is blank this control code has no effect.  
LPRINT CHR$(12);  
Carriage return  
CR  
(13)  
<0Dh>  
·
The CR control code (ASCII 13) moves the current print position to the left margin on the current line.  
·
If automatic line feed is ON, this code moves the current print position to the left margin on the next  
line.  
LPRINT CHR$(13);  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Automatic line feed  
Esc5n (27)(53)n  
<1Bh><35h>n  
·
When automatic line feed is ON, a line feed is automatically performed every time a carriage return is  
sent to the printer.  
·
·
To turn the automatic line feed function ON, set n to 1.  
To turn the automatic line feed function OFF, set n to 0.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(53); CHR$(1); 'Turn auto line feed on  
Enable printer  
DC1 (17)  
(11h>  
The DC1 control code (ASCII 17) enables the printer to accept data for printing again after a disable printer  
instruction.  
LPRINT CHR$(17);  
Disable printer  
EscQ22  
or  
EscQ3  
(27)(81)(50)(50)  
<1Bh><51h><32h><32h>  
<1Bh><51h><32h>  
(27)(81)(51)  
·
·
These two commands stop the printer from accepting any data for printing or any control codes until it  
has received a DC1 code (enable printer).  
The DC3 code (ASCII 19) is not recognised by the printer.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(81); CHR$(22); 'Disable printer  
Change emulation mode  
EscCR<mode> (27)(13)mode  
<1Bh><0Dh>mode  
·
·
This command changes the printer emulation mode or performs a reset.  
mode can be ‘E’ (Epson), ‘H’ (LaserJet), ‘I’ (IBM Proprinter XL), 'AB' (BR-Script Batch), 'AI' (BR-Script  
Interactive), 'GL' (HP-GL) or ‘FD’ (factory default).  
·
·
On receiving this command the printer prints any remaining data and performs a page eject (unless the  
current page is blank). The new emulation mode default settings come into effect, except when the  
mode is set to ‘FD’.  
If you set the mode to ‘FD’ to reset the printer to its factory default settings, LaserJet mode (the  
factory default emulation mode) is selected and the LaserJet factory default environment is restored.  
For a list of the factory default settings see the sub-section “Factory default environment” in Chapter 2  
"PCL" of this manual.  
·
Selecting IBM Proprinter XL emulation with mode = ‘I’ causes the printer to be reset.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(13); CHR$(69); 'Change to Epson emulation  
User Reset  
EscCR!#R (27)(13)(33)#(82)  
<1Bh><0Dh><21h>#<52h>  
·
·
·
# = 0, restores to the current user setting.  
# = 1, restores to User settings 1.  
# = 2, restores to User settings 2.  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Paper input control  
EscEMn  
(27)(25)n  
<1Bh><19h>n  
n Value  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/3260N/2460  
n = 0  
n = 1  
n = 2  
n = 3  
n = 4  
n = 5  
n = R  
Initialize the feeder mode.  
Feed from the MP tray.  
Feed from Tray 1.  
Feed from Tray 2.  
Feed from Tray 3.  
Feed from Tray 4.  
Eject paper.  
n Value  
HL-1050  
n = 0  
Initialize the feeder mode.  
Feed from the tray.  
Eject paper.  
n = 1/2  
n = R  
n Value HL-1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1650/1670N  
n = 0  
n = 1  
n = 2  
n = R  
Initialize the feeder mode.  
Feed from Tray 1.  
Feed from Tray 2.  
Eject paper.  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.2. Page Format  
Set page length  
EscCn  
(27)(67)n  
<1Bh><43h>n  
This command sets the page length in lines.  
or  
EscCNULn (27)(67)(0)n  
<1Bh><43h><00h>n  
·
·
This command sets the page length in inches.  
n is the number of lines that make up one page, or the length of the page in inches, according to the  
form of the command.  
·
If the first form of the command is used (n = the number of lines in the page) the current line spacing  
setting is used to determine the length of the page.  
·
·
If the first form of the command is used, n must be in the range 1 to 255.  
If the second form of the command is used ( n = page length in inches ), n must be in the range 1 to  
14.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(81); CHR$(22); 'Disable printer  
Set left and right margins  
EscXmn (27)(88)mn  
<1Bh><88h>mn  
·
·
This command sets the left and right margins.  
m = the number of character positions at the current pitch (characters per inch) between the left edge  
of the page and the left margin.  
·
n = the number of character positions at the current pitch between the left edge of the page and the  
right margin.  
·
·
If you set m = 0 the current left margin setting is retained.  
If you set n = 0 the current right margin setting is retained.  
LPRINT CHR$(18); 'Set pitch to 10 CPI  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(88); CHR$(10); CHR$(70); 'Set margins to 1" and  
7"  
Set perforation skip  
EscNn (27)(78)n  
<1Bh><4Eh>n  
·
This command sets the bottom margin and enables perforation skip, that is, whenever the print  
position reaches the bottom margin the printer performs a page eject and moves the print position to  
the top of the next page.  
·
n = the number of lines at the current line space setting between the bottom edge of the page and the  
bottom margin.  
·
·
·
n must be in the range 1 to 255.  
Esc C (set page length) and Esc O(Cancel perforation skip) cancel automatic perforation skip.  
If the bottom margin is set to be above the top margin, the top margin is discarded and one line is  
enabled for printing.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(78); CHR$(4); 'Set bottom margin to 4 lines.  
Cancel perforation skip  
EscO (27)(79)  
<1Bh><4Fh>  
This command cancels the automatic perforation skip feature.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(79); 'Cancel perforation skip.  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Line spacing and tabs  
Set 1/8" line spacing  
Esc0  
(27)(48)  
<1Bh><30h>  
This command sets the line spacing to 1/8". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print  
position 1/8" down the page.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(48); 'Set line spacing to 1/8".  
Set 7/72" line spacing  
Esc1  
(27)(48)  
<1Bh><31h>  
·
This command sets the line spacing to 7/72". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print  
position 7/72" down the page.  
·
Since the printer's resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing will not be exactly 7/72".  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(49); 'Set line spacing to 7/72".  
Save n/72" line spacing  
EscAn (27)(65)n  
<1Bh><41h>n  
·
This command allows you to select a line spacing of n/72". Your selection does not take effect until  
you activate it with the Esc 2 command.  
·
·
·
Since the printer's resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing may not be exactly n/72".  
n must be in the range 1 to 85.  
If n is outside the range 1 to 85 the default line spacing, 1/6" is selected.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(65); CHR$(10); 'Select line spacing of 10/72".  
Activate n/72" line spacing  
Esc2 (27)(50)  
<1Bh><32h>  
This command allows you to activate the line spacing setting you specified with the Esc A command.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(50); 'Activate selected line spacing of n/72".  
Set n/216" line spacing  
Esc3n  
(27)(51)n  
<1Bh><33h>n  
·
This command sets the line spacing to n/216". All subsequent line feed operations will move the print  
position n/216" down the page.  
·
·
Since the printer's resolution is 600 dots per inch the line spacing may not be exactly n/216".  
n must be in the range 1 to 255.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(51); CHR$(25); 'Select line spacing of 25/216".  
Execute n/216" line spacing  
EscJn (27)(74)n  
<1Bh><4Ah>n  
·
·
This command moves the print position one line down the page using a line spacing of n/216".  
The existing line space setting is not affected.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(50); CHR$(30); 'Move print position down 30/216".  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Set horizontal tabs  
EscD<n1><n2><n3>...NUL  
(27)(68)n1n2n3...(00)  
<1Bh><44h>n1n2n3...<00h>  
·
·
·
·
·
This command enables you to set up to 28 horizontal tab stops using the current character pitch.  
The tab stops should be set in ascending order.  
Esc D 0 clears all horizontal tab settings.  
Esc R restores the default settings, which are at every eighth column, starting at the ninth column.  
You can move the print position to the tab stops using the HT control code.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(68); CHR$(10); CHR$(20); CHR$(0); 'Set tab stops  
at columns 10 and 20.  
Set vertical tabs  
EscB<n1><n2><n3> ...NUL (27)(66)n1n2n3...(00)  
<1Bh><42h>n1n2n3...<00h>  
·
·
·
·
This command enables you to set up to 64 vertical tab stops using the line feed pitch.  
The tab stops should be set in ascending order.  
Esc B 0 and Esc R both clear all vertical tab settings.  
You can move the print position to the tab stops using the VT control code.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(66); CHR$(12); CHR$(24); CHR$(0); 'Set tab stops  
at lines 12 and 24.  
Horizontal tab  
HT  
(09)  
<09h>  
·
The HT control code (ASCII 9) moves the current print position one tab stop to the right.  
·
The command is ignored if there are no tab stops to the right of the current print position or if the next  
tab stop is beyond the right margin.  
LPRINT CHR$(9);  
Vertical tab  
VT  
(11)  
<0Bh>  
·
·
·
The VT control code (ASCII 11) moves the current print position one vertical tab stop down the page.  
If there are no tab stops below the current print position a line feed is performed.  
If no tab stops have been set a line feed is performed.  
LPRINT CHR$(9);  
Restore default tab settings  
EscR (27)(82)  
<1Bh><52h>  
·
This command restores the default horizontal tab settings which are at every eight columns, starting at  
the ninth column. There are no default vertical tab settings.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(82); 'Restore default tab stops.  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.3. Using Characters  
Select character set I  
Esc7  
(27)(55)  
<1Bh><37h>  
This command selects IBM Character set I for use in subsequent printing operations.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(55); 'Select character set I  
Select character set II  
Esc6  
(27)(56)  
<1Bh><36h>  
This command selects IBM character set II for use in subsequent printing operations.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(54); 'Select character set II  
Set pitch to 10 cpi  
DC2  
(18)  
<12h>  
·
·
This command sets the printing pitch to 10 characters per inch (cpi).  
If condensed character mode has previously been set, it is cancelled.  
LPRINT CHR$(18); 'set pitch to 10 CPI  
Set pitch to 12 cpi  
Esc: (27)(58)  
<1Bh><3Ah>  
This command sets the printing pitch to 12 characters per inch (cpi).  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(58); 'set pitch to 12 CPI  
Proportional spacing  
EscPn  
(27)(80)n  
<1Bh><50h>n  
·
·
·
·
This command allows you to turn proportional spacing on or off.  
Setting n to 1 turns proportional spacing on. Subsequent text is printed proportionally spaced.  
Setting n to 0 turns proportional spacing off. Subsequent text is printed monospaced.  
If you change the character pitch using DC2, SI or Esc :, proportional spacing is automatically turned  
off.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(80); CHR$(1); 'Turn proportional spacing on  
Set condensed character mode  
SI  
(15)  
<0Fh>  
·
This command selects condensed character mode. Subsequent text characters are condensed  
horizontally when printed.  
·
The DC2 code, used to select a character pitch of 10 cpi, cancels condensed character mode.  
LPRINT CHR$(15); 'Set condensed character mode  
Set emphasized character mode  
EscE (27)(69)  
<1Bh><45h>  
This command turns emphasized character mode on. Subsequent text is printed with a bold stroke width.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(69); 'Turn emphasized character mode on  
Cancel emphasized character mode  
EscF  
(27)(70)  
<1Bh><46h>  
This command turns emphasized character mode off. Subsequent text is printed with medium stroke width.  
LPRINT CHR$(27)l CHR$(70); 'Turn emphasized character mode off  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Set enlarged character mode for a single line  
SO  
(14)  
<0Eh>  
·
This command turns enlarged character mode on for one line only. The subsequent line of text is  
printed using double-width characters and with the line space setting doubled.  
·
The following commands cancel enlarged character mode set using the SO control code: CR, CAN,  
LF, FF, VT, Esc W 0, DC4 and Esc [@.  
LPRINT CHR$(14); 'Set enlarged character mode for one line  
Cancel enlarged character mode  
DC4 (20) <14h>  
·
This control code cancels the single-line enlarged character mode set with the SO control code.  
Subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters. The previous line spacing setting is restored.  
·
The previous character pitch is restored.  
LPRINT CHR$(20); 'Cancel enlarged character mode set with SO  
Cancel  
CAN  
(24)  
<18h>  
This control code cancels single-line enlarged character mode set with the SO control code. Subsequent  
text is printed using normal sized characters and the previous line spacing setting is restored.  
LPRINT CHR$(24); 'Cancel enlarged character mode set with SO  
Enlarged character mode  
EscWn  
(27)(87)n  
<1Bh><57h>n  
·
·
This command turns enlarged character mode on or off.  
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed using double-width characters. The line spacing setting is  
doubled.  
·
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is printed using normal sized characters. The previous line spacing and  
character pitch settings are restored.  
·
·
Only Esc W 0 can be used to cancel enlarged character mode set using the Esc W 1 instruction.  
Esc W 0 cancels enlarged character mode set using the Esc W 1 instruction, the SO control code or  
the Esc [@ instruction.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(87); CHR$(1); 'Set enlarged character mode  
Set superscript or subscript character mode  
EscSn (27)(83)n <1Bh><53h>n  
·
·
·
This command allows you to print superscripts or subscripts.  
Set n to 0 to print subsequent text using superscript characters.  
Set n to 1 to print subsequent text using subscript characters.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(83); CHR$(1); 'Turn on subscript mode  
Cancel superscript or subscript character mode  
EscT (27)(84) <1Bh><54h>  
·
·
This command stops superscript or subscript printing if either had been enabled.  
Subsequent text is printed using normal characters.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(84); 'Turn off superscript/subscript mode  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Underline mode  
Esc-n (27)(126)n  
<1Bh><7Eh>n  
·
·
·
·
This command turns character underlining on or off.  
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is underlined.  
Horizontal tab spaces are not underlined irrespective of whether underlining mode is on or off.  
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is not underlined.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(45); CHR$(1); 'Underline following text  
Continuous overline mode  
Esc_n (27)(95))n  
<1Bh><5Fh>n  
·
·
·
This command turns character overline printing on or off.  
If n is set to 1 subsequent text is printed with a continuous line above it.  
Horizontal tab spaces are not printed overlined irrespective of whether overline printing mode is on or  
off.  
·
If n is set to 0 subsequent text is not printed with an overline.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(95); CHR$(1); 'Print following text with an  
overline  
Select double-height / double-width mode  
Esc[@n1n2n3n4n5n6 (27)(91)(64)n1n2n3n4n5n6  
<1Bh><5Bh><40h>n1n2n3n4n5n6  
·
This command enables you to select single or double line spacing and single or double character  
height and width.  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
n1 should be set to 4 and n2,n3 and n4 to 0.  
To set double line spacing and select double-height characters set n5 to 34.  
To set double line spacing and select normal height characters set to n5 to 33.  
To set single line spacing and select double-height characters set to n5 to 18.  
To set single line spacing and select normal height characters set n5 to 17.  
To select double-width characters set n6 to 2.  
To select single-width characters set n6 to 1.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(91); CHR$(64); CHR$(4); CHR$(0); CHR$(0);  
CHR$(0); CHR$(34); CHR$(1); 'Set double line spacing and print double-  
height, double-width characters.  
Select character from the All Character Code table  
Esc\n1n2<Character data>  
(27)(92)n1n2<Character data>  
<1Bh><5Ch>n1n2<Character data>  
·
·
This command enables you to print characters from the All Character Code table.  
n1 and n2 specify the number of characters to be printed.  
·
·
The number of characters printed is 256*n2+n1.  
Control codes included in the character data are not executed.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(92); CHR$(64); CHR$(1); CHR$(65); CHR$(66);  
CHR$(67); CHR$(68); CHR$(69); 'Print 320 characters starting ABCDE...  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Select a character from the All Character Code table  
Esc^<char-code> (27)(94)<Char-code>  
This command enables you to print a single character from the All Character Code table.  
<1Bh><5Eh><Char-code>  
·
·
A control code is not executed if the code is sent immediately following this instruction.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(94); CHR$(36); 'Printed a dollar sign  
Select character font  
EscIn (27)(73)n  
<1Bh><49h>n  
·
·
·
·
This command enables you to select a font and choose the print quality.  
If n is set to 0 the printer's standard font and draft quality are selected.  
If n is set to 2 the printer's standard font and letter quality are selected.  
If n is set to 4 the download font (the characters you sent to the printer using the Esc = command) and  
draft quality are selected.  
·
If n is set to 6 the download font ( the characters you sent to the printer using the Esc = command) and  
letter quality are selected.  
LPRINT CHR$(27); CHR$(73); CHR$(2); 'Selected letter quality printer  
font  
Define characters  
Esc=n1n220n3(n4n5<character definition data>...)  
(27)(61)n1n220n3(...  
<1Bh><3Dh>n1n220n3(...  
·
·
This command enables you to define and download characters for printing.  
Monospaced characters are designed on a grid eleven dots wide by twelve dots high. The width of  
proportionally spaced characters is specified in n5.  
Character width  
Blank columns  
1
2
3
4
Rows 1 - 8  
5
6
7
Rows 2 - 9  
8
9
10  
11  
12  
Replication area  
·
·
n1 and n2 define the number of characters to be defined as follows: number of characters =  
((n1+(n2*256)-2)/13.  
n3 is the character code of the first character in the sequence to be defined. It is assumed that you are  
defining a sequence of characters whose code numbers increment by one for each character to be  
defined.  
·
·
If bits 1 and 2 of n4 are 0 and bit 8 is set to 1, the bytes that make up the character definition define the  
top eight rows of the grid, the most significant bit representing the top dot, and the least significant  
bit representing the eighth dot down. Simply set a bit to 1 to print a dot in that position on the grid, or  
to 0 to print white space.  
If bits 1 and 2 of n4 are 00 and bit 8 is set to 0 the bytes that make up the character definition define  
rows 2 to 9 of the grid, the most significant bit representing the second dot, and the least significant  
bit representing the ninth dot down. Simply set a bit to 1 to print a dot in that position on the grid, or  
to 0 to print white space.  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
If bits 1 and 2 of n4 are 01 the least significant bit of each data byte is replicated in rows 9 to 12 of the  
grid.  
·
·
If bits 1 and 2 of n4 are 10 the bits 1 to 4 of each data byte are replicated in rows 9 to 12 of the grid.  
Bits 5 to 7 of n5 specify the number of columns left blank to the left of the defined character in  
proportional spacing mode. Up to seven columns can be skipped.  
·
·
Bits 1 to 4 of n5 specify the width in columns of the defined character in proportional spacing mode.  
Up to fifteen columns can be used to define the character.  
Downloaded characters are selected using the Esc I command and then printed by sending the  
appropriate character codes.  
5.4. Graphics  
Set single-density image mode  
EscKn1n2<image data> (27)(75)n1n2<image data>  
data>  
<1Bh><4Bh>n1n2<image  
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.  
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.  
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of  
4/30".  
·
·
Images are printed left to right.  
Images are printed at a horizontal resolution of 60 dots per inch and at an approximate vertical  
resolution of 72 dots per inch.  
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at  
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white  
space to appear.  
10 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
20 LPRINT "*** ESC K n1 n2 ***";CHR$(10);  
30 FOR i=1 TO 5  
40 '* STANDARD DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"K";CHR$(160);CHR$(0);  
60 FOR J=1 TO 8  
70 FOR K=1 TO 20  
80 N=2^J-1  
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);  
100 NEXT K  
110 NEXT J  
120 LPRINT CHR$(10);  
130 NEXT I:END  
< Sample 15 >  
Set double-density image mode  
EscLn1n2<image data> (27)(76)n1n2<image data>  
data>  
<1Bh><4Ch>n1n2<image  
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.  
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.  
·
The image consists of 256*n1+n2 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of  
4/30".  
·
Images are printed left to right.  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 120 dots per inch and at an approximate  
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.  
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at  
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white  
space to appear.  
10 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
20 LPRINT "***ESC L n1 n2 ***"CHR$(10);  
30 FOR I=1 TO 5  
40 '*DOUBLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"L";CHR$(160);CHR$(0);  
60 FOR J=1 TO 8  
70 FOR K=1 TO 20  
80 N=2^J-1  
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);  
100 NEXT K  
110 NEXT J  
120 LPRINT CHR$(10);  
130 NEXT I:END  
< Sample 16 >  
Set double-speed, double-density image mode  
EscYn1n2<image data> (27)(89)n1n2<image data>  
data>  
<1Bh><59h>n1n2<image  
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.  
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.  
·
The image consists of 256*n2+n1 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of  
4/30".  
·
·
Images are printed left to right.  
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 120 dots per inch and at an approximate  
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.  
·
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at  
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white  
space to appear.  
This printer always prints as fast as possible, hence this command is the exact equivalent of the Esc L  
command.  
10 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
20 LPRINT "*** ESC Y n1 n2 ***", CHR$(10);  
30 FOR I=1 TO 5  
40 '*DOUBLE-SPEED & DOUBLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"Y";CHR$(160);CHR$(0);  
60 FOR J=1 TO 8  
70 FOR k=1 TO 20  
80 N=2^J-1  
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);  
100 NEXT K  
110 NEXT J  
120 LPRINT CHR$(10);  
130 NEXT I:END  
< Sample 17 >  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Set quadruple-density image mode  
EscZn1n2<image data> (27)(90)n1n2<image data>  
data>  
<1Bh><5Ah>n1n2<image  
·
·
This command enables you to define and print a single line raster bit image on a single text line.  
n1 and n2 define the number of bytes that comprise the image.  
·
The image consists of 256*n1+n2 bytes of data, each byte representing a single vertical column of  
4/30".  
·
·
Images are printed left to right.  
Images are printed at an approximate horizontal resolution of 240 dots per inch and at an approximate  
vertical resolution of 72 dots per inch.  
·
Each byte represents a vertical column of eight dots, the most significant bit representing the dot at  
the top. Simply set a bit to 1 if you want a dot to appear in that position, and to 0 if you want white  
space to appear.  
10 WIDTH "LPT1:",255  
20 LPRINT "*** ESC Z n1 n2 ***";CHR$(10);  
30 FOR I=1 TO 5  
40 '* QUADRUPLE-DENSITY BIT IMAGE MODE *  
50 LPRINT CHR$(27);"Z";CRH$(16);CHR$(0);  
60 FOR J=1 TO 8  
70 FOR K=1 TO 20  
80 N=2^J-1  
90 LPRINT CHR$(N);  
100 NEXT K  
110 NEXT J  
120 LPRINT CHR$(10);  
130 NEXT I:END  
< Sample 18 >  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
6.  
INDEX  
A
O
Automatic line feed....................................................................9  
overline mode ........................................................................... 16  
B
P
Backspace....................................................................................8  
page length ............................................................................... 11  
paper input control.................................................................. 10  
perforation skip ........................................................................ 11  
pitch ........................................................................................... 14  
print quality............................................................................... 17  
proportional spacing ............................................................... 14  
C
cancel.........................................................................................15  
Carriage return ............................................................................8  
character set..........................................................................6, 14  
characters ..................................................................................17  
condensed character................................................................14  
control codes ..............................................................................6  
Q
quadruple-density image mode.............................................. 20  
D
R
double-density image mode....................................................18  
double-height / double-width mode......................................16  
resolution .................................................................................... 6  
right margin ............................................................................... 11  
E
S
emphasized character...............................................................14  
emulation mode...........................................................................9  
enlarged character....................................................................15  
Escape..........................................................................................8  
Escape sequences ......................................................................6  
single-density image mode..................................................... 18  
Space............................................................................................ 8  
subscript character mode........................................................ 15  
superscript character mode .................................................... 15  
syntax........................................................................................... 7  
F
T
feeder mode...............................................................................10  
Form feed.....................................................................................8  
tab settings ............................................................................... 13  
U
G
underline mode......................................................................... 16  
User reset .................................................................................... 9  
graphics .....................................................................................18  
H
V
horizontal tab ............................................................................13  
vertical tab................................................................................. 13  
L
left margin ..................................................................................11  
Line feed ......................................................................................8  
line spacing ...............................................................................12  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 7 IBM PROPRINTER - 22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 8  
BAR CODE  
CONTROL  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................3  
2. PRINT BAR CODES OR EXPANDED CHARACTERS .................................................................4  
3. DEFINITION OF PARAMETERS.........................................................................................................5  
3.1. Bar Code Mode ..................................................................................................................................5  
3.2. Bar Code Style, Expanded Character Shading, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Shading.........5  
3.3. Bar Code Scaling (Width only)...........................................................................................................6  
3.4. Bar Code Human Readable Line On or Off.......................................................................................6  
3.5. Quiet Zone..........................................................................................................................................6  
3.6. Bar Code, Expanded Character Unit, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Units..............................6  
3.7. Bar Code, Expanded Character, Line, Block Drawing & Box Drawing Offset in the X-axis .............7  
3.8. Bar Code & Expanded Character Offset in the Y-axis ......................................................................7  
3.9. Bar Code, Expanded Character, Line, Block Drawing & Box Drawing Height..................................7  
3.10. Expanded Character, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Width...................................................7  
3.11. Expanded Character Rotation..........................................................................................................7  
3.12. Bar Code Data Start.........................................................................................................................8  
3.13. Box Drawing.....................................................................................................................................9  
3.14. Line Block Drawing ..........................................................................................................................9  
3.15. Expanded Character Data Start.......................................................................................................9  
4. EXAMPLE PROGRAM LISTINGS ................................................................................................... 10  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
INTRODUCTION  
Some of the HL series printers can print bar codes in the HP LaserJet, EPSON FX-850, and IBM Proprinter XL  
emulation modes, refer to the printer User guide for information.  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
PRINT BAR CODES OR EXPANDED CHARACTERS  
ESC i n ... n \ (27)(105)n ... n (92)  
<1Bh><69h>n ... n <5Ch>  
Creates bar codes or expanded characters according to the parameters “n ... n”. For further information about  
the parameters, see the following “Definition of Parameters.” This command must end with the “ \ ” code (5CH).  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
DEFINITION OF PARAMETERS  
This bar code command can have the following parameters in the parameter segment (n ... n). Parameters are  
effective only within the single command sequence using the syntax ESC i n ... n \. They do not take effect in  
any subsequent bar code commands. If any parameters are not specified, they take the default settings. The  
last parameter must be the bar code data start identifier (“b” or “B”) or the expanded character data start identifier  
(“l” or “L”). Other parameters can be specified in any sequence. The prefix of each parameter can be either a  
lower-case or upper-case character, - for example, “t0” or “T0”, “s3” or “S3”, etc.  
3.1. Bar Code Mode  
n = “t0” or “T0”  
n = “t1” or “T1”  
n = “t3” or “T3”  
n = “t4” or “T4”  
n = “t5” or “T5”  
n = “t6” or “T6”  
n = “t9” or “T9”  
n = “t12” or “T12”  
n = “t13” or “T13”  
n = “t14” or “T14”  
n = “t130” or “T130”  
CODE 39 (default)  
Interleaved 2 of 5  
FIM (US-Post Net)  
Post Net (US-Post Net)  
EAN 8, EAN 13, or UPC A  
UPC E  
Codabar  
Code 128 set A  
Code 128 set B  
Code 128 set C  
ISBN (EAN)  
n = “t131” or “T131”  
n = "t132" or "T132"  
n = "t133" or "T133"  
n = "t134" or "T134"  
ISBN (UPC-E)  
EAN 128 set A  
EAN 128 set B  
EAN 128 set C  
This parameter selects the bar code mode as above. When n is “t5” or “T5”, the bar code mode (EAN 8, EAN  
13, or UPC A) varies according to the number of characters in the data.  
3.2. Bar Code Style, Expanded Character Shading, Line Block Drawing & Box  
Drawing Shading  
ŸBar Code Style  
n = “s0” or “S0”  
n = “s1” or “S1”  
n = “s3” or “S3”  
3 : 1 (default)  
2 : 1  
2.5 : 1  
This parameter selects the bar code style as above. When the EAN 8, EAN 13 or UPC-A bar code mode is  
selected, this bar code style parameter is ignored.  
ŸExpanded Character shading  
“S” 0 = White  
1 = Black  
2 = Vertical stripes  
3 = Horizontal stripes  
4 = Cross hatch  
e.g. “S” n1 n2  
n1 = Background fill pattern  
n2 = Foreground fill pattern  
If “S” is followed by only one parameter, the parameter is a foreground fill pattern.  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
ŸLine Block Drawing & Box Drawing Shading  
“S” 1 = Black  
2 = Vertical stripes  
3 = Horizontal stripes  
4 = Cross hatch  
3.3. Bar Code Scaling (Width only)  
n = “mnnn” or “Mnnn” (nnn = 0 ~ 32767)  
This parameter specifies the bar code width scaling. The unit of "nnn" is %. The default value is m100  
(100%).  
3.4. Bar Code Human Readable Line On or Off  
n = “r0” or “R0”  
n = “r1” or “R1”  
Human readable line OFF  
Human readable line ON  
Default:  
Human readable line ON when the following barcode types are selected.  
(1) “T5” or “t5”  
(2) “T6” or “t6”  
(3) “T130” or “t130”  
(4) “T131” or “t131”  
Default:  
Human readable line OFF  
All others  
This parameter specifies whether or not the printer prints the human readable line below the bar code. Human  
readable characters are always printed with OCR-B font at 10 cpi pitch and all the current character style  
enhancements are masked. Note that the default setting is subject to the bar code mode selected by “t” or “T”.  
3.5. Quiet Zone  
n = “onnn” or “Onnn” (nnn = 0 ~ 32767)  
Quiet Zone is the space on both side of the bar codes. Its width can be specified using the units which are set  
by the "u" or "U" parameter. ( For the description of "u" or "U" parameter, see the next section.) The  
default setting of Quiet Zone width is 1 inch.  
3.6. Bar Code, Expanded Character Unit, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing  
Units  
n = “u0” or “U0”  
n = “u1” or “U1”  
n = “u2” or “U2”  
n = “u3” or “U3”  
n = “u4” or “U4”  
n = “u5” or “U5”  
n = “u6” or “U6”  
n = “u7” or “U7”  
Millimeters (default)  
1/10”  
1/100”  
1/12”  
1/120”  
1/10 Millimeter  
1/300”  
1/720”  
This parameter specifies the measurement units of X-axis offset, Y-axis offset and bar code height.  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.7. Bar Code, Expanded Character, Line, Block Drawing & Box Drawing Offset in  
the X-axis  
n = “xnnn” or “Xnnn”  
This parameter specifies the offset from the current print position in the “u”- or “U”-specified units.  
3.8. Bar Code & Expanded Character Offset in the Y-axis  
n = “ynnn” or “Ynnn”  
This parameter specifies the downward offset from the current print position in the “u”- or “U”-specified units.  
3.9. Bar Code, Expanded Character, Line, Block Drawing & Box Drawing Height  
n = “hnnn”, “Hnnn”, “dnnn”, or “Dnnn”  
Default heights  
(1)  
EAN13, EAN8, UPC-A, ISBN (EAN13, EAN8, UPC-A),  
ISBN (UPC-E):  
UPC-E:  
22 mm  
18 mm  
12 mm  
(2)  
(3)  
Others:  
Expanded characters  
Ý
Ý
2.2 mm (default)  
1 dot  
Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing  
This parameter specifies the height of bar codes or expanded characters as above. It can take the prefix “h”,  
“H”, “d”, or “D”. The height is specified in the “u”- or “U”-specified units. Note that the default setting of  
the bar code height (12 mm, 18 mm or 22 mm) is subject to the bar code mode selected by “t” or “T”.  
3.10. Expanded Character, Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Width  
n = “wnnn” or “Wnnn”  
Default widths  
Expanded character  
Ý
1.2 mm  
Line Block Drawing & Box Drawing Ý  
1 dot  
This parameter specifies the width of expanded characters in the selected units as above.  
3.11. Expanded Character Rotation  
n = “a0” or “A0”  
n = “a1” or “A1”  
n = “a2” or “A2”  
n = “a3” or “A3”  
Upright (default)  
Rotated 90 degrees clockwise  
Upside down, rotated 180 degrees clockwise  
Rotated 270 degrees clockwise  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.12. Bar Code Data Start  
n = “b” or “B”  
·
·
Data that follows “b” or “B” is read in as bar code data. Bar code data must end with the “ \ ” code (5CH),  
which also terminates this command. The acceptable bar code data is subject to the bar code mode selected  
by “t” or “T” as listed below.  
When the CODE 39 is selected with the parameter “t0” or “T0”:  
Forty three characters “0” to “9”, “A” to “Z”, “–”, “ . ”, “ (space)”, “$”, “ / ”, “+”, and “%” can be accepted  
as bar code data. Other characters cause data error. The number of characters for bar codes is not limited.  
The bar code data automatically starts and ends with an asterisk “ * ” (start character and stop character). If  
the received data has an asterisk “ * ” at its beginning or end, the asterisk is regarded as a start character or  
stop character. When you put "?" on the end of the data, a check digit is automatically added.  
·
When the Interleaved 2 of 5 is selected with the parameter “t1” or “T1”:  
Ten numerical characters “0” to “9” can be accepted as bar code data. Other characters cause data error.  
The number of characters for bar codes is not limited. Since this mode of bar codes require even characters,  
if the bar code data has odd characters, the zero character “0” is automatically added to the end of the bar  
code data. When you put "?" on the end of the data, a check digit is automatically added.  
·
·
·
When the FIM (US-Post Net) is selected with the parameter “t3” or “T3”:  
Characters “A” to “D” are valid and 1 digit of data can be printed. Uppercase and lowercase alphabet  
characters can be accepted.  
When the Post Net (US-Post Net) is selected with the parameter “t4” or “T4”:  
Characters “0” to “9” can be accepted as bar code data and it must be terminated by a check digit. “?” can  
be used in place of a check digit.  
When the EAN 8, EAN 13, or UPC A is selected with the parameter “t5” or “T5”:  
Ten numerical characters “0” to “9” can be accepted as bar code data. The number of characters for bar  
codes is limited as follows.  
EAN 8:  
EAN 13:  
UPC A:  
Total 8 digits (7 digits + 1 check digit)  
Total 13 digits (12 digits + 1 check digit)  
Total 12 digits (11 digits + 1 check digit)  
Any number of characters other than as above causes a data error and the bar code data is printed as normal  
print data. If the check digit is incorrect, the printer calculates it and replaces it with the correct check digit  
so that the correct bar code data will be printed. When EAN13 is selected, adding “+” and a 2-or 5-digit  
number after the data will create the add-on code.  
When UPC-E is selected with the parameter “t6” or “T6”:  
The numerical characters “0” to “9” can be accepted as bar code data.  
8 digits  
Standard format. The first character must be “0” and the data must be terminated by a  
check digit.  
Total 8 digits = "0" + 6 digits + 1 check digit  
6 digits  
*1:  
The first character "0" and the last check digit are removed from the 8 digit data.  
For 8 digits, “?” can be used in place of a check digit.  
*2:  
Adding “+” and 2- or 5-digit number after the data creates an add-on code  
for all 6 and 8 digit formats.  
·
When Codabar is selected with the parameter “t9” or “T9”:  
Characters “0” to “9”, “–”, “ . ”, “$”, “/”, “+”, “ : ” can be printed. Characters “A” to “D” can be printed as a  
start-stop code, which can be uppercase or lowercase. If there is no start-stop code, an error will occur.  
The check digit cannot be added and “?” causes an error.  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
When Code 128 Set A, Set B, or Set C is selected with the parameter “t12” or “12,” “t13” or “T13,” or “t14” or  
“T14” respectively:  
Code sets A, B and C are individually selectable. Set A encodes characters in the range Hex 00 to 5F. Set  
B encodes characters in the range Hex 20 to 7F. Set C encodes numeric pairs in the range 00 to 99.  
-
-
-
Switching is allowed between the code sets by sending %A, %B, or %C.  
FNC 1, 2, 3, and 4 are produced with %1, %2, %3, and %4.  
The SHIFT code, %S, allows temporary switching (for 1 character only) between set A and set B and  
vice versa.  
-
To print the “%” character, it must be sent twice.  
·
When ISBN (EAN) is selected with the parameter “t130” or “T130”:  
The rules are the same as for “t5” or “T5”  
·
·
When the ISBN (UPC-E) is selected with the parameter “t131” or “T131”:  
The rules are the same as for “t6” or “T6”  
When EAN 128 set A, set B or set C is selected with the parameter "t132" or "T132," "t133" or "T133" or  
"t134" or "T134" respectively: Same rules apply as for "t12" or "T12," "t13" or "T13", or "t14" or "T14."  
3.13. Box Drawing  
ESC i ... E (or e)  
“E” or “e” is a terminator.  
3.14. Line Block Drawing  
ESC i ... V (or v)  
“V” or “v” is a terminator.  
3.15. Expanded Character Data Start  
n = “l” or “L”  
Data that follows “l” or “L” is read in as expanded character data (or labeling data). Expanded character data  
must end with the “ \ ” code (5CH), which also terminates this command. To print the '\' character, you must  
input '\\'.  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
EXAMPLE PROGRAM LISTINGS  
10 ' Barcode  
20 WIDTH "LPT1:", 255  
30 ' CODE 39  
40 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it0r1s0x00y00b123456\";  
50 'INTER LEAVED  
60 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it1r1s0x70y00b123456\";  
70 ' EAN-13  
80 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x00y020b123456789012?\";  
90 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x70y020b123456789012?+12345\";  
100 ' UPC-A  
110 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x00y050b12345678901?\";  
120 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x70y050b12345678901?+12345\";  
130 ' EAN-8  
140 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x00y080b1234567?\";  
150 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it5r1s0x70y080b1234567?+12345\";  
160 ' UPC-E  
170 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it6r1s0x00y110b0123456?\";  
180 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it6r1s0x70y110b0123456?+12344\";  
190 ' CODABAR  
195 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it9r1s0x00y140bA123456A\";  
210 ' POST NET  
220 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it4r1x70y140b1234567?\";  
230 ' FIM  
240 LPRINT CHR$(27); "iT3R1x130Y140BA\";  
250 ' ISBN  
260 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it130r1s0x00y170b123456789012?+12345\";  
270 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it130r1s0x70y170b12345678901?+12345\";  
280 LPRINT CHR$(27); "it130r1s0x00y200b1234567?+12345\";  
300 ' LABEL PRINT  
310 LPRINT CHR$(27); "ih10w10x25y230lSample\";  
320 LPRINT CHR$(27); "ix90y230s4h10w10f2g2e";  
330 LPRINT CHR$(27); "ix105y230s4h10w10v";  
400 LPRINT CHR$(&HC);  
< Sample 19 >  
CHAPTER 8 BAR CODE CONTROL - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CHAPTER 9  
HP-GL  
GRAPHICS  
LANGUAGE  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. COMMAND LIST....................................................................................................................................3  
2. INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................................................4  
2.1. HP-GL Syntax.....................................................................................................................................4  
2.2. Font Selection ....................................................................................................................................4  
2.3. Coordinate System and Printing Area................................................................................................4  
2.3.1. Coordinate system........................................................................................................................... 4  
2.3.2. Printing area.................................................................................................................................... 5  
3. COMMANDS...........................................................................................................................................6  
3.1. Initialization and Default Setting Instructions......................................................................................6  
3.2. Plot Area and Unit Setting Instructions...............................................................................................7  
3.3. Pen Control and Plot Instructions ......................................................................................................8  
3.4. The polygon Group...........................................................................................................................13  
3.5. Plot Function Instructions.................................................................................................................18  
3.6. Character Plot Instructions ..............................................................................................................20  
3.7. Dual Context Extensions..................................................................................................................26  
4. INDEX.................................................................................................................................................... 27  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
COMMAND LIST  
DF  
IN  
IP  
Default set instruction  
Initialize set instruction  
Input scaling point  
Scale  
Input window  
Rotate coordinate system  
Page feed  
Pen up  
Pen down  
Plot absolute  
Relative coordinate pen move  
Draw absolute arc  
Draw relative arc  
Circle plot  
Edge rectangle absolute  
Edge rectangle relative  
Edge wedge  
Fill rectangle absolute  
Fill rectangle relative  
Fill wedge  
Fill type  
Line type selection  
Pen width  
Symbol mode  
Select pen  
6
6
7
7
8
8
8
9
9
SC  
IW  
RO  
PG  
PU  
PD  
PA  
PR  
AA  
AR  
CI  
EA  
ER  
EW  
RA  
RR  
WG  
FT  
LT  
PW  
SM  
SP  
TL  
XT  
YT  
PT  
CS  
CA  
SS  
9
10  
11  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
16  
17  
18  
18  
19  
19  
19  
19  
20  
20  
20  
20  
20  
21  
21  
21  
22  
22  
23  
23  
23  
24  
24  
25  
Tick length  
X-axis tick  
Y-axis tick  
Pen thickness select  
Standard character set  
Alternate character set  
Select standard character set  
Select alternate character set  
Define label terminator  
Character plot  
Absolute direction  
Relative direction  
Character plot  
SA  
DT  
LB  
DI  
DR  
CP  
SI  
SR  
SL  
UC  
Set absolute character size  
Set relative character size  
Character slant  
User-defined character  
EscCRRO, EscCRRL, EscCRRM, EscCRRD  
Set high resolution control (Brother original)  
26  
26  
26  
EscCR!#R  
EscCRFD  
User reset (Brother original)  
Factory reset (Brother original)  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
INTRODUCTION  
The HP-GL graphics mode emulates 40 out of 56 instructions for the HP 7475A plotter made by Hewlett-Packard.  
Default measurement unit in the HP-GL graphics mode is 1/1016"(0.025mm).  
2.1. HP-GL Syntax  
A command consists of a two-letter instruction mnemonic, a parameter field (not needed for some instructions)  
and a terminator. Parameters following the instruction mnemonic must be separated from each other by at least a  
single space or comma.  
Parameter Field  
Instruction Mnemonic  
Terminator  
P
A
10  
20 ;  
At least one space or  
comma (,) must be used  
Numeric values used in the parameter field are in one of the following four formats.  
(1) Integer - integers between -230 and 230 -1. Real numbers specified for a parameter that should be an integer are  
rounded to the nearest integer.  
(2) Clamped integers - integers between -32768 and 32767. Values outside this range are converted to the nearest  
integer within the range. Real numbers are rounded to the nearest integer.  
(3) Real - real numbers between -230 and 230 -1.  
(4) Clamped Real - real numbers between -32768 and 32767. Values outside this range are converted to the  
nearest real number within the range.  
2.2. Font Selection  
Eighteen character sets compatible with the HP 7454A are available.  
2.3. Coordinate System and Printing Area  
2.3.1. Coordinate system  
Paper feed direction  
Y
Home Position  
X
The home position is at the upper left corner of the area where printing is possible.  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.3.2. Printing area  
c
d
a
b
a
4
b
5
c
5
d
5
(mm)  
A4  
A3  
4
5
5
5 (HL-3400CN/3260N)  
Letter  
Legal  
6
6
5
5
5
5
5
5
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
COMMANDS  
3.1. Initialization and Default Setting Instructions  
DF - Default set instruction  
DF[;]  
·
·
Returns the graphics mode to the default conditions.  
The following are the default settings.  
Function  
Equivalent  
Instruction  
PA;  
DR 1,0;  
LT;  
Condition  
Plot mode  
Relative character direction  
Line type  
Absolute plotting  
Horizontal  
Solid line  
Line pattern length  
Window  
LT;  
IW;  
4% of distance from P1 to P2  
Set at limits of printable area  
according to paper size  
Width=0.75% of |P2x - P1x|  
Height=1.5% of |P2y - P1y|  
Off  
X-axis: 0.5% of |P2y - P1y|  
Y-axis: 0.5% of |P2x - P1x|  
Character set 0  
Relative character size  
SR;  
Symbol mode  
Tick length  
SM;  
TL;  
Standard character set  
Alternate character set  
Character set  
Character slant  
Scaling  
CS 0;  
CA 0;  
SS;  
SL 0;  
SC;  
Character set 0  
Standard character set selected  
0 degrees  
Off  
Label terminator  
Chord angle  
DT chr$(3)  
-----  
chr$(3)  
5 degrees  
Fill type  
Fill distance  
Fill slant  
FT;  
FT;  
FT;  
Bi-directional fill, type 1  
1% of distance from P1 to P2  
0 degrees  
Pen Thickness  
PT;  
Set at 0.3 mm  
NOTE:  
The location of the scaling points(P1, P2) remains constant.  
IN - Initialize set instruction  
IN[;]  
·
Returns the graphics mode to the following initial conditions;  
Function  
Equivalent  
Instruction  
PA;  
Condition  
Plot mode  
Absolute  
Relative character direction  
Line type  
DR 1,0;  
LT;  
Horizontal  
Solid line  
Line pattern length  
Window  
LT;  
IW;  
4% of distance from P1 to P2  
Set at limits of printable  
area according to paper size  
Width=0.75% of |P2x-P1X|  
Height=1.5% of |P2y-P1y |  
Off  
X-axis: 0.5% of |P2y-P1y |  
Y-axis: 0.5% of |P2x-P1x|  
Character set 0  
Character set 0  
Standard character set  
selected  
Relative character size  
SR;  
Symbol mode  
Tick length  
SM;  
TL;  
Standard character set  
Alternate character set  
Character set  
CS 0;  
CA 0;  
SS;  
Character slant  
Scaling  
SL 0;  
SC ;  
0 degrees  
Off  
Label terminator  
Chord angle  
DT chr$(3)  
-----  
chr$(3)  
5 degrees  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Function  
Equivalent  
Instruction  
FT;  
FT;  
FT;  
Condition  
Fill type  
Fill distance  
Fill slant  
Bi-directional fill, type 1  
1% of distance from P1 to P2  
0 degrees  
Pen thickness  
Pen condition  
Rotation  
PT;  
PU;  
RO;  
IP;  
Set at 0.3 mm  
Pen up  
Set at 0 degrees  
Initialized according to  
paper size  
Scaling points  
3.2. Plot Area and Unit Setting Instructions  
Instruction  
Function  
IP  
Scaling point  
Scale  
Input window  
Rotate coordinate system  
Page output  
SC  
IW  
RO  
PG  
IP - Input scaling point  
IP [ P1X, P1Y [,P2X, P2Y]] [;]  
P1X ; X coordinate of P1  
P2X ; X coordinate of P2  
P1Y ; Y coordinate of P1  
P2Y ; Y coordinate of P2  
·
·
·
The coordinate values used are absolute values in graphics units.  
Sets the location of the scaling points(P1, P2).  
Coordinate values for P1X, P1Y, P2X and P2Y are given as integer numbers.  
The IP instruction is ignored when the set coordinates are outside the print area.  
·
·
Using this instruction without a parameter field initializes the scaling points(P1, P2).  
P2X and P2Y may be omitted. (If P2X and P2Y are omitted, P2 is set automatically so as not to alter the distance  
between P1 and P2).  
SC - Scale  
SC Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, Ymax  
Xmin ; X coordinate of P1  
Ymin ; Y coordinate of P1  
Xmax ; X coordinate of P2  
Ymax ; Y coordinate of P2  
·
·
·
·
Sets the scale for the coordinates the user wants to establish.  
Coordinate values for Xmin, Xmax, Ymin and Ymax are given as real numbers.  
Using this instruction without a parameter field turns the scaling off.  
The technical terms user unit and graphics unit as used in this manual are defined as follows;  
User unit  
: the unit of the coordinates set by the SC instruction  
Graphics unit  
: the unit (1/1016 of an inch) of the coordinates not set by the SC  
instruction  
10 '*** SCEX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN; IP3000,2000,4500,3500;SP1;SC0,120,0,120;"  
30 FOR T=0 TO 2*3.1416+3.1416/20 STEP 3.1416/20  
40 X=COS(T)*100  
50 Y=SIN(T)*100  
60 LPRINT "PA";X;",";Y;";PD;"  
70 NEXT T  
80 LPRINT "PU;"  
90 END  
<Sample 61>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
IW - Input window  
IW [ X1, Y1, X2, Y2 ] [;]  
X1-Window lower left X coordinate  
X2-Window upper right X coordinate  
Y1-Window lower left Y coordinate  
Y2-Window upper right Y coordinate  
·
·
·
·
This instruction sets the window inside which plotting can be performed.  
Graphic units are always used.  
Coordinate values for X1, Y1, X2 and Y2 are integer numbers from 0 to 32,767.  
The order of the pairs (X1, Y1) and (X2, Y2) may be reversed with no change in the window created: "IW X1,  
Y1, X2, Y2" is identical in effect to "IW X2, Y2, X1, Y1".  
·
Using this instruction without a parameter field releases any previous limitations on the plot area.  
(X2,Y2)  
(X1,Y1)  
Print paper  
Window  
RO - Rotate coordinate system  
RO [q][;]  
q : Angle in degrees through which the coordinate system is rotated.  
·
·
·
This instruction rotates the coordinate system.  
A value of 0 or 90 must be used for q.  
Using this instruction without a parameter field sets the rotation of the coordinate system to 0 degrees.  
PG - Page feed  
PG [;]  
·
·
Executes a page feed  
After page feeding, the cursor position return to the home position (0, 0).  
3.3. Pen Control and Plot Instructions  
Instruction  
Function  
PU  
PD  
PA  
PR  
AA  
AR  
CI  
Pen Up  
Pen Down  
Plot Absolute  
Relative Coordinate Pen Move  
Absolute Arc Plot  
Relative Arc Plot  
Circle  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
PU - Pen up  
PU [ X,Y [,...]] [;]  
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
·
X and Y are either relative or absolute, depending on whether a PA or a PR was the last plot command  
executed. The absolute coordinates are set as default.  
·
·
·
·
·
·
Moves the cursor to the specified coordinates after raising the pen.  
Using this instruction without a parameter field raises the pen without changing the cursor position.  
When scaling is on, user coordinates are used.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.  
When scaling is off graphics units are used.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinates values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
(X1, Y1)  
(Xn, Yn)  
(X2,Y2)  
(X3, Y3)  
Current position  
PD - Pen down  
PD [ X, Y [,...]] [;]  
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
·
X and Y are either relative or absolute, depending on whether a PA or a PR was the last plot command  
executed. The absolute coordinates are set as default.  
·
·
Moves the cursor to the specified coordinates after lowering the pen. (This plots a straight line.)  
Using this instruction without a parameter lowers the pen without changing the cursor position. ( One dot is  
plotted.)  
·
·
·
·
When scaling has been performed, the cursor is moved by user coordinates.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.  
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by absolute coordinates in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
(X1, Y1)  
(Xn, Yn)  
(X2,Y2)  
(X3, Y3)  
Current position  
PA - Plot absolute  
PA [X, Y [,...]] [;]  
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
·
·
·
·
·
·
X and Y are absolute values in user units or graphics units.  
Moves the cursor to the specified coordinates.  
Plots a straight line only when the pen is down.  
When scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by absolute coordinates in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
(X1, Y1)  
(X2,Y2)  
(Xn, Yn)  
(X3, Y3)  
Current position  
10 '*** PAEX1 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"  
30 LPRINT "PA2000,6000;PD0,6000,2000,7500,2000,6000;PU2500,6000;"  
40 LPRINT "PAPD4500,6000,2500,7500,2500,6000;PU10365,500;"  
50 END  
<Sample 62>  
10 ' *** PAEX2 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;SC0,100,0,100;"  
30 LPRINT "PA50,30;PD25,30,50,50,50,30;PU55,30;"  
40 LPRINT "PAPD80,30,55,50,55,30,PU;"  
50 END  
<Sample 63>  
PR - Relative coordinate pen move  
PR [X, Y [,...]] [;]  
X ; X coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
Y ; Y coordinate of the cursor movement destination  
·
·
·
·
·
·
Coordinates are relative to the current position in user units or graphics units.  
Plots a straight line only when the pen is down.  
When scaling has been performed, the cursor is moved by relative coordinates in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.  
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by relative coordinates in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
X1  
Y2  
Y
Y3  
Current position  
X3  
10 ' *** prex 1 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;"  
30 LPRINT "PA5000,4500,;PDPR-2000,0,2000,2000,0,-2000;PU500,0;"  
40 LPRINT "PD2000,0,-2000,2000,0,-2000;PU;"  
50 END  
<Sample 64>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
AA - Draw absolute arc  
AA [ X, Y, qc [, qd ]] [;]  
X ; Arc centre X coordinate  
qc ; Arc angle in degrees  
Y ; Arc centre Y coordinate  
qd ; Chord angle in degrees  
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in user units or graphics units.  
Starting from the current position, plots an arc centred on the absolute coordinates X, Y having the specified  
arc angle and chord angle, with the radius being the distance between the current position and the point X,Y.  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor position moves to the plot end point.  
Plotting is performed only when the pen is down.  
When the pen is up, plotting is not performed but the cursor position moves to the plot end point.  
When scaling has been performed, the cursor is moved by absolute coordinates in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.  
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by absolute coordinates in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer number.  
The value for pc is a clamped real number.  
When qc is positive, counterclockwise plotting from the current point is performed.  
When qc is negative, plotting is made clockwise from the current position.  
The value for qd is a clamped real number.  
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees ).  
qc = Arc Angle  
qd = Chord Angle  
(X,Y)  
10 '*** AAEX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"  
30 LPRINT "SC0,100,0,100;"  
40 LPRINT "PA0,30;"  
50 LPRINT "PD;PA0,45;AA0,50,180;PA0,70;"  
60 LPRINT "AA0,100,90;PA45,100;AA50,100,180;PA70,100;"  
70 LPRINT "AA100,100,90;PA100,55;AA100,50,180;PA100,30;"  
80 LPRINT "AA100,0,90;PA100,55;AA100,50,180;PA70,100;"  
90 LPRINT "AA100,0,90;PA55,0;AA50,0,180;PA30,0;AA0,0,90;"  
100 LPRINT "PU;PA50,50,CI20;"  
110 END  
<Sample 68>  
AR - Draw relative arc  
AR X, Y, qc(, qd)[;]  
X ; Arc centre X coordinate  
qc ; Arc angle in degrees  
Y ; Arc centre Y coordinate  
qd ; Chord angle in degrees  
·
·
X and Y coordinates are relative coordinates in user units or graphics units.  
Starting from the current cursor position the command plots an arc whose centre is at the relative coordinate  
position (X,Y) and which has the specified arc and chord angles. The radius of the arc is the distance  
between the current position and the point (X,Y).  
·
After plotting the cursor position changes to the plot end point.  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Plotting is performed only when the pen is down.  
When the pen is up, plotting is not performed but the cursor position moves to the plot end point.  
When scaling has been performed, the cursor is moved by relative coordinates in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.  
When there is no scaling, the cursor is moved by relative coordinates in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
The value for qc is a clamped real number.  
When qc is positive, counterclockwise plotting from the current point is performed.  
When qc is negative, plotting is made clockwise from the current position.  
The value for qd is a clamped real number.  
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees ).  
10 '*** AREX1 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"  
30 LPRINT "SC-100,100,-100,100;"  
40 LPRINT "PA-80,-80;PD;AR0,50,90;AR50,0,90;PU;"  
50 END  
<Sample 69>  
10 ' *** AREX2 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"  
30 LPRINT "SC-100,100,-100,100;"  
40 LPRINT "PA-100,70;PD;PR30,0;AR-,-70,-90;AR70,0,90;PR60,0;PU;"  
50 END  
100 END  
<Sample 70>  
CI - Circle plot  
CI r(, qd)[;]  
r : Radius of circle ( in user units or graphic units )  
qd : Chord angle ( in degrees )  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Plots a circle centred on the current position with a radius r and chord angle qd.  
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin at the centre of the circle.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
When scaling has been performed, the circle is plotted in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the value for r is a real number.  
When scaling is off, the circle is plotted in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate value for r is an integer number.  
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value (5 degrees).  
Radius  
Chord angle  
Current position  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10 '*** CIEX1 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"  
30 LPRINT "SC-100,100,-100,100;"  
40 LPRINT "PA-60,50;CI40,45;"  
50 LPRINT "PA60,50;CI40,30;"  
60 LPRINT "PA-60,-50;CI40,15;"  
70 LPRINT "PA60,-50;CI40,5;"  
80 END  
<Sample 65>  
10 '*** CIEX2 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,8650,7325;"  
30 LPRINT "SC0,170,0,170;"  
40 LPRINT "PA100,100;LT;CI10,5;LT0;CI-20,5;LT1;CI30,5;"  
50 LPRINT "LT2;CI-40,5;LT3;CI50,5;LT4;CI-  
60,5;LT5;CI70,5;LT6;CI80,5;"  
60 END  
<Sample 66>  
10 '*** CIEX3 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;IP2650,1325,7650,6325;"  
30 LPRINT "SC-1000,1000,-1000,1000;"  
40 LPRINT "PA-800,800;"  
50 GOSUB 130  
60 LPRINT "PA200,800;"  
70 GOSUB 130  
80 LPRINT "PA-800,-200;"  
90 GOSUB 130  
100 LPRINT"PA200,-200;"  
110 GOSUB 130  
120 END  
130 LPRINT "CI70;PR600,0;CI70;PR-300,-300;CI250;"  
140 LPRINT "PR-300,-300;CI70;PR600,0;CI70;"  
150 RETURN  
<Sample 67>  
3.4. The polygon Group  
Instruction  
Function  
EA  
ER  
EW  
RA  
RR  
WG  
Edge Absolute Rectangle  
Edge Relative Rectangle  
Edge Wedge  
Fill Absolute Rectangle  
Fill Relative Rectangle  
Fill Wedge  
EA - Edge rectangle absolute  
EA X, Y[;]  
X ; X coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle  
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in user units or graphics units.  
Plots the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite angle specified by X and Y.  
After plotting the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
When scaling has been performed, the rectangle is plotted in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.  
When there is no scaling, the rectangle is plotted in graphics units.  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
·
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
(X, Y)  
Current position  
10 '*** EAEX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA7000,4000;"  
30 LPRINT "PT.3;FT1;RA6000,3000;"  
40 LPRINT "SP3,;EA6000,3000;"  
50 LPRINT "SP4;FT3,100;RA8000,3000;"  
60 LPRINT "SP3,;EA8000,3000;"  
70 LPRINT "SP5;PT.3;FT2;RA8000,5000;"  
80 LPRINT "SP3;EA8000,5000;"  
90 LPRINT "SP6;FT4,100,45;RA6000,5000;"  
100 LPRINT "SP3;EA6000,5000;PG"  
110 END  
<Sample 72>  
ER - Edge rectangle relative  
ER X, Y[;]  
X ; X coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle  
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Coordinates are relative to the current position in user units or graphics units.  
Plots the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite angle specified by X and Y.  
After plotting the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
When scaling has been performed, the rectangle is plotted in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.  
When there is no scaling, the rectangle is plotted in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
Y increment  
Current position  
X increment  
10 '*** EREX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,5000;"  
30 LPRINT "PT.3;FT1;RR500,500;"  
40 LPRINT "SP3,;ER500,500;"  
50 LPRINT "PR500,0"  
60 LPRINT "SP4;FT3,;RR500,500;"  
70 LPRINT "SP3,;ER500,500;"  
80 LPRINT "PR0,500;"  
90 LPRINT "SP5;PT.3;FT2;RR500,500;"  
100 LPRINT "SP3;ER500,500;"  
110 LPRINT "SP6;FT4,100,45;RR-500,500;"  
120 LPRINT "SP3;ER-500,500;PG"  
130 END  
<Sample 74>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
EW - Edge wedge  
EW r,q1,qc(,qd)[;]  
r ; Radius in user units or graphics units  
q1; Start point angle  
qc ; Arc angle  
qd ; Chord angle  
·
Plots a wedge centred on the current position with radius r, start point angle q1, arc angle qc and chord angle  
qd.  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
When scaling has been performed, the circle is plotted in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the value for r is a real number.  
When there is no scaling, the circle is plotted in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate value for r is an integer number.  
The value for q1 is a clamped real number.  
qc  
q1  
0° reference point  
current  
position  
r
·
·
q1 specifies the wedge starting point related to the 0 degree reference point.  
When q1 is positive, the positive direction of the X axis relative to the current position is set at 0 degrees and  
the start point is sought in the counterclockwise direction. The opposite occurs when q1 is negative: the  
negative X axis is set at 0 degrees and the start point is sought by going clockwise.  
·
·
·
·
·
qc specifies the angle of the wedge in degrees.  
The value for qc is a real number.  
Plotting proceeds counterclockwise when qc is positive and clockwise when negative.  
The value for qd is a clamped real number.  
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees )  
10 ' *** EWEX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;FT3,100;"  
30 LPRINT "PA5000,4000;"  
40 LPRINT "WG1250,90,180,5;"  
50 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,90,180,5;"  
60 LPRINT "SP4,FT4,100,45;"  
70 LPRINT "WG1250,270,120;"  
80 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,270,120;"  
80 LPRINT "SP1;PT.3;FT1;"  
100 LPRINT "WG1250,30,60;"  
110 LPRINT "SP3;EW1250,30,60;PG;"  
120 END  
<Sample 76>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
RA - Fill rectangle absolute  
RA X, Y[;]  
X ; X coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle  
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
X and Y coordinates are absolute coordinates in user units or graphics units.  
Fill in the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite angle specified by X and Y.  
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
When scaling has been performed, the rectangle is plotted in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.  
When there is no scaling, the rectangle is plotted in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
(X, Y)  
Fill pattern specified by FT and PT  
Current position  
10 '*** RAEX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,4000;"  
30 LPRINT "PT.3;FT1;RA4250,3250;"  
40 LPRINT "FT3,100;RA5750,3250;"  
50 LPRINT "FT2;RA5750,4750;"  
60 LPRINT "FT4,100,45;RA4250,4750;"  
70 END  
<Sample 71>  
RR - Fill rectangle relative  
RR X, Y[;]  
X ; X coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle  
Y ; Y coordinate of opposite angle for the rectangle  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
Coordinates are relative to the current position in user units or graphics units.  
Fill in the rectangle formed by the current position and the opposite angle specified by X and Y.  
After plotting the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
When scaling has been performed, the rectangle is plotted in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the values for X and Y are real numbers.  
When there is no scaling, the rectangle is plotted in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate values for X and Y are integer numbers.  
Fill pattern specified by FT and PT  
Y increment  
Current position  
X increment  
10 '*** PREX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,5000;"  
30 LPRINT "PT.3;FT1;RR500,500;"  
35 LPRINT "PR500,0;"  
40 LPRINT "FT3,70;RR500,500;"  
45 LPRINT "PR0,500;"  
50 LPRINT "FT2;RR500,500;"  
60 LPRINT "FT4,70,45;RR-500,500;"  
70 END  
<Sample 73>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
WG - Fill wedge  
WG r,q1,qc(,qd)[;]  
r ; Radius in user units or graphics units  
q1 ; Start point angle  
qc ; Arc angle  
qd ; Chord angle  
·
Fill in a wedge centred on the current position with radius r, start point angle q1, arc angle qc and chord angle  
qd.  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
When scaling has been performed, the circle is plotted in user units.  
Also, when scaling has been performed, the value for r is a real number.  
When there is no scaling, the circle is plotted in graphics units.  
When there is no scaling, the coordinate value for r is an integer number.  
The value for q1 is a clamped real number.  
When q1 is positive, the positive direction of the X axis relative to the current position is set at 0 degrees and  
the start point is sought in the counterclockwise direction. The opposite occurs when q1 is negative: the  
negative X axis is set at 0 degrees and the start point is sought by going clockwise.  
·
·
·
·
The value for qc is a clamped real number.  
Plotting proceeds counterclockwise when qc is positive and clockwise when it is negative.  
The value for qd is a clamped real number.  
When qd is not specified, the chord angle is the default value ( 5 degrees ).  
Fill pattern specified  
by FT and PT  
Radius  
Start point angle  
0 degrees  
Current position  
Arc angle  
10 ' *** WGEX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;FT3,100;"  
30 LPRINT "PA5000,4000;"  
40 LPRINT "WG1250,90,180,5;"  
50 LPRINT "SP4;FT4,100,45;"  
60 LPRINT "WG1250,270,120;"  
70 LPRINT "SP1;PT.3;FT1;"  
80 LPRINT "WG1250,30,60;PG;"  
90 END  
<Sample 75>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.5. Plot Function Instructions  
Instruction  
FT  
Function  
Fill Type  
LT  
PW  
SM  
SP  
TL  
Line Type  
Pen Width  
Symbol Mode  
Select Pen  
Tick Length  
X Tick  
XT  
YT  
Y Tick  
PT  
Pen Thickness  
FT - Fill type  
FT [ n [, d [, q]]] [;]  
n : Fill type  
d : Fill interval (interval between the parallel lines of the area being filled)  
q : Fill angle (degrees )  
·
·
Sets the fill type, interval and angle when filling an area.  
The value for n is a clamped integer number.  
Solid lines (bi-directional fill)  
Solid lines (single direction fill)  
Parallel lines  
Crosshatching  
·
·
·
·
·
·
·
The fill interval when n is 1 or 2 is the interval set by the pen thickness (PT) instruction.  
Any value given for d when n is 1 or 2 will be ignored.  
If d is omitted, the fill interval already specified will be used.  
If d is 0, the default value will be used ( 1% of distance from P1 to P2. )  
The value of d is a clamped real number .  
If q is omitted, the fill angle already specified will be used.  
The value of q is a clamped real number.  
LT - Line type selection  
LT [, n [, p ]] [;]  
n ; Line pattern number  
p ; Line pattern length (percentage or millimeters of distance between P1 and P2)  
·
·
·
Specifies the line type and pattern length.  
When the n parameter field is omitted a solid line is selected.  
When the p parameter field is omitted the pattern length is 4% of the distance between P1 and P2 (default  
value ).  
·
·
·
The value of n is a clamped integer number.  
The value of p is a clamped real number from 0.0000 to 127.9999.  
When p is omitted the previously set line pattern length is used.  
Default :Solid line  
:For straight line, start and end points are plotted.  
:For an arc, plotting takes place for every chord angle that is set.  
1 :  
2 :  
3 :  
4 :  
5 :  
6 :  
P
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
PW-Pen width  
PW n[;]  
w ; width (unit = 1/300 inch)  
·
·
This command specifies the width of the currently selected pen.  
The value of w is an integer number from 1 to 10.  
SM - Symbol mode  
SM c[;]  
c ; ASCII character or symbol code  
·
·
·
The command specifies the symbol to be drawn.  
When the PA, PR, PD or PU instruction is used, the specified symbol will be drawn at the end of each vector.  
The specified symbol will be drawn at the end of each vector even if the pen is up when the PA or PR  
instructions are used.  
·
Omitting the parameter field cancels the symbol mode.  
10 '*** SMEX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;SM*;PA500,1500;"  
30 LPRINT "PD600,1590,670,1860,850,1960,1320,1900,1940,2350:"  
40 LPRINT "PU;SM;PA500,500;SM3;"  
50 LPRINT "PA550,800,680,720,800,950,1150,1230,1870,1350;PU;"  
60 LPRINT "SM;PA1850,600;PD;SMY;PA3000,1450;"  
70 LPRINT "SMZ;PA3300,1150;SMX;PA1850,600;PU;"  
80 END  
<Sample 78>  
SP - Select pen  
SP [ n ] [;]  
n ; Pen number  
·
·
Selects the pen specified by the pen number.  
The value for n must be an integer from 0 to 6.  
TL - Tick length  
TL l1(,l2)[;]  
1-Length of ticks in the positive X- and Y-axes  
2-Length of ticks in the negative X- and Y-axes  
·
·
·
Tick length is a percentage of the vertical and horizontal distances between P1 and P2.  
Sets the length of tick marks for the XT and YT instructions.  
Values for 1 and 2 are clamped real numbers.  
·
When the parameter field is omitted, the default values for tick length are used, for both l1 and l2, these are  
0.5% of the horizontal and vertical distances between P1 and P2.  
10 '*** TLEX ***  
30 FOR I=1 TO 10  
40 LPRINT "PR800,0;XT;"  
50 NEXT I  
60 LPRINT "TL;PU;PA300,279;PD;"  
70 GOSUB 1000  
80 LPRINT "TL1,0;PU;PA1100,279;PD;"  
20 LPRINT "IN;PA300,279;SP2;PD;TL90;XT;";  
90 GOSUB 1000  
100 LPRINT "TL0,5;PU;PA1900,279;"  
110 GOSUB 1000  
120 LPRINT "PA300,6759;TL80;YT;PU;"  
130 END  
1000 '* SUBROUTINE DRAW TICKS *  
1010 FOR J=1 TO 8  
1020 LPRINT "PRO,720;YT;"  
1030 NEXT J  
1040 RETURN  
<Sample 77>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
XT - X-axis tick  
XT [;]  
·
·
·
Plots vertical tick marks as specified by the TL instruction from the current position.  
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
YT - Y-axis tick  
YT [;]  
·
·
·
Plots horizontal tick marks as specified by the TL instruction from the current position.  
After plotting, the cursor returns to its point of origin.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
10 '*** XTYTEX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;PA300,279;SP2;PD";  
30 LPRINT "PR1300,0;XT;PR1300,0;XT;PU;"  
40 END  
PT - Pen thickness select  
PT [d] [;]  
d : Fill line interval (mm)  
·
·
·
Sets the line interval when filling in with solid lines.  
The value for d is a clamped number from 0.0000 to 5.0000.  
The default value (0.3 mm) is used when d is omitted.  
3.6. Character Plot Instructions  
Instruction  
CS  
CA  
SS  
SA  
DT  
LB  
Function  
Standard Set Definition  
Alternate Set Definition  
Select Standard Font  
Select Alternate Font  
Define Label Terminator  
Define Label  
DI  
DR  
CP  
Absolute Direction  
Relative Direction  
Character Plot  
SI  
SR  
SL  
UC  
Set Absolute Character Size  
Set Relative Character Size  
Set Character Slant  
User-defined Character  
CS - Standard character set  
CS n[;]  
n ; Character set number(*)  
·
·
·
Specifies the standard character set.  
When the parameter field is omitted, character set 0 is specified.  
The value for n is a clamped integer number in the range of 0 to 4, 6 to 7, 9 or 30 to 39.  
CA - Alternate character set  
CA n[;]  
n ; Character set number (*)  
·
·
·
Specifies the alternate character set.  
When the parameter field is omitted, character set 0 is specified.  
The value for n is a clamped integer number in the range of 0 to 4, 6 to 7, 9 or 30 to 39.  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
n
0
Character Set  
ANSI ASCII  
1
2
3
9825 Character Set  
French/German  
Scandinavian  
4
6
Spanish/Latin American  
JIS ASCII  
7
9
ROMAN 8 Extensions  
ISO IRV  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
ISO Swedish  
ISO Swedish for Names  
ISO Norway, Version 1  
ISO German  
ISO French  
ISO Kingdom  
ISO Italian  
ISO Spanish  
ISO Portuguese  
ISO Norway, Version 2  
SS - Select standard character set  
SS [;]  
Selects the standard character set specified by the CS instruction.  
SA - Select alternate character set  
SA [;]  
Selects the alternate character set specified by the CA instruction.  
10 '*** SASSEX ***  
20 LPRINT "PA5000,5000;"  
30 LPRINT "SP2;CS4;CA9;SS;LBS_E_T_4";CHR$(14);"S_E_T_9";CHR$(3)  
40 ENDø  
<Sample 79>  
DT - Define label terminator  
DT c [;]  
c : Character  
·
·
·
·
The specified character is used as the character plotter terminator.  
The character plot mode is canceled by sending a terminator at the end of a character plot string.  
The parameter field used for this command must be only one character in length.  
The default value (chr$(3)) is used when the parameter field is omitted.  
10 '*** DTEX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;SC0,5000,0,5000;"  
30 LPRINT "PA0,4500;LBDefault control character  
ETX";CHR$(13);CHR$(3);  
40 LPRINT "LBterminates by performing end-";CHR$(13);CHR$(3):  
50 LPRINT "LBof-text function.";CHR$(3);  
60 LPRINT "PA0,3500;DT@;LBPrinting characters  
terminate,";CHR$(13):"@";  
70 LPRINT "LBbut are also printed.@";  
80 LPRINT "PA0,3000;DT";CHR$(13);";LBcontrol characters  
terminate";CHR$(10);CHR$(13)  
90 LPRINT "LBand perform their function.";CHR$(13)  
100 END  
<Sample 80>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
LB - Character plot  
LB [ cs ] < terminator > [;]  
cs : character string  
·
·
·
Plots character strings, numerical expressions, variables etc.  
Plotting is performed whether the pen is up or down.  
After plotting, the cursor moves to the position of the next character.  
10 '*** LBEX1 ***  
20 LPRINT "SP2;PA1000,4000;"  
30 X=30  
40 LPRINT "LB",X,X+1,X+2,CHR$(3)  
50 END  
<Sample 81>  
10 '*** LBEX2 ***  
20 LPRINT "SP2;PA4000,5000;"  
30 X=30  
40 LPRINT "LB";X;X+1;X+2,CHR$(3)  
70 END  
<Sample 82>  
10 '*** LBEX3 ***  
20 LPRINT "SP2;PA5000,6000;"  
30 X=30  
40 LPRINT "LB";X;" ";X+1;" ";X+2,CHR$(3)  
70 END  
<Sample 83>  
DI - Absolute direction  
DI [ run, rise ] [;]  
run : X direction component  
rise : Y direction component  
·
·
·
·
Specifies the character plot direction.  
Values for the run and rise are clamp ed real numbers.  
The instruction is ignored when the values for both run and rise are 0.  
When the parameter field is omitted, the default value (horizontal direction) is used.  
sin q  
tan  
q=  
rise  
cosq  
q
run  
10 '*** DIEX ***  
15 DEG=-45  
16 RAD3.1416/180*DEG  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;PA3050,4450;"  
30 LPRINT "DI0,2;LB_*_1988";CHR$(3);"DI2,2;LB_*_1989";CHR$(3)  
40 LPRINT "DI2,0;LB_*_1990";CHR$(3);"DI2,-2;LB_*_1991";CHR$(3)  
50 LPRINT "DI0,-2;LB_*_1992";CHR$(3);DI-2,-2;LB_*_1993";CHR$(3)  
60 LPRINT "DI-2,0;LB_*_1994";CHR$(3);"DI-2,2;LB_*_1995";CHR$(3)  
70 LPRINT  
"PA3500,5350;DI",COS(0),SIN(0);"LB_*_2000";CHR$(13);CHR$(3);  
80 LPRINT "DI",COS(RAD);SIN(RAD);"LB_RETURN  
POINT";CHR$(13);CHR$(3)  
90 END  
<Sample 84>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
DR - Relative direction  
DR [ run, rise ] [;]  
run : X direction component  
rise : Y direction component  
·
·
·
·
·
A percentage of the distance in the X and Y directions between P1 and P2 is used as the units  
Specifies the character plot direction.  
Values for the run and rise are clamped real numbers.  
The instruction is ignored when values for both run and rise are 0.  
When the parameter field is omitted, the default value (horizontal direction) is used.  
(0, 100)  
(100, 100)  
(0,60)  
rise = 60%  
q
(70,0)  
(0, 100)  
run=70%  
CP - Character plot  
CP X,Y [;]  
X ; the number of text spaces the pen position is moved.  
Y ; the number of text lines the pen position is moved.  
Moves the cursor the specified number of characters.  
Values for X and Y are clamped real numbers.  
·
·
·
When the parameter field is omitted, the cursor is not moved along the X-axis but it is moved 1 character in  
the negative direction along the Y-axis (identical to executing CP 0, -1;).  
X increment  
Current position  
Y increment  
10 '*** CPEX ***  
20 LPRINT "DF;SP1;PA1000,3000;PDPR3000,0;PU;PR-3000,0;"  
30 LPRINT "CP5,.55;LBABOVE THE LINE";CHR$(3);"PA2000,3000;"  
40 LPRINT "XT;CP0,-1.15;LBBELOW THE LINE";CHR$(13);CHR$(10);"AND  
WITH A NEAT";CHR$(3)  
50 LPRINT "CP;LBMARGIN";CHR$(3)  
60 END  
<Sample 85>  
SI - Set absolute character size  
SI [ width, height ] [;]  
width : the width in centimeters of printed characters  
height : the height in centimeters of printed characters  
·
·
·
Specifies the size of characters to be plotted.  
Values for width and height are clamped real numbers.  
When the parameter field is omitted, the default values are used (width: 0.1879 cm, height: 0.2690 cm).  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10 '*** SIEX1 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA1000,1000;"  
30 LPRINT "SI2,1.5;LBLASER";CHR$(3)  
40 END  
<Sample 86>  
10 '*** SIEX2 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,3000:"  
30 LPRINT "SI-.35,.35;LBCHARACTER";CHR$(3)  
40 END  
<Sample 87>  
10 '*** SIEX3 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,3000;"  
30 LPRINT "SI.35,-.35;LBCHARACTER";CHR$(3)  
40 END  
<Sample 88>  
10 '*** SIEX4 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP1;PA5000,3000;"  
30 LPRINT "SI-.35,-.35;LBCHARACTER";CHR$(3)  
40 END  
<Sample 89>  
SR - Set relative character size  
SR [ width, height ] [;]  
width ; the width of printed characters expressed as a percentage of the x-component of the distance  
between P1 and P2.  
height ; the height of printed characters expressed as a percentage of the y-component of the distance  
between P1 and P2.  
·
·
·
Specifies the size of characters to be plotted.  
Values for width and height are clamped real numbers.  
When the parameter field is omitted, the default values are used (width: 0.7500%, height: 1.5000%).  
10 ' *** SREX ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;PA100,7000;LBDEFAULT SIZE";CHR$(3)  
30 LPRINT "IP 2000,2000,6500,6500;PA100,6500;"  
40 LPRINT "LBNEW P1 AND P2 CHANGE LABEL SIZE";CHR$(3);"SR5,5;"  
50 LPRINT "PA100,6000;LBNEW SR INSTRUCTION";CHR$(13);CHR$(3);  
60 LPRINT "LBCHANGE LABEL SIZE";CHR$(3);  
<Sample 90>  
SL - Character slant  
SL [ tan f ] [;]  
tan f - tangent of character slant angle (f)  
·
·
·
Specifies the slant of characters to be plotted.  
Va lue for tanq is a clamped real number.  
When the parameter field is omitted, the default value is used (0 degree character slant).  
q
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
10 '"*** SLEX ***  
20 LPRINT "DF;SP1;SI1.3,1.3;PA100,6000;"  
30 LPRINT "SL2;LBLASER";CHR$(3)  
40 LPRINT "SL-2;PR3000,0;LBLASER";CHR$(3)  
50 END  
<Sample 91>  
UC - User-defined character  
UC X1, Y1, X2, Y2..., Xn, Yn[;]  
Xi : Number of grids in X direction  
Yi : Number of grids in Y direction  
·
·
·
Draws user-generated character or symbol.  
Values for Xi and Yi are clamped real numbers.  
If a value between 99.0000 and 127.9999 is entered between(Xi, Yi) and (Xi+1, Yi+1), the pen will be lowered at  
that point.  
·
If a value between -128.0000 and -99.0000 is entered between (Xi, Yi) and (Xi+1, Yi+1), the pen will be raised at  
that point.  
(-4,0)  
UC 4, 99, 0, 1, -4, 0, 2, -4, -2, -4, 4, 0, 0, 1;  
(0, 1)  
(2, -4)  
(-2, -4)  
(0, 1)  
Character point of origin  
(4, 0)  
10 '*** UCEX1 ***  
20 LPRINT "IN;SP2;PA2000,2000;"  
30 FOR AA=19 TO 89 STEP 10  
40 A=AA/100  
50 LPRINT "SI",A,A*1.7  
60 LPRINT "UC4,7,99,0,1,-4,0,2,-4,-2,-4,4,0,0,1;"  
70 NEXT AA  
80 LPRINT "PA2000,3750;"  
90 FOR BB=19 TO 89 STEP 10  
100 B=BB/100  
110 LPRINT "SI",B,B*1.7  
120 LPRINT "LBE";CHR$(3)  
130 NEXT BB  
140 END  
<Sample 92>  
10 '*** UCEX2 ***  
20 LPRINT "SP1;PA3000,5000;SI.5,.8"  
30 LPRINT "UC0,4,99,1.75,0,1.5,4,3,-8,3,8,3,-8,3,8,3,-  
8,1.5,4,1.75,0;"  
40 LPRINT "CP5,0;LB1000 ohms";CHR$(3)  
50 END  
<Sample 93>  
10 '*** UCEX2 ***  
20 LPRINT "SP1;PA3000,4500;SI.5,.8"  
30 LPRINT "UC0,8,99,3.5,0,3,8,6,-16,6,16,6,-16,6,16,6,-  
16,3,8,3.5,0;"  
40 END  
<Sample 94>  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.7. Dual Context Extensions  
Set High resolution control  
(Brother original)  
EscCRRO  
This command sets high resolution control off.  
EscCRRL  
This command sets high resolution control light level.  
EscCRRM  
This command sets high resolution control medium level.  
EscCRRD  
This command sets high resolution control dark level.  
User reset (Brother original)  
EscCR!#R  
·
·
·
·
# can be 0, 1 or 2.  
#0 indicates the current setting are restored.  
#1 indicates the user settings 1 are restored.  
#2 indicates the user settings 2 are restored.  
Factory reset  
(Brother original)  
EscCRFD  
·
·
This command causes a factory reset to be performed, restoring all the printer's factory default settings.  
You can also perform a factory reset using the printer's control panel (see the User Guide).  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
INDEX  
A
P
Absolute direction ...................................................................22  
Alternate character set ............................................................20  
Pen down..................................................................................... 9  
Pen thickness select ................................................................ 20  
Pen up.......................................................................................... 9  
Pen width................................................................................... 19  
Plot absolute............................................................................... 9  
printing area................................................................................ 5  
C
Character plot......................................................................22, 23  
character set................................................................................4  
Character slant..........................................................................24  
Circle plot...................................................................................12  
R
Relative coordinate pen move................................................ 10  
Relative direction ..................................................................... 23  
Rotate coordinate system......................................................... 8  
D
Default set instruction...............................................................6  
Define label terminator.............................................................21  
Draw absolute arc.....................................................................11  
Draw relative arc .......................................................................11  
S
Scale ............................................................................................. 7  
Select alternate character set.................................................. 21  
Select pen.................................................................................. 19  
Select standard character set ................................................. 21  
Set absolute character size ..................................................... 23  
Set relative character size........................................................ 24  
Standard character set............................................................. 20  
Symbol mode ............................................................................ 19  
syntax........................................................................................... 4  
E
Edge rectangle absolute..........................................................13  
Edge rectangle relative ............................................................14  
Edge wedge...............................................................................15  
F
T
Factory reset .............................................................................26  
Fill rectangle absolute..............................................................16  
Fill rectangle relative................................................................16  
Fill type ......................................................................................18  
Fill wedge...................................................................................17  
Tick length ................................................................................ 19  
U
User rest.................................................................................... 26  
User-defined character............................................................ 25  
H
High resolution control...........................................................26  
home position .............................................................................4  
X
X-axis tick.................................................................................. 20  
I
Initialize set instruction .............................................................6  
Input scaling point.....................................................................7  
Input window..............................................................................8  
Y
Y-axis tick.................................................................................. 20  
L
Line type selection...................................................................18  
CHAPTER 9 HP-GL - 27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
APPENDIX A  
COMPARISON LIST  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
ONTENTS  
C
PCL5/5E................................................................................................... 3  
Typeface Selection (PCL).........................................................................15  
HP-GL/2..................................................................................................17  
EPSON FX-850........................................................................................19  
IBM PROPRINTER XL...........................................................................22  
BAR CODE.............................................................................................24  
HP-GL.....................................................................................................25  
PJL..........................................................................................................27  
General PJL Environment Variables...........................................................33  
PCL Specific Variables.............................................................................38  
PostScript Specific Variables.....................................................................40  
EPSON Specific Variables........................................................................41  
IBM Specific Variables.............................................................................42  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
In this chapter, you can find which commands are supported by your printer.  
PCL5/5e  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
Esc&k#G  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Line Termination  
Esc&s#C  
End of Line Wrap  
EscY  
Display Function ON  
EscZ  
Display Function OFF  
Esc&l1A  
Paper Size  
Executive  
Esc&l2A  
Paper Size  
Letter  
Esc&l3A  
Paper Size  
Legal  
Esc&l6A  
Paper Size  
Ledger  
Esc&l25A  
Paper Size  
A5  
Esc&l26A  
Paper Size  
A4  
Esc&l27A  
Paper Size  
A3  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
Esc&l45A  
Paper Size  
JIS B5  
Esc&l46A  
Paper Size  
JIS B4  
Esc&l100A  
Paper Size  
B5  
Esc&l1024A  
Paper Size  
B6  
Esc&l1025A  
Paper Size  
A5  
Esc&l1026A  
Paper Size  
A6  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc&l1028A  
Paper Size  
13”X19"  
Esc&l2048A  
Paper Size  
A4 Long  
Esc&l80A  
Paper Size  
Monarch  
Esc&l81A  
Paper Size  
COM 10  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
Esc&l90A  
Paper Size  
DL  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc&l91A  
Paper Size  
C5  
Esc&l101A  
Paper Size  
Free Size  
Esc&l0H  
Paper Eject  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc&l1H  
Primary Tray  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Upper  
Cassette  
Upper  
Cassette  
Feeder1  
Tray1  
Tray1  
Tray1  
Tray1  
Tray1  
Tray1  
Tray1  
Esc&l2H  
Manual Feed  
Esc&l3H  
Envelope  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Feed  
from  
v
Feed  
from  
v
Feed  
from  
v
Feed  
from  
Manual  
Feed  
v
MP  
Tray  
v
Tray2  
(LT-  
1600)  
v
v
Feed  
from  
Manual  
Feed  
v
MP  
Tray  
v
Tray2  
(LT-  
2000)  
v
v
Feed  
from  
Manual Manual  
Feed  
v
Tray2  
v
Feed  
from  
v
Feed  
from  
v
Feed  
from  
v
Feed  
from  
Manual Manual Manual  
Feed  
Manual Manual Manual  
Feed  
v
Lower  
Cassette  
Feed  
Feed  
Feed  
v
Tray2  
Feed  
v
Tray2  
Feed  
v
Tray2  
v
v
v
Esc&l4H  
Secondary Tray  
v
Lower  
Lower  
Lower  
Feeder2  
Cassette Cassette Cassette  
v
v
v
v
Esc&l5H/6H  
Optional Tray  
v
v
v
v
Lower  
Lower  
Lower  
Lower  
Cassette  
Tray2  
Tray2  
Tray2  
Tray2  
Cassette Cassette Cassette  
Esc&l7H  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Automatic Selection  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
1470N  
Esc&l8H  
v
v
v
Optional Tray  
Tray3  
Tray3  
Tray3  
Esc&l9H  
v
v
Optional Tray  
Tray4  
Tray4  
Esc&l100H  
Tray ID 1  
v
v
Tray ID TrayID  
1
v
1
v
Esc&l101H  
Tray ID 2  
Tray ID TrayID  
2
v
2
v
Esc&l102H  
Tray ID 3  
Tray ID TrayID  
3
v
3
v
Esc&l103H  
Tray ID 4  
Tray ID TrayID  
4
v
4
v
Esc&l0S  
Simplex  
Esc&l1S  
Duplex Long-Edge Binding  
Esc&l2S  
Duplex Short-Edge Binding  
Esc&l#U  
Long-edge Offset  
Esc&l#Z  
Short-edge Offset  
Esc&l#X  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Copy Volume  
#:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327 #:1~327  
67  
v
67  
v
67  
v
67  
v
67  
v
67  
v
67  
v
67  
v
Esc&l#T  
v
v
v
v
Job Separation  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
EscE  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Printer Reset  
EscCR!#R  
User Reset  
Escz  
Self-test  
Esc%-12345X  
UEL  
Esc&u#D  
Unit of Measure  
Esc&a#L  
Left Margin  
Esc&a#M  
Right Margin  
Esc9  
Clear Side Margin  
Esc&l#E  
Top Margin  
Esc&l#C  
Line Pitch  
Esc&k#H  
Character Pitch  
Esc&l#D  
Line Spacing  
Esc&l#F  
Text Length  
Esc&l#P  
Page Length  
Esc&l#L  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Perforation Skip  
Esc&a#R  
Vertical Position(line)  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
Esc*p#Y  
Position(dot)  
Esc&a#V  
Vertical Position(decipoint)  
Esc&a#C  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Horizontal Position(column)  
Esc&a#H  
Horizontal  
Position(decipoint)  
Esc*p#X  
Horizontal Position(dot)  
Esc&f0S  
Push Cursor Position  
Esc&f1S  
Pop Cursor Position  
Esc=  
Half-line Feed  
Esc&l#O  
Print Orientation  
Esc&a#G  
Paper Side Selection  
EscCR!#H  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
#:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3 #:0,1,2,3  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Scalable Font  
Ratio(Horizontal)  
EscCR!#V  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Scalable Font  
Ratio(Vertical)  
EscCR!#E  
Execute Card Data  
Esc&a#P  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Print Direction  
Esc(3@, Esc)3@  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
SO  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Secondary Font Select  
SI  
Primary Font Select  
Esc*c#R  
Symbol Set ID Set  
Esc(f#W  
Define Symbol Set  
Esc*c#S  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Symbol Set Control  
Esc(symbol ID  
Esc(s#C,  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#C  
Character Set  
Esc(s#P,  
Esc)s#P  
Fixed Pitch or PS  
Esc(s#H,  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#H  
Character Pitch Selection  
Esc&k#S  
Character Pitch Selection  
Esc(s#V,  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#V  
Point Size  
Esc(s#S,  
Esc)s#S  
Italics or Upright  
Esc(s#B,  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#B  
Stroke Weight  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
Esc(s#T,  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc)s#T  
Typeface  
Esc&p#X  
Transparent Print  
Esc&d#D,  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc&d@  
Auto Underline  
Esc*c#D  
Download Font  
Font ID Set  
Esc*c#F  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
#:0~6,10  
26,  
1028,  
1029  
v
v
v
v
v
Download Font Control  
#:0~6  
#:0~6  
#:0~6  
#:0~6  
#:0~6,10 #:0~6,10 #:0~6,10  
26,  
1028,  
1029  
v
26,  
1028,  
1029  
v
26,  
1028,  
1029  
v
Esc(#X  
Set to Primary Font  
Esc)#X  
Set to Secondary Font  
Esc(#@  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Font Default  
Setting(Primary)  
Esc)#@  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Font Default  
Setting(Secondary)  
Esc)s#W  
Download Font Header  
Esc*c#E  
Character Code Set  
Esc(s#W  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Download Character  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
Esc*v#N  
Select Source Transparency  
Mode  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc*v#O  
v
v
v
v
Select Pattern Transparency  
Mode  
Esc*c#G  
Pattern ID Setting  
Esc*c#W  
Define Pattern  
Esc*p#R  
Set Pattern Reference Point  
Esc*c#Q  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
User-defined Pattern  
Control  
Esc*v#T  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Select Pattern  
#:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13 #:0~4,13  
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
0
v
Esc*c#A  
Pattern Horizontal Size(dot)  
Esc*c#H  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Pattern Horizontal  
Size(decipoint)  
Esc*c#B  
Pattern Vertical Size(dot)  
Esc*c#V  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Pattern Vertical  
Size(decipoint)  
Esc*c#P  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Print Pattern  
#:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13 #:0~5,13  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
Esc*t#R  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Resolution Setting  
#:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100, #:75,100,  
150,  
200,  
150,  
200,  
150,  
200,  
150,  
200,  
150,  
200,  
150,  
200,  
150,  
200,  
150,  
200,  
150,  
200,  
300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600 300,600  
Esc*r#F  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Raster Graphics  
Presentation  
Esc*r#T  
Raster Height  
Esc*r#S  
Raster Width  
Esc*b#Y  
Raster Y Offset  
Esc*b#M  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Set Compression Mode  
#:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3, #:0,1,2,3,  
5,9,  
1027,  
1028,  
1152  
v
5,9,1027,  
1028,  
1024,  
1152  
v
5,9,  
1027,  
1028,  
1152  
v
5,9,  
1027,  
1028,  
1152  
v
5,9,  
1027,  
1028,  
1152  
v
5,9,  
1024,  
1027,  
1152  
v
5,9,  
1024,  
1027,  
1152  
v
5,9,  
1024,  
1027,  
1152  
v
5,9,  
1024,  
1027,  
1152  
v
Esc*r#A  
Begin Raster Graphics  
Esc*b#W  
Transfer Data  
Esc*b#C  
Compression Transfer  
Esc*rB  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
End Raster Graphics  
Esc*rC  
End Raster Graphics  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
Esc%#B  
Enter HP-GL/2 Mode  
Esc*c0T  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Set Picture Frame Anchor  
Point  
Esc*c#Y  
Picture Frame Vertical size  
Esc*c#X  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Picture Frame Horizontal  
size  
Esc*c#L  
HP-GL2 Plot  
Vertical Size  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc*c#K  
HP-GL2 Plot Horizontal  
Size  
Esc&f0X  
Start Macro Definition  
Esc&f1X  
End Macro Definition  
Esc&f2X  
Execute Macro  
Esc&f3X  
Call Macro  
Esc&f4X  
Macro Overlay ON  
Esc&f5X  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Macro Overlay OFF  
Esc&f6X  
Delete All Macros  
Esc&f7X  
Delete Temporary Macro  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
HL-  
1270N/  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
1450  
v
1470N  
v
Esc&f8X  
Delete Current Macro  
Esc&f9X  
Make Temporary Macro  
Esc&f10X  
Make Permanent Macro  
Esc&f1030X  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Delete All Macro from Card  
Esc&f1036X  
Delete Current Macro from  
Card  
Esc&f1038X  
Save Current Macro into  
Card  
Esc*s#T  
Set Status Readback  
Location Type  
Esc*s#U  
Set Status Readback  
Location Unit  
Esc*s#l  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Inquire Status Readback  
Entity  
Esc*s1M  
Free Memory Space  
Esc&r#F  
Flush All Pages  
Esc*s#X  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Echo  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
Typeface Selection (PCL)  
COMMAND TYPEFACE  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
1450  
HL-  
1270N/  
1470N  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
HL-  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
3400CN 1650/  
1670N  
Esc(s129T  
Esc(s128T  
Anelia  
Brougham  
Esc(s130T  
Esc(s104T  
Esc(s110T  
Letter Gothic  
OCR-A  
OCR-B  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc(s152T  
Esc(s153T  
Esc(s154T  
Esc(s155T  
Esc(s156T  
Esc(s157T  
Esc(s158T  
Esc(s159T  
Helsinki  
Tennessee  
Helsinki Narrow  
Atlanta  
Brussels  
Copenhagen  
Portugal  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Calgary  
Esc(s4101T  
Esc(s4143T  
Esc(s4148T  
Esc(s4362T  
Esc(s4168T  
Esc(s4099T  
Esc(s4140T  
PC Tennessee  
PC Brussels  
Utah  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Alaska  
Antique Oakland  
Brougham  
Cleveland  
Condensed  
Connecticut  
Guatemala  
Letter Gothic  
Maryland  
Esc(s4116T  
Esc(s4197T  
Esc(s4102T  
Esc(s4297T  
Esc(s4113T  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Oklahoma  
Esc(s16686T BR Symbol  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND TYPEFACE  
HL-  
1050  
HL-  
1070  
HL-  
1250/  
1450  
v
v
v
HL-  
1270N/  
1470N  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-  
2060  
HL-  
2400  
C/Ce  
HL-  
HL-  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-  
2460  
3400CN 1650/  
1670N  
Esc(s16602T Helsinki  
Esc(s16901T Tennessee  
Esc(s31402T W Dingbats  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
ESC(s134T  
ESC(s132T  
ESC(s133T  
ESC(s135T  
Bermuda Script  
Germany  
San Diego  
US Roman  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
HP-GL/2  
COMMAND  
DF  
IN  
IP  
IR  
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
SC  
IW  
RO  
PU  
PD  
PA  
PR  
AA  
AR  
AT  
RT  
PE  
CI  
BR  
BZ  
PM  
EA  
ER  
EP  
EW  
RA  
RR  
WG  
FP  
AC  
FT  
LA  
LT  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
PW  
RF  
SM  
SP  
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
SV  
TR  
UL  
WU  
SD  
AD  
SS  
SA  
FI  
FN  
LB  
DT  
LO  
DI  
DR  
DV  
CP  
CF  
SI  
SR  
SL  
SB  
ES  
TD  
CO  
PG  
RP  
NP  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
Epson FX-850  
COMMAND  
SP  
BS  
CR  
LF  
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
FF  
Esc SP n  
Esc a n  
Esc $ n1 n2  
Esc \ n1 n2  
Esc <  
Esc >  
Esc #  
Esc @  
Esc CR!#R  
Esc EM n  
Esc C n  
Esc C NUL n  
Esc l n  
Esc Q n  
Esc N n  
Esc O  
Esc 2  
Esc 0  
Esc 1  
Esc A n  
Esc 3 n  
Esc J n  
Esc j n  
Esc D n1 n2 n3 ... NUL  
HT  
Esc B n1 n2 n3... NUL  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
Esc b n m1 m2 m3 ...  
NUL  
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
v
Esc / n  
VT  
Esc P  
Esc M  
Esc p n  
SI  
Esc SI  
DC2  
Esc E  
Esc F  
Esc G  
Esc H  
Esc W n  
SO  
Esc SO  
DC4  
Esc 4  
Esc 5  
Esc S n  
Esc T  
Esc w n  
Esc -n  
Esc ! n  
Esc 6  
Esc 7  
Esc l n  
Esc R n  
Esc t n  
Esc&NUL n1 n2  
Esc % n NUL  
Esc:000  
Esc * m n1 n2  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
Esc ? n m  
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc ^ a n1 n2  
Esc K n1 n2  
Esc L n1 n2  
Esc Y n1 n2  
Esc Z n1 n2  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
IBM ProPrinter XL  
COMMAND  
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
ESC  
SP  
BS  
CR  
LF  
FF  
Esc 5 n  
DC1  
Esc Q 22  
Esc Q 3  
Esc CR ! #R  
Esc EM n  
Esc C n  
Esc C NUL n  
Esc X m n  
Esc N n  
Esc O  
Esc 0  
Esc 1  
Esc A n  
Esc 2  
Esc 3 n  
Esc J n  
Esc D n1 n2 n3 ... NUL  
Esc B n1 n2 n3 ... NUL  
HT  
VT  
Esc R  
Esc 7  
Esc 6  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
DC2  
Esc :  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
Esc P n  
SI  
Esc E  
Esc F  
SO  
DC4  
CAN  
Esc W n  
Esc S n  
Esc T  
Esc - n  
Esc _ n  
Esc [ @ n1n2n3n4n5n6  
Esc \ n1 n2  
Esc ^  
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Esc I n  
Esc = n1 n2 20 n3  
Esc K n1 n2  
Esc L n1 n2  
Esc Y n1 n2  
Esc Z n1 n2  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
BAR CODE  
COMMAND  
CODE 39  
Interleaved 2 of 5  
FIM(US-Post Net)  
Post Net  
HL-1050/1070/1250/1270N/1450/1470N/P2500/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/1650/1670N/3260N/2460  
v
v
v
v
v
EAN8,EAN13,  
UPC A  
UPC E  
Codabar  
UPS Code128  
set A  
v
v
v
UPS Code128  
set B  
UPS Code128  
set C  
v
v
ISBN(EAN)  
ISBN(UPC-E)  
EAN128 set A  
EAN 128 set B  
EAN 128 set C  
v
v
v
v
v
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
HP-GL  
COMMAND  
HL-1050 HL-1070  
HL-  
1250/  
1450  
HL-  
1270N/  
1470N  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-2060  
HL-  
2400C/  
Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-2460  
DF  
IN  
IP  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
SC  
IW  
RO  
PG  
PU  
PD  
PA  
PR  
AA  
AR  
CI  
EA  
ER  
EW  
RA  
RR  
WG  
FT  
LT  
PW  
SM  
SP  
TL  
XT  
YT  
PT  
CS  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-1050 HL-1070  
HL-  
1250/  
1450  
HL-  
1270N/  
1470N  
HL-  
P2500  
HL-  
1660e  
HL-2060  
HL-  
2400C/  
Ce  
HL-  
3400CN  
HL-  
1650/  
1670N  
HL-  
3260N  
HL-2460  
CA  
SS  
SA  
DT  
LB  
DI  
DR  
CP  
SI  
SR  
SL  
UC  
DC  
DP  
EX  
IM  
QA  
QC  
QD  
QE  
QF  
QH  
QI  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
QQ  
QP  
QS  
QW  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
PJL  
PJL commands are supported by HL-1050, HL-1070, HL-1250, HL-1270N/1450/1470N, HL-P2500, HL-1660e, HL-2060, HL-2400C, HL-2400Ce, HL-3400CN,  
HL-1650, HL-1670N, HL-3260N and HL-2460. Other our printers does not support PJL.  
COMMAND  
HL-1050  
HL-1070  
HL-  
HL-  
HL-P2500 HL-1660e  
HL-2060  
HL-  
2400C/Ce/,  
3400CN  
v
HL-1650/ HL-3260N HL-2460  
1670N  
1250/1450 1270N/1470  
N
Esc%-  
123245X  
PJL ENTER  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
LANGUAGE PCL, IBM, PCL, IBM, PCL, IBM, PCL, IBM,  
= personality EPSON EPSON, EPSON EPSON  
PCLXL POSTSCRIP PCLXL PCLXLPOS  
PCL  
PCL, PCLXL, POSTSCRIPT, IBM,  
EPSON, HPGL  
PCL, PCLXL, POSTSCRIPT, IBM,  
EPSON  
T
TSCRIPT  
PCLXL  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
@PJL  
v
v
v
EXECUTE  
operation  
SHUTDOWN, DEMOPAGE, RESIFONT, PERMFONT, PRTCONFIG, TESTPRINT  
DEMOPAG  
E,  
TESTPRINT  
, RESIFONT,  
PERMFONT  
,
TESTPRINT  
, RESIFONT,  
PERMFONT  
,
PRTCONFI  
G,  
PRTCONFI  
G,  
BRNETDEF  
AULT,  
LAMINATE,  
ROTATERO  
LLER,  
BRNETDEF  
AULT,  
BRNETINIT  
,
ENTBRNET  
TEST,  
EXITBRNE  
TTEST,  
NVCLR  
BRNETINIT  
,
ENTBRNET  
TEST,  
EXITBRNE  
TTEST,  
ITEM,  
SERVICEIN  
IT  
@PJL  
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
COMMENT  
remarks  
[<CR>]<LF>  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
COMMAND  
HL-1050  
HL-1070  
HL-  
1250/1450  
HL-1270N/ HL-P2500 HL-1660e, HL-2060  
1470N  
HL-  
2400C/Ce/,  
HL-1650/ HL-3260N HL-2460  
1670N  
3400CN  
@PJL JOB  
[NAME =  
"job name"]  
[START =  
first page]  
[END = last  
page]  
v
[NAME = "job name"] [START = first page] [END = last page] [PASSWORD = "password"] [<CR>]<LF>  
[PASSWOR  
D =  
"password"]  
[<CR>] <LF>  
@PJL EOJ  
[NAME =  
"job name"]  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL  
v
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
DEFAULT  
[LPARM :  
personality]  
variable =  
value  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL  
v
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
INITIALIZE  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL  
RESET  
[<CR>]<LF>  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
@PJL SET  
[LPARM :  
personality]  
variable =  
value  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL  
v
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
INQUIRE  
[LPARM :  
personality]  
variable  
[<CR>]<LF>  
COMMAND  
HL-1050  
v
HL-1070  
<…  
HL-  
1250/1450  
HL-1270N/ HL-P2500 HL-1660e, HL-2060  
1470N  
HL-  
2400C/Ce/,  
3400CN  
<…  
HL-1650/ HL-3260N HL-2460  
1670N  
@PJL  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
DINQUIRE  
[LPARM :  
personality]  
variable  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL ECHO  
[<words>][<C  
R>]<LF>  
@PJL INFO  
ID  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL INFO  
CONFIG  
v
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
v
feature,  
value,  
[<CR>]<LF>  
information,  
returned  
option,  
attribute  
v
@PJL INFO  
MEMORY  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
[<CR>]<LF>  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
@PJL INFO  
STATUS  
v
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL INFO  
VARIABLES  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL INFO  
USTATUS  
<…  
<…  
v
DEVICE,  
[<CR>]<LF> JOB, PAGE,  
TIMED  
@PJL INFO  
PAGECOUN  
T
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL INFO  
PHYSICAL  
MEMORY  
[<CR>]<LF>  
COMMAND  
v
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
HL-1050  
HL-1070  
<…  
HL-  
1250/1450  
HL-1270N/ HL-P2500 HL-1660e, HL-2060  
1470N  
HL-  
2400C/Ce/,  
3400CN  
<…  
HL-1650/ HL-3260N HL-2460  
1670N  
@PJL INFO  
FEATURES  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL INFO  
DRUMLIFE  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL  
v
v
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
v
USTATUS  
variable =  
value  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL  
DEVICE,  
JOB, PAGE,  
TIMED  
v
DEVICE,  
JOB, PAGE  
DEVICE, JOB, PAGE, TIMED  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
USTATUSO  
FF  
[<CR>]<LF>  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
@PJL  
v
v
v
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
<…  
RDYMSG  
DISPLAY =  
"message"  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL  
OPMSG  
DISPLAY =  
"message"  
[<CR>]<LF>  
@PJL  
STMSG  
DISPLAY =  
"message"  
[<CR>]<LF>  
*1 This option is available only when the optional BR-Script 2 ROM Board is installed into the printer.  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
General PJL Environment Variables  
GENERAL PJL  
ENVIRONME  
NT  
HL-1050  
HL-1070  
HL-1250/  
1270N/1450/  
1470N  
HL-P2500  
HL-1660e/  
2060  
HL-  
2400C/Ce  
HL-3400CN HL-1650/  
1670N  
HL-3260N  
HL-2460  
VARIABLES  
COPIES  
PAPER  
1~200  
LETTER,  
1~200  
LETTER,  
1~999  
LETTER,  
1~999  
LETTER,  
1~999  
LETTER,  
1~999  
LETTER,  
1~999  
LETTER,  
1~999  
LETTER,  
1~999  
LETTER,  
LEGAL,  
1~999  
LETTER,  
LEGAL,  
LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4,  
EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXICUTIVE, EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE  
, COM10,  
, COM10,  
, COM10,  
, COM10,  
, COM10,  
, COM10,  
DL, B5  
B5, JISB5,  
LEDGER, C5, COM10,  
A3, JISB4, DL,  
A3PLUS, MONARCH,  
COM10, DL, A5, A6, B6 MONARCH, MONARCH,  
, B5, JISB5, , A3, A4, B5, , A4, JISB5,  
A5, A6, B5, A5, B6,  
COM10, C5, A6, DOM10,  
DL, DL,  
MONARCH, MONARCH, MONARCH, MONARCH, MONARCH,  
C5, DL, B5, C5, DL, B5, C5, DL, B5, C5, DL, B5, C5, DL, B5,  
JIS B5, A4  
LONG  
JIS B5, A4  
LONG  
JIS B5, A4  
LONG  
JIS B5, A4  
LONG  
A5, A6, B6  
A5, A6  
A5, A6  
LTRS, A4S  
LEDGER,  
JISB4, LTRS,  
A4S,  
C5, A4  
LONG  
EXECUTIVE  
S, B5S  
ORIENTATIO PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT,  
N
LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP  
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
FORMLINES  
MANUALFEE  
D
5~128  
ON, OFF  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
HRC  
LIGHT,  
LIGHT,  
LIGHT,  
MEDIUM,  
MEDIUM,  
MEDIUM,  
DARK, OFF DARK, OFF DARK, OFF  
PAGEPROTEC AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF, AUTO, OFF,  
LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER, LETTER,  
T
LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4 LEGAL, A4  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
RESOLUTION  
300, 600  
300, 600  
300, 600,1200  
300, 600  
PCL  
300, 600  
(HL-1660e)  
300, 600,  
1200 (HL-  
2060)  
300, 600  
300, 600  
300, 600,  
1200  
300, 600  
300, 600,  
1200  
PERSONALIT AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL,  
Y
AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL, AUTO, PCL,  
POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP POSTSCRIP  
IBM, EPSON  
IBM,  
EPSON,  
POSTSCRIP  
T
IBM, EPSON  
T, IBM,  
EPSON,  
HPGL  
T, IBM,  
EPSON,  
HPGL  
T, IBM,  
EPSON,  
HPGL  
T, IBM  
EPSON  
T, IBM,  
EPSON,  
HPGL  
T, IBM,  
EPSON,  
HPGL  
TIMEOUT  
INTRAY1  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
1~99  
LOCKED,  
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED  
LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED,  
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED  
LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED, LOCKED,  
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED UNLOCKED  
LOCKED, LOCKED,  
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED  
LOCKED, LOCKED,  
UNLOCKED UNLOCKED  
ON, OFF ON, OFF  
INTRAY2  
INTRAY3  
INTRAY4  
INTRAY5  
AUTOCONT  
LOWTONER  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
CONTINUE, CONTINUE, CONTINUE,  
STOP STOP STOP  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
INTRAY1SIZE  
LETTER,  
LETTER,  
LETTER,  
LETTER,  
LEGAL,  
EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE  
LETTER,  
LEGAL,  
LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4, LEGAL, A4,  
EXECUTIVE EXECUTIVE EXICUTIVE,  
, COM10,  
MONARCH,  
C5, DL, B5,  
A5, A6, B6  
, COM10,  
DL, B5  
B5, JIS B5,  
LEDGER,  
A3, JIS B4,  
A3PLUS,  
COM10, DL,  
LTRS, A4S  
, A3, A4, B5, , A4, JISB5,  
A5, A6,  
COM10, C5, A6, COM10,  
DL, DL,  
MONARCH, MONARCH,  
B5, A5, B6,  
LEDGER,  
JISB4, LTRS,  
A4S,  
C5, A4  
LONG,  
CUSTOM  
EXECUTIVE  
S, B5S  
INTRAY2SIZE  
.
.
.
.
A4 LETTER,  
B5  
EXECUTIVE  
,
ENVELOPE  
S, LEGAL  
A5, B6, A6,  
A4 LONG,  
NO  
CASSETTE  
INTRAY3SIZE  
INTRAY4SIZE  
INTRAY5SIZE  
SOURCETRA  
Y
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
AUTO,  
AUTO,  
AUTO,  
MP TRAY, MP TRAY, MP TRAY,  
TRAY1,  
TRAY2  
TRAY1,  
TRAY2,  
TRAY3,  
TRAY4  
TRAY1,  
TRAY2,  
TRAY3,  
TRAY4,  
TRAYID1,  
TRAYID2,  
TRAYID3,  
TRAYID4  
OFF, ON  
ECONOMODE  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
OFF, ON  
OFF, ON  
OFF, ON  
OFF, ON  
OFF, ON  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
ECONOLEVE  
L
0~3  
0~3  
0~3  
0~3  
0~3  
0~3  
0~3  
0~3  
0~3  
0~3  
XOFFSET  
YOFFSET  
TIMEOUTEM  
U
-500~500  
-500~500  
1~99  
-500~500  
-500~500  
1~99  
-500~500  
-500~500  
1~99  
-500~500  
-500~500  
-500~500  
-500~500  
1~99  
-500~500  
-500~500  
1~99  
-500~500  
-500~500  
1~99  
-500~500  
-500~500  
1~99  
-104~500  
-500~500  
1~99  
-500~500  
-500~500  
1~99  
PRIORITY  
AUTOFF  
TIMEOUTFF  
CDCCHIGH  
DTRCTRL  
XOFFTIMING  
SEL  
EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM  
EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM EPSON, IBM  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
0~3  
ON, OFF  
0~3  
ON, OFF  
0~3  
0, 1, 2, 3  
0, 1, 2, 3  
0, 1, 2, 3  
(HL-1250  
only)  
AUTOSLEEP  
TIMEOUTSLE  
EP  
ON, OFF  
1 ~99  
ON, OFF  
1 ~99  
ON, OFF  
1 ~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
ON, OFF  
1~240  
ON, OFF  
1~99  
1 ~99  
IBMCHARA1  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
ON, OFF  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
ON, OFF  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
ON, OFF  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
ON, OFF  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
ON, OFF  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
ON, OFF  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
BETA,  
ESSZET  
ON, OFF  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
DEMOPRINT  
LANG  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
ENGLISH,  
FRENCH,  
GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN, GERMAN,  
DUTCH,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
FINNISH,  
DUTCH,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
FINNISH,  
DUTCH,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
FINNISH,  
DUTCH,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
FINNISH,  
DUTCH,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
FINNISH,  
DUTCH,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
FINNISH,  
DUTCH,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
DUTCH,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
DUTCH,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
DUTCH,,  
SPANISH,  
ITALIAN,  
FINNISH, NORWEGIA DANISH NORWEGIA  
NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA NORWEGIA  
N,  
N, DANISH,  
N, N, N, N, N, N, N,  
SWEDISH,  
SWEDISH  
PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE PORTUGUE DANISH,  
SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH SE, DANISH JAPANESE  
SWEDISH  
CANADA,U  
SA  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
KEEPPCL  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
(HL-1270N  
only)  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
DOUBLESTRI  
KE  
DUPLEX  
BINDING  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
LONGEDGE,  
SHORTEDG  
E
LONGEDGE, LONGEDGE LONGEDGE LONGEDGE  
SHORTEDG  
E
FIRSTPRINT  
DENSITY  
NORMAL, NORMAL, NORMAL,  
NORMAL  
MIDDLE,  
HIGH  
MIDDLE,  
HIGH  
MIDDLE,  
HIGH  
1~15  
1~15  
1~15  
-6, -5, -4, -3, - -2, -1, 0, 1, 2 -2, -1, 0, 1, 2  
2, -1, 0, 1, 2,  
3, 4, 5, 6  
CPLOCK  
PASSWORD  
MPTRAY  
ON, OFF  
0~65535  
CASSETTE,  
FIRST  
ON, OFF  
0~65535  
ON, OFF  
0~65535  
ON, OFF  
0~65535  
ON, OFF  
0~65535  
ON, OFF  
0~65535  
0~65535  
0~65535  
0~65535  
0~65535  
CASSETTE CASSETTE CASSETTE  
MEDIATYPE  
REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR, REGULAR,  
THICK,  
THICK2,  
THICK,  
THICK2,  
THIN,  
THICK,  
THIN,  
THICK,  
THICK2,  
THICK,  
THICK,  
THICK,  
THICK,  
THICK,  
THICK,  
TRANSPAR TRANSPAR TRANSPAR THICK2, TRANSPAR THICK2,  
TRANSPAR TRANSPAR THICK2,  
ENCY  
ENCY  
ENCY  
TRANSPAR  
ENCY,  
ENCY  
TRANSPAR  
ENCY,  
ENVELOPE  
S, BOND  
ENCY ENCY  
TRANSPAR TRANSPAR  
ENCY ENCY  
THIN,  
BOND  
*2 This option is available only when the optional BR-Script 2 ROM Board is installed into the printer.  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
PCL Specific Variables  
PCL SPECIFIC VARIABLES HL-1050, HL-1070, HL-1250,  
HL-1660e, HL-2060, HL-  
2400C/Ce, HL-3400CN  
HL-1650/1670N  
HL-3260N, HL-2460  
HL-1270N/1450/1470N, HL-  
P2500  
FONTSOURCE  
FONTNUMBER  
PITCH  
PTSIZE  
SYMSET  
I, S  
0,1,2, ...n  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2,  
I, C, C1, S  
0,1,2, ...n  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2,  
I, S  
0-0x7FFFFFF  
I, C1, C2, S  
0-0x7FFFFFF  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852, PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC852,  
PC8TK, PC1004, WINL1, PC8TK, PC1004, WINL1,  
WINL2, WINL5, WINBALT, WINL2, WONL5, WINBALT,  
ISOL5, ISOL6, PC8, PC8DN, ISOL5, ISOL6, PC8, PC8DN,  
PC850, PC852, PC8TK,  
PC775, PC1004, WINL1,  
WINL2, WINL5, WINBALT, WINL2, WINL5, WINBALT, VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL,  
DESKTOP, PSTEXT,  
VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL,  
MATH8, PSMATH,  
PC850, PC852, PC8TK,  
PC775, PC1004, WINL1,  
DESKTOP, PSTEXT,  
DESKTOP, PSTEXT,  
VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL,  
MATH8, PASMATH,  
DESKTOP, PSTEXT,  
MATH8, PSMATH,  
VNINTL, VNUS, MSPUBL, VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL, VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL,  
MATH8, PSMATH,  
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,  
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,  
ISO11, ISO14, ISO15, ISO16,  
ISO17, ISO21, ISO25, ISO57,  
ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84,  
ISO85, WIN30, HPGERM,  
HPSPAN, MCTEXT,  
VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL, VNMATH, PIFONT, LEGAL, ISO11, ISO14, ISO15, ISO16,  
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,  
ISO11, ISO14, ISO15, ISO16,  
ISO17, ISO21, ISO25,ISO57,  
ISO2, ISO4, ISO6, ISO10,  
ISO11, ISO14, ISO15, ISO16,  
ISO17, ISO21, ISO25,ISO57,  
ISO17, ISO21, ISO25, ISO57,  
ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84,  
ISO85, WIN30, HPGERM,  
HPSPAN, MCTEXT,  
ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84, ISO60, ISO61, ISO69, ISO84,  
ISO85, WIN30, HPGERM,  
HPSPAN, MCTEXT  
SYMBOL  
ISO85, WIN30, HPGERM,  
HPSPAN, MCTEXT  
SYMBOL, OCRA, OCRB,  
WDINGS, HEBREW7,  
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2,  
ISOL5, ISOL6, PC775  
ROMAN8, ISOL1, ISOL2,  
ISOL5, ISOL6, PC775  
OCRA,OCRB  
WDINGS  
HEBREW7  
LEFTMARGIN  
RIGHTMARGIN  
TOPMARGIN  
BOTMARGIN  
FORMLINES  
AUTOLF  
0 ~145columns  
10 ~155 columns  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
5~128  
0 ~126 columns  
10 ~136 columns  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
5~128  
0 ~145 columns  
10 ~155 columns  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
5~128  
0 ~126 columns  
10 ~136 columns  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0 inch  
5~128  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
AUTOCR  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
AUTOWRAP  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
AUTOSKIP  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
PostScript Specific Variables  
POSTSCRIPT  
SPECIFIC  
HL-1050  
HL-1070  
HL-1250/1450  
HL-  
HL-P2500  
HL-1660e,  
HL-  
HL-3260  
ON, OFF  
HL-2460  
ON, OFF  
1270N/1470N  
1650/1670N  
HL-2060,  
HL-2400C/Ce,  
HL-3400CN  
VARIABLES  
PRTPSERRS  
ORIENTATION  
ON, OFF  
PORTRAIT,  
LANDSCAP  
E
ON, OFF  
PORTRAIT,  
LANDSCAP  
E
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT, PORTRAIT,  
LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP LANDSCAP  
E
E
E
E
CRLFCONV  
APPLETALKPS  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
EPSON Specific Variables  
EPSON SPECIFIC  
VARIABLES  
HL-1050, HL-1070,  
HL-1250, HL-  
HL-P2500  
HL-1660e, HL-2060,  
HL-2400C/Ce,  
HL-3400CN  
HL-1650/1670N  
HL-2460  
HL-3260N  
1270N/1450/1470N  
ORIENTAION  
PORTRAIT  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~145  
PORTRAIT  
LANDSCAPE  
PORTRAIT  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~126 columns  
PORTRAIT  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~145 columns  
PORTRAIT  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~126 columns  
PORTRAIT  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~126 columns  
LEFTMARGIN  
RIGHTMARGIN  
TOPMARGIN  
BOTMARGIN  
columns  
10 ~155  
columns  
10 ~136 columns  
10 ~155  
columns  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
10 ~136 columns  
10 ~136 columns  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
FORMLINES  
FONTNUMBER  
PITCH  
PTSIZE  
SYMSET  
5~128  
0,1,2, ...n  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
USASCII, GERMAN,  
UKASCI1,  
5~128  
0,1,2, ...n  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
5~128  
5~128  
5~128  
0-0x7FFFFFFF  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
0-0x7FFFFFFF  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
0-0x7FFFFFFF  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
USASCII, GERMAN, USASCII, GERMAN, USASCII, GERMAN, USASCII, GERMAN,  
UKASCI1,  
FRENCH1,  
UKASCII1,  
FRENCH1,  
UKASCII1,  
FRENCH1,  
UKASCII1,  
FRENCH1,  
FRENCH1,  
DANISH1, ITALY,  
SPANISH,  
DANISH1, ITALY,  
SPANISH,  
DANISH1, ITALY,  
SPANISH,  
DANISH1, ITALY,  
SPANISH,  
DANISH1, ITALY,  
SPANISH,  
SWEDISH, JAPAN,  
SWEDISH, JAPAN,  
SWEDISH,  
SWEDISH,  
SWEDISHM,  
NORWEG,  
NORWEG,  
JAPANESE,  
NORWEGIAN,  
DANISH2,  
JAPANESE,  
NORWEGIAN,  
DANISH2,  
JAPANESE,  
NORWEGIAN,  
DANISH2,  
DANISH2, UKASCI2,  
FRENCH2, DUTCH,  
SAFRICA, PC8,  
PC8DN, PC850,  
PC852, PC860, PC863,  
PC865, PC8TK  
DANISH2, UKASCI2,  
FRENCH2, DUTCH,  
SAFRICA, PC8,  
PC8DN, PC850,  
UKASCII2,  
FRENCH2, DUTCH, FRENCH2, DUTCH,  
SOUTHAFRICAN,  
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850,  
PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863,  
UKASCII2,  
UKASCII2, FENCH2,  
DUTCH,  
SOUTHAFRICAN,  
PC852, PC860, PC863, SOUTHAFRICAN,  
PC865, PC8TK  
PC865, PC8TK  
ON, OFF  
PC865, PC8TK  
ON, OFF  
PC865, PC8TK  
ON, OFF  
AUTOLF  
AUTOMASK  
SELREADOUT  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10/5/2001  
IBM Specific Variables  
IBM SPECIFIC  
VARIABLES  
HL-1050, HL-1070,  
HL-1250, HL-  
1270N/1450/1470N  
HL-P2500  
HL-1660C, HL-2060,  
HL-2400C/Ce, HL-  
3400CN  
HL-1650/1670N  
HL-3260N  
HL-2460  
ORIENTATION  
PORTRAIT,  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~145 columns  
10 ~155  
PORTRAIT,  
PORTRAIT,  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~145 columns  
10 ~155  
PORTRAIT,  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~126 columns  
10 ~136 columns  
PORTRAIT,  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~126 columns  
10 ~136 columns  
LANDSCAPE  
0 ~126 columns  
10 ~136 columns  
LEFTMARGIN  
RIGHTMARGIN  
columns  
columns  
TOPMARGIN  
BOTMARGIN  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
0, 0.33, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5,  
2.0 inch  
FORMLINES  
FONTNUMBER  
PITCH  
PTSIZE  
SYMSET  
5~128  
0,1,2, ...n  
5~128  
0,1,2, ...n  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
5~128  
5~128  
5~128  
0-0x7FFFFFFF  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
0-0x7FFFFFFF  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
0-0x7FFFFFFF  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
0.44, 0.45 ~ 99.99  
4.00, 4.25 ~ 999.75  
PC8, PC8DN, PC850,  
PC852, PC860, PC863,  
PC865, PC8TK  
ON, OFF  
PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850, PC8, PC8DN, PC850,  
PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863, PC852, PC860, PC863,  
PC865, PC8TK  
ON, OFF  
PC865, PC8TK  
ON, OFF  
PC865  
PC865, PC8TK  
ON, OFF  
AUTOLF  
AUTOCR  
AUTOMASK  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
ON, OFF  
APPENDIX A -COMPARISON LIST-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
APPENDIX B  
FLASH/PCMCIA  
CARD COMMANDS  
<For HL-1 2 7 0 N/ 1 4 7 0 N/ 1 6 6 0 e/ 2 0 6 0 / 2 4 0 0 C/ 2 4 0 0 Ce/ 3 4 0 0 CN  
/ 1 6 5 0 / 1 6 7 0 N/ 2 4 6 0 / 3 2 6 0 N On ly>  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. INTRODUCTION ..........................................................................................................................3  
2. HOW TO READ THE CARD COMMANDS SPECIFICATION..............................................4  
2.1 Commands................................................................................................................................ 4  
2.2 Available Devices ...................................................................................................................... 4  
2.3 Description ................................................................................................................................ 4  
2.4 Error........................................................................................................................................... 4  
3. COMMANDS .................................................................................................................................5  
3.1 Select Storage Dvice Command  
(For HL-2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/3260N Only)......................................................... 5  
3.2 Format Command..................................................................................................................... 6  
3.2.1 Physical format........................................................................................................................6  
3.2.2 Logical format ..........................................................................................................................6  
3.3 Save Data Command................................................................................................................ 7  
3.3.1 Save specified type ..................................................................................................................7  
3.4 Data........................................................................................................................................... 8  
3.4.1 Save data................................................................................................................................8  
3.4.2 Execute data...........................................................................................................................8  
3.5 Font............................................................................................................................................ 9  
3.5.1 Save primary font .....................................................................................................................9  
3.5.2 Save secondary font .................................................................................................................9  
3.5.3 Delete all download fonts ........................................................................................................10  
3.5.4 Delete download font with specified ID......................................................................................10  
3.5.5 Save download font with specified ID........................................................................................11  
3.6 Macro....................................................................................................................................... 12  
3.6.1 Delete all macros ...................................................................................................................12  
3.6.2 Delete macro with specified ID.................................................................................................12  
3.6.3 Save macro with specified ID...................................................................................................13  
3.6.4 Save image (Fixed printing location) (For HL-1270N/1470N/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN only)  
.....................................................................................................................................................13  
3.6.5 Save image (Printing location not fixed) (For HL-1270N/1470N/1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN  
only)..............................................................................................................................................14  
3.7 Copy Card (For HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/3260N Only)........................ 15  
4. USE CARD COMMANDS FROM PCL...................................................................................16  
4.1 Execute Macros....................................................................................................................... 16  
4.2 Use Download Fonts............................................................................................................... 17  
5. USE CARD COMMANDS FROM POSTSCRIPT .................................................................18  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
INTRODUCTION  
The Flash/Card Commands described in this chapter are applicable to the HL-1270N / 1470N / 1660e / 2060  
/ 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN / 1650 / 1670N / 2460 / 3260N printers only. The following types of devices can  
be used for the printers;  
1) Flash memory card (HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN)  
2) ATA flash memory card (HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN / 2460 / 3260N)  
3) Internal flash memory (HL-1270N / 1470N / 1650 / 1670N)  
4) Internal HDD (HL-2400Ce / 3400CN / 2460 / 3260N)  
Both command and control panel operations allow you to read / write data onto these devices. The  
PostScript emulation recognizes device types 2), 3)and 4) as a hard disk and the PostScript file operator  
allows you to read / write data on these devices.  
For the HL-1270N / 1470N / 1650 / 1670N printer, please note that the part of the internal printer flash  
memory can be used as though it was a HDD.  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
HOW TO READ THE CARD COMMANDS SPECIFICATION  
Each command is described in the following four sections of this manual.  
2.1  
Commands  
Command data sequences and syntax.  
ESC or CR stands for 0x1b or 0x0d as follows;  
ESC ----0x1b  
CR ---- 0x0d  
2.2  
Available Devices  
The supported memory card devices which can be used for each command are represented in this manual  
using the abbreviations as follows.  
Abbreviation  
Device Type  
F
Flash memory card (HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN)  
ATA flash memory card  
A
(HL-1660e / 2060 / 2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN / 2460 / 3260N)  
Internal IDE HDD (HL-2400C / 2400Ce / 3400CN / 2460 / 3260N)  
Internal flash memory (HL-1650 / 1670N / 1270N / 1470N)  
H
I
2.3  
2.4  
Description  
The detailed description about each command with command structure and syntax.  
Error  
Possible errors that may occur during cards operations.  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
COMMANDS  
3.1  
Select Storage Device Command  
(For HL-2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/3260N Only)  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12358F Slot No  
** Slot No = 1  
Slot No = 2 (Slot No. 2 is not used for the HL-2460/3260N.)  
Slot No = 3 (Internal HDD)  
Default = 1  
Available Devices  
F, A, H  
Description  
The card is specified and controlled by the following commands.  
For the detailed information on specific card operation commands, refer to the following sections which  
describe each command in detail.  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12340F  
ESC CR ! 12341F  
ESC CR ! 12343F  
ESC CR ! 12344F  
ESC CR ! 12345F  
ESC CR ! 12347F  
ESC CR ! 12348F  
ESC CR ! 12349F  
ESC CR ! 12350F  
ESC * c 1028F  
ESC * c 1026F  
ESC * c 1029F  
ESC & f 1030X  
ESC & f 1036X  
ESC & f 1038X  
ESC CR ! 12357F  
Physical Format  
Logical Format  
Save Primary Font  
Save Secondary Font  
Save by Type  
Save Data  
Save Image (Fixed Printing Location)  
Execute Data  
Save Image (Infixed Printing Location)  
Delete All Download Fonts  
Delete Download Fonts of Specified ID  
Save Download Fonts of Specified ID  
Delete All Macros  
Delete Macros of Specified ID  
Save Macros of Specified ID  
Copy Card  
Default value is 1 (slot 1). The card is reset to the default value under the following circumstances:-  
1) When the printer is turned on.  
2) When the printer is reset on the control panel.  
Error  
N/A  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.2  
Format Command  
3.2.1 Physical format  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12340F  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command executes a physical format for the storage device. This will delete all existing data on the  
device.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command formats the device specified by the select  
storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command formats that device.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
3.2.2 Logical format  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12341F  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command executes a logical format.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command formats the device specified by the select  
storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command formats that device.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.3  
Save Data Command  
3.3.1 Save specified type  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12345F type(4byte) size(4byte) data...  
** type = MCRO, DATA  
Available Devices  
F, A, H  
Description  
This command saves data of the specified type with the data ID which is set with the ESC & f # Y  
(Macro ID Configuration) command.  
If there is insufficient memory in the printer to store the data, a memory full error occurs.  
When the printer supports two or more storage devices, the command saves the data onto the device  
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is enabled, the command saves  
onto that device.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
34 MEMORY FULL  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.4  
Data  
3.4.1 Save data  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12347F ID(2byte) size(4byte) data...  
Available Devices  
F, A, H  
Description  
This command saves data which is sent from the PC with the specified ID onto the device.  
If there is insufficient memory in the printer to store the data, a memory full error occurs.  
When the printer supports two or more storage devices, the command saves the data onto the device  
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is enabled, the command saves  
onto that device.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
34 MEMORY FULL  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
3.4.2 Execute data  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12349F ID(2byte)  
Available Devices  
F, A, H  
Description  
This command executes the specified ID data.  
When the printer supports two or more storage devices, the command saves the data onto the device  
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is enabled, the command saves  
onto that device.  
Error  
N/A  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.5  
Font  
3.5.1 Save primary font  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12343F  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command saves the primary font which is currently selected into the device. The primary font can  
also be saved by control panel operation.  
The ID specified with the ESC * c # D(Font ID ) command is used for registration.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the font onto the device specified by  
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the font onto  
that device.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
3.5.2 Save secondary font  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12344F  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command saves the secondary font which is currently selected into the device. The secondary font  
can also be saved by control panel operation.  
The ID specified with the ESC * c # D(Font ID) command is used for registration.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the font onto the device specified by  
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the font onto  
that device.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.5.3 Delete all download fonts  
Command  
ESC * c 1028F  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command deletes all the download fonts which are saved in the device.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command deletes the download fonts in the device  
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command deletes  
the download fonts in that device.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
3.5.4 Delete download font with specified ID  
Command  
ESC * c 1026F  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command deletes the font with the ID which is specified with the ESC * c # D(Font ID )  
command from the device.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command deletes the download fonts in the device  
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command deletes  
the download fonts in that device.  
If any download fonts with the specified ID are not saved in the device, this command is ignored.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/34000CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.5.5 Save download font with specified ID  
Command  
ESC * c 1029F  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command saves the font with the ID which is specified with the ESC * C # D(Font ID) command.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the download fonts in the device  
specified by the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves  
the download fonts in that device.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.6  
Macro  
3.6.1 Delete all macros  
Command  
ESC & f 1030X  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command deletes all the macros which are saved in the device.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command deletes all the macros in the device specified  
by the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command deletes all the  
macros in that device.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
3.6.2 Delete macro with specified ID  
Command  
ESC & f 1036X  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command deletes the macro with the ID which is specified with the ESC & f # Y(Macro ID  
Configuration) command from the device.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command deletes the macros in the device specified by  
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command deletes the macros  
in that device. If any macros with the specified ID are not saved in the device, the command is ignored.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.6.3 Save macro with specified ID  
Command  
ESC & f 1038X  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
This command saves a macro with the ID which is specified with the ESC & f # Y(Macro ID  
Configuration) command on the device.  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the macros on the device specified by  
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the macros on  
that device.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
HL-2460/3260N:  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
HL-1650/1670N:  
43 SERVICE E74  
3.6.4  
Save image (Fixed printing location)  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12348F  
Available Devices  
F
Description  
After transferring the last print data into the image data area, this command saves the data with the ID  
which is specified with the ESC & f # Y(Macro ID Configuration) command as a PCL command on the  
device.  
The printing location for the saved data is fixed on the page.  
The data can be executed by the data execute command (ESC CR ! 12349 F).  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the data on the device specified with  
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the data on  
that device.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.6.5  
Save image (Printing location not fixed)  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12350F  
Available Device  
F
Description  
After transferring the last print data into the image data area, this command saves the data with the ID  
which is specified with the ESC & f # Y(Macro ID Configuration) command as a PCL command on the  
device.  
The printing location for the saved data is not fixed on the page.  
The move cursor command allows you to print the data anywhere you want when executing this command.  
The data can be executed by the data execute command (ESC CR ! 12349 F).  
When two devices are installed into the printer, the command saves the data on the device specified with  
the select storage device command. When only one device is installed, the command saves the data on  
that device.  
This command is only valid in PCL emulation.  
Error  
HL-1660e/2060/2400C:  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
HL-2400Ce/3400CN:  
43 DEVICE1 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE2 W ERROR  
43 DEVICE3 W ERROR  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.7  
Copy Card (For HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/3260N Only)  
Command  
ESC CR ! 12357F  
Available Devices  
F, A  
Description  
1) Flash memory card  
After executing a logical format on the transfer device, this command copies to the transfer device only  
when the two devices have the same memory size. It is essential that the transfer device has already been  
formatted.  
The specify device command allows you to specify the source device.  
Specified Device  
Copy Order  
Slot 2 ® Slot 1  
Slot 1 ® Slot 2  
1
2
** “Slot 2 ® Slot 1” is the default setting.  
2) ATA flash memory card  
After executing a logical format on the transfer device, this command copies to the transfer device file by  
file from the master device.  
If the memory runs short in the transfer device during the data transfer, the copy process is discontinued.  
Data written to the transfer device before the error is valid in the device.  
The specify device command allows you to specify the source device.  
Specified Device  
Copy Order  
Slot 2 ® Slot 1  
Slot 1 ® Slot 2  
1
2
** “Slot 2 ® Slot 1” is the default setting.  
Error  
43 CARD1 W ERROR  
43 CARD2 W ERROR  
(HL-2460 / 3260N)  
Specified Device  
Copy Order  
1
Internal HDD ® Slot 1  
Slot 1 ® Internal HDD  
2,3  
Note that this command cannot copy the spool data.  
Error  
43 CARD ERROR  
43 HDD ERROR  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
USE CARD COMMANDS FROM PCL  
4.1  
Execute Macros  
Command  
ESC & l 2 X  
ESC & l 3 X  
ESC & l 4 X  
Execute Macro  
Call Macro  
Macro Overlay  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
The macros saved in the device can be executed from the PCL command language as well as saving  
macros in the printer memory.  
The priority for searching is as follows;  
1. Macro in printer memory  
2. Macro in Card 1  
3. Macro in Card 2  
4. Macro in Internal HDD  
The above priority is never affected by the select storage device command (ESC CR ! 12358F).  
Error  
N/A  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.2  
Use Download Fonts  
Command  
ESC ( # X  
ESC ) # X  
Designates soft font # as Primary  
Designates soft font # as Secondary  
** # = font ID number  
Available Devices  
F, A, H, I  
Description  
The download fonts saved in the device can be selected from the PCL command language as well as  
saving download fonts in printer memory.  
The priority for searching is as follows;  
1. Macro in printer memory  
2. Macro in Card 1  
3. Macro in Card 2  
4. Macro in Internal HDD  
The above priority is never affected by the select storage device command (ESC CR ! 12358F).  
The download fonts can be also selected from the font select command in PCL.  
Error  
N/A  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/ PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
5.  
USE CARD COMMANDS FROM POSTSCRIPT  
The PostScript emulation recognizes the storage device as a hard disk (except a Flash memory card) and  
the PostScript file operation allows you to read/write data on these devices.  
(i.e.)  
Create the file named “test” and write the data, “This is a data string” onto the device which is inserted  
into Slot 1.  
/fl (%disk0%test)(w)file def  
fl (This is a data string) write  
fl closefile  
For PostScript, the following command should be used to specify the hard disk which is to be used;  
(%disk#%)  
** # = number  
The above number corresponds to the slots of the HL-1660e/2060/2400C/2400Ce/3400CN/2460/2460N  
printer as follows;  
Slot 1:  
Slot 2:  
(%disk0%)  
(%disk1%)  
Internal HDD: (%disk2%)  
APPENDIX B - FLASH/PCMCIA CARD COMMANDS - 18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
APPENDIX C  
HBP MODE  
COMMANDS  
<For HL-8 2 0 / 1 0 2 0 / 1 0 4 0 On ly>  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. DESCRIPTIONS.....................................................................................................................................3  
2. COMMAND TO ENTER HBP MODE..................................................................................................4  
3. HBP COMMANDS .................................................................................................................................5  
3.1 Command List.....................................................................................................................................5  
3.2 Commands (Detailed Explanation).....................................................................................................6  
3.2.1 Resolution setting commands ............................................................................................................ 6  
3.2.2 Economy mode setting commands..................................................................................................... 6  
3.2.3 Sleep mode setting commands .......................................................................................................... 7  
3.2.4 Mode setting commands ................................................................................................................... 8  
3.2.5 Engine related setting commands....................................................................................................... 9  
3.2.6 Engine related execute commands..................................................................................................... 9  
3.2.7 Graphic data input commands.......................................................................................................... 10  
3.2.8 Formfeed commands....................................................................................................................... 10  
3.2.9 Exit commands .............................................................................................................................. 10  
3.3 Graphic Data Format ........................................................................................................................11  
4. RECOMMENDED COMMAND STRING......................................................................................... 13  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
DESCRIPTIONS  
The HBP mode commands can be used for the HL-820/1020/1040 printers only.  
The following commands and syntax are used in these specifications.  
Description:  
<Esc>:  
meaning or code  
0 x 1b  
<Space>: 0 x 20  
<LF>:  
*:  
0 x 0a  
1byte of data  
+:  
sign for combining data ( This is not a control code.)  
character string enclosed in parentheses means 1 data byte described in binary format  
(••••)B:  
CHR$(•): character of the value (in decimal) enclosed in parentheses  
••H:  
means hexadecimal value  
(Examples)  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<LF>  
1bH  
58H  
25H  
40H  
2dH  
50H  
31H  
4aH  
32H  
4cH  
33H  
0aH  
34H  
35H  
@L+(00000000)B  
-> 40H  
4cH  
00H  
00H  
@J+CHR$ (0) + CHR$ (1)  
- > 40H 4aH  
01H  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
COMMAND TO ENTER HBP MODE  
Command  
<ESC>%-12345X@PJL<LF>  
@PJL<Space>ENTER<Space>LANGUAGE<Space>=<Space>HBP<LF>  
Function  
The printer enters the HBP mode when this command is received.  
Explanation  
The printer can receive this command when it is in the idle condition (during HP emulation, IBM emulation, Epson  
emulation and Auto emulation for HL-1040). The printer reports an error if it receives this command when it is  
already in HBP mode. The printer enters HBP mode when it receives this command. This mode continues until  
one of following occurs.  
(1) The printer receives the Exit command.  
(2) The printer power is turned off.  
(3) InputPrime Signal is brought LOW.  
The printer executes the following HBP commands in HBP mode.  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
HBP COMMANDS  
An HBP command is composed of ‘@’ + an Uppercase Alphabetic character + parameters (not necessary for  
some commands).  
3.1  
Command List  
<Character string>  
<Functions>  
@A  
@B  
@C  
@D  
@E  
@F  
@G  
@H  
@I  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Not used  
Speed setting for Centronics I/F  
Economy mode setting  
Form feed  
Data input  
Not used  
Information request  
@J  
Settings for engine related items  
@K  
@L  
@M  
@N  
@O  
@P  
@Q  
@R  
@S  
@T  
@U  
@V  
@W  
@X  
@Y  
@Z  
Execution for engine related items  
Resolution setting  
Mode setting  
Reserved  
Not used  
Reserved  
Not used  
Reserved  
Not used  
Setting for sleep time  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Exit  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used : An error occurs in the printer if these character strings are sent as commands.  
Reserved : These commands are not necessary to create the driver. Do not use these commands.  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.2  
Commands (Detailed Explanation)  
3.2.1 Resolution setting commands  
Command  
@L + *  
Function  
This command sets the printer resolution.  
Command  
Resolution  
@ L+ (00000000)B  
@ L+ (00000101)B  
@ L+ (00001010)B  
600dpi  
300dpi  
150dpi  
(Default)  
Explanation  
The resolution is set when the printer receives this command.  
This command is applied from the next page printed after the FormFeed command after this command is sent (i.e.  
the next complete page).  
The resolution is valid until the one of the following occurs.  
(1) The printer receives the Exit command.  
(2) The printer power is turned off.  
(3) InputPrime Signal is brought LOW.  
After (1) is sent, the printer resolution is uncertain. The driver must resend this command again after the HBP  
mode switch command is sent.  
After (2) or (3), the resolution returns to default (600 dpi).  
3.2.2 Economy mode setting commands  
Command  
@E + *  
Function  
Command  
Economy Mode  
@ E+ (00000000)B  
@ E+ (00000001)B  
@ E+ (00000010)B  
@ E+ (00000011)B  
OFF  
Level 1 (Darkest)  
Level 2  
(Default)  
Level 3 (Lightest)  
Explanation  
This command is applied from the next page printed after the FormFeed command after this command is input.  
Default value is Economy Mode OFF.  
The ECONOMY MODE is valid until the one of the following occurs.  
(1) The printer receives the Exit command.  
(2) The printer power is turned off.  
(3) InputPrime Signal is brought LOW.  
After (1) is sent, the ECONOMY MODE value is uncertain. The driver must resend this command again after the  
HBP mode switch command is sent.  
After (2) or (3), the ECONOMY MODE value returns to default. (OFF)  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.2.3 Sleep mode setting commands  
Command  
@T+ *  
Function  
This command sets the sleep time in minutes.  
Explanation  
This command is valid immediately after the printer receives the command.  
The command is valid until one of the following occurs.  
(1) The printer receives the Exit command.  
(2) The printer receives a new sleep time setting command.  
(3) The printer power is turned off.  
(4) InputPrime Signal is brought LOW.  
This command sets the time from the last printer operation (printing, key pressing, motor being driven) to entering  
sleep mode.  
1 byte of binary data (0-255) after the @T command indicates the minute(s) delay to enter sleep mode. However,  
there are two exceptions. If the value is set to 0, the sleep time is set to 5 seconds. If the value is set to 255, the  
printer does not go into sleep mode.  
For the HL-1040, the command is valid during HBP mode only, it is not effective after using the @X Exit  
command.  
Note1:  
Sleep time means the time from the last operation ( Key Pressing, Data receiving, Printing) to entering sleep  
mode.  
Note2:  
HL-1040 also accepts the PJL command which sets the sleep time. The sleep time set by the PJL command is  
valid both in HBP mode and in Non-HBP modes. (PCL, EPSON or IBM emulation)  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.2.4 Mode setting commands  
Command  
@M+*  
Function  
This command allows various error mode operations to be set. 1 byte, used as 8 bits, that follows the @M  
command select the settings for each mode.  
Bit0:0 = The printer clears the input buffer when a Paper Jam error or Undefined Code error occurs. The printer  
does not recover automatically from a Print Overrun error.  
1 = The printer does not clear the input buffer when a Paper Jam error or Undefined Code error occurs.  
The printer recovers automatically 10 seconds later from a Print Overrun error.  
Bit1:  
Not used  
Bit2:0 = The printer generates an error when an undefined code is received.  
1 = The printer ignores any undefined codes.  
Bit3:  
Not used  
Bit4:0 = The printer does not ignore any illegal data which is received before entering the HBP mode. (The  
printer will ignore any illegal data until approx. 32kbyte is received, then the data after that is  
recognized as undefined code.)  
Bit5:  
Bit6:  
Bit7:  
Not used  
Not used  
Select printer error messages ON or OFF. (HL-820/1020/1040)  
The printer does not print an error message when an error occurs.  
0:  
1:  
The printer prints an error message when an error occurs. The printer resets when an error occurs  
when Bit7:1. Therefore the setting of Bit0:1 is ignored.  
This command works immediately after it is sent to the printer. The command actions apply to the data before  
printing.  
The most appropriate value is as follows;  
@M<81H>  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.2.5 Engine related setting commands  
Command  
@J+*  
Function  
This command allows the setting of engine related commands. Each setting depends on the value of the 3 byte  
command string.  
@J+CHR$ (0) +CHR$ (n): Sets Media Type  
This command allows the printer to change the temperature control for the fuser unit when printing.  
n=0:  
n=1:  
n=2:  
n=3:  
Regular (Default)  
Thick paper  
Thicker paper  
Transparency  
@J+CHR$ (1) +CHR$ (n): Sets the toner stirring time  
The value of n (0-255) sets the toner stirring time in seconds. The value 0 gives the default setting of 30 seconds  
stored in the printer, and 1- 6 is fixed at 6 seconds. Toner is stirred by the @K+CHR$ (0) command. It is not  
necessary to set it from the driver.  
@J+CHR$ (2) +CHR$ (n): Indicates Envelope mode  
n=0  
n=1  
Normal mode  
Envelope mode  
The driver sets the value to 1 if the paper length is from 180 mm to 250 mm, and the value to 0 when it is shorter  
or longer.  
@J+CHR$ (3) +CHR$ (n): Sets the envelope mode level  
The value n sets the time limit in continuous envelope printing. The default (0) is 20 seconds, which represents a  
printing speed of 3 ppm.  
When set to 0, the time limit in continuous envelope printing is set to 20 seconds.  
The printing speed is fastest if the setting is shorter than normal loading speed, such as 1 second or 2 seconds.  
It is not necessary to set it from the driver.  
3.2.6 Engine related execute commands  
Command  
@K+*  
Function  
This is an immediately executed command.  
@K+CHR$ (0):  
Execute toner stirring  
To set the toner stirring time, use the command, @J+CHR$(1)+CHR$(n).  
It is not necessary to set this command from the driver.  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.2.7 Graphic data input commands  
Command  
@G+[data length(3bytes)]+data  
Function  
The 3 bytes of data following the @G command shows the length of the data, N. The N bytes following this 3  
byte header is handled as graphic data.  
(Example)  
fprintf(fp,”@G%c%c%c”,  
(char)((data_length>>16)&0xff),  
(char)((data_length>>8)&0xff),  
(char)((data_length>>0)&0xff) );  
fwrite(data,(size_t)1,(size_t)data_length,fp);  
See section 2.3 for further details of the data format.  
The printer driver can send the printer 1 page of print data divided into sections by sending these commands  
continuously. It is recommended to send 1 page of print data without dividing into sections when the 1 page  
print data is more than the printer memory (500 Kbytes) as the printer will print this ' on the fly' and sending it in  
one block will improve the print performance.  
3.2.8 Formfeed commands  
Command  
@F  
Remark: The last raster scan on each page should be a white raster. For instance, the white raster command  
‘@G<00H><00H><01H><FFH>‘ should be sent before the @F command.  
Function  
This command sets a page break.  
The printer works as follows when it receives this command;  
(1) If 1 page of print data is less than the input buffer size in the printer, the printer recognizes the command  
as a page break and starts printing.  
(2) If 1 page of print data is more than the input buffer size in the printer, then since the printer has already  
started printing, this command is handled as a page break only.  
When it is received after printing, a Print Overrun error occurs in the printer. If Bit0 is set to 1 in the mode  
setting command (@M+*) mentioned in section 2.2.5., the printer ignores the data until it receives this  
form feed command when a Print Overrun error occurs.  
3.2.9 Exit commands  
Command  
@X  
Function  
This command exits from HBP mode  
The HL-1040 printer is restored to the default emulation mode by this command  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.3  
Graphic Data Format  
The data format, which follows the @G+ [number of data bytes (3 bytes)] command, is as shown below.  
the number of  
command bytes for  
raster 1  
command byte 1 modified data 1  
command byte 1 modified data 1  
command byte 2 modified data 2  
the number of  
command bytes for  
raster 2  
modified data 2  
modified data 3  
:
:
The number of  
command bytes for  
raster n  
command byte 1 modified data 1  
The description of each byte  
(1) the number of command bytes for raster n  
This byte describes the number of command bytes for each raster.  
In the case that the raster data is the same as the former raster, 00h is sent as the number of command bytes.  
In the case that the data is all white, FFh is sent as the number of command bytes and the data format ,  
which should follow the number of command bytes, is not necessary.  
(2) command byte  
The operation of this byte is divided into the following 2 uses.  
Data replacement  
0
b6  
b5  
b4  
b3  
b2  
b1  
b0  
b6, b5, b4, b3 the replacement position (4bits)  
b2, b1, b0  
the amount of replacement data (3bits): The input value is 1 less than the actual data count  
of the replacement data.  
When both b6, b5, b4, b3 and b2, b1, b0 are overflow, the next byte shows the replacement position and the  
byte after the next byte shows the amount of replacement data.  
Repeated data replacement  
1
b6  
b5  
b4  
b3  
b2  
b1  
b0  
b6, b5  
the replacement position (2bits)  
b4, b3, b2, b1, b0 the number of loops (5bits): The input value is 2 less than the actual number of loops.  
(Example)  
The 4th byte of data onward is replaced by the three data bytes 00h, AAh, 55h  
00100010b,00h,AAh,55h  
The 15th byte of data onward is replaced by the two data bytes 33h, 44h and the 20th data onward  
( absolute value) is replaced by the two data bytes FFh.  
01111001b,33h,44h,00100001b,FFh  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
The 5th byte data onward is replaced by the twelve data bytes AAh.  
11101010b,02h,Aah  
When the replacement position and the amount of replacement data are overflow, the next data byte  
becomes an Expansion Offset Byte. However, if the number is FFh, 00h is added.  
The number of command bytes = 300, FFh+2Dh  
The number of command bytes = 510, FFh+FFh+00h  
If there are more than two command bytes for 1 raster, the replacement position for the second command  
byte onwards is indicated by the offset byte, starting from the data position replaced by the first command  
byte.  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
4.  
RECOMMENDED COMMAND STRING  
The command strings below shows the recommended command stream for two pages of a print job.  
<Esc>%-12345X@PJL<LF>  
used for HL-820/1020/1040  
used for HL-820/1020/1040  
@PJL DEFAULT AUTOSLEEP=0<LF>  
@PJL DEFAULT TIMEOUTSLEEP= 15<LF> used for HL-820/1020/1040  
<Esc>%-12345X@PJL<LF>  
@PJL ENTER LANGUAGE = HBP<LF>  
Enter into HBP mode  
Set 600 dpi resolution  
Set economy mode off  
Set Sleep time to 15 minutes  
Set mode  
@L<00H>  
@E<00H>  
@T<0FH>  
@M<81H>  
Error Print on  
@J<00H><00H>  
@J<02H><00H>  
Set the MediaType ( normal paper)  
Thick paper : @J<00H><01H>]  
Normal Paper ( not Envelope)  
Envelope [@J<02H><01H>]  
1 page of data (1st page)  
white raster  
@G<size(3byte)><data>  
@G+ <00H><00H><01H><FFH>  
@F  
Form feed ( 1st page)  
1 page of data (2nd page)  
white raster  
@G<size(3byte)><data>  
@G+ <00H><00H><01H><FFH>  
@F  
Form feed ( 2nd page)  
Exit from HBP mode  
@X  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
APPENDIX C HBP MODE COMMANDS - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
APPENDIX D  
REFERENCE LIST OF  
MX-2000/4000/5000  
SERIES UNIQUE  
COMMANDS  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. INTRODUCTION .............................................................................................................3  
2. GENERAL SPECIFICATION ........................................................................................4  
3. COMMAND REFERENCE LIST...................................................................................5  
3.1. Commands Descriptions............................................................................................ 5  
3.1.1.  
3.1.2.  
3.1.3.  
3.1.4.  
3.1.5.  
3.1.6.  
PJL output tray & mode setting .................................................................................5  
PJL mailbox protection & bin number setting ..............................................................6  
PJL avoidance of mailbox bin full................................................................................6  
PCL output tray setting.............................................................................................7  
PS output tray & mode setting ..................................................................................7  
PS mailbox protection & bin number setting ...............................................................9  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
INTRODUCTION  
This manual covers the general specifications and the command reference list of the MX-2000 series (MX-2001 /  
MX-2002 / MX-2003), MX-4000 series (MX-4100 / MX-4200 / MX-4300) and MX-5000 Mailbox units. The MX-  
2000 series Mailbox units are optionally installed onto the HL-2060 printer, the MX-4000 series are optionally  
installed onto the HL-2460 printer, and MX-5000 series are optionally installed onto the HL-3260 printer.  
If you need further information on the mechanical system, refer to the service manual of MX-2000 series or MX-  
4000 series.  
Note:  
While the MX-2001/4100 Mailbox unit is available in all countries, the MX-2003/4200 is available in U.S.  
and Canada only, and the MX-2002/4300 is available in the other countries than U.S. and Canada.  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
2.  
GENERAL SPECIFICATION  
The Mailbox unit is an option for the HL-2060, HL-2460 or HL-3260 printer and the MX-2000/4000 series  
composed of three types of units. The MX-2001/4100 Lower Mailbox unit consists of five bins. The MX-  
2002/4200 Upper Mailbox unit is additionally installed onto the MX-2001/4100 and also consists of five bins. The  
MX-2003/4300 Mailbox unit consists of ten bins. Once you have installed the unit, it works as a stacker, sorter  
and mailbox for the printer.  
HL-2060 : MX-2001/2002/2003  
HL-2460 : MX-4001/4002/4003  
HL-3260 : MX-5000  
Function  
Stacker  
Description  
Printed paper is ejected into the multiple output bins behaving as a single  
high-capacity tray.  
Sorter  
Printed paper is ejected as a set for a print job into a bin when multiple  
sets of documents are printed and collated.  
Mailbox  
Printed paper is ejected into the bin specified as your own mail box.  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.  
COMMAND REFERENCE LIST  
This section describes the specific commands as listed below used to support the functions of the Mailbox unit.  
1) PJL output tray & mode setting  
2) PJL mailbox protection & bin number setting  
3) PJL avoidance of output bin full  
4) PCL output tray setting  
5) PS output tray & mode setting  
6) PS mailbox protection & bin number setting  
For the details on each command, refer to the following sections.  
3.1. Commands Descriptions  
3.1.1. PJL output tray & mode setting  
Format  
@PJL SET/DEFAULT OUTBIN=TrayName  
Parameter  
TrayName*  
· UPPER:  
Select the printer face-down output tray.  
Select the #1 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN1:  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN2:  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN3:  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN4:  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN5:  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN6:  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN7:  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN8:  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN9:  
· OPTIONALOUTPUTBIN10:  
· ALLSTACKER:  
Select the #2 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select the #3 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select the #4 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select the #5 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select the #6 bin of the Mailbox unit (except HL-3260)  
Select the #7 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select the #8 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select the #9 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select the #10 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select the stacker function. **  
· ALLSORTER:  
Select the sorter function. **  
* = The tray names are compatible with the HP tray naming.  
** = These are unique tray names (parameters) for the HL-2060/2460/3260.  
Default = ALLSTACKER  
Explanation  
·
This command selects the specified output tray and output mode, trays defined as Mailboxes are numbered  
from the bottom of the unit upwards  
·
·
This command is ignored when there is no specified tray.  
The ALLSTACKER and ALLSORTER parameters are executed for all output trays other than the ones which  
are defined and protected as mailboxes. (Refer to Section 3.1.2 ‘PJL mailbox protection & tray number  
setting’.)  
·
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the  
PJL specifications.  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.1.2. PJL mailbox protection & bin number setting  
Format  
@PJL SET/DEFAULT MAILBOXPROTECT=TrayNumber  
Parameter  
TrayNumber  
<HL-2060/2460>  
· Lower unit:  
#1 to 5 from bottom to top  
· Lower unit + Upper unit: #1 to 10 from bottom to top  
<HL-3260>  
#1 to 4 from bottom to top  
Default = 0  
Explanation  
·
·
·
This command sets the bins with numbers larger than the TrayNumber specified as mailbox use only. They  
cannot then be used for either stacker or sorter functions.  
If the bin number is set to 0, the mailbox protection is released, then all bins can be used for stacker and sorter  
functions.  
If the bin number is set out of the effective range, this command is ignored.  
<HL-2060/2460>  
Setting type  
Effective range  
0
· MX not installed  
· Lower unit installed  
· Lower & upper unit installed  
0, 1 ~ 5  
0, 1 ~ 10  
<HL-3260>  
Setting type  
· MX not installed  
· MX installed  
Effective range  
0
0, 1 ~ 4  
·
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the  
PJL specifications.  
3.1.3. PJL avoidance of mailbox bin full  
Command  
@PJL SET/DEFAULT AVOIDMAILBOXFULL=ON/OFF  
Parameter  
ON/OFF  
· OFF:  
· ON:  
Paper is ejected to the printer face-down output tray when the specified tray is full.  
Paper is not ejected to the printer face-down output tray even when the specified tray is full.  
Default = OFF  
Explanation  
·
·
When paper is ejected into a bin specified by a setting command which limits the bin selection, this command  
selects whether to eject automatically paper to the printer face-down output tray or not when the specified bin  
is full.  
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the  
PJL specifications.  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.1.4. PCL output tray setting  
Command  
Esc&l#G (27)(38)(108)#(71) <1Bh><38h><6ch>#<47h>  
Parameter  
# denotes the output tray.  
· 1:  
· 3:  
· 4:  
· 5:  
· 6:  
· 7:  
· 8:  
· 9:  
Select the printer face-down output tray.  
Select #1 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select #2 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select #3 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select #4 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select #5 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select #6 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select #7 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
· 10: Select #8 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
· 11: Select #9 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
· 12: Select #10 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Default = 1  
Explanation  
·
This command selects the specified output tray, trays defined as Mailboxes are numbered from the bottom of  
the unit upwards  
·
·
·
This command is ignored when the specified tray is not available.  
The PJL OUTBIN command is ignored when this command is executed.  
Refer to the Technical Reference Guide Section 4.1.2 ‘Output tray’ in Chapter 2 ‘PCL’.  
3.1.5. PS output tray & mode setting  
Command  
<HL-2060>  
# setoutputmode  
<HL-2460/3260>  
<</BROutbinMode #>> setpagedevice  
Parameter  
#
· 0:  
Select the printer face-down output tray.  
Select the stacker function.  
· 1:  
· 2:  
Select the sorter function.  
· 4~10:  
· 11:  
· 12:  
· 13:  
· 14:  
· 15  
Select the printer face-down output tray.  
Select #1 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select #2 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select #3 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select #4 bin of the Mailbox unit.  
Select #5 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select #6 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select #7 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select #8 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select #9 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
Select #10 bin of the Mailbox unit. (except HL-3260)  
· 16:  
· 17:  
· 18:  
· 19:  
· 20:  
Default = 0  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
Explanation  
·
·
·
This operator selects the specified output tray and output mode.  
This operator is ignored when no tray is specified.  
The ‘1’ and ‘2’ parameters are executed for all output trays other than ones which are defined and protected  
as mailboxes.  
<Example>  
(HL-2060)  
This operator is registered in ‘statusdict’.  
statusdict begin  
0 setoutputmode  
end  
(HL-2460/3260)  
<</BROutbinMode 0>> setpagedevice  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.1.6. PS mailbox protection & bin number setting  
Command  
<HL-2060>  
# setoutputprotect  
<HL-2460/3260>  
<</BROutbinProtect #>> setpagedevice  
Parameter  
#
<HL-2060/2460>  
· Lower unit:  
#1 to 5 from bottom to top  
· Lower unit + Upper unit: #1 to 10 from bottom to top  
<HL-3260>  
#1 to 4 from bottom to top  
Default = 0  
Explanation  
·
·
·
This operator sets the bins with numbers larger than the TrayNumber specified as mailbox use only. They  
cannot then be used for either stacker or sorter functions.  
If the bin number is set to 0, the mailbox protection is released, then all bins can be used for stacker and sorter  
functions.  
If the bin number is set out of the effective range, this operator is ignored.  
<HL-2060/2460>  
Setting type  
Effective range  
· MX not installed  
0
· Lower unit installed  
· Lower & upper unit installed  
0, 1 ~ 5  
0, 1 ~ 10  
<HL-3260>  
Setting type  
· MX not installed  
· MX installed  
Effective range  
0
0, 1 ~ 4  
<Example>  
(HL-2060)  
This operator is registered in ‘statusdict’.  
statusdict begin  
5 setoutputprotect  
end  
(HL-2460/3260)  
<</BROutbinProtect 4>> setpagedevice  
APPENDIX D REFERENCE LIST OF MX-2000/4000/5000 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
APPENDIX E  
REFERENCE LIST OF  
FS-5050 UNIQUE  
COMMANDS  
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
CONTENTS  
1. INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................3  
2. GENERAL SPECIFICATION ...........................................................................................3  
3. COMMAND REFERENCE LIST......................................................................................3  
3.1. Commands Descriptions................................................................................................ 4  
3.1.1. PJL output tray..............................................................................................................4  
3.1.2. PCL output tray .............................................................................................................4  
3.1.3. PS output tray...............................................................................................................4  
3.1.4. PJL staple on/off............................................................................................................5  
3.1.5. PS staple on/off.............................................................................................................5  
3.1.6. PJL job offset on/off........................................................................................................6  
3.1.7. PS job offset on/off.........................................................................................................6  
3.1.8. PCL job separate (Esc&l1T).........................................................................................6  
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
1.  
2.  
INTRODUCTION  
This manual covers the general specifications and the command reference list of the FS-5050 Finisher/Stapler  
units, which are optionally installed onto the HL-3260 printer.  
GENERAL SPECIFICATION  
The Finisher/Stapler unit is an option for the HL-3260 printer.  
Function  
Description  
Printed pages can be sorted or stapled.  
Finisher/  
Stapler  
3.  
COMMAND REFERENCE LIST  
This section describes the specific commands as listed below used to support the functions of the  
Finisher/Stapler unit.  
1) PJL output tray  
2) PCL output tray  
3) PS output tray  
4) PJL staple on/off  
5) PS staple on/off  
6) PJL job offset on/off  
7) PS job offset on/off  
8) PCL job separate  
For the details on each command, refer to the following sections.  
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.1. Commands Descriptions  
3.1.1. PJL output tray  
Format  
@PJL SET/DEFAULT OUTBIN=TrayName  
Parameter  
TrayName*  
· FINISHER:  
Select the tray of the Finisher/Stapler unit  
Default = ALLSTACKER  
Explanation  
·
·
·
This command selects the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.  
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the  
PJL specifications.  
3.1.2. PCL output tray  
Command  
Esc&l#G (27)(38)(108)#(71) <1Bh><38h><6ch>#<47h>  
Parameter  
# denotes the output tray.  
· 100: Select the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
Default = 1  
Explanation  
·
·
·
This command selects the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.  
The PJL OUTBIN command is ignored when this command is executed.  
3.1.3. PS output tray  
Command  
<</BROutbinMode #>>setpagedevice  
Parameter  
#
· 3:  
Select the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
Default = 0  
Explanation  
·
·
This command selects the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.  
<Examp le>  
<</BROutbinMode 3>>setpagedevice  
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.1.4. PJL staple on/off  
Format  
@PJL SET/DEFAULT STAPLE=StapleName  
Parameter  
StapleName*  
· UPPER LEFT:  
· UPPER RIGHT:  
· LOWER LEFT:  
· LOWER RIGHT:  
· OFF:  
Select the upper left of the Finisher/Stapler unit  
Select the upper right of the Finisher/Stapler unit  
Select the lower left of the Finisher/Stapler unit  
Select the lower right of the Finisher/Stapler unit  
Default = UPPER LEFT  
Explanation  
·
·
·
This command selects the staple.  
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.  
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the  
PJL specifications.  
3.1.5. PS staple on/off  
Command  
<</BRStaple #>>setpagedevice  
Parameter  
#
· 0:  
· 1:  
· 2:  
· 3:  
· 4:  
Select off of the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
Select the upper left of the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
Select the upper right of the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
Select the lower left of the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
Select the upper right of the Finisher/Stapler unit.  
Default = 0  
Explanation  
·
·
This command selects the staple.  
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.  
<Example>  
<</BRStaple 0>>setpagedevice  
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2001/10/02  
3.1.6. PJL job offset on/off  
Format  
@PJL SET/DEFAULT JOBOFFSET=ON/OFF  
Parameter  
· ON:  
Paper is ejected offset by each job.  
Paper is ejected together.  
· OFF:  
Default = ON  
Explanation  
·
·
·
This command selects the job offset.  
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.  
The difference between the SET and DEFAULT selection and the effective period of this setting follow the  
PJL specifications.  
3.1.7. PS job offset on/off  
Command  
Parameter  
bool  
· True:  
Paper is ejected offset by each job.  
Paper is ejected together.  
· False:  
Default = false  
Explanation  
·
·
This command selects the job off set.  
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.  
<Example>  
<<BRjoboffset true>>setpagedevice  
3.1.8. PCL job separate (Esc&l1T)  
Command  
Esc&l1T (27)(38)(108)(49)(84) <1Bh><26h><6ch><31h><54h>  
Explanation  
·
·
This command separates the job.  
This command is ignored when the Finisher/Stapler unit is not available.  
APPENDIX E REFERENCE LIST OF FS-5050 SERIES UNIQUE COMMANDS - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Black Box Network Hardware GSHDSL Four Wire Ethernet Network Extender Kit User Manual
Black Decker Automobile Battery Charger 90556511 User Manual
Black Decker Bread Maker B1630 User Manual
Blodgett Range B24C FF User Manual
Blue Rhino Electric Heater 62900 User Manual
Boss Audio Systems Car Stereo System BV6450 User Manual
Broil King Griddle PCG 10 User Manual
Casio Video Game Keyboard CS 2X User Manual
CDA Washer CI230 User Manual
Chicago Electric Router 67119 User Manual